e10vk
Table of Contents

 
UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
Form 10-K
FOR ANNUAL AND TRANSITION REPORTS
PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
 
     
þ
  ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
    For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010
or
o
  TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
    For the transition period from          to          
 
Commission File Number 001-33289
ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
 
     
BERMUDA
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
  N/A
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)
P.O. Box HM 2267
Windsor Place, 3rd Floor, 18 Queen Street
Hamilton HM JX
Bermuda
(Address of principal executive offices, including zip code)
 
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (441) 292-3645
 
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
 
     
Title of Each Class   Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered
 
Ordinary shares, par value $1.00 per share
  The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC
 
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
None
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.  Yes o     No þ
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.  Yes o     No þ
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.  Yes þ     No o
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).  Yes o     No o
 
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.  þ
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):
 
Large accelerated filer o Accelerated filer þ Non-accelerated filer o Smaller reporting company o
(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).  Yes o     No þ
 
The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates, computed by reference to the closing price as of the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter, June 30, 2010, was approximately $455,419,690.
 
As of March 1, 2011, the registrant had outstanding 13,073,210 ordinary shares, $1.00 par value per share.
 
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
 
Portions of the registrant’s definitive proxy statement to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to Regulation 14A relating to its 2011 annual general meeting of shareholders are incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K.
 


 

 
Table of Contents
 
             
        Page
 
PART I
Item 1.   Business     3  
Item 1A.   Risk Factors     48  
Item 1B.   Unresolved Staff Comments     59  
Item 2.   Properties     60  
Item 3.   Legal Proceedings     61  
 
PART II
Item 5.   Market for the Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities     62  
Item 6.   Selected Financial Data     64  
Item 7.   Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations     66  
Item 7A.   Quantitative and Qualitative Information About Market Risk     108  
Item 8.   Financial Statements and Supplementary Data     111  
Item 9.   Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure     178  
Item 9A.   Controls and Procedures     178  
Item 9B.   Other Information     179  
 
PART III
Item 10.   Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant     181  
Item 11.   Executive Compensation     181  
Item 12.   Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters     181  
Item 13.   Certain Relationships and Related Transactions     181  
Item 14.   Principal Accountant Fees and Services     181  
 
PART IV
Item 15.   Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules     182  
 EX-10.24
 EXHIBIT 10.25
 EX-21.1
 EX-23.1
 EX-31.1
 EX-31.2
 EX-32.1
 EX-32.2


2


Table of Contents

 
PART I
 
ITEM 1.   BUSINESS
 
Company Overview
 
Enstar Group Limited, or Enstar, was formed in August 2001 under the laws of Bermuda to acquire and manage insurance and reinsurance companies in run-off and portfolios of insurance and reinsurance business in run-off, and to provide management, consulting and other services to the insurance and reinsurance industry. Since our formation, we have acquired 30 insurance and reinsurance companies and 15 portfolios of insurance and reinsurance business and are now administering those businesses in run-off. Insurance and reinsurance companies and portfolios of insurance and reinsurance business we acquire that are in run-off no longer underwrite new policies. We derive our net earnings from the ownership and management of these companies and portfolios of business in run-off primarily by settling insurance and reinsurance claims below the acquired value of loss reserves and from returns on the portfolio of investments retained to pay future claims. In addition, we provide management and consultancy services, claims inspection services and reinsurance collection services to our affiliates and third-party clients for both fixed and success-based fees.
 
Our primary corporate objective is to grow our net book value per share. We believe growth in our net book value is driven primarily by growth in our net earnings, which is in turn partially driven by successfully completing new acquisitions.
 
We evaluate each acquisition opportunity presented by carefully reviewing the portfolio’s risk exposures, claim practices, reserve requirements and outstanding claims, and may seek an appropriate discount and/or seller indemnification to reflect the uncertainty contained in the portfolio’s reserves. Based on this initial analysis, we can determine if a company or portfolio of business would add value to our current portfolio of run-off business. If we determine to pursue the purchase of a company in run-off, we then proceed to price the acquisition in a manner we believe will result in positive operating results based on certain assumptions including, without limitation, our ability to favorably resolve claims, negotiate with direct insureds and reinsurers, and otherwise manage the nature of the risks posed by the business.
 
Initially, at the time we acquire a company in run-off, we estimate the fair value of liabilities acquired based on external actuarial advice, as well as our own views of the exposures assumed. While we earn a larger share of our total return on an acquisition from commuting the liabilities that we have assumed, we also try to maximize reinsurance recoveries on the assumed portfolio.
 
In the primary (or direct) insurance business, the insurer assumes risk of loss from persons or organizations that are directly subject to the given risks. Such risks may relate to property, casualty, life, accident, health, financial or other perils that may arise from an insurable event. In the reinsurance business, the reinsurer agrees to indemnify an insurance or reinsurance company, referred to as the ceding company, against all or a portion of the insurance risks arising under the policies the ceding company has written or reinsured. When an insurer or reinsurer stops writing new insurance business, either entirely or with respect to a particular line of business, the insurer, reinsurer, or the line of discontinued business is in run-off.
 
In recent years, the insurance industry has experienced significant consolidation. As a result of this consolidation and other factors, the remaining participants in the industry often have portfolios of business that are either inconsistent with their core competency or provide excessive exposure to a particular risk or segment of the market (i.e. property/casualty, asbestos, environmental, director and officer liability, etc.). These non-core and/or discontinued portfolios are often associated with potentially large exposures and lengthy time periods before resolution of the last remaining insured claims resulting in significant uncertainty to the insurer or reinsurer covering those risks. These factors can distract management, drive up the cost of capital and surplus for the insurer or reinsurer, and negatively impact the insurer’s or reinsurer’s credit rating, which makes the disposal of the unwanted company or portfolio an attractive option. Alternatively, the insurer may wish to maintain the business on its balance sheet, yet not divert significant management attention to the run-off of the portfolio. The insurer or reinsurer, in either case, is likely to engage a third party, such as us, that specializes in run-off management to purchase the company or portfolio, or to manage the company or portfolio in run-off.


3


Table of Contents

In the sale of a run-off company, a purchaser, such as us, may pay a discount to the book value of the company based on the risks assumed and the relative value to the seller of no longer having to manage the company in run-off. Such a transaction can be beneficial to the seller because it receives an up-front payment for the company, eliminates the need for its management to devote any attention to the disposed company and removes the risk that the established reserves related to the run-off business may prove to be inadequate. The seller is also able to redeploy its management and financial resources to its core businesses.
 
In some situations an insurer or reinsurer may wish to divest itself of a portfolio of non-core legacy business that may have been underwritten alongside other ongoing core business that the insurer or reinsurer does not want to dispose of and so cannot sell the non-core business. In such instances we are able to provide economic finality for the insurer or reinsurer by providing a retroactive loss portfolio reinsurance contract to protect the insurer or reinsurer against deterioration of the subject portfolio of loss reserves. During 2010, we entered into eight loss portfolio reinsurance contracts.
 
We have entered into ten Reinsurance to Close, or “RITC” transactions, with Lloyd’s of London insurance and reinsurance syndicates in run-off, whereby the portfolio of run-off liabilities is transferred from one Lloyd’s syndicate to another.
 
Alternatively, if the insurer or reinsurer hires a third party, such as us, to manage its run-off business, the insurer or reinsurer will, unlike in a sale of the business, receive little or no cash up front. Instead, the management arrangement may provide that the insurer or reinsurer will retain the profits, if any, derived from the run-off with certain incentive payments allocated to the run-off manager. By hiring a run-off manager, the insurer or reinsurer can outsource the management of the run-off business to experienced and capable individuals, while allowing its own management team to focus on the insurer’s or reinsurer’s core businesses. Our desired approach to managing run-off business is to align our interests with the interests of the owners through both fixed management fees and certain incentive payments. Under certain management arrangements to which we are a party, however, we receive only a fixed management fee and do not receive any incentive payments.
 
Following the purchase of a run-off company, or acquisition of a portfolio of business in run-off, or the engagement to manage a run-off company or portfolio of business, it is incumbent on the new owner or manager to conduct the run-off in a disciplined and professional manner in order to efficiently discharge the liabilities associated with the business while preserving and maximizing its assets. Our approach to managing our acquired companies in run-off, as well as run-off companies or portfolios of businesses on behalf of third-party clients, includes negotiating with third-party insureds and reinsureds to commute their insurance or reinsurance agreement (sometimes called policy buy-backs) for an agreed upon up-front payment by us, or the third-party client, and to more efficiently manage payment of insurance and reinsurance claims. We attempt to commute policies with direct insureds or reinsureds in order to eliminate uncertainty over the amount of future claims. Commutations and policy buy-backs provide an opportunity for the company to exit exposures to certain policies and insureds generally at a discount to the ultimate liability and provide the ability to eliminate exposure to further losses. Such a strategy also contributes to the reduction in the length of time and future cost of the run-off.
 
Following the acquisition of a company in run-off, or acquisition of a portfolio of business in run-off, or new consulting engagement, we will spend time analyzing the acquired exposures and reinsurance receivables on a policyholder-by-policyholder basis. This analysis enables us to identify those policyholders and reinsurers we wish to approach to discuss commutation or policy buy-back. Furthermore, following the acquisition of a company or portfolio of business in run-off, or new consulting engagement, we will often be approached by policyholders or reinsurers requesting commutation or policy buy-back. In these instances we will also carry out a full analysis of the underlying exposures in order to determine the viability of a proposed commutation or policy buy-back. From the initial analysis of the underlying exposures it may take several months, or even years, before a commutation or policy buy-back is completed. In a number of cases, if we and the policyholder or reinsurer are unable to reach a commercially acceptable settlement, the commutation or policy buy-back may not be achievable, in which case we will continue to settle valid claims from the policyholder, or collect reinsurance receivables from the reinsurer, as they become due.
 
Insureds and reinsureds are often willing to commute with us, subject to receiving an acceptable settlement, as this provides certainty of recovery of what otherwise may be claims that are disputed in the future, and often


4


Table of Contents

provides a meaningful up-front cash receipt that, with the associated investment income, can provide funds to meet future claim payments or even commutation of their underlying exposure. Therefore, subject to negotiating an acceptable settlement, all of our insurance and reinsurance liabilities and reinsurance receivables are able to be either commuted or settled by way of policy buy-back over time. Many sellers of companies that we acquire have secure claims paying ratings and ongoing underwriting relationships with insureds and reinsureds, which often hinders their ability to commute the underlying insurance or reinsurance policies. Our lack of claims paying rating and our lack of potential conflicts with insureds and reinsureds of companies we acquire provides a greater ability to commute the newly acquired policies than that of the sellers.
 
We also attempt, where appropriate, to negotiate favorable commutations with reinsurers by securing the receipt of a lump-sum settlement from the reinsurer in complete satisfaction of the reinsurer’s liability in respect of any future claims. We, or the third-party client, are then fully responsible for any claims in the future. We typically invest proceeds from reinsurance commutations with the expectation that such investments will produce income, which, together with the principal, will be sufficient to satisfy future obligations with respect to the acquired company or portfolio.
 
Strategy
 
We aim to maximize our growth in net book value per share by using the following strategies:
 
  •  Solidify Our Leadership Position in the Run-Off Market by Leveraging Management’s Experience and Relationships.  We continue to utilize the extensive experience and significant relationships of our senior management team to solidify our position as a leader in the run-off segment of the insurance and reinsurance market. The experience and reputation of our management team is expected to generate opportunities for us to acquire or manage companies and portfolios in run-off, and to price effectively the acquisition or management of such businesses. Most importantly, we believe the experience of our management team will continue to allow us to manage the run-off of such businesses efficiently and profitably.
 
  •  Professionally Manage Claims.  We are professional and disciplined in managing claims against companies and portfolios we own or manage. Our management understands the need to dispose of certain risks expeditiously and cost-effectively by constantly analyzing changes in the market and efficiently settling claims with the assistance of our experienced claims adjusters and in-house and external legal counsel. When we acquire or begin managing a company or portfolio, we initially determine which claims are valid through the use of experienced in-house adjusters and claims experts. We pay valid claims on a timely basis, while relying on well-documented policy terms and exclusions where applicable and litigation when necessary to defend against paying invalid claims under existing policies and reinsurance agreements.
 
  •  Commute Assumed Liabilities and Ceded Reinsurance Assets.  Using detailed analysis and actuarial projections, we negotiate with the policyholders of the insurance and reinsurance companies or portfolios we own or manage with a goal of commuting insurance and reinsurance liabilities for one or more agreed upon payments at a discount to the ultimate liability. Such commutations can take the form of policy buy-backs and structured settlements over fixed periods of time. By acquiring companies that are direct insurers, reinsurers or both, we are able to negotiate favorable entity-wide commutations with reinsurers that would not be possible if our subsidiaries had remained independent entities. We also negotiate with reinsurers to commute their reinsurance agreements providing coverage to our subsidiaries on terms that we believe to be favorable based on then-current market knowledge. We invest the proceeds from reinsurance commutations with the expectation that such investments will produce income, which, together with the principal, will be sufficient to satisfy future obligations with respect to the acquired company or portfolio.
 
  •  Continue to Commit to Highly Disciplined Acquisition, Management and Reinsurance Practices.  We utilize a disciplined approach to minimize risk and increase the probability of positive operating results from companies and portfolios we acquire or manage. We carefully review acquisition candidates and management engagements for consistency with accomplishing our long-term objective of producing positive operating results. We focus our investigation on risk exposures, claims practices and reserve requirements. In particular, we carefully review all outstanding claims and case reserves, and follow a highly disciplined


5


Table of Contents

  approach to managing allocated loss adjustment expenses, such as the cost of defense counsel, expert witnesses and related fees and expenses.
 
  •  Prudent Management of Investments and Capital.  We strive to structure our investments in a manner that recognizes our liquidity needs for future liabilities. In that regard, we attempt to correlate the maturity and duration of our investment portfolio to our general liability profile. If our liquidity needs or general liability profile unexpectedly change, we may not continue to structure our investment portfolio in its current manner and would adjust as necessary to meet new business needs. We pursue prudent capital management relative to our risk exposure and liquidity requirements to maximize profitability and long-term growth in shareholder value. Our capital management strategy is to deploy capital efficiently to acquisitions and to establish, and re-establish when necessary, adequate loss reserves to protect against future adverse developments.
 
Recent Transactions
 
Claremont
 
On December 31, 2010, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, CLIC Holdings, Inc., completed the acquisition of Claremont Liability Insurance Company, or Claremont, for an aggregate purchase price of $13.9 million. Claremont is a California-domiciled insurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.
 
CIGNA Reinsurance
 
On December 31, 2010, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Fitzwilliam Insurance Limited, or Fitzwilliam, entered into a 100% reinsurance agreement, administrative services agreement, and related transaction documents with three affiliates of CIGNA Corporation, or CIGNA affiliates, pursuant to which Fitzwilliam reinsured all of the run-off workers compensation and personal accident reinsurance business of those CIGNA affiliates. Pursuant to the transaction documents, the CIGNA affiliates have transferred assets into three reinsurance collateral trusts securing the obligations of Fitzwilliam under the reinsurance agreement and administrative services agreement. Fitzwilliam received total assets and assumed total net reinsurance reserves of approximately $190.5 million. Fitzwilliam transferred approximately $50 million of additional funds to the trusts to further support these obligations. We funded the contribution to the trusts through a draw on a new $115 million credit facility entered into with Barclays Bank PLC on December 29, 2010.
 
In addition to the trusts, we have provided a limited parental guarantee supporting certain obligations of Fitzwilliam in the amount of $79.7 million. The amount of the guarantee will increase or decrease over time under certain circumstances, but will always be subject to an overall maximum cap with respect to reinsurance liabilities.
 
Clarendon
 
On December 22, 2010, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Clarendon Holdings, Inc., entered into a definitive agreement for the purchase of Clarendon National Insurance Company, or Clarendon, from Clarendon Insurance Group, Inc., an affiliate of Hannover Re. Clarendon is a New Jersey-domiciled insurer that is in run-off. The purchase price is approximately $200 million and will be financed in part by a bank loan facility provided by a London-based bank entered into on March 4, 2011 and in part from available cash on hand. Completion of the transaction is conditioned on, among other things, regulatory approval and satisfaction of various customary closing conditions. The transaction is expected to close in the second quarter of 2011.
 
Inter-Hannover Reinsurance
 
On December 3, 2010, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Fitzwilliam, entered into a 100% quota share reinsurance agreement with International Insurance Company of Hannover, or IICH, with respect to a specific portfolio of run-off business. Fitzwilliam received total assets and assumed total net reinsurance reserves of approximately $137.1 million. In addition, we provided a parental guarantee supporting the IICH obligations of Fitzwilliam in the amount of approximately £76.0 million (approximately $118.7 million). The amount of the guarantee will decrease over time in line with relevant independent actuarial assessments.


6


Table of Contents

New Castle
 
On December 3, 2010, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Kenmare Holdings Ltd., or Kenmare, completed the acquisition of New Castle Reinsurance Company Ltd., or New Castle, for an aggregate purchase price of $22.0 million. New Castle is a Bermuda-domiciled insurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.
 
CitiLife
 
On November 8, 2010, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Kenmare, entered into a definitive agreement for the purchase of CitiLife Financial Limited from Citigroup Insurance Holding Corporation, an affiliate of Citigroup Inc. CitiLife Financial Limited is a Dublin, Ireland-based life insurer that is in run-off. The purchase price is €30 million (approximately $40.2 million) and is expected to be financed from available cash on hand. Completion of the transaction is conditioned on, among other things, regulatory approval and satisfaction of various customary closing conditions. The transaction is expected to close in the first quarter of 2011.
 
Brampton (formerly Aioi Europe)
 
In March 2006, we and Shinsei Bank, Ltd., or Shinsei, through Hillcot Holdings Ltd., or Hillcot, completed the acquisition of Brampton Insurance Company of Europe Limited, or Brampton, a London-based subsidiary of Aioi Insurance Company Limited. Brampton underwrote general insurance and reinsurance business in Europe for its own account from 1982 until 2002 when it generally ceased underwriting and placed its general insurance and reinsurance business into run-off. The aggregate purchase price paid for Brampton was £62.0 million (approximately $108.9 million), with £50.0 million in cash paid upon the closing of the transaction and £12.0 million in the form of a promissory note, payable twelve months from the date of the closing. In April 2006, Hillcot borrowed approximately $44.0 million from a London-based bank to partially assist with the financing of the Brampton acquisition. Following a repurchase by Brampton of its shares valued at £40.0 million in May 2006, Hillcot repaid the promissory note and reduced the bank borrowing to $19.2 million, which was repaid in May 2008.
 
On November 2, 2010, we acquired the 49.9% of the shares of Hillcot from Shinsei that we did not previously own for a purchase price of $38.0 million, resulting in us owning 100% of Hillcot. At the time of acquisition, Hillcot owned 100% of the shares of Brampton. The fair value of the assets acquired that we did not previously own was $34.9 million. The excess of the purchase price over the fair value of assets acquired in the amount of $3.1 million was recorded as a charge to additional paid-in capital in accordance with the applicable guidance of accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America, or U.S. GAAP. J. Christopher Flowers, a member of our board of directors and one of our largest shareholders, is a director and the largest shareholder of Shinsei.
 
Sale of Interest in Stonewall and Acquisition of Seaton
 
On June 13, 2008, our indirect subsidiary, Virginia Holdings Ltd., or Virginia, completed the acquisition from Dukes Place Holdings, L.P. (a portfolio company of GSC European Mezzanine Fund II, L.P.) of 44.4% of the outstanding capital stock of Stonewall Acquisition Corporation, or SAC, which at that time was the parent of two Rhode Island-domiciled insurers in run-off, Stonewall Insurance Company and Seaton Insurance Company, or Seaton. The total purchase price, including acquisition costs, was $21.4 million and was funded from available cash on hand. SAC entered into a definitive agreement on December 3, 2009 for the sale of its shares in Stonewall Insurance Company to Columbia Insurance Company, an affiliate of National Indemnity Company (an indirect subsidiary of Berkshire Hathaway, Inc.), for a sale price of $56.0 million, subject to certain post-closing purchase price adjustments that brought the total consideration received to $60.4 million. The transaction received the required regulatory approval on March 31, 2010 and subsequently closed on April 7, 2010. The proceeds received by SAC and certain other assets were distributed between Dukes Place Holdings, L.P. and Virginia. The proceeds received by Virginia included the shares of Seaton distributed on August 3, 2010, resulting in Virginia owning 100% of Seaton following the distribution (prior to the distribution, Virginia had indirectly owned 44.4% of Seaton through its holdings in SAC).


7


Table of Contents

Providence Washington
 
On July 20, 2010, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary PWAC Holdings, Inc., completed the acquisition of PW Acquisition Company, or PWAC, for a purchase price of $25.0 million. PWAC owns the entire share capital of Providence Washington Insurance Company. Providence Washington Insurance Company and its two subsidiaries are Rhode Island-domiciled insurers that are in run-off. The purchase price was financed by a term facility provided by a London-based bank, or the EGL Facility, which was fully repaid in September 2010.
 
Torus Reinsurance
 
In July 2010, following the acquisition of the entire issued share capital of Glacier Insurance AG by Torus Insurance (Bermuda) Limited, or Torus, Fitzwilliam entered into two quota share reinsurance agreements with Torus protecting the prior year reserve development of two portfolios of business reinsured by them: a 79% quota share of Torus’ 95% quota share reinsurance of Glacier Insurance AG, and a 75% quota share of Torus’ 100% quota share reinsurance of Glacier Reinsurance AG. Fitzwilliam received total assets and assumed total gross reinsurance reserves of approximately $105.0 million.
 
Bosworth
 
In May 2010, a specific portfolio of business in run-off underwritten by Mitsui Sumitomo Insurance Co., Ltd. of Japan, or Mitsui, was transferred to our 50.1% owned subsidiary, Bosworth Run-off Limited, or Bosworth. This transfer, which occurred under Part VII of the U.K. Financial Services and Markets Act 2000, was approved by the U.K. Court and took effect on May 31, 2010. As a result of the transfer, Bosworth received total assets and assumed net reinsurance reserves of approximately $117.5 million. Shinsei owns the remaining 49.9% of Bosworth.
 
Assuransinvest
 
On March 30, 2010, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Nordic Run-Off Limited, completed the acquisition of Forsakringsaktiebolaget Assuransinvest MF, or Assuransinvest, for a purchase price of SEK 78.8 million (approximately $11.0 million). Assuransinvest is a Swedish-domiciled reinsurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.
 
Knapton Insurance (formerly British Engine)
 
On March 2, 2010, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Knapton Holdings Limited, or Knapton Holdings, completed the acquisition of Knapton Insurance Limited, formerly British Engine Insurance Limited, or Knapton, from RSA Insurance Group plc for a total purchase price of £28.8 million (approximately $44.0 million). Knapton is a U.K.-domiciled reinsurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.
 
In April 2010, Knapton Holdings entered into a term facility agreement with a London-based bank, or the Knapton Facility. On April 20, 2010, Knapton Holdings drew down $21.4 million from the Knapton Facility.
 
Allianz Reinsurance
 
In February 2010, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Fitzwilliam, entered into a 100% quota share reinsurance agreement with Allianz Global Corporate & Specialty AG (UK) Branch, or Allianz, with respect to a specific portfolio of run-off business of Allianz. Fitzwilliam received total assets and assumed total gross reinsurance reserves of approximately $112.6 million.
 
Shelbourne RITC Transactions
 
In December 2007, we, in conjunction with JCF FPK I L.P., or JCF FPK, and a newly-hired executive management team, formed U.K.-based Shelbourne Group Limited, or Shelbourne, to invest in RITC transactions (the transferring of liabilities from one Lloyd’s syndicate to another) with Lloyd’s of London insurance and reinsurance syndicates in run-off. We own approximately 56.8% of Shelbourne, which in turn owns 100% of Shelbourne Syndicate Services Limited, the Managing Agency for Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008, a syndicate approved by Lloyd’s of London on December 16, 2007 to undertake RITC transactions with Lloyd’s syndicates in run-off.


8


Table of Contents

JCF FPK is a joint investment program between J.C. Flowers II L.P., or the Flowers Fund, and Fox-Pitt Kelton Cochran Caronia & Waller (USA) LLC, or FPK. The Flowers Fund is a private investment fund advised by J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC. J. Christopher Flowers, a member of our board of directors and one of our largest shareholders, is the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC. John J. Oros, who served as our Executive Chairman and a member of our board of directors until his resignation on August 20, 2010, is a Managing Director of J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC. In addition, an affiliate of the Flowers Fund controlled approximately 41% of FPK until its sale of FPK in December 2009.
 
Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 has, to date, entered into ten RITC agreements with Lloyd’s syndicates, inclusive of two agreements entered into in February 2011. In February 2008, Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 entered into RITC agreements with four Lloyd’s syndicates with total gross insurance reserves of approximately $471.2 million. In February 2009, Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 entered into a RITC agreement with a Lloyd’s syndicate with total gross insurance reserves of approximately $67.0 million. During 2010, Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 entered into RITC agreements with three Lloyd’s syndicates with total gross insurance reserves of approximately $192.6 million. In February 2011, Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 entered into RITC agreements with two Lloyd’s syndicates with total gross insurance reserves of approximately $129.6 million.
 
The capital commitment to Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008, at February 28, 2011, amounted to £80.1 million (approximately $125.1 million) and was financed by approximately £47.4 million (approximately $74.0 million) from available cash on hand; £19.0 million (approximately $29.7 million) from a letter of credit issued by a London-based bank that has been secured by a parental guarantee from us; approximately £5.2 million (approximately $8.1 million) from the Flowers Fund (acting in its own capacity and not through JCF FPK) by way of non-voting equity participation; and approximately £8.5 million (approximately $13.3 million) from JCF FPK.
 
Copenhagen Re
 
On October 15, 2009, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Marlon Insurance Company Limited, completed the acquisition of Copenhagen Reinsurance Company Ltd., or Copenhagen Re, from Alm. Brand Forsikring A/S for a total purchase price, including acquisition costs, of DKK149.2 million (approximately $29.9 million). Copenhagen Re is a Danish-domiciled reinsurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.
 
Constellation
 
On January 31, 2009, we, through our indirect subsidiary, Sun Gulf Holdings Inc., completed the acquisition of all of the outstanding capital stock of Constellation Reinsurance Company Limited, or Constellation, for a total purchase price of approximately $2.5 million. Constellation is a New York-domiciled reinsurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.
 
Unionamerica
 
On December 30, 2008, our indirect subsidiary Royston Run-Off Limited, or Royston, completed the acquisition of all of the outstanding capital stock of Unionamerica Holdings Limited, or Unionamerica, from St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company, an affiliate of The Travelers Companies, Inc., or Travelers. Unionamerica is comprised of the discontinued operations of Travelers’ U.K.-based London Market business, which were placed into run-off between 1992 and 2003. The total purchase price, including acquisition costs, of $343.4 million was financed by approximately $184.6 million from a credit facility provided by a London-based bank; approximately $49.8 million from the Flowers Fund by way of its non-voting equity interest in Royston Holdings Ltd., the direct parent company of Royston; and the remainder from available cash on hand. In December 2010, approximately $114.0 million of the credit facility was repaid and, on March 3, 2011, another $40.5 million of the credit facility was repaid.
 
Hillcot Re
 
On October 27, 2008, our wholly-owned subsidiary Kenmare, purchased the entire issued share capital of Hillcot Re Ltd., or Hillcot Re, the wholly-owned subsidiary of Hillcot for a total purchase price, including acquisition costs, of $54.7 million. Prior to the completion of the transaction, we owned 50.1% of the outstanding share capital of Hillcot


9


Table of Contents

and Shinsei owned the remaining 49.9%. Upon completion of the transaction, Hillcot paid a distribution to Shinsei of approximately $27.1 million representing its 49.9% share of the consideration. The total purchase price of $54.7 million was funded from available cash on hand. Hillcot Re is a U.K.-based reinsurer that is in run-off.
 
Capital Assurance
 
On August 18, 2008, we completed the acquisition of all of the outstanding capital stock of Capital Assurance Company Inc. and Capital Assurance Services, Inc. for a total purchase price, including acquisition costs, of approximately $5.6 million. Capital Assurance Company, Inc. is a Florida-domiciled insurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.
 
EPIC
 
On August 14, 2008, we completed the acquisition of all of the outstanding capital stock of Electricity Producers Insurance Company (Bermuda) Limited, or EPIC, from its parent British Nuclear Fuels plc. The total purchase price, including acquisition costs, of £36.8 million (approximately $69.0 million) was financed by approximately $32.8 million from a credit facility provided by a London-based bank; approximately $10.2 million from the Flowers Fund by way of non-voting equity participation; and the remainder from available cash on hand. In October 2008, we fully repaid the outstanding principal and accrued interest on the credit facility.
 
Goshawk
 
On June 20, 2008 we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary Enstar Acquisitions Limited, or EAL, announced a cash offer to all of the shareholders of Goshawk Insurance Holdings Plc, or Goshawk, at 5.2 pence (approximately $0.103) for each share, or the Offer, conditioned on, among other things, receiving acceptance from shareholders owning 90% of the shares of Goshawk. Goshawk owns Rosemont Reinsurance Limited, a Bermuda-based reinsurer that wrote primarily property and marine business, which was placed into run-off in October 2005. The Offer valued Goshawk at approximately £45.7 million in the aggregate.
 
On July 17, 2008, after acquiring more than 30% of the shares of Goshawk through market purchases, EAL was obligated to remove all of the conditions of the Offer except for the receipt of acceptances from shareholders owning 50% of the shares of Goshawk. On July 25, 2008, the acceptance condition was met and the Offer became unconditional. On August 19, 2008, the Offer closed with shareholders representing approximately 89.44% of Goshawk accepting the Offer for total consideration of £40.9 million (approximately $80.9 million).
 
The total purchase price, including acquisition costs, of approximately $82.0 million was financed by a drawdown of $36.1 million from a credit facility provided by a London-based bank, a contribution of $11.7 million of the acquisition price from the Flowers Fund, by way of non-voting equity participation, and the remainder from available cash on hand.
 
In connection with the acquisition, Goshawk’s existing bank loan of $16.3 million was refinanced by the drawdown of $12.2 million (net of fees) from a credit facility provided by a London-based bank and $4.1 million from the Flowers Fund. In December 2009, we fully repaid the outstanding principal and interest on the credit facility.
 
On November 26, 2009, we acquired an additional 10.01% of the outstanding shares that we did not previously own for a purchase price of approximately $4.7 million. We now own 99.45% of the outstanding shares of Goshawk.
 
Gordian
 
On March 5, 2008, we completed the acquisition of AMP Limited’s, or AMP’s, Australian-based closed reinsurance and insurance operations, or Gordian. The purchase price, including acquisition expenses, of approximately AU$436.9 million (approximately $405.4 million) was financed by approximately AU$301.0 million (approximately $276.5 million), including an arrangement fee of AU$4.5 million (approximately $4.2 million), from bank financing provided jointly by a London-based bank and a German bank (the Flowers Fund is a significant shareholder of the German bank); approximately AU$41.6 million (approximately $39.5 million) from the Flowers Fund, by way of non-voting equity participation; and approximately AU$98.7 million (approximately $93.6 million) from available cash on hand. In September 2010, the remaining balance of the outstanding facility was repaid in full.


10


Table of Contents

Guildhall
 
On February 29, 2008, we completed the acquisition of Guildhall Insurance Company Limited, or Guildhall, a U.K.-based reinsurance company that has been in run-off since 1986. The purchase price, including acquisition expenses, of approximately £33.4 million (approximately $65.9 million) was financed by the drawdown of approximately £16.5 million (approximately $32.5 million) from a U.S. dollar facility loan agreement with a London-based bank; approximately £5.0 million (approximately $10.0 million) from the Flowers Fund, by way of non-voting equity participation; and approximately £11.9 million (approximately $23.5 million) from available cash on hand. In September 2008, the facility loan was repaid in full.
 
Marlon
 
On August 28, 2007, we completed the acquisition of Marlon Insurance Company Limited, a reinsurance company in run-off, and Marlon Management Services Limited for a total purchase price, including acquisition costs, of approximately $31.2 million, which was funded by $15.3 million borrowed under a facility loan agreement with a London-based bank and available cash on hand. Marlon Insurance Company Limited and Marlon Management Services Limited are both U.K.-based companies. In February 2008, the facility loan was repaid in full.
 
Tate & Lyle
 
On June 12, 2007, we completed the acquisition of Tate & Lyle Reinsurance Ltd., or Tate & Lyle, for a total purchase price, including acquisition costs, of approximately $5.9 million funded from available cash on hand. Tate & Lyle is a Bermuda-based reinsurance company in run-off.
 
Inter-Ocean
 
On February 23, 2007, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary Oceania Holdings Ltd, or Oceania, completed the acquisition of Inter-Ocean Holdings Ltd., or Inter-Ocean. The total purchase price, including acquisition costs, was approximately $57.5 million, which was funded by $26.8 million borrowed under a facility loan agreement with a London-based bank and available cash on hand. Inter-Ocean owns two reinsurers, one based in Bermuda and one based in Ireland. Both of these companies wrote international reinsurance and had in place retrocessional policies providing for the full reinsurance of all of the risks they assumed. In October 2007, Oceania repaid its bank debt in full.
 
The Enstar Group, Inc.
 
On January 31, 2007, we completed the merger, or the Merger, of CWMS Subsidiary Corp. with and into The Enstar Group, Inc., or EGI, and, as a result, EGI, renamed Enstar USA, Inc., is now our wholly-owned subsidiary. Prior to the Merger, EGI owned approximately 32% economic and 50% voting interests in us. As a result of the completion of the Merger, B.H. Acquisition Ltd. is now our wholly-owned subsidiary.
 
Unione
 
In November 2006, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary Virginia, purchased Unione Italiana (U.K.) Reinsurance Company Limited, or Unione, a U.K. company, for approximately $17.4 million. Unione underwrote business from the 1940’s though to 1995. Prior to acquisition, Unione closed the majority of its portfolio by way of a solvent scheme of arrangement in the U.K. Unione’s remaining business is a portfolio of international insurance and reinsurance which has been in run-off since 1971.
 
Cavell
 
In October 2006, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary Virginia, purchased Cavell Holdings Limited (U.K.), or Cavell, for approximately £31.8 million (approximately $60.9 million). Cavell owns a U.K. reinsurance company and a Norwegian reinsurer, both of which wrote portfolios of international reinsurance business and went into run-off in 1993 and 1992, respectively. The purchase price was funded by $24.5 million borrowed under a


11


Table of Contents

facility loan agreement with a London-based bank and available cash on hand. In February 2008, Virginia repaid its bank debt in full.
 
Share Repurchase
 
On October 1, 2010, we entered into share repurchase agreements, or the Repurchase Agreements, with three of our executives and certain trusts and a corporation affiliated with the executives to repurchase an aggregate of 800,000 of our ordinary shares at a price of $70.00 per share. We repurchased an aggregate of 600,000 ordinary shares from Dominic F. Silvester (our Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board of Directors) and a trust of which he and his immediate family are the sole beneficiaries, 100,000 ordinary shares from a trust of which Paul J. O’Shea (our Joint Chief Operating Officer, Executive Vice President and a member of our Board of Directors) and his immediate family are the sole beneficiaries and 100,000 ordinary shares from a corporation owned by a trust of which Nicholas A. Packer (our Joint Chief Operating Officer and Executive Vice President) and his immediate family are the sole beneficiaries. The repurchase transactions closed on October 14, 2010. The aggregate purchase price of $56.0 million is payable by us through promissory notes to the selling shareholders. The annual interest rate for the notes is fixed at 3.5%, and the notes are repayable in three equal installments on December 31, 2010, December 1, 2011 and December 1, 2012. In connection with the Repurchase Agreements, we entered into lock-up agreements with each of Messrs. Silvester, O’Shea and Packer, and their respective family trusts and corporation. The lock-up agreements prohibit future sales and transfers of shares now owned or subsequently acquired for two years from the date of the Repurchase Agreements.
 
Share Offering
 
In July 2008, we completed the sale to the public of 1,372,028 newly-issued ordinary shares, inclusive of the underwriters’ over-allotment, or the Offering. The shares were priced at $87.50 per share and we received net proceeds of approximately $116.8 million, after underwriting fees and other expenses of approximately $3.3 million. FPK served as lead managing underwriter in the Offering. The Flowers Fund and certain of its affiliated investment partnerships purchased 285,714 ordinary shares with a value of approximately $25.0 million in the Offering at the public offering price. An affiliate of the Flowers Fund controlled approximately 41% of FPK until its sale of FPK in December 2009.
 
Management of Run-Off Portfolios
 
We are a party to several management engagements pursuant to which we have agreed to manage the run-off portfolios of third parties with gross loss reserves, as of December 31, 2010, of approximately $658.4 million. Such arrangements are advantageous for third-party insurers because they allow a third-party insurer to focus their management efforts on their core competency while allowing them to maintain the portfolio of business on their balance sheet. In addition, our expertise in managing portfolios in run-off allows the third-party insurer the opportunity to potentially realize positive operating results if we achieve our objectives in management of the run-off portfolio. We specialize in the collection of reinsurance receivables through our subsidiary Kinsale Brokers Limited. Through our subsidiaries, Enstar (US) Inc. and Cranmore Adjusters Limited, we also specialize in providing claims inspection services whereby we are engaged by third-party insurance and reinsurance providers to review certain of their existing insurance and reinsurance exposures, relationships, policies and/or claims history.
 
Our primary objective in structuring our management arrangements is to align the third-party insurer’s interests with our interests. Consequently, management agreements typically are structured so that we receive fixed fees in connection with the management of the run-off portfolio and also typically receive certain incentive payments based on a portfolio’s positive operating results. These agreements do not include the recurring engagements managed by our claims inspection and reinsurance collection subsidiaries, Cranmore Adjusters Limited, Enstar (US), Inc. and Kinsale Brokers Limited, respectively.
 
Claims Management and Administration
 
An integral factor to our success is our ability to analyze, administer, manage and settle claims and related expenses, such as loss adjustment expenses. Our claims teams are located in different offices within our


12


Table of Contents

organization and provide global claims support. We have implemented effective claims handling guidelines along with claims reporting and control procedures in all of our claims units. To ensure that claims are appropriately handled and reported in accordance with these guidelines, all claims matters are reviewed regularly, with all material claims matters being circulated to and authorized by management prior to any action being taken.
 
When we receive notice of a claim, regardless of size and regardless of whether it is a paid claim request or a reserve advice, it is reviewed and recorded within the claims system, reserving our rights where appropriate. Claims reserve movements and payments are reviewed daily, with any material movements being reported to management for review. This enables “flash reporting” of significant events and potential insurance or reinsurance losses to be communicated to senior management worldwide on a timely basis irrespective from which geographical location or business unit location the exposure arises.
 
We are also able to efficiently manage claims and obtain savings through our extensive relationships with defense counsel (both in-house and external), third-party claims administrators and other professional advisors and experts. We have developed relationships and protocols to reduce the number of outside counsel by consolidating claims of similar types and complexity with experienced law firms specializing in the particular type of claim. This approach has enabled us to more efficiently manage outside counsel and other third parties, thereby reducing expenses, and to establish closer relationships with ceding companies.
 
When appropriate, we negotiate with direct insureds to buy back policies either on favorable terms or to mitigate against existing and/or potential future indemnity exposures and legal costs in an uncertain and constantly evolving legal environment. We also pursue commutations on favorable terms with ceding companies of reinsurance business in order to realize savings or to mitigate against potential future indemnity exposures and legal costs. Such buy-backs and commutations typically eliminate all past, present and future liability to direct insureds and reinsureds in return for a lump sum payment.
 
With regard to reinsurance receivables, we manage cash flow by working with reinsurers, brokers and professional advisors to achieve fair and prompt payment of reinsured claims, taking appropriate legal action to secure receivables where necessary. We also attempt where appropriate to negotiate favorable commutations with our reinsurers by securing a lump sum settlement from reinsurers in complete satisfaction of the reinsurer’s past, present and future liability in respect of such claims. Properly priced commutations reduce the expense of adjusting direct claims and pursuing collection of reinsurance receivables (both of which may often involve extensive legal expense), realize savings, remove the potential future volatility of claims and reduce required regulatory capital.
 
Reserves for Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expense
 
Applicable insurance laws and generally accepted accounting practices require us to maintain reserves to cover our estimated losses under insurance policies that we have assumed and for loss adjustment expense, or LAE, relating to the investigation, administration and settlement of policy claims. Our LAE reserves consist of both reserves for allocated loss adjustment expenses, or ALAE, and for unallocated loss adjustment expenses, or ULAE. ALAE are linked to the settlement of an individual claim or loss, whereas ULAE reserve is based on our estimates of future costs to administer the claims.
 
We and our subsidiaries establish losses and LAE reserves for individual claims by evaluating reported claims on the basis of:
 
  •  our knowledge of the circumstances surrounding the claim;
 
  •  the severity of the injury or damage;
 
  •  the jurisdiction of the occurrence;
 
  •  the potential for ultimate exposure;
 
  •  the type of loss; and
 
  •  our experience with the line of business and policy provisions relating to the particular type of claim.


13


Table of Contents

 
Because a significant amount of time can lapse between the assumption of risk, the occurrence of a loss event, the reporting of the event to an insurance or reinsurance company and the ultimate payment of the claim on the loss event, the liability for unpaid losses and LAE is based largely upon estimates. Our management must use considerable judgment in the process of developing these estimates. The liability for unpaid losses and LAE for property and casualty business includes amounts determined from loss reports on individual cases and amounts for losses incurred but not reported, or IBNR. Such reserves, including IBNR reserves, are estimated by management based upon loss reports received from ceding companies, supplemented by our own estimates of losses for which no ceding company loss reports have yet been received.
 
In establishing reserves, management also considers actuarial estimates of ultimate losses. Our independent actuaries employ generally accepted actuarial methodologies and procedures to estimate ultimate losses and loss adjustment expenses. Our loss reserves are largely related to casualty exposures including latent exposures primarily relating to asbestos and environmental, or A&E, as discussed below. In establishing the reserves for unpaid claims, management considers facts currently known and the current state of the law and coverage litigation. Liabilities are recognized for known claims (including the cost of related litigation) when sufficient information has been developed to indicate the involvement of a specific insurance policy, and management can reasonably estimate its liability. In addition, reserves are established to cover loss development related to both known and unasserted claims.
 
The estimation of unpaid claim liabilities is subject to a high degree of uncertainty for a number of reasons. Unpaid claim liabilities for property and casualty exposures in general are impacted by changes in the legal environment, jury awards, medical cost trends and general inflation. Moreover, for latent exposures in particular, developed case law and adequate claims history do not exist. There is significant coverage litigation involved with these exposures which creates further uncertainty in the estimation of the liabilities. Therefore, for these types of exposures, it is especially unclear whether past claim experience will be representative of future claim experience. Ultimate values for such claims cannot be estimated using reserving techniques that extrapolate losses to an ultimate basis using loss development factors, and the uncertainties surrounding the estimation of unpaid claim liabilities are not likely to be resolved in the near future. There can be no assurance that the reserves established by us will be adequate or will not be adversely affected by the development of other latent exposures. The actuarial methods used to estimate ultimate loss and ALAE for our latent exposures are discussed below.
 
For the non-latent loss exposures, a range of traditional loss development extrapolation techniques is applied. Incremental paid and incurred loss development methodologies are the most commonly used methods. Traditional cumulative paid and incurred loss development methods are used where inception-to-date, cumulative paid and reported incurred loss development history is available. These methods assume that groups of losses from similar exposures will increase over time in a predictable manner. Historical paid and incurred loss development experience is examined for earlier underwriting years to make inferences about how later underwriting years’ losses will develop. Where company-specific loss information is not available or not reliable, industry loss development information published by reliable industry sources such as the Reinsurance Association of America is considered.
 
The reserving process is intended to reflect the impact of inflation and other factors affecting loss payments by taking into account changes in historical payment patterns and perceived trends. However, there is no precise method for the subsequent evaluation of the adequacy of the consideration given to inflation, or to any other specific factor, or to the way one factor may affect another.
 
The loss development tables below show changes in our gross and net loss reserves in subsequent years from the prior loss estimates based on experience as of the end of each succeeding year. The estimate is increased or decreased as more information becomes known about the frequency and severity of losses for individual years. A redundancy means the original estimate was higher than the current estimate; a deficiency means that the current estimate is higher than the original estimate. The “Reserve redundancy” line represents, as of the date indicated, the difference between the latest re-estimated liability and the reserves as originally estimated.
 


14


Table of Contents

                                                                                 
Gross Loss and Loss
                                       
Adjustment Expense
  Year Ended December 31,
Reserves   2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009   2010
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 
Reserves assumed
  $ 419,717     $ 284,409     $ 381,531     $ 1,047,313     $ 806,559     $ 1,214,419     $ 1,591,449     $ 2,798,287     $ 2,479,136     $ 3,291,275  
1 year later
    348,279       302,986       365,913       900,274       909,984       1,227,427       1,436,051       2,661,011       2,237,124          
2 years later
    360,558       299,281       284,583       1,002,773       916,480       1,084,852       1,358,900       2,422,291                  
3 years later
    359,771       278,020       272,537       1,012,483       853,139       1,020,755       1,284,304                          
4 years later
    332,904       264,040       243,692       953,834       778,216       949,595                                  
5 years later
    316,257       242,278       216,875       879,504       733,151                                          
6 years later
    294,945       238,315       204,875       835,488                                                  
7 years later
    290,926       229,784       195,795                                                          
8 years later
    282,066       216,969                                                                  
9 years later
    269,522                                                                          
Reserve redundancy
  $ 150,195     $ 67,440     $ 185,736     $ 211,825     $ 73,408     $ 264,824     $ 307,145     $ 375,996     $ 242,012          
 
                                                                                 
    Year Ended December 31,
Gross Paid Losses   2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009   2010
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 
1 year later
  $ 97,036     $ 43,721     $ 19,260     $ 110,193     $ 117,666     $ 90,185     $ 407,692     $ 364,440     $ 377,159          
2 years later
    123,844       64,900       43,082       226,225       198,407       197,751       575,522       727,205                  
3 years later
    142,282       84,895       61,715       305,913       268,541       353,032       688,946                          
4 years later
    160,193       101,414       75,609       375,762       402,134       423,731                                  
5 years later
    174,476       110,155       87,274       509,319       442,624                                          
6 years later
    181,800       121,000       101,958       549,033                                                  
7 years later
    189,023       135,426       108,901                                                          
8 years later
    200,454       140,492                                                                  
9 years later
    204,805                                                                          
 
                                                                                 
Net Loss and Loss
                                       
Adjustment Expense
  Year Ended December 31,
Reserves   2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009   2010
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 
Reserves assumed
  $ 224,507     $ 184,518     $ 230,155     $ 736,660     $ 593,160     $ 872,259     $ 1,163,485     $ 2,403,712     $ 2,131,408     $ 2,765,835  
1 year later
    190,768       176,444       220,712       653,039       590,153       875,636       1,034,588       2,216,928       1,851,268          
2 years later
    176,118       178,088       164,319       652,195       586,059       753,551       950,739       1,940,472                  
3 years later
    180,635       138,251       149,980       649,355       532,804       684,999       874,961                          
4 years later
    135,219       129,923       136,611       600,939       454,933       611,182                                  
5 years later
    124,221       119,521       108,666       531,666       408,270                                          
6 years later
    114,375       112,100       104,127       485,392                                                  
7 years later
    106,920       108,447       92,972                                                          
8 years later
    103,311       93,188                                                                  
9 years later
    88,345                                                                          
Reserve redundancy
  $ 136,162     $ 91,330     $ 137,183     $ 251,268     $ 184,890     $ 261,077     $ 288,524     $ 463,240     $ 280,140          
 
                                                                                 
    Year Ended December 31,
Net Paid Losses   2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009   2010
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 
1 year later
  $ 38,634     $ 10,557     $ 11,354     $ 78,488     $ 79,398     $ 43,896     $ 112,321     $ 247,823     $ 250,635          
2 years later
    32,291       24,978       6,312       161,178       125,272       (70,430 )     243,146       480,102                  
3 years later
    44,153       17,304       9,161       206,351       (14,150 )     58,228       324,735                          
4 years later
    34,483       24,287       (1,803 )     67,191       102,776       108,109                                  
5 years later
    39,232       9,686       2,515       184,150       132,405                                          
6 years later
    23,309       14,141       11,348       212,822                                                  
7 years later
    24,176       22,966       11,808                                                          
8 years later
    30,551       21,400                                                                  
9 years later
    28,303                                                                          

15


Table of Contents

The following table provides a reconciliation of the liability for losses and LAE, net of reinsurance ceded:
 
                                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009     2008     2007     2006  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Net reserves for loss and loss adjustment expenses, beginning of period
  $ 2,131,408     $ 2,403,712     $ 1,163,485     $ 872,259     $ 593,160  
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
    (311,834 )     (259,627 )     (242,104 )     (24,482 )     (31,927 )
Net losses paid
    (294,996 )     (257,414 )     (174,013 )     (20,422 )     (75,293 )
Effect of exchange rate movement
    (3,836 )     73,512       (124,989 )     18,625       24,856  
Retroactive reinsurance contracts assumed
    785,731       56,630       373,287              
Acquired on purchase of subsidiaries
    459,362       114,595       1,408,046       317,505       361,463  
                                         
Net reserves for loss and loss adjustment expenses, end of period
  $ 2,765,835     $ 2,131,408     $ 2,403,712     $ 1,163,485     $ 872,259  
                                         
 
In the table above, net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities represents changes in estimates of prior period net loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities comprising net incurred loss movements during a period and changes in estimates of net IBNR liabilities. Net incurred loss movements during a period comprise increases or reductions in specific case reserves advised during the period to us by our policyholders and attorneys, or by us to our reinsurers, less claims settlements made during the period by us to our policyholders, plus claim receipts made to us by our reinsurers. Prior period estimates of net IBNR liabilities may change as our management considers the combined impact of commutations, policy buy-backs, settlement of losses on carried reserves and the trend of incurred loss development compared to prior forecasts. The trend of incurred loss development in any period comprises the movement in net case reserves less net claims settled during the period. See “— Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Critical Accounting Policies — Loss and Loss Adjustment Expenses” on page 72 for an explanation of how the loss reserving methodologies are applied to the movement, or development, of net incurred losses during a period to estimate IBNR liabilities.
 
Commutations provide an opportunity for us to exit exposures to entire policies with insureds and reinsureds at a discount to the previously estimated ultimate liability. To the extent possible, our internal and external actuaries eliminate all prior historical loss development that relates to commuted exposures and apply their actuarial methodologies to the remaining aggregate exposures and revised historical loss development information to reassess estimates of ultimate liabilities.
 
Policy buy-backs provide an opportunity for us to settle individual policies and losses usually at a discount to carried advised loss reserves. As part of our routine claims settlement operations, claims will settle at either below or above the carried advised loss reserve. The impact of policy buy-backs and the routine settlement of claims updates historical loss development information to which actuarial methodologies are applied often resulting in revised estimates of ultimate liabilities. Our actuarial methodologies include industry benchmarking which, under certain methodologies (discussed further under “— Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Critical Accounting Policies” on page 72, compares the trend of our loss development to that of the industry. To the extent that the trend of our loss development compared to the industry changes in any period, it is likely to have an impact on the estimate of ultimate liabilities.
 
Year Ended December 31, 2010
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2010 was $311.8 million, excluding the impact of foreign exchange rate movements of $3.8 million and including both net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities of $19.0 million relating to companies and portfolios acquired during the year and premium and commission adjustments triggered by incurred losses of $16.5 million.


16


Table of Contents

The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2010 of $311.8 million was attributable to a reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $278.1 million, a reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debts of $49.6 million and a reduction in estimates of unallocated loss adjustment expense liabilities of $39.7 million, relating to 2010 run-off activity, partially offset by the amortization, over the estimated payout period, of fair value adjustments relating to companies acquired amounting to $55.4 million.
 
The reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $278.1 million comprised net incurred favorable loss development of $41.1 million and reductions in IBNR reserves of $236.9 million. The decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $236.9 million was comprised of $67.8 million relating to asbestos liabilities, $4.2 million relating to environmental liabilities and $164.9 million relating to all other remaining liabilities. The reduction in IBNR was a result of the application, on a basis consistent with the assumptions applied in the prior period, of our actuarial methodologies to loss data to estimate loss reserves required to cover liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses. The prior period estimate of net IBNR liabilities was reduced as a result of the combined impact of loss development activity during 2010, including commutations and the favorable trend of loss development related to non-commuted policies compared to prior forecasts. The net incurred favorable loss development of $41.1 million, resulting from settlement of net advised case and LAE reserves of $336.1 million for net paid losses of $295.0 million, related to the settlement of non-commuted losses in the year and approximately 90 commutations of assumed and ceded exposures. Commutations provide an opportunity for us to exit exposures to entire policies with insureds and reinsureds at a discount to the previous estimated ultimate liability. As a result of exiting all exposures to such policies, all advised case reserves and IBNR liabilities relating to that insured or reinsured are eliminated. This often results in a net gain irrespective of whether the settlement exceeds the advised case reserves. We adopt a disciplined approach to the review and settlement of non-commuted claims through claims adjusting and the inspection of underlying policyholder records such that settlements of assumed exposures may often be achieved below the level of the originally advised loss, and settlements of ceded receivables may often be achieved at levels above carried balances. Of the 90 commutations completed during 2010, three related to our top ten insured and/or reinsured exposures, including one commutation completed shortly after December 31, 2009 whereby the related reduction in IBNR reserves was recorded in the reduction in net ultimate losses for the year ended December 31, 2009, and one related to the commutation of one of our largest ceded reinsurance assets. The remaining 86 commutations, of which approximately 43% were completed during the three months ended December 31, 2010, were of a smaller size, consistent with our approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships, as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships. The combination of the claims settlement activity in 2010, including commutations (but excluding the impact of the commutation that was completed subsequent to the year ended December 31, 2009) and the actuarial estimation of IBNR reserves required for the remaining non-commuted exposures (which took into account the favorable trend of loss development in 2010 related to such exposures compared to prior forecasts), resulted in our management concluding that the loss development activity that occurred subsequent to the prior reporting period provided sufficient new information to warrant a reduction in IBNR reserves of $236.9 million in 2010.
 
The reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debt of $49.6 million was a result of the collection, primarily during the three months ended December 31, 2010, of certain reinsurance receivables against which bad debt provisions had been provided in earlier periods.
 
Year Ended December 31, 2009
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2009 was $259.6 million, excluding the impact of adverse foreign exchange rate movements of $73.5 million and including both net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities of $4.8 million relating to companies acquired during the year and premium and commission adjustments of $5.5 million triggered by incurred losses.
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2009 of $259.6 million was attributable to a reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $274.8 million, a reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debts of $11.7 million and a reduction in estimates of loss adjustment expense liabilities of $50.4 million, relating to 2009 run-off activity, partially offset by the amortization, over the estimated payout period, of fair value adjustments relating to companies acquired amounting to $77.3 million.


17


Table of Contents

The reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $274.8 million comprised net incurred loss development of $43.3 million and reductions in IBNR reserves of $318.2 million. The decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $318.2 million was comprised of $158.4 million relating to asbestos liabilities, $17.0 million relating to environmental liabilities and $142.8 million relating to all other remaining liabilities. The reduction in IBNR is a result of the application, on a basis consistent with the assumptions applied in the prior period, of our actuarial methodologies to loss data to estimate loss reserves required to cover liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses. The prior period estimate of net IBNR liabilities was reduced as a result of the combined impact of loss development activity during 2009, including commutations and the favorable trend of loss development related to non-commuted policies compared to prior forecasts. The net incurred loss development of $43.3 million resulting from settlement of net advised case and LAE reserves of $214.1 million for net paid losses of $257.4 million, related to the settlement of non-commuted losses in the year and approximately 79 commutations of assumed and ceded exposures. Of the 79 commutations completed during 2009, two related to our top ten insured and/or reinsured exposures. The remaining 77 were of a smaller size, consistent with our approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships, as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships. Approximately 76% of commutations completed in 2009 related to commutations completed during the three months ended December 31, 2009. Subsequent to the year end, one of our insurance entities completed a commutation of another of one of our top ten reinsured exposures. The combination of the claims settlement activity in 2009, including commutations, and the actuarial estimation of IBNR reserves required for the remaining non-commuted exposures (which took into account the favorable trend of loss development in 2009 related to such exposures compared to prior forecasts as well as the impact of the commutation that was completed subsequent to the year end), resulted in our management concluding that the loss development activity that occurred subsequent to the prior reporting period provided sufficient new information to warrant a reduction in IBNR reserves of $318.2 million in 2009.
 
The reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debt of $11.7 million was a result of the collection, primarily during the three months ended March 31, 2009, of certain reinsurance receivables against which bad debt provisions had been provided in earlier periods.
 
Year Ended December 31, 2008
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2008 was $242.1 million, excluding the impacts of favorable foreign exchange rate movements of $36.1 million (relating to companies acquired in 2007 and earlier) and including both net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities of $149.4 million relating to companies acquired during the year and premium and commission adjustments of $0.1 million triggered by incurred losses.
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for 2008 of $242.1 million was attributable to a reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $161.4 million, a reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debt of $36.1 million (excluding $3.1 million relating to one of our entities that benefited from substantial stop loss reinsurance protection discussed below) and a reduction in estimates of loss adjustment expense liabilities of $69.1 million, relating to 2008 run-off activity, partially offset by the amortization, over the estimated payout period, of fair value adjustments relating to companies acquired amounting to $24.5 million.
 
The reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $161.4 million comprised the following:
 
(i) A reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $21.7 million in one of our insurance entities that benefited from substantial stop loss reinsurance protection. Net incurred loss development relating to this entity of $21.6 million was offset by reductions in IBNR reserves of $94.8 million and reductions in provisions for bad debt of $3.1 million, resulting in a net reduction in estimates of ultimate losses of $76.3 million. The entity in question benefited, until December 18, 2008, from substantial stop loss reinsurance protection whereby $54.6 million of the net reduction in ultimate losses of $76.3 million was ceded to a single AA- rated reinsurer such that we retained a reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses relating to this entity of $21.7 million. On December 18, 2008, we commuted the stop loss reinsurance protection with the reinsurer for the receipt of $190.0 million payable by the reinsurer to us over four years together with interest compounded at 3.5% per annum. The commutation resulted in no significant financial impact to us. The decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $94.8 million for this one


18


Table of Contents

insurance entity was comprised of $77.7 million relating to asbestos liabilities, $9.0 million relating to environmental liabilities and $8.1 million relating to all other remaining liabilities. The reduction in IBNR is a result of the application, on a basis consistent with the assumptions applied in the prior period, of our actuarial methodologies to loss data to estimate loss reserves required to cover liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses. The prior period estimate of net IBNR liabilities was reduced as a result of the combined impact of loss development activity during 2008, which was comprised of the settlement of certain advised case reserves below their prior period carried amounts, commutations completed and the trend of loss development relating to non-commuted policies compared to prior forecasts. The net incurred loss development relating to this entity of $21.6 million, whereby advised net case reserves of $25.0 million were settled for net paid losses of $46.6 million, primarily related to six commutations of assumed and ceded liabilities completed during 2008. As a result of exiting all exposures to such policies, all advised case reserves and IBNR liabilities relating to that insured or reinsured were eliminated. This often results in a net gain irrespective of whether the settlement exceeds the advised case reserves. Of the six commutations completed for this entity, of which the three largest were completed during the three months ended December 31, 2008, one was among its top ten assumed exposures. The remaining five commutations were of a smaller size, consistent with our approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships. The combination of the claims settlement activity in 2008, including commutations, combined with the actuarial estimation of IBNR reserves required for the remaining non-commuted exposures (which took into account the favorable trend of loss development in 2008 related to such exposures compared to prior forecasts), resulted in our management concluding that the loss development activity that occurred subsequent to the prior reporting period provided sufficient new information to warrant a reduction in IBNR reserves of $94.8 million for this one insurance entity in 2008.
 
(ii) A reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $139.7 million in our other insurance and reinsurance entities comprised net favorable incurred loss development of $24.1 million and reductions in IBNR reserves of $115.6 million. The decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $115.6 million was comprised of $23.8 million relating to asbestos liabilities, $1.8 million relating to environmental liabilities and $90.0 million relating to all other remaining liabilities. The reduction in IBNR is a result of the application, on a basis consistent with the assumptions applied in the prior period, of our actuarial methodologies to loss data to estimate loss reserves required to cover liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses. The prior period estimate of net IBNR liabilities was reduced as a result of the combined impact of favorable loss development activity during 2008, which was comprised of the settlement of advised case reserves below their prior period carried amounts, commutations completed and the favorable trend of loss development related to non-commuted policies compared to prior forecasts. The net favorable incurred loss development in our remaining insurance and reinsurance entities of $24.1 million, whereby net advised case and LAE reserves of $123.5 million were settled for net paid losses of $99.4 million, primarily related to the settlement of non-commuted losses in the year below carried reserves and approximately 59 commutations of assumed and ceded exposures at less than case and LAE reserves. Of the 59 commutations completed during 2008 for our other reinsurance and insurance companies, two (both of which were completed during the three months ended December 31, 2008) were among our top ten insured and/or reinsured exposures. The remaining 57 were of a smaller size, consistent with our approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships, as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships.
 
Approximately 82% of commutations completed in 2008 related to commutations completed during the three months ended December 31, 2008. The combination of the claims settlement activity in 2008, including commutations, with the actuarial estimation of IBNR reserves required for the remaining noncommuted exposures (which took into account the favorable trend of loss development in 2008 related to such exposures compared to prior forecasts), resulted in our management concluding that the loss development activity that occurred subsequent to the prior reporting period provided sufficient new information to warrant a reduction in IBNR reserves of $115.6 million for our remaining insurance and reinsurance entities in 2008.
 
One of our reinsurance companies had retrocessional arrangements providing for full reinsurance of all risks assumed. During the year, this entity commuted its largest assumed liability and related retrocessional protection whereby the subsidiary paid net losses of $222.0 million and reduced net IBNR by the same amount, resulting in no gain or loss to us.


19


Table of Contents

The reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debt of $36.1 million (excluding $3.1 million relating to one of our entities that benefited from substantial stop loss reinsurance protection discussed above) was comprised of: (1) $13.7 million as a result of the collection, primarily during the three months ended December 31, 2008, of certain reinsurance receivables against which bad debt provisions had been provided in earlier periods, (2) $8.5 million as a result of the revision of estimates of bad debt provisions following the receipt of new information during the three months ended December 31, 2008 and (3) $13.9 million as a result of reduced exposures to reinsurers with bad debt provisions following the commutation of assumed liabilities.
 
Year Ended December 31, 2007
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2007 was $24.5 million, excluding the impacts of adverse foreign exchange rate movements of $18.6 million and including both net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities of $9.0 million relating to companies acquired during the year and premium and commission adjustments triggered by incurred losses of $0.3 million.
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for 2007 of $24.5 million was attributable to a reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $30.7 million and a reduction in estimates of loss adjustment expense liabilities of $22.0 million, relating to 2007 run-off activity, partially offset by an increase in aggregate provisions for bad debt of $1.7 million, primarily relating to companies acquired in 2006, and the amortization, over the estimated payout period, of fair value adjustments relating to companies acquired amounting to $26.5 million.
 
The reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $30.7 million comprised the following:
 
(i) An increase in estimates of net ultimate losses of $2.1 million in one of our insurance entities that benefited from substantial stop loss reinsurance protection. This entity increased ultimate net losses by $23.5 million which was largely offset by a recoverable from a single AA- rated reinsurer such that a net ultimate loss of $2.1 million was retained by us. The increase in ultimate net losses of $23.5 million, before the recoverable from the stop loss reinsurer, comprised net incurred loss development of $36.6 million, partially offset by a decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $13.1 million. The decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $13.1 million was comprised of $2.9 million relating to asbestos liabilities, $6.2 million relating to environmental liabilities and $4.0 million relating to all other remaining liabilities. The reduction in IBNR is a result of the application, on a basis consistent with the assumptions applied in the prior period, of our actuarial methodologies to loss data to estimate loss reserves required to cover liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses. The prior period estimate of net IBNR liabilities was reduced as a result of the combined impact of favorable loss development activity during 2007, which was comprised of the settlement of certain advised case reserves below their prior period carried amounts, commutations completed and the favorable trend of loss development relating to non-commuted policies compared to prior forecasts. The net incurred loss development relating to this entity of $36.6 million, whereby advised net case reserves of $16.9 million were settled for net paid losses of $53.5 million, resulted from the settlement of case and LAE reserves above carried levels and from new loss advices, partially offset by approximately 12 commutations of assumed and ceded exposures below carried reserve levels. As a result of exiting all exposures to such policies, all advised case reserves and IBNR liabilities relating to that insured or reinsured were eliminated. This often results in a net gain irrespective of whether the settlement exceeds advised case reserves. Of the 12 commutations completed for this entity, three were among our top ten cedant exposures. The remaining nine were of a smaller size, consistent with our approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships. The combination of the claims settlement activity in 2007, including commutations, with the actuarial estimation of IBNR reserves required for the remaining non-commuted exposures (which took into account the favorable trend of loss development in 2007 related to such exposures compared to prior forecasts), resulted in our management concluding that the favorable loss development activity that occurred subsequent to the prior reporting period provided sufficient new information to warrant a reduction in IBNR reserves of $13.1 million for this one insurance entity in 2007.


20


Table of Contents

(ii) Net favorable incurred loss development of $29.0 million, comprising net paid loss recoveries, relating to another one of our reinsurance companies, offset by increases in net IBNR loss reserves of $29.0 million, resulting in no ultimate gain or loss. This reinsurance company has retrocessional arrangements providing for full reinsurance of all risks assumed.
 
(iii) A reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $32.8 million in our remaining insurance and reinsurance entities, which was comprised of net favorable incurred loss development of $6.5 million and reductions in IBNR reserves of $26.3 million. The decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $26.3 million was comprised of $20.1 million relating to asbestos liabilities and $7.7 million relating to all other remaining liabilities, partially offset by an increase of $1.5 million relating to environmental liabilities. The reduction in IBNR is a result of the application, on a basis consistent with the assumptions applied in the prior period, of our actuarial methodologies to loss data to estimate loss reserves required to cover liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses. The prior period estimate of net IBNR liabilities was reduced as a result of the combined impact of favorable loss development activity during 2007, which was comprised of the settlement of certain advised case reserves below their prior period carried amounts, commutations completed and the trend of loss development related to non-commuted policies compared to prior forecasts. The net favorable incurred loss development in our remaining insurance and reinsurance entities of $6.5 million, whereby net advised case and LAE reserves of $2.5 million were settled for net paid loss recoveries of $4.0 million, primarily related to the settlement of non-commuted losses in the year below carried reserves and approximately 57 commutations of assumed and ceded exposures at less than case and LAE reserves. Of the 57 commutations completed during 2007 for our remaining reinsurance and insurance companies, five were among our top ten cedant and/or reinsured exposures. The remaining 52 were of a smaller size, consistent with our approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships, as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships. The combination of the claims settlement activity in 2007, including commutations, with the actuarial estimation of IBNR reserves required for the remaining non-commuted exposures (which took into account the favorable trend of loss development in 2007 related to such exposures compared to prior forecasts), resulted in our management concluding that the loss development activity that occurred subsequent to the prior reporting period provided sufficient new information to warrant a reduction in IBNR reserves of $26.3 million for our remaining insurance and reinsurance entities in 2007.
 
Year Ended December 31, 2006
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2006 was $31.9 million, excluding the impacts of adverse foreign exchange rate movements of $24.9 million and including both net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities of $2.7 million relating to companies acquired during the year and premium and commission adjustments triggered by incurred losses of $1.3 million.
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for 2006 of $31.9 million was attributable to a reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $21.4 million, a reduction in estimates of loss adjustment expense liabilities of $15.1 million relating to 2006 run-off activity, a reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debt of $6.3 million, resulting from the collection of certain reinsurance receivables against which bad debt provisions had been provided in earlier periods, partially offset by the amortization, over the estimated payout period, of fair value adjustments relating to companies acquired amounting to $10.9 million.
 
The reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $21.4 million comprised net incurred loss development of $37.9 million offset by reductions in estimates of IBNR reserves of $59.3 million. An increase in estimates of ultimate losses of $3.4 million relating to one of our insurance entities was offset by reductions in estimates of net ultimate losses of $24.8 million in our remaining insurance and reinsurance entities.
 
The incurred loss development of $37.9 million, whereby advised case and LAE reserves of $37.4 million were settled for net paid losses of $75.3 million, comprised incurred loss development of $59.2 million relating to one of our insurance companies partially offset by favorable incurred loss development of $21.3 million relating to our remaining insurance and reinsurance companies.


21


Table of Contents

The incurred loss development of $59.2 million relating to one of our insurance companies was comprised of net paid loss settlements of $81.3 million less reductions in case and LAE reserves of $22.1 million and resulted from the settlement of case and LAE reserves above carried levels and from new loss advices, partially offset by approximately ten commutations of assumed and ceded exposures below carried reserves levels. Actuarial analysis of the remaining unsettled loss liabilities resulted in an increase in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $35.0 million after consideration of the $59.2 million adverse incurred loss development during the year, and the application of the actuarial methodologies to loss data pertaining to the remaining non-commuted exposures. Factors contributing to the increase include the establishment of a reserve to cover potential exposure to lead paint claims, a significant increase in asbestos reserves related to the entity’s single largest cedant (following a detailed review of the underlying exposures), and a change in the assumed A&E loss reporting time-lag as discussed further below. Of the ten commutations completed for this entity, two were among our top ten cedant and/or reinsurance exposures. The remaining eight were of a smaller size, consistent with our approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships. This entity also benefited from substantial stop loss reinsurance protection whereby the loss development of $59.2 million was largely offset by a recoverable from a single AA- rated reinsurer. The increase in estimated net ultimate losses of $3.4 million was retained by us.
 
The net favorable incurred loss development of $21.3 million, relating to our remaining insurance and reinsurance companies, whereby net advised case reserves of $15.3 million were settled for net paid loss recoveries of $6.0 million, arose from approximately 35 commutations of assumed and ceded exposures at less than case and LAE reserves, where receipts from ceded commutations exceeded settlements of assumed exposures, and the settlement of non-commuted losses in the year below carried reserves.
 
The net reduction in the estimate of IBNR loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities relating to our remaining insurance and reinsurance companies (i.e., excluding the net $55.8 million reduction in IBNR reserves relating to the entity referred to above) amounted to $3.5 million. This net reduction was comprised of an increase of $19.8 million resulting from (i) a change in assumptions as to the appropriate loss reporting time lag for asbestos related exposures from two to three years and for environmental exposures from two to two and one-half years, which resulted in an increase in net IBNR reserves of $6.4 million, and (ii) a reduction in ceded IBNR recoverables of $13.4 million resulting from the commutation of ceded reinsurance protections. The increase in IBNR of $19.8 million is offset by a reduction of $23.3 million resulting from the application of our reserving methodologies to (i) the reduced historical incurred loss development information relating to remaining exposures after the 35 commutations, and (ii) reduced case and LAE reserves in the aggregate. Of the 35 commutations completed during 2006 for the remaining of our reinsurance and insurance companies, ten were among our top ten cedant and/or reinsurance exposures. The remaining 25 were of a smaller size, consistent with our approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships.
 
Asbestos and Environmental (A&E) Exposure
 
General A&E Exposures
 
A number of our subsidiaries wrote general liability policies and reinsurance prior to our acquisition of them under which policyholders continue to present asbestos-related injury claims and claims alleging injury, damage or clean-up costs arising from environmental pollution. These policies, and the associated claims, are referred to as A&E exposures. The vast majority of these claims are presented under policies written many years ago.
 
There is a great deal of uncertainty surrounding A&E claims. This uncertainty impacts the ability of insurers and reinsurers to estimate the ultimate amount of unpaid claims and related LAE. The majority of these claims differ from any other type of claim because there is inadequate loss development and there is significant uncertainty regarding what, if any, coverage exists, to which, if any, policy years claims are attributable and which, if any, insurers/reinsurers may be liable. These uncertainties are exacerbated by lack of clear judicial precedent and legislative interpretations of coverage that may be inconsistent with the intent of the parties to the insurance contracts and expand theories of liability. The insurance and reinsurance industry as a whole is engaged in extensive


22


Table of Contents

litigation over these coverage and liability issues and is, thus, confronted with continuing uncertainty in its efforts to quantify A&E exposures.
 
Our A&E exposure is administered out of our offices in the United Kingdom and Rhode Island and centrally administered from the United Kingdom. In light of the intensive claim settlement process for these claims, which involves comprehensive fact gathering and subject matter expertise, our management believes that it is prudent to have a centrally administered claim facility to handle A&E claims on behalf of all of our subsidiaries. Our A&E claims staff, working in conjunction with two U.S.-qualified attorneys experienced in A&E liabilities, proactively administers, on a cost-effective basis, the A&E claims submitted to our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries.
 
We use industry benchmarking methodologies to estimate appropriate IBNR reserves for our A&E exposures. These methods are based on comparisons of our loss experience on A&E exposures relative to industry loss experience on A&E exposures. Estimates of IBNR are derived separately for each relevant subsidiary of ours and, for some subsidiaries, separately for distinct portfolios of exposure. The discussion that follows describes, in greater detail, the primary actuarial methodologies used by our independent actuaries to estimate IBNR for A&E exposures.
 
In addition to the specific considerations for each method described below, many general factors are considered in the application of the methods and the interpretation of results for each portfolio of exposures. These factors include the mix of product types (e.g. primary insurance versus reinsurance of primary versus reinsurance of reinsurance), the average attachment point of coverages (e.g. first-dollar primary versus umbrella over primary versus high-excess), payment and reporting lags related to the international domicile of our subsidiaries, payment and reporting pattern acceleration due to large “wholesale” settlements (e.g. policy buy-backs and commutations) pursued by us, lists of individual risks remaining and general trends within the legal and tort environments.
 
1. Paid Survival Ratio Method.  In this method, our expected annual average payment amount is multiplied by an expected future number of payment years to get an indicated reserve. Our historical calendar year payments are examined to determine an expected future annual average payment amount. This amount is multiplied by an expected number of future payment years to estimate a reserve. Trends in calendar year payment activity are considered when selecting an expected future annual average payment amount. Accepted industry benchmarks are used in determining an expected number of future payment years. Each year, annual payments data is updated, trends in payments are re-evaluated and changes to benchmark future payment years are reviewed. This method has advantages of ease of application and simplicity of assumptions. A potential disadvantage of the method is that results could be misleading for portfolios of high excess exposures where significant payment activity has not yet begun.
 
2. Paid Market Share Method.  In this method, our estimated market share is applied to the industry estimated unpaid losses. The ratio of our historical calendar year payments to industry historical calendar year payments is examined to estimate our market share. This ratio is then applied to the estimate of industry unpaid losses. Each year, calendar year payment data is updated (for both us and industry), estimates of industry unpaid losses are reviewed and the selection of our estimated market share is revisited. This method has the advantage that trends in calendar-year market share can be incorporated into the selection of company share of remaining market payments. A potential disadvantage of this method is that it is particularly sensitive to assumptions regarding the time-lag between industry payments and our payments.
 
3. Reserve-to-Paid Method.  In this method, the ratio of estimated industry reserves to industry paid-to-date losses is multiplied by our paid-to-date losses to estimate our reserves. Specific considerations in the application of this method include the completeness of our paid-to-date loss information, the potential acceleration or deceleration in our payments (relative to the industry) due to our claims handling practices, and the impact of large individual settlements. Each year, paid-to-date loss information is updated (for both us and the industry) and updates to industry estimated reserves are reviewed. This method has the advantage of relying purely on paid loss data and so is not influenced by subjectivity of case reserve loss estimates. A potential disadvantage is that the application to our portfolios which do not have complete inception-to-date paid loss history could produce misleading results. To address this potential disadvantage, a variation of the method is also considered, which multiplies the ratio of


23


Table of Contents

estimated industry reserves to industry losses paid during a recent period of time (e.g. 5 years) times our paid losses during that period.
 
4. IBNR:Case Ratio Method.  In this method, the ratio of estimated industry IBNR reserves to industry case reserves is multiplied by our case reserves to estimate our IBNR reserves. Specific considerations in the application of this method include the presence of policies reserved at policy limits, changes in overall industry case reserve adequacy and recent loss reporting history for us. Each year, our case reserves are updated, industry reserves are updated and the applicability of the industry IBNR:case ratio is reviewed. This method has the advantage that it incorporates the most recent estimates of amounts needed to settle open cases included in current case reserves. A potential disadvantage is that results could be misleading where our case reserve adequacy differs significantly from overall industry case reserve adequacy.
 
5. Ultimate-to-Incurred Method.  In this method, the ratio of estimated industry ultimate losses to industry incurred-to-date losses is applied to our incurred-to-date losses to estimate our IBNR reserves. Specific considerations in the application of this method include the completeness of our incurred-to-date loss information, the potential acceleration or deceleration in our incurred losses (relative to the industry) due to our claims handling practices and the impact of large individual settlements. Each year incurred-to-date loss information is updated (for both us and the industry) and updates to industry estimated ultimate losses are reviewed. This method has the advantage that it incorporates both paid and case reserve information in projecting ultimate losses. A potential disadvantage is that results could be misleading where cumulative paid loss data is incomplete or where our case reserve adequacy differs significantly from overall industry case reserve adequacy.
 
Under the Paid Survival Ratio Method, the Paid Market Share Method and the Reserve-to-Paid Method, we first determine the estimated total reserve and then deduct the reported outstanding case reserves to arrive at an estimated IBNR reserve. The IBNR:Case Ratio Method first determines an estimated IBNR reserve which is then added to the advised outstanding case reserves to arrive at an estimated total loss reserve. The Ultimate-to-Incurred Method first determines an estimate of the ultimate losses to be paid and then deducts paid-to-date losses to arrive at an estimated total loss reserve and then deducts outstanding case reserves to arrive at the estimated IBNR reserve.
 
Within the annual loss reserve studies produced by our external actuaries, exposures for each subsidiary are separated into homogeneous reserving categories for the purpose of estimating IBNR. Each reserving category contains either direct insurance or assumed reinsurance reserves and groups relatively similar types of risks and exposures (e.g. asbestos, environmental, casualty and property) and lines of business written (e.g. marine, aviation and non-marine). Based on the exposure characteristics and the nature of available data for each individual reserving category, a number of methodologies are applied. Recorded reserves for each category are selected from the indications produced by the various methodologies after consideration of exposure characteristics, data limitations and strengths and weaknesses of each method applied. This approach to estimating IBNR has been consistently adopted in the annual loss reserve studies for each period presented.
 
As of December 31, 2010, we had 35 separate insurance and/or reinsurance subsidiaries whose reserves are categorized into approximately 276 reserve categories in total, including 40 distinct asbestos reserving categories and 27 distinct environmental reserving categories.
 
To the extent data availability allows, the five methodologies described above are applied for each of the 40 asbestos reserving categories and each of the 27 environmental reserving categories. As is common in actuarial practice, no one methodology is exclusively or consistently relied upon when selecting a recorded reserve. Consistent reliance on a single methodology to select a recorded reserve would be inappropriate in light of the dynamic nature of both the A&E liabilities in general, and our actual exposure portfolios in particular.
 
In selecting a recorded reserve, our management considers the range of results produced by the methods, and the strengths and weaknesses of the methods in relation to the data available and the specific characteristics of the portfolio under consideration. Trends in both our data and industry data are also considered in the reserve selection process. Recent trends or changes in the relevant tort and legal environments are also considered when assessing methodology results and selecting an appropriate recorded reserve amount for each portfolio.


24


Table of Contents

The liability for unpaid losses and LAE, inclusive of A&E reserves, reflects our best estimate for future amounts needed to pay losses and related LAE as of each of the balance sheet dates reflected in the financial statements herein in accordance with U.S. GAAP. As of December 31, 2010, we had net loss reserves of $640.1 million for asbestos-related claims and $96.1 million for environmental pollution-related claims. The following table provides a reconciliation of our gross and net loss and ALAE reserves from A&E exposures and the movement in gross and net reserves:
 
                                                 
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009     2008  
    Gross     Net     Gross     Net     Gross     Net  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Provisions for A&E claims and ALAE at January 1
  $ 750,972     $ 667,632     $ 943,970     $ 846,421     $ 677,610     $ 419,977  
A&E losses and ALAE incurred during the year
    (71,302 )     (78,801 )     (51,612 )     (78,756 )     (54,337 )     (14,448 )
A&E losses and ALAE paid during the year
    (101,917 )     (67,756 )     (158,391 )     (115,479 )     (58,916 )     108,583  
Provision for A&E claims and ALAE acquired during the year
    247,459       215,097       17,005       15,446       379,613       332,309  
                                                 
Provision for A&E claims and ALAE at December 31
  $ 825,212     $ 736,172     $ 750,972     $ 667,632     $ 943,970     $ 846,421  
                                                 
 
During 2010 and 2009, excluding the impact of loss reserves acquired during the year, our reserves for A&E liabilities decreased by $173.2 million and $210.0 million on a gross basis and by $146.6 million and $194.2 million on a net basis, respectively. The reductions in gross reserves arose from paid claims, successful commutations, policy buy-backs, generally favorable claim settlements during the year and reductions in IBNR resulting from actuarial analysis of remaining liabilities.
 
During 2008, excluding the impact of loss reserves acquired during the year, our reserves for A&E liabilities decreased by $113.3 million on a gross basis and increased by $94.1 million on a net basis. The reduction in gross reserves arose from paid claims, successful commutations, policy buy-backs, generally favorable claim settlements during the year and a reduction in IBNR resulting from actuarial analysis of remaining liabilities. The increase in net reserves arose as a result of (i) the commutation of a substantial stop loss protection in one of our reinsurance entities which had the effect of reducing ceded A&E IBNR recoverable by $163.4 million; partially offset by (ii) a reduction in net reserves of $69.3 million which arose from successful commutations, policy buy-backs, generally favorable claims settlements and a reduction in IBNR resulting from actuarial analysis of remaining net liabilities. This commutation, which settled for a total amount receivable of $190.0 million (including $163.4 million related to A&E IBNR recoverable), resulted in net A&E losses and ALAE recovered during the year of $108.6 million.
 
Asbestos continues to be the most significant and difficult mass tort for the insurance industry in terms of claims volume and expense. We believe that the insurance industry has been adversely affected by judicial interpretations that have had the effect of maximizing insurance recoveries for asbestos claims, from both a coverage and liability perspective. Generally, only policies underwritten prior to 1986 have potential asbestos exposure, since most policies underwritten after this date contain an absolute asbestos exclusion.
 
From 2001 through 2003 the industry experienced increasing numbers of asbestos claims, including claims from individuals who did not appear to be impaired by asbestos exposure. Since 2003, however, new claim filings have been fairly stable. It is possible that the increases observed in the early part of the decade were triggered by various state tort reforms (discussed immediately below). At this point, we cannot predict whether claim filings will return to pre-2004 levels, remain stable, or begin to decrease.


25


Table of Contents

Since 2001, several U.S. states have proposed, and in many cases enacted, tort reform statutes that impact asbestos litigation by, for example, making it more difficult for a diverse group of plaintiffs to jointly file a single case, reducing “forum-shopping” by requiring that a potential plaintiff must have been exposed to asbestos in the state in which he/she files a lawsuit, or permitting consolidation of discovery. These statutes typically apply to suits filed after a stated date. When a statute is proposed or enacted, asbestos defendants often experience a marked increase in new lawsuits, as plaintiffs’ attorneys seek to file suit before the effective date of the legislation. Some of this increased claim volume likely represents an acceleration of valid claims that would have been brought in the future, while some claims will likely prove to have little or no merit. As many of these claims are still pending, we cannot predict what portion of the increased number of claims represent valid claims. Also, the acceleration of claims increases the uncertainty surrounding projections of future claims in the affected jurisdictions.
 
During the same timeframe as tort reform, the U.S. federal and various U.S. state governments sought comprehensive asbestos reform to manage the growing court docket and costs surrounding asbestos litigation, in addition to the increasing number of corporate bankruptcies resulting from overwhelming asbestos liabilities. Whereas the federal government has failed to establish a national asbestos trust fund to address the asbestos problem, several states, including Texas and Florida, have implemented a medical criteria reform approach that only permits litigation to proceed when a plaintiff can establish and demonstrate actual physical impairment.
 
Much like tort reform, asbestos litigation reform has also spurred a significant increase in the number of lawsuits filed in advance of the law’s enactment. We cannot predict whether the drop off in the number of filed claims is due to the accelerated number of filings or an actual trend decline in alleged asbestos injuries.
 
Environmental Pollution Exposures
 
Environmental pollution claims represent another significant exposure for us. However, environmental pollution claims have been developing as expected over the past few years as a result of stable claim trends. Claims against Fortune 500 companies are generally declining, and while insureds with single-site exposures are still active, in many cases claims are being settled for less than initially anticipated due to improved site remediation technology and effective policy buy-backs.
 
Despite the stability of recent trends, there remains significant uncertainty involved in estimating liabilities related to these exposures. Unlike asbestos claims which are generated primarily from allegedly injured private individuals, environmental claims generally result from governmentally initiated activities. First, the number of waste sites subject to cleanup is unknown. Approximately 1,282 sites are included on the National Priorities List (NPL) of the United States Environmental Protection Agency as of the most recent rulemaking dated September 30, 2010, an increase of 12 sites from the prior year. State authorities have separately identified many additional sites and, at times, aggressively implement site cleanups. Second, the liabilities of the insureds themselves are difficult to estimate. At any given site, the allocation of remediation cost among the potentially responsible parties varies greatly depending upon a variety of factors. Third, as with asbestos liability and coverage issues, judicial precedent regarding liability and coverage issues regarding pollution claims does not provide clear guidance. There is also uncertainty as to the U.S. federal “Superfund” law itself and, at this time, we cannot predict what, if any, reforms to this law might be enacted by the U.S. federal government, or the effect of any such changes on the insurance industry.
 
Other Latent Exposures
 
While we do not view health hazard exposures such as silica and tobacco as becoming a material concern, recent developments in lead litigation have caused us to watch these matters closely. Recently, municipal and state governments have had success, using a public nuisance theory, pursuing the former makers of lead pigment for the abatement of lead paint in certain home dwellings. As lead paint was used almost exclusively into the early 1970’s, large numbers of old housing stock contain lead paint that can prove hazardous to people and, particularly, children. Although governmental success has been limited thus far, we continue to monitor developments carefully due to the size of the potential awards sought by plaintiffs. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Critical Accounting Policies — Latent Claims” on page 73 for a further discussion of recent lead paint developments.


26


Table of Contents

Investments
 
Investment Strategy and Guidelines
 
We derive a significant portion of our income from our invested assets. As a result, our operating results depend in part on the performance of our investment portfolio. Because of the unpredictable nature of losses that may arise under our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries’ insurance or reinsurance policies and as a result of our opportunistic commutation strategy, our liquidity needs can be substantial and may arise at any time. Except for that portion of our portfolio that is invested in non-investment grade securities, we generally follow a conservative investment strategy designed to emphasize the preservation of our invested assets and provide sufficient liquidity for the prompt payment of claims and settlement of commutation payments.
 
As of December 31, 2010, we had cash and cash equivalents of $1.46 billion. Our cash and cash equivalent portfolio is comprised mainly of high-grade fixed deposits, commercial paper with maturities of less than three months and money market funds.
 
Our investment portfolio consists primarily of investment grade-rated, liquid, fixed-maturity securities of short-to-medium term duration along with mutual funds — 87.6% of our total investment portfolio as of December 31, 2010 consisted of investment grade securities, as compared to 92.4% as of December 31, 2009. In addition, our non-investment grade securities, excluding bond funds included as part of other investments, comprised 8.2% and 7.6% of our total investment portfolio, as at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively, and consisted of exposures to equities, limited partnerships and limited liability companies, collectively private equities, fixed maturity securities and bond and hedge funds. Assuming the commitments to the other investments were fully funded as of December 31, 2010 out of cash balances on hand at that time, the percentage of investments held in other than investment grade securities would increase to 11.0%. As of December 31, 2009, the increase would have been to 13.0%.
 
We strive to structure our investments in a manner that recognizes our liquidity needs for future liabilities. In that regard, we attempt to correlate the maturity and duration of our investment portfolio to our general liability profile. If our liquidity needs or general liability profile unexpectedly change, we may not continue to structure our investment portfolio in its current manner and would adjust as necessary to meet new business needs.
 
Our investment performance is subject to a variety of risks, including risks related to general economic conditions, market volatility, interest rate fluctuations, foreign exchange risk, liquidity risk and credit and default risk. Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors, including governmental monetary policies, domestic and international economic and political conditions and other factors beyond our control. A significant increase in interest rates could result in significant losses, realized or unrealized, in the value of our investment portfolio. A significant portion of our non-investment grade securities consists of alternative investments that subject us to restrictions on redemption, which may limit our ability to withdraw funds for some period of time after the initial investment. The values of, and returns on, such investments may also be more volatile.
 
Investment Committee and Investment Manager
 
The investment committee of our board of directors supervises our investment activity. The investment committee regularly monitors our overall investment results, which it ultimately reports to the board of directors. Our investment committee is comprised of Robert J. Campbell, a member of our board of directors and the chairman of the committee, Richard J. Harris, our Chief Financial Officer, and, as of August 4, 2010, J. Christopher Flowers and Charles T. Akre, Jr., both members of our board of directors. John J. Oros served on the investment committee until his resignation as our Executive Chairman and a member of our board of directors on August 20, 2010. The investment committee met five times during the year ended December 31, 2010 in conjunction with our regularly scheduled board of directors meetings. The committee made the following major decisions during the year: (i) approved increased allocations to equities and structured credit securities; (ii) approved increased allocation from cash into short duration securities, predominantly corporate and non-U.S. government securities; and (iii) ensured that the investment portfolio of each entity we acquired during the year met our investment criteria in regards to duration and ratings.


27


Table of Contents

As stated in “— Investment Strategy and Guidelines” above, we generally follow a conservative investment strategy designed to emphasize the preservation of our invested assets and provide sufficient liquidity for the prompt payment of claims and settlement of commutation payments. Our investment portfolio consists primarily of investment grade-rated, liquid, fixed-maturity securities of short-to-medium duration and mutual funds. As of December 31, 2010, only 5.7% of our total investment portfolio was classified as Level 3 as defined in the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosure topic of the Financial Accounting Standards Board Accounting Standards Codification, or FASB ASC. Given our investment objectives, the composition of our current investment portfolio, and our business strategy to acquire insurance and reinsurance companies in run-off, our investment committee’s efforts tend to be focused on the structural issues surrounding acquired portfolios. While the investment committee does review the ongoing performance of our investment portfolio, we have not experienced significant widespread liquidity or pricing issues with our portfolio that would require meaningful review by the committee.
 
We utilize various companies to provide investment advisory and/or management services. We have agreed to pay investment management fees to the managers. These fees, which vary depending on the amount of assets under management, are included in net investment income. The total fees we paid to our investment managers for the year ended December 31, 2010 were $1.7 million, including approximately $0.4 million to our largest single investment manager. We have investment management agreements with all of our managers, however, none of them are material to us.
 
Investment Portfolio
 
Accounting Treatment
 
Our investments primarily consist of fixed maturity securities. Our fixed maturity investments are comprised of available-for-sale and trading investments as defined in the Investment — Debt and Equity Securities topic of FASB ASC. Available-for-sale and trading investments are carried at their fair value on the balance sheet date. Unrealized holdings gains and losses on trading investments, which represent the difference between the amortized cost and the fair market value of securities, are included in our net earnings and are reported as net realized and unrealized gains and losses. Unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale securities are recognized as part of other comprehensive income.
 
Composition as of December 31, 2010 and 2009
 
As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, the fair value of our aggregate invested assets totaled approximately $3.88 billion and $3.34 billion, respectively. Aggregate invested assets included cash and cash equivalents, restricted cash and cash equivalents, fixed maturity securities, equities, short-term investments and other investments.


28


Table of Contents

The following table shows the types of securities in our portfolio, including cash equivalents, and their fair market values as of December 31, 2010 and 2009:
 
                                 
    December 31, 2010     December 31, 2009  
    Fair Value     % of Total Fair Value     Fair Value     % of Total Fair Value  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Cash and cash equivalents (1)
  $ 1,455,354       37.5 %   $ 1,700,105       50.9 %
                                 
U.S. government and agency
    227,803       5.9 %     242,395       7.3 %
Non-U.S. government
    386,866       10.0 %     316,630       9.5 %
Corporate
    1,347,384       34.7 %     881,692       26.4 %
Municipal
    2,297       0.1 %     9,654       0.3 %
Residential mortgage-backed
    102,506       2.6 %     17,644       0.5 %
Commercial mortgage-backed
    38,841       1.0 %     30,409       0.9 %
Asset backed
    28,613       0.7 %     33,991       1.0 %
                                 
Fixed maturities
    2,134,310       55.0 %     1,532,415       45.9 %
Other investments
    234,714       6.0 %     81,801       2.5 %
Equities
    60,082       1.5 %     24,503       0.7 %
                                 
Total investments
    2,429,106       62.5 %     1,638,719       49.1 %
                                 
Total cash and investments
  $ 3,884,460       100.0 %   $ 3,338,824       100.0 %
                                 
 
 
(1) Includes restricted cash and cash equivalents of $656.2 million and $433.7 million as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
 
U.S. Government and Agency Securities
 
U.S. government and agency securities are comprised primarily of bonds issued by the U.S. Treasury, the Federal Home Loan Bank, the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation and the Federal National Mortgage Association.
 
Non-U.S. Government Securities
 
Non-U.S. government securities represent the fixed maturity obligations of non-U.S. governmental entities. These are comprised primarily of bonds issued by the Australian, United Kingdom, French, Canadian and German governments.
 
Corporate Securities
 
Corporate securities are comprised of bonds issued by corporations that are diversified across a wide range of issuers and industries. The largest single issuer of corporate securities in our portfolio as of December 31, 2010 was National Australia Bank, which represented 5.3% of our total cash and investments and had a credit rating of AA.
 
Other Investments
 
                 
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Private equities
  $ 104,109     $ 77,359  
Bond funds
    102,279        
Hedge fund
    22,037        
Other
    6,289       4,442  
                 
Total
  $ 234,714     $ 81,801  
                 


29


Table of Contents

In December 2005, we invested in New NIB, a Province of Alberta limited partnership, in exchange for an approximately 1.6% limited partnership interest. New NIB was formed for the purpose of purchasing, together with certain affiliated entities, 100% of the outstanding share capital of NIBC. J. Christopher Flowers, a member of our board of directors and one of our largest shareholders, is a director of New NIB. Certain affiliates of J.C. Flowers I L.P., which is a private investment fund formed and managed by J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC, of which Mr. Flowers is its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, and Mr. Oros, who was our Executive Chairman and a member of our board of directors until his resignation on August 20, 2010, is a managing director, also participated in the acquisition of NIBC. Certain of our officers and directors made personal investments in New NIB.
 
We own a non-voting 7.0% membership interest in Affirmative Investment LLC, or Affirmative. J.C. Flowers I L.P. owns the remaining 93.0% interest in Affirmative. Affirmative and its affiliates own approximately 51.0% of the outstanding stock of Affirmative Insurance Holdings, a publicly traded company.
 
We have a capital commitment of up to $10.0 million in the GSC European Mezzanine Fund II, LP, or GSC. GSC invests in mezzanine securities of middle and large market companies throughout Western Europe. As of December 31, 2010, the capital contributed to GSC was $9.9 million, with the remaining commitment being $0.1 million.
 
In 2006, we committed to invest up to $100.0 million in the Flowers Fund. As of December 31, 2010, the capital contributed to the Flowers Fund was $97.1 million, with the remaining commitment being approximately $2.9 million. During 2010, we received $0.3 million in advisory service fees from the Flowers Fund. Certain of our officers and directors made personal investments in the Flowers Fund.
 
During 2008, we committed to invest up to $100.0 million in J.C. Flowers III L.P., or Fund III. As of December 31, 2010, the capital contributed to Fund III was $18.3 million, with the remaining commitment being $81.7 million. Fund III is a private investment fund advised by J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC.
 
On January 28, 2009, we invested approximately $8.7 million in JCF III Co-invest I L.P., an entity affiliated with J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC and Messrs. Flowers and Oros, in connection with its investment in certain of the operations, assets and liabilities of OneWest Bank FSB (formerly known as IndyMac Bank, F.S.B).
 
We had, as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, excluding our investment in Varadero International Ltd., or Varadero, investments in entities affiliated with Messers. Flowers and Oros with a total value of $96.1 million and $76.1 million, respectively, and outstanding commitments to entities managed by Messers. Flowers and Oros, for the same periods, of $84.6 million and $98.1 million, respectively. Our outstanding commitments may be drawn down over approximately the next five years. As at December 31, 2010, our related party investments associated with Messrs. Flowers and Oros accounted for 99.9% of our total unfunded capital commitments and 50.3% of our total amount of investments classified as other investments.
 
In March 2010, we committed to invest $20.0 million in Varadero, a hedge fund. The investment manager of Varadero is Varadero Capital, L.P., of which Varadero GP, LLC is the general partner. As at December 31, 2010, we had funded 100% of our capital commitment. Both the investment manager and general partner are partially owned by an entity affiliated with us and Messrs. Flowers and Oros.
 
During 2010, we made investments of approximately $85.4 million in various bond funds.
 
Equities
 
During 2007, we funded two equity portfolios that invest in both small and large market capitalization publicly traded U.S. companies. In 2009, we increased funding to those portfolios along with adding a third equity portfolio. In 2010, we further increased the funding of these equity portfolios. The equity portfolios are actively managed by two third-party managers.


30


Table of Contents

Ratings as of December 31, 2010 and 2009
 
The investment ratings (provided by major rating agencies) for our fixed maturity securities held as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 were as follows:
 
                                 
    December 31, 2010     December 31, 2009  
    Fair Value     % of Total Fair Value     Fair Value     % of Total Fair Value  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
AAA
  $ 812,407       38.1 %   $ 719,622       47.0 %
AA
    450,802       21.1 %     283,418       18.5 %
A
    741,761       34.8 %     424,841       27.7 %
BBB or lower
    122,257       5.7 %     85,696       5.6 %
Not Rated
    7,083       0.3 %     18,838       1.2 %
                                 
Total
  $ 2,134,310       100.0 %   $ 1,532,415       100.0 %
                                 
 
Maturity Distribution as of December 31, 2010 and 2009
 
The maturity distribution for our fixed maturity securities held as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 was as follows:
 
                                 
    December 31, 2010     December 31, 2009  
          % of Total
          % of Total
 
    Fair Value     Fair Value     Fair Value     Fair Value  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Due in one year or less
  $ 966,319       45.3 %   $ 639,191       41.7 %
Due after one year through five years
    940,017       44.0 %     680,630       44.4 %
Due after five years through ten years
    47,627       2.2 %     101,868       6.6 %
Due after ten years
    10,387       0.5 %     28,682       1.9 %
                                 
      1,964,350       92.0 %     1,450,371       94.6 %
Residential mortgage-backed
    102,506       4.8 %     17,644       1.2 %
Commercial mortgage-backed
    38,841       1.8 %     30,409       2.0 %
Asset backed
    28,613       1.4 %     33,991       2.2 %
                                 
Total
  $ 2,134,310       100.0 %   $ 1,532,415       100.0 %
                                 
 
Unrealized Losses as of December 31, 2010 and 2009
 
The unrealized losses for our fixed maturity available-for-sale securities held as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 were as follows:
 
                                                 
    December 31, 2010     December 31, 2009  
    Fair
    Unrealized
    % of
    Fair
    Unrealized
    % of
 
    Value     Losses     Total Fair Value     Value     Losses     Total Fair Value  
 
U.S. government and agency
  $ 23,777     $ (92 )     10.9%     $ 782     $ (13 )     4.5%  
Non-U.S. government
    38,838       (314 )     17.8%                   0.0%  
Corporate
    129,774       (1,615 )     59.3%       16,242       (867 )     93.4%  
Residential mortgage-backed
    13,642       (234 )     6.2%       369       (160 )     2.1%  
Commercial mortgage-backed
    2,046       (11 )     0.9%                   0.0%  
Asset backed
    10,641       (346 )     4.9%                   0.0%  
                                                 
Total available-for-sale investments
  $ 218,718       (2,612 )     100.0%     $ 17,393     $ (1,040 )     100.0%  
                                                 


31


Table of Contents

Investment Returns for the Years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009
 
Our investment returns for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 were as follows:
 
                 
    Year Ended
 
    December 31,  
    2010     2009  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Net investment income
  $ 99,906     $ 81,371  
Net realized and unrealized gains (losses)
    13,137       4,237  
                 
Net investment income and net realized and unrealized gains (losses)
  $ 113,043     $ 85,608  
                 
Effective annualized yield (1)
    2.38 %     2.13 %
 
 
(1) Effective annualized yield is calculated by dividing net investment income, excluding writedowns and income on other investments, by the average balance of aggregate cash and cash equivalents, equities and fixed maturity securities on a carrying value basis. Trading securities where the investment return is for the benefit of insureds and reinsurers are excluded from the calculation.
 
Regulation
 
General
 
The business of insurance and reinsurance is regulated in most countries, although the degree and type of regulation varies significantly from one jurisdiction to another. We have a significant presence in Bermuda, the United Kingdom, Australia and the United States and are subject to extensive regulation under the applicable statutes in these countries. A summary of the regulations governing us in these countries is set forth below.
 
Bermuda
 
As a holding company, we are not subject to Bermuda insurance regulations. However, the Insurance Act 1978 of Bermuda and related regulations, as amended, or, together, the Insurance Act, regulate the insurance business of our operating subsidiaries in Bermuda and provide that no person may carry on any insurance business in or from within Bermuda unless registered as an insurer by the Bermuda Monetary Authority, or BMA, under the Insurance Act. Insurance as well as reinsurance is regulated under the Insurance Act.
 
The Insurance Act also imposes on Bermuda insurance companies certain solvency and liquidity standards and auditing and reporting requirements and grants the BMA powers to supervise, investigate, require information and the production of documents and intervene in the affairs of insurance companies. Certain significant aspects of the Bermuda insurance regulatory framework are set forth below.
 
Classification of Insurers.  The Insurance Act distinguishes between insurers carrying on long-term business and insurers carrying on general business. There are six classifications of insurers carrying on general business, with Class 4 insurers subject to the strictest regulation. Our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries, which are incorporated to carry on general insurance and reinsurance business, are registered as Class 2 or 3A insurers in Bermuda and are regulated as such under the Insurance Act. These regulated Bermuda subsidiaries are not licensed to carry on long-term business. Long-term business broadly includes life insurance and disability insurance with terms in excess of five years. General business broadly includes all types of insurance that are not long-term business.
 
Principal Representative.  An insurer is required to maintain a principal office in Bermuda and to appoint and maintain a principal representative in Bermuda. For the purpose of the Insurance Act, each of our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries’ principal offices is at Windsor Place, 3rd Floor, 18 Queen Street, in Hamilton, Bermuda, and each of their principal representatives is Enstar Limited. Without a reason acceptable to the BMA, an insurer may not terminate the appointment of its principal representative, and the principal representative may not cease to act in that capacity, unless 30 days’ notice in writing is given to the BMA. It is the duty of the principal representative, forthwith on reaching the view that there is a likelihood that the insurer will become insolvent or that a reportable “event” has, to the principal representative’s knowledge, occurred or is believed to have occurred, to notify the BMA and, within 14 days of such notification, to make a report in writing to the BMA setting forth all the particulars


32.1


Table of Contents

of the case that are available to the principal representative. For example, any failure by the insurer to comply substantially with a condition imposed upon the insurer by the BMA relating to a solvency margin or a liquidity or other ratio would be a reportable “event.”
 
Independent Approved Auditor.  Every registered insurer must appoint an independent auditor who will audit and report annually on the statutory financial statements and the statutory financial return of the insurer, both of which, in the case of our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries, are required to be filed annually with the BMA. The independent auditor must be approved by the BMA and may be the same person or firm that audits our consolidated financial statements and reports for presentation to our shareholders. Our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries’ independent auditor is Deloitte & Touche, who also audits our consolidated financial statements.
 
Loss Reserve Specialist.  As a registered Class 2 or 3A insurer, each of our regulated Bermuda insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries is required, every year, to submit an opinion of its approved loss reserve specialist with its statutory financial return in respect of its losses and loss expenses provisions. The loss reserve specialist, who will normally be a qualified casualty actuary, must be approved by the BMA.
 
Statutory Financial Statements.  Each of our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries must prepare annual statutory financial statements. The Insurance Act prescribes rules for the preparation and substance of the statutory financial statements, which include, in statutory form, a balance sheet, an income statement, a statement of capital and surplus and notes thereto. Each of our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries is required to give detailed information and analyses regarding premiums, claims, reinsurance and investments. The statutory financial statements are not prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP and are distinct from the financial statements prepared for presentation to an insurer’s shareholders under the Companies Act. As a general business insurer, each of our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries is required to submit to the BMA the annual statutory financial statements as part of the annual statutory financial return. The statutory financial statements and the statutory financial return do not form part of the public records maintained by the BMA.
 
Annual Statutory Financial Return.  Each of our regulated insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries is required to file with the BMA a statutory financial return no later than six months, in the case of a Class 2, or four months in the case of a Class 3A, after its fiscal year end unless specifically extended upon application to the BMA. The statutory financial return for an insurer includes, among other matters, a report of the approved independent auditor on the statutory financial statements of the insurer, solvency certificates, declaration of statutory ratios, the statutory financial statements, and the opinion of the loss reserve specialist. The solvency certificates must be signed by the principal representative and at least two directors of the insurer certifying that the minimum solvency margin has been met and whether the insurer has complied with the conditions attached to its certificate of registration. The independent approved auditor is required to state whether, in its opinion, it was reasonable for the directors to make these certifications. If an insurer’s accounts have been audited for any purpose other than compliance with the Insurance Act, a statement to that effect must be filed with the statutory financial return. Further, every Class 2 insurer must submit a Loss Reserve Specialist Opinion on a triennial basis, while Class 3A insurers must submit annually. Additionally, all Class 3A insurers are required to submit a Schedule of Ceded Reinsurance pursuant to the Insurance Act.
 
Minimum Liquidity Ratio.  The Insurance Act provides a minimum liquidity ratio for general business insurers, like our regulated Bermuda insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries. An insurer engaged in general business is required to maintain the value of its relevant assets at not less than 75% of the amount of its relevant liabilities. Relevant assets include, but are not limited to, cash and time deposits, quoted investments, unquoted bonds and debentures, first liens on real estate, investment income due and accrued, accounts and premiums receivable and reinsurance balances receivable. There are some categories of assets that unless specifically permitted by the BMA, do not automatically qualify as relevant assets, such as unquoted equity securities, investments in and advances to affiliates and real estate and collateral loans. Relevant liabilities are total general business insurance reserves and total other liabilities less deferred income tax and sundry liabilities (i.e., liabilities that are not otherwise specifically defined).
 
Minimum Solvency Margin, Enhanced Capital Requirement and Restrictions on Dividends and Distributions.  Under the Insurance Act, the value of the general business assets of a Class 2 or 3A insurer, such as our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries, must exceed the amount of its general business liabilities by an amount greater than the


33


Table of Contents

prescribed minimum solvency margin. Each of our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries is required, with respect to its general business, to maintain a minimum solvency margin equal to the greatest of:
 
For Class 2 insurers:
 
  •  $250,000;
 
  •  20% of net premiums written (being gross premiums written less any premiums ceded by the insurer) if net premiums do not exceed $6,000,000 or $1,200,000 plus 10% of net premiums written in excess of $6,000,000; and
 
  •  10% of net losses and loss expense reserves.
 
For Class 3A insurers:
 
  •  $1,000,000;
 
  •  20% of net premiums written (being gross premiums written less any premiums ceded by the insurer) if net premiums do not exceed $6,000,000 or $1,200,000 plus 15% of net premiums written in excess of $6,000,000; and
 
  •  15% of net losses and loss expense reserves.
 
After the year ended December 31, 2011, Class 3A insurers will be required to maintain available statutory capital and surplus in an amount that is equal to or exceeds the target capital levels based on Enhanced Capital Requirements, or ECR, calculated using the Bermuda Solvency Capital Requirement, or BSCR, model. The BSCR model is a risk based capital model introduced by the BMA that measures risk and determines enhanced capital requirements and a target capital level (defined as 120% of the enhanced capital requirement) based on the subsidiary’s statutory financial statements. Each of our regulated Bermuda insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries is prohibited from declaring or paying any dividends during any fiscal year if it is in breach of its minimum solvency margin or minimum liquidity ratio or if the declaration or payment of such dividends would cause it to fail to meet such margin or ratio. If the subsidiary has failed to meet its minimum solvency margin or minimum liquidity ratio on the last day of any fiscal year, each of our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries will be prohibited, without the approval of the BMA, from declaring or paying any dividends during the next fiscal year. In addition, once a Class 3A insurer is required to meet the ECR, if it is in breach of its ECR, it will be prohibited from declaring or paying dividends until it rectifies that breach.
 
Each of our regulated Bermuda insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries is prohibited, without the approval of the BMA, from reducing by 15% or more its total statutory capital as set out in its previous year’s financial statements.
 
Additionally, under the Companies Act, we and each of our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries may declare or pay a dividend, or make a distribution from contributed surplus, only if we have no reasonable grounds for believing that the subsidiary is, or will be after the payment, unable to pay its liabilities as they become due, or that the realizable value of its assets will thereby be less than the aggregate of its liabilities and its issued share capital and share premium accounts.
 
Supervision, Investigation and Intervention.  The BMA may appoint an inspector with extensive powers to investigate the affairs of our regulated Bermuda insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries if the BMA believes that such an investigation is in the best interests of its policyholders or persons who may become policyholders. In order to verify or supplement information otherwise provided to the BMA, the BMA may direct our regulated Bermuda insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries to produce documents or information relating to matters connected with its business. In addition, the BMA has the power to require the production of documents from any person who appears to be in possession of those documents. Further, the BMA has the power, in respect of a person registered under the Insurance Act, to appoint a professional person to prepare a report on any aspect of any matter about which the BMA has required or could require information. If it appears to the BMA to be desirable in the interests of the clients of a person registered under the Insurance Act, the BMA may also exercise the foregoing powers in relation to any company that is, or has at any relevant time been, (1) a parent company, subsidiary company or related company of that registered person, (2) a subsidiary company of a parent company of that registered person, (3) a parent company


34


Table of Contents

of a subsidiary company of that registered person or (4) a controlling shareholder of that registered person, which is a person who either alone or with any associate or associates, holds 50% or more of the shares of that registered person or is entitled to exercise, or control the exercise of, more than 50% of the voting power at a general meeting of shareholders of that registered person. If it appears to the BMA that there is a risk of a regulated Bermuda insurance and reinsurance subsidiary becoming insolvent, or that a regulated Bermuda insurance and reinsurance subsidiary is in breach of the Insurance Act or any conditions imposed upon its registration, the BMA may, among other things, direct such subsidiary (1) not to take on any new insurance business, (2) not to vary any insurance contract if the effect would be to increase its liabilities, (3) not to make certain investments, (4) to liquidate certain investments, (5) to maintain in, or transfer to the custody of a specified bank, certain assets, (6) not to declare or pay any dividends or other distributions or to restrict the making of such payments and/or (7) to limit such subsidiary’s premium income.
 
Disclosure of Information.  In addition to powers under the Insurance Act to investigate the affairs of an insurer, the BMA may require insurers and other persons to furnish information to the BMA. Further, the BMA has been given powers to assist other regulatory authorities, including foreign insurance regulatory authorities, with their investigations involving insurance and reinsurance companies in Bermuda. Such powers are subject to restrictions. For example, the BMA must be satisfied that the assistance being requested is in connection with the discharge of regulatory responsibilities of the foreign regulatory authority. Further, the BMA must consider whether cooperation is in the public interest. The grounds for disclosure are limited and the Insurance Act provides sanctions for breach of the statutory duty of confidentiality. Under the Companies Act, the Minister of Finance has been given powers to assist a foreign regulatory authority that has requested assistance in connection with inquiries being carried out by it in the performance of its regulatory functions. The Minister’s powers include requiring a person to furnish him or her with information, to produce documents to him or her, to attend and answer questions and to give assistance in connection with inquiries. The Minister must be satisfied that the assistance requested by the foreign regulatory authority is for the purpose of its regulatory functions and that the request is in relation to information in Bermuda that a person has in his possession or under his control. The Minister must consider, among other things, whether it is in the public interest to give the information sought.
 
Notification by Shareholder Controller of New or Increased Control.  Any person who, directly or indirectly, becomes a holder of at least 10%, 20%, 33% or 50% of our ordinary shares must notify the BMA in writing within 45 days of becoming such a holder.. The BMA may, by written notice, object to such a person if it appears to the BMA that the person is not fit and proper to be such a holder. The BMA may require the holder to reduce their holding of ordinary shares and direct, among other things, that voting rights attaching to the ordinary shares shall not be exercisable. A person that does not comply with such a notice or direction from the BMA will be guilty of an offense.
 
Objection to Existing Shareholder Controller.  For so long as we have as a subsidiary an insurer registered under the Insurance Act, the BMA may at any time, by written notice, object to a person holding 10% or more of the ordinary shares if it appears to the BMA that the person is not, or is no longer fit and proper to be, such a holder. In such a case, the BMA may require the shareholder to reduce its holding of ordinary shares and direct, among other things, that such shareholder’s voting rights attaching to ordinary shares shall not be exercisable. A person who does not comply with such a notice or direction from the BMA will be guilty of an offense.
 
Certain Other Bermuda Law Considerations.  Although we are incorporated in Bermuda, we are classified as a non-resident of Bermuda for exchange control purposes by the BMA. Pursuant to our non-resident status, we may engage in transactions in currencies other than Bermuda dollars and there are no restrictions on our ability to transfer funds (other than funds denominated in Bermuda dollars) in and out of Bermuda or to pay dividends to U.S. residents who are holders of our ordinary shares.
 
Under Bermuda law, exempted companies are companies formed for the purpose of conducting business outside Bermuda from a principal place of business in Bermuda. As “exempted” companies, neither we nor any of our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries may, without the express authorization of the Bermuda legislature or under a license or consent granted by the Minister of Finance, participate in certain business transactions, including: (1) the acquisition or holding of land in Bermuda (except that held by way of lease or tenancy agreement that is required for our business and held for a term not exceeding 50 years, or that is used to provide accommodation or recreational


35


Table of Contents

facilities for our officers and employees and held with the consent of the Bermuda Minister of Finance, for a term not exceeding 21 years), (2) the taking of mortgages on land in Bermuda to secure an amount in excess of $50,000, or (3) the carrying on of business of any kind for which we are not licensed in Bermuda, except in limited circumstances such as doing business with another exempted undertaking in furtherance of our business carried on outside Bermuda. Each of our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries is a licensed insurer in Bermuda, and, as such, may carry on activities from Bermuda that are related to and in support of its insurance business.
 
Ordinary shares may be offered or sold in Bermuda only in compliance with the provisions of the Investment Business Act 2003 of Bermuda, which regulates the sale of securities in Bermuda. In addition, the BMA must approve all issues and transfers of securities of a Bermuda exempted company. Where any equity securities (meaning shares that entitle the holder to vote for or appoint one or more directors or securities that by their terms are convertible into shares that entitle the holder to vote for or appoint one or more directors) of a Bermuda company are listed on an appointed stock exchange (which includes Nasdaq), the BMA has given general permission for the issue and subsequent transfer of any securities of the company from and/or to a non-resident for so long as any such equity securities of the company remain so listed.
 
The Bermuda government actively encourages foreign investment in “exempted” entities like us and our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries that are based in Bermuda, but which do not operate in competition with local businesses. We and our regulated Bermuda subsidiaries are not currently subject to taxes computed on profits or income or computed on any capital asset, gain or appreciation, or any tax in the nature of estate duty or inheritance tax or to any foreign exchange controls in Bermuda.
 
Under Bermuda law, non-Bermudians (other than spouses of Bermudians, holders of a permanent resident’s certificate or holders of a working resident’s certificate) may not engage in any gainful occupation in Bermuda without an appropriate governmental work permit. Work permits may be granted or extended by the Bermuda government upon showing that, after proper public advertisement in most cases, no Bermudian (or spouse of a Bermudian, holder of a permanent resident’s certificate or holder of a working resident’s certificate) is available who meets the minimum standard requirements for the advertised position. In 2004, the Bermuda government announced a new immigration policy limiting the duration of work permits to six years, with specified exemptions for “key” employees. The categories of “key” employees include senior executives (chief executive officers, presidents through vice presidents), managers with global responsibility, senior financial posts (treasurers, chief financial officers through controllers, specialized qualified accountants, quantitative modeling analysts), certain legal professionals (general counsels, specialist attorneys, qualified legal librarians and knowledge managers), senior insurance professionals (senior underwriters, senior claims adjusters), experienced/specialized brokers, actuaries, specialist investment traders/analysts and senior information technology engineers/managers. All of our executive officers who work in our Bermuda office have obtained work permits.
 
United Kingdom
 
General.  On December 1, 2001, the U.K. Financial Services Authority, or the FSA, assumed its full powers and responsibilities as the single statutory regulator responsible for regulating the financial services industry in respect of the carrying on of “regulated activities” (including deposit taking, insurance, investment management and most other financial services business by way of business in the U.K.), with the purpose of maintaining confidence in the U.K. financial system, providing public understanding of the system, securing the proper degree of protection for consumers and helping to reduce financial crime. It is a criminal offense for any person to carry on a regulated activity in the U.K. unless that person is authorized by the FSA and has been granted permission to carry on that regulated activity or falls under an exemption.
 
Insurance business (which includes reinsurance business) is authorized and supervised by the FSA. Insurance business in the United Kingdom is divided between two main categories: long-term insurance (which is primarily investment-related) and general insurance. Aside from certain insurers with historical exemptions, it is not possible for an insurance company to be authorized in both long-term and general insurance business. These two categories are both divided into “classes” (for example: permanent health and pension fund management are two classes of long-term insurance; damage to property and motor vehicle liability are two classes of general insurance). Under the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000, or the FSMA, effecting or carrying out contracts of insurance, within


36


Table of Contents

a class of general or long-term insurance, by way of business in the United Kingdom, constitutes a regulated activity requiring individual authorization. An authorized insurance company must have permission for each class of insurance business it intends to write.
 
Certain of our regulated U.K. subsidiaries, as authorized insurers, would be able to operate throughout the European Union, subject to certain regulatory requirements of the FSA and in some cases, certain local regulatory requirements. An insurance company with FSA authorization to write insurance business in the United Kingdom can seek consent from the FSA to allow it to provide cross-border services in other member states of the E.U. As an alternative, FSA consent may be obtained to establish a branch office within another member state. Although in run-off, our regulated U.K. subsidiaries remain regulated by the FSA, but may not underwrite new business.
 
As FSA authorized insurers, the insurance and reinsurance businesses of our regulated U.K. subsidiaries are subject to close supervision by the FSA. The FSA has implemented specific requirements for senior management arrangements, systems and controls of insurance and reinsurance companies under its jurisdiction, which place a strong emphasis on risk identification and management in relation to the prudential regulation of insurance and reinsurance business in the United Kingdom.
 
Supervision.  The FSA carries out the prudential supervision of insurance companies through a variety of methods, including the collection of information from statistical returns, review of accountants’ reports, visits to insurance companies and regular formal interviews.
 
The FSA has adopted a risk-based approach to the supervision of insurance companies. Under this approach the FSA performs a formal risk assessment of insurance companies or groups carrying on business in the U.K. periodically. The periods between U.K. assessments vary in length according to the risk profile of the insurer. The FSA performs the risk assessment by analyzing information which it receives during the normal course of its supervision, such as regular prudential returns on the financial position of the insurance company, or which it acquires through a series of meetings with senior management of the insurance company. After each risk assessment, the FSA will inform the insurer of its views on the insurer’s risk profile. This will include details of any remedial action that the FSA requires and the likely consequences if this action is not taken.
 
Solvency Requirements.  The Integrated Prudential Sourcebook requires that insurance companies maintain a required solvency margin at all times in respect of any general insurance undertaken by the insurance company. The calculation of the required margin in any particular case depends on the type and amount of insurance business a company writes. The method of calculation of the required solvency margin is set out in the Integrated Prudential Sourcebook, and for these purposes, all insurer’s assets and liabilities are subject to specific valuation rules which are set out in the Integrated Prudential Sourcebook. Failure to maintain the required solvency margin is one of the grounds on which wide powers of intervention conferred upon the FSA may be exercised. For fiscal years ending on or after January 1, 2004, the calculation of the required solvency margin has been amended as a result of the implementation of the EU Solvency I Directives. In respect of liability business accepted, 150% of the actual premiums written and claims incurred must be included in the calculation, which has had the effect of increasing the required solvency margin of our regulated U.K. subsidiaries. We continuously monitor the solvency capital position of the U.K. subsidiaries and maintain capital in excess of the required solvency margin.
 
Insurers are required to calculate an Enhanced Capital Requirement, or ECR, in addition to their required solvency margin. This represents a more risk-sensitive calculation than the previous required solvency margin requirements and is used by the FSA as its benchmark in assessing its Individual Capital Adequacy Standards. Insurers must maintain financial resources which are adequate, both as to amount and quality, to ensure that there is no significant risk that its liabilities cannot be met as they come due. In order to carry out the assessment as to the necessary financial resources that are required, insurers are required to identify the major sources of risk to its ability to meet its liabilities as they come due, and to carry out stress and scenario tests to identify an appropriate range of realistic adverse scenarios in which the risk crystallizes and to estimate the financial resources needed in each of the circumstances and events identified. In addition, the FSA gives Individual Capital Guidance, or ICG, regularly to insurers and reinsurers following receipt of individual capital assessments, prepared by firms themselves. The FSA’s guidance may be that a company should hold more or less than its then current level of regulatory capital, or that the company’s regulatory capital should remain unaltered. We calculated the ECR for our regulated U.K. subsidiaries for the period ended December 31, 2009 and submitted those calculations in March


37


Table of Contents

2010 to the FSA as part of their statutory filings. The ECR calculations for its regulated U.K. subsidiaries for the year ended December 31, 2010 will be submitted by no later than March 31, 2011.
 
In addition, an insurer (other than a pure reinsurer) that is part of a group is required to perform and submit to the FSA an audited Group Capital Adequacy Return, or GCAR. The GCAR is a solvency margin calculation return in respect of its ultimate parent undertaking, in accordance with the FSA’s rules. This return is not part of an insurer’s own solvency return and hence will not be publicly available. Although there is no requirement for the parent undertaking solvency calculation to show a positive result, the FSA may take action where it considers that the solvency of the insurance company is or may be jeopardized due to the group solvency position. Further, an insurer is required to report in its annual returns to the FSA all material related party transactions (e.g., intra-group reinsurance, whose value is more than 5% of the insurer’s general insurance business amount).
 
Solvency II.  In April 2009, the European Parliament approved the Solvency II framework directive, due to come into force on December 31, 2012. Solvency II will set out new, strengthened EU-wide requirements on capital adequacy and risk management for insurers with the aim of increasing policyholder protection, instilling greater risk awareness and improving the international competitiveness of EU insurers.
 
Restrictions on Dividend Payments.  U.K. company law prohibits our regulated U.K. subsidiaries from declaring a dividend to their shareholders unless they have “profits available for distribution.” The determination of whether a company has profits available for distribution is based on its accumulated realized profits less its accumulated realized losses. While the United Kingdom insurance regulatory laws impose no statutory restrictions on a general insurer’s ability to declare a dividend, the FSA strictly controls the maintenance of each insurance company’s required solvency margin within its jurisdiction. The FSA’s rules require our regulated U.K. subsidiaries to obtain FSA approval for any proposed or actual payment of a dividend.
 
Reporting Requirements.  U.K. insurance companies must prepare their financial statements under the Companies Act 2006, which requires the filing with Companies House of audited financial statements and related reports. In addition, U.K. insurance companies are required to file with the FSA regulatory returns, which include a revenue account, a profit and loss account and a balance sheet in prescribed forms. Under the Interim Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers, audited regulatory returns must be filed with the FSA within two months and 15 days (or three months where the delivery of the return is made electronically) of the company’s year end. Our regulated U.K. insurance subsidiaries are also required to submit abridged quarterly information to the FSA.
 
Supervision of Management.  The FSA closely supervises the management of insurance companies through the approved persons regime, by which any appointment of persons to perform certain specified “controlled functions” within a regulated entity, must be approved by the FSA.
 
Change of Control.  FSMA regulates the acquisition of “control” of any U.K. insurance company authorized under FSMA. Any company or individual that (together with its or his associates) directly or indirectly acquires 20% or more of the shares in a U.K. authorized insurance company or its parent company, or is entitled to exercise or control the exercise of 20% or more of the voting power in such authorized insurance company or its parent company, would be considered to have acquired “control” for the purposes of the relevant legislation, as would a person who had significant influence over the management of such authorized insurance company or its parent company by virtue of his shareholding or voting power in either. A purchaser of 20% or more of our ordinary shares would therefore be considered to have acquired “control” of our regulated U.K. subsidiaries.
 
Under FSMA, any person proposing to acquire “control” over a U.K. authorized insurance company must give prior notification to the FSA of his intention to do so. The FSA would then have up to 60 working days (without taking into account any interruption period) to consider that person’s application to acquire “control.” In considering whether to approve such application, the FSA must be satisfied that both the acquirer is a fit and proper person to have such “control” and that the interests of consumers would not be threatened by such acquisition of “control.” Failure to make the relevant prior application could result in action being taken against us by the FSA.
 
Intervention and Enforcement.  The FSA has extensive powers to intervene in the affairs of an authorized person, culminating in the ultimate sanction of the removal of authorization to carry on a regulated activity. FSMA imposes on the FSA statutory obligations to monitor compliance with the requirements imposed by FSMA, and to enforce the provisions of FSMA-related rules made by the FSA. The FSA has power, among other things, to enforce


38


Table of Contents

and take disciplinary measures in respect of breaches of both the Interim Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers and breaches of the conduct of business rules generally applicable to authorized persons.
 
The FSA also has the power to prosecute criminal offenses arising under FSMA, and to prosecute insider dealing under Part V of the Criminal Justice Act of 1993, and breaches of money laundering regulations. The FSA’s stated policy is to pursue criminal prosecution in all appropriate cases.
 
Passporting.  European Union directives allow our regulated U.K. subsidiaries to conduct business in European Union states other than the United Kingdom in compliance with the scope of permission granted these companies by the FSA without the necessity of additional licensing or authorization in other European Union jurisdictions. This ability to operate in other jurisdictions of the European Union on the basis of home state authorization and supervision is sometimes referred to as “passporting.” Insurers may operate outside their home member state either on a “services” basis or on an “establishment” basis. Operating on a “services” basis means that the company conducts permitted businesses in the host state without having a physical presence there, while operating on an “establishment” basis means the company has a branch or physical presence in the host state. In both cases, a company remains subject to regulation by its home regulator, and not by local regulatory authorities, although the company nonetheless may have to comply with certain local rules. In addition to European Union member states, Norway, Iceland and Liechtenstein (members of the broader European Economic Area) are jurisdictions in which this passporting framework applies.
 
Australia
 
In Australia, four of our subsidiaries are companies with Insurance Act 1973 authorizations. Three of these companies are insurance companies authorized to conduct run-off business and one is an authorized non-operating holding company, or NOHC. In addition, we have five Australian registered companies not authorized to conduct insurance business, but which provide services to the authorized entities.
 
Regulators.  The authorized non-operating holding company and the authorized insurers are regulated and are subject to prudential supervision by the Australian Prudential Regulation Authority, or APRA. APRA is the primary regulatory body responsible for regulating compliance with the Insurance Act 1973, or the 1973 Act. In addition, all companies, including the non-authorized entities, must comply with the Corporations Act 2001 and its primary regulator the Australian Securities and Investments Commission, or ASIC.
 
APRA was established in 1998 as an independent body to supervise banks, credit unions, building societies, general insurance and reinsurance companies, life insurance, friendly societies, and most members of the superannuation industry. APRA’s supervisory role over these institutions includes licensing, conducting on-site operational reviews, assessing risk, responding to queries and collecting data. In addition, APRA enforces and administers the 1973 Act and promulgates Prudential Standards to regulate the industries it supervises.
 
ASIC is Australia’s corporate, markets and financial services regulator. In 2001, the Financial Services Reform Act 2001 amended Chapter 7 of the Corporations Act 2001 and the reforms came into force, after a transitional period, in March 2004. These reforms, as they relate to insurance and insurers, are intended to promote: confident and informed decision making by consumers of insurance products and services while facilitating efficiency, flexibility and innovation in the provision of those products and services; fairness, honesty and professionalism by those who provide insurance services; and fair, orderly and transparent markets for insurance products. In 2010, ASIC took on responsibility for regulation of Australia’s domestic financial markets and their participants. Through its responsibility for the regulation of financial services, ASIC regulates the giving of advice and making of disclosures in relation to insurance products.
 
APRA and ASIC entered into a Memorandum of Understanding in June 2004. The objective of the Memorandum was to set out the framework for cooperation between the two agencies in areas of common interest and to set out the responsibilities of each entity. The Memorandum outlined APRA’s responsibilities as the prudential supervisor of the financial services industry and ASIC’s responsibilities as the body that would be monitoring, regulating and enforcing the Corporations Act and the Financial Services Reform Act and promoting market integrity.


39


Table of Contents

APRA’s Powers.  The 1973 Act prescribes APRA’s powers in respect of the authorization and prudential supervision of general insurers. The 1973 Act aims to protect the interests of policy holders and prospective policy holders under insurance policies in ways that are consistent with the continued development of a viable, competitive and innovative insurance industry.
 
APRA’s enforcement and disciplinary powers under the 1973 Act include powers to: (a) revoke the authorization of a general insurer or authorized non-operating holding company; (b) remove a director or senior manager of a general insurer, authorized non-operating holding company or corporate agent; (c) determine prudential standards; (d) monitor prudential matters; (e) collect information from auditors and actuaries; (f) remove auditors and actuaries; (g) investigate general insurers and unauthorized insurance matters; (h) apply to have a general insurer wound up; (i) determine insolvent insurer’s liabilities in respect of early claims; (j) direct Lloyd’s underwriters to not issue or renew policies; and (k) make directions in certain circumstances.
 
Conducting Insurance Business in Australia.  The 1973 Act only permits APRA authorized bodies corporate and Lloyd’s underwriters to carry on general insurance business in Australia. Those entities authorized to conduct insurance business in Australia are classified into the following categories:
 
  •  Category A insurer — an insurer incorporated in Australia that does not fall within any of the other categories of insurer;
 
  •  Category B insurer — an insurer incorporated in Australia that is also a subsidiary of a local or foreign insurance group;
 
  •  Category C insurer — “a foreign general insurer,” which is a foreign insurer operating as a foreign branch in Australia;
 
  •  Category D insurer — an insurer incorporated in Australia that is owned by an industry or a professional association, or by the members of the industry or professional association or a combination of both; and only underwrites business risk of the members of the association or those who are eligible to become members. Medical indemnity insurers are not included in this definition; or
 
  •  Category E insurer — an insurer incorporated in Australia that is a corporate captive or a partnership captive. Category E insurers are often referred to as “sole parent captives.”
 
Foreign-owned subsidiaries and foreign general insurers must be authorized by APRA to conduct business in Australia and are subject to similar legislative and prudential requirements as Australian owned and incorporated insurers.
 
Ownership and Control.  The Financial Sector (Shareholdings) Act 1998 governs the ownership of insurers in Australia. The interest of an individual shareholder or a group of associated shareholders in an insurer is generally limited to 15% of the insurer’s voting shares. A higher percentage limit may be approved by the Treasurer of the Commonwealth of Australia on national interest grounds.
 
The Insurance Acquisitions and Takeovers Act 1991 governs the control of and compulsory notification of proposals relating to both the acquisition and lease of Australian-registered insurance companies. All acquisition or lease proposals must be notified to the Minister for Revenue, with authority delegated to APRA, who has the discretion to make a “permanent restraining order” or “go ahead decision” regarding the proposal.
 
Compliance and Governance.  Section 32 of the 1973 Act authorizes APRA to determine, vary and revoke prudential standards that impose different requirements to be complied with by different classes of general insurers, authorized non-operating holding companies and their respective subsidiaries. Presently APRA has issued prudential standards that apply to general insurers in relation to capital adequacy, the holding of assets in Australia, risk management, business continuity management, reinsurance management, outsourcing, audit and actuarial reporting and valuation, the transfer and amalgamation of insurance businesses, governance, and the fit and proper assessment of the insurer’s responsible persons.
 
In November 2009, APRA released a new prudential standard entitled GPS 510-Governance with an effective commencement date of April 1, 2010. GPS 510-Governance updated the previous version of GPS 510-Governance by imposing new remuneration obligations on general insurers. GPS 510-Governance mandates that the Board of a


40


Table of Contents

general insurer (or the group Board if part of a corporate group) must have a remuneration policy that aligns remuneration and risk management. Furthermore, it requires that a Board remuneration committee must be established for each regulated entity (or each group if the regulated entity is part of a corporate group).
 
Capital Adequacy.  APRA’s prudential standards require that all insurers maintain and meet prescribed capital adequacy requirements to enable its insurance obligations to be met under a wide range of circumstances. This requires authorized insurers to hold eligible capital in excess of the minimum capital requirement. This amount may be determined using the prescribed method or an internal model based method. APRA has determined that two tiers of capital may be deemed eligible capital and may be used to determine an insurer’s capital base. Tier 1 capital comprises the highest quality capital components and Tier 2 capital includes other components that fall short of the quality of Tier 1 capital but still contribute to the overall strength of the insurer. As part of the determination of the proper capital adequacy using the prescribed method, insurers must determine and consider whether or not they must apply prudentially required investment risk charges, insurance risk capital charges and concentration risk capital charges to their capital amount for the purposes of determining the applicable minimum capital requirements.
 
In addition to the foregoing capital adequacy regulation, APRA has determined that capital adequacy must also be regulated at the group level, see “Group Supervision and Reporting” below.
 
Group Supervision and Reporting.  APRA introduced a new regime for group supervision and reporting in 2009. The Level 2 insurance group supervision and reporting framework applies to a Level 2 insurance group and introduced additional prudential standards, known as Level 2 prudential standards, that are to be read in conjunction with the existing prudential framework, now known as the Level 1 prudential standards. The definition of a Level 2 insurance group includes a NOHC and its controlled insurers and entities, subject to the exemption of certain non-regulated companies from the insurance group.
 
The foundation of APRA’s approach to the supervision of Level 2 insurance groups is that the group as a whole should meet essentially the same minimum capital requirements as apply to individual general insurers. APRA deemed this approach essential to ensure that the acts of an individual insurer in a group do not alter the risk profile of other insurers in the group through financial and operational inter-relationships with other group members or through decisions taken at the group level.
 
For the purposes of the new group supervision and reporting prudential standards, our Australian authorized NOHC is deemed the parent entity of a Level 2 insurance group. The new prudential standards for insurance group supervision became effective on March 31, 2009 and new reporting standards apply to all Level 2 insurance groups for reporting periods commencing on or after June 30, 2009.
 
Capital Releases.  An insurer must obtain APRA’s written consent prior to making any planned reductions in its capital.
 
A reduction in an insurer’s capital includes, but is not limited to:
 
  •  a share buyback;
 
  •  the redemption, repurchase or early repayment of any qualifying Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital instruments issued by the insurer or a special purpose vehicle;
 
  •  trading in the insurer’s own shares or capital instruments outside of any arrangement agreed upon with APRA;
 
  •  payment of dividends on ordinary shares that exceeds an insurer’s after-tax earnings, after including payments on more senior capital instruments, in the financial year to which they relate; and
 
  •  dividend or interest payments (whether whole or partial) on specific types of Tier 2 and Tier 1 capital that exceed an insurer’s after-tax earnings, including any payments made on more senior capital instruments, calculated before any such payments are applied in the financial year to which they relate.


41


Table of Contents

 
An Australian insurer in run-off must provide APRA a valuation prepared by the appointed actuary that demonstrates that the tangible assets of the insurer, after the proposed capital reduction, are sufficient to cover its insurance liabilities to a 99.5% level of sufficiency of capital before APRA will consent to a capital release.
 
Assets in Australia.  The 1973 Act and APRA require that all insurers are required to maintain assets in Australia at least equal to their liabilities in Australia and foreign insurers are required to maintain assets in Australia that exceed their liabilities in Australia by an amount that is greater than their minimum capital requirements.
 
Audit and Actuarial Reporting Requirements.  APRA requires insurers to submit data in accordance with the reporting standards under the Financial Sector (Collection of Data) Act 1988. Insurers must provide quarterly returns and annual audited returns to APRA. Insurers in run-off must provide a run-off plan annually. Insurance contract transactions are accounted for on a “prospective accounting basis,” which results in all premium revenue, acquisition costs and reinsurance expenses being recorded directly into profit and loss. Australian Prudential Standard GPS 310 was updated effective July 1, 2010 to simplify prudential reporting obligations for general insurers.
 
APRA requires all insurers, except for small insurers (those insurers with less than $20 million of gross insurance liabilities and no material long-tail insurance liabilities) to appoint an actuary. These insurers must obtain an annual insurance liability valuation report, or ILVR, and financial condition report from the appointed actuary. Although an appointed actuary for an insurer in run-off need not provide a financial condition report, he or she must provide a report setting out his or her review of the insurer’s required run-off plan.
 
The ILVR must be peer reviewed by another actuary. Insurance liabilities are to be determined as central estimates on a discounted basis plus a risk margin assessed at a 75% level of sufficiency.
 
APRA requires all insurers to appoint an auditor. The auditor must prepare a certificate in relation to the insurer’s annual APRA reporting requirements and prepare a report annually about the systems, procedures and controls within the insurer.
 
Section 334 of the Corporations Act 2001 provides that the Australian Accounting Standards Board may make accounting standards for the purposes of the Corporations Act. The relevant standards are Accounting Standards AASB 4 (Insurance) and AASB 1023 (General Insurance Contracts).
 
Outsourcing.  APRA requires that all outsourcing arrangements of material business activities must be documented in the form of written contracts except for some intra-group arrangements. An insurer must consult with APRA prior to entering into outsourcing arrangements where the service and the entity providing the service are located outside of Australia. Insurers are also required to maintain a policy relating to outsourcing that ensures there is sufficient monitoring of the outsourced activities.
 
SOARS and PAIRS.  APRA maintains two risk assessment, supervisory and response tools to assist APRA with its risk-based approach to supervision. The Probability and Impact Ratings System, or PAIRS, is APRA’s risk assessment model and is divided into two dimensions, the probability and impact of the failure of an APRA regulated insurer. The PAIRS risk assessment involves an assessment of the following categories: board, management, risk governance, strategy and planning; liquidity risk; operational risk; credit risk; market and investment risk; insurance risk; capital coverage/surplus risk; earnings; and access to additional capital. The assessment of these categories involves consideration of four key factors: inherent risk, management and control, net risk and capital support. APRA does not publish insurer’s PAIRS ratings, but does make them available to the insurer.
 
The Supervisory Oversight and Response System, or SOARS, is used to determine the regulatory response based on the PAIRS risk assessment. An insurer may have a SOARS supervision stance of normal, oversight, mandated improvement or restructure. APRA does not publish insurer’s SOARS ratings, but does make them available to the insurer.
 
Australian Prudential Framework and Australian Accounting Standards Board.  APRA maintains a prudential framework that requires the maintenance and collection of certain financial information. In certain circumstances the collection of this information is categorized differently that the manner prescribed by the Australian Accounting Standards Board, or AASB, in the Accounting Standards. AASB’s standards are based on


42


Table of Contents

the matching concept whereas the APRA prudential framework is based on perspective accounting. While there are differences between the two methods, those differences do not apply to our Australian subsidiaries for a variety of reasons, such as going concern issues and the current assets held by those entities.
 
United States
 
As of December 31, 2010, we own seven property and casualty insurance companies domiciled in the U.S., our U.S. Insurers, all of which are in run-off.
 
General.  In common with other insurers, our U.S. Insurers are subject to extensive governmental regulation and supervision in the various states and jurisdictions in which they are domiciled and licensed and/or approved to conduct business. The laws and regulations of the state of domicile have the most significant impact on operations. This regulation and supervision is designed to protect policyholders rather than investors. Generally, regulatory authorities have broad regulatory powers over such matters as licenses, standards of solvency, premium rates, policy forms, marketing practices, claims practices, investments, security deposits, methods of accounting, form and content of financial statements, reserves and provisions for unearned premiums, unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, reinsurance, minimum capital and surplus requirements, dividends and other distributions to shareholders, periodic examinations and annual and other report filings. In addition, transactions among affiliates, including certain reinsurance agreements or arrangements, as well as certain third-party transactions, require prior approval or non-disapproval from, or prior notice to, the applicable regulator under certain circumstances. Regulatory authorities also conduct periodic financial, claims and other types of examinations. Finally, our U.S. Insurers are also subject to the general laws of the jurisdictions in which they do business. Certain insurance regulatory requirements are highlighted below.
 
Insurance Holding Company Systems Acts.  State insurance holding company system statutes and related regulations provide a regulatory apparatus that is designed to protect the financial condition of domestic insurers operating within a holding company system. All insurance holding company statutes and regulations require disclosure and, in some instances, prior approval or non-disapproval of certain transactions involving the domestic insurer and an affiliate. These transactions typically include sales, purchases, exchanges, loans and extensions of credit, reinsurance agreements, service agreements, guarantees, investments and other material transactions between an insurance company and its affiliates, involving in the aggregate specified percentages of an insurance company’s admitted assets or policyholders surplus, or dividends that exceed specified percentages of an insurance company’s surplus or income.
 
The state insurance holding company system statutes and regulations may discourage potential acquisition proposals and may delay, deter or prevent a change of control of us, any of the other direct or indirect parents of any of our U.S. Insurers, or any of our U.S. Insurers, including through transactions, and in particular unsolicited transactions, that we or our shareholders might consider to be desirable.
 
Before a person can acquire control of a domestic insurer (including a reinsurer) or any person controlling such insurer or reinsurer, prior written approval must be obtained from the insurance commissioner of the state in which the domestic insurer is domiciled and, under certain circumstances, from insurance commissioners in other jurisdictions. Prior to granting approval of an application to acquire control of a domestic insurer or person controlling the domestic insurer, the state insurance commissioner of the jurisdiction in which the insurer is domiciled will consider such factors as the financial strength of the applicant, the integrity and management of the applicant’s board of directors and executive officers, the acquiror’s plans for the future operations of the domestic insurer and any anti-competitive results that may arise from the closing of the acquisition of control. Generally, state statutes and regulations provide that “control” over a domestic insurer or person controlling a domestic insurer is presumed to exist if any person, directly or indirectly, owns, controls, holds with the power to vote, or holds proxies representing, 10% or more of the voting securities or securities convertible into voting securities of the domestic insurer or of a person who controls a domestic insurer. Florida statutes create a presumption of control when any person, directly or indirectly, owns, controls, holds with the power to vote, or holds proxies representing, 5% or more of the voting securities or securities convertible into voting securities of the domestic insurer or person controlling a domestic insurer.


43


Table of Contents

Because a person acquiring 5% or more of our ordinary shares would be presumed to acquire control of Capital Assurance, which is domiciled in Florida, and because a person acquiring 10% or more of our ordinary shares would be presumed to acquire control of the other U.S. Insurers, the U.S. insurance change of control laws will likely apply to such transactions.
 
Typically, the holding company statutes and regulations will also require each of our U.S. Insurers periodically to file information with state insurance regulatory authorities, including information concerning capital structure, ownership, financial condition and general business operations.
 
Regulation of Dividends and other Payments from Insurance Subsidiaries.  The ability of a U.S. insurer to pay dividends or make other distributions is generally subject to insurance regulatory limitations of the insurance company’s state of domicile. Generally, these laws require prior regulatory approval before an insurer may pay a dividend or make a distribution above a specified level. In many U.S. jurisdictions, dividends may only be paid out of earned surplus. In addition, the laws of many U.S. jurisdictions require an insurer to report for informational purposes to the insurance commissioner of its state of domicile all declarations and proposed payments of dividends and other distributions to security holders. Any return of capital from a U.S. insurance company generally would require prior approval of the domestic regulators.
 
The dividend limitations imposed by state insurance laws are based on statutory financial results, determined by using statutory accounting practices that differ in certain respects from accounting principles used in financial statements prepared in conformity with U.S. GAAP. The significant differences include treatment of deferred acquisition costs, deferred income taxes, required investment reserves, reserve calculation assumptions and surplus notes. In connection with the acquisition of a U.S. insurer, insurance regulators in the United States often impose, as a condition to the approval of the acquisition, additional restrictions on the ability of the U.S. insurer to pay dividends or make other distributions for specified periods of time.
 
Accreditation.  The National Association of Insurance Commissioners, or the NAIC, has instituted its Financial Regulations Standards and Accreditation Program, or FRSAP, in response to federal initiatives to regulate the business of insurance. FRSAP provides a set of standards designed to establish effective state regulation of the financial condition of insurance companies. Under FRSAP, a state must adopt certain laws and regulations, institute required regulatory practices and procedures, and have adequate personnel to enforce these laws and regulations in order to become an “accredited” state. Accredited states are not able to accept certain financial examination reports of insurers prepared solely by the regulatory agency in an unaccredited state. The respective states in which our U.S. Insurers are domiciled are accredited states.
 
Insurance Regulatory Information System Ratios.  The NAIC Insurance Regulatory Information System, or IRIS, was developed by a committee of state insurance regulators and is intended primarily to assist state insurance departments in executing their statutory mandates to oversee the financial condition of insurance companies operating in their respective states. IRIS identifies 13 industry ratios and specifies “usual values” for each ratio. Departure from the usual values of the ratios can lead to inquiries from individual state insurance commissioners regarding different aspects of an insurer’s business. Insurers that report four or more unusual values are generally targeted for regulatory review. For 2010, certain of our U.S. Insurers generated IRIS ratios that were outside of the usual ranges. Only Seaton has been subject to any increased regulatory review, but there is no assurance that our other U.S. Insurers will not be subject to increased scrutiny in the future.
 
Risk-Based Capital Requirements.  In order to enhance the regulation of insurer solvency, the NAIC adopted a formula and model law to implement risk-based capital requirements for property and casualty insurance companies. These risk-based capital requirements change from time to time and are designed to assess capital adequacy and to raise the level of protection that statutory surplus provides for policyholder obligations. The risk-based capital model for property and casualty insurance companies measures three major areas of risk facing property and casualty insurers:
 
  •  underwriting, which encompasses the risk of adverse loss developments and inadequate pricing;
 
  •  declines in asset values arising from credit risk; and
 
  •  declines in asset values arising from investment risks.


44


Table of Contents

 
Insurers having less statutory surplus than required by the risk-based capital calculation will be subject to varying degrees of regulatory action, depending on the level of capital inadequacy.
 
Under the approved formula, an insurer’s statutory surplus is compared to its risk-based capital requirement. If this ratio is above a minimum threshold, no company or regulatory action is necessary. Below this threshold are four distinct action levels at which a regulator can intervene with increasing degrees of authority over an insurer as the ratio of surplus to risk-based capital requirement decreases. The four action levels include:
 
  •  insurer is required to submit a plan for corrective action;
 
  •  insurer is subject to examination, analysis and specific corrective action;
 
  •  regulators may place insurer under regulatory control; and
 
  •  regulators are required to place insurer under regulatory control.
 
Some of our U.S. Insurers, from time to time, may have risk-based capital levels that are below required levels and be subject to increased regulatory scrutiny and control by their domestic insurance regulator. As of December 31, 2010, one of our U.S. insurance companies was not in compliance with its applicable risk-based capital level. We do not believe this company’s non-compliance presents material risk to our operations or our financial condition. With the exception of the above, all of our consolidated U.S. Insurers were in compliance with minimum risk-based capital levels as of December 31, 2010.
 
Guaranty Funds and Assigned Risk Plans.  Most states require all admitted insurance companies to participate in their respective guaranty funds that cover various claims against insolvent insurers. Solvent insurers licensed in these states are required to cover the losses paid on behalf of insolvent insurers by the guaranty funds and are generally subject to annual assessments in the state by its guaranty fund to cover these losses. Some states also require admitted insurance companies to participate in assigned risk plans, which provide coverage for automobile insurance and other lines for insureds that, for various reasons, cannot otherwise obtain insurance in the open market. This participation may take the form of reinsuring a portion of a pool of policies or the direct issuance of policies to insureds. The calculation of an insurer’s participation in these plans is usually based on the amount of premium for that type of coverage that was written by the insurer on a voluntary basis in a prior year. Participation in assigned risk pools tends to produce losses which result in assessments to insurers writing the same lines on a voluntary basis. Our U.S. Insurers may be subject to guaranty fund assessments and may participate in assigned risk plans.
 
Credit for Reinsurance.  Licensed reinsurers in the United States are subject to insurance regulation and supervision that is similar to the regulation of licensed primary insurers. However, the terms and conditions of reinsurance agreements generally are not subject to regulation by any governmental authority with respect to rates or policy terms. This contrasts with primary insurance policies and agreements, the rates and terms of which sometimes are regulated by state insurance regulators. As a practical matter, however, the rates charged by primary insurers do have an effect on the rates that can be charged by reinsurers. A primary insurer ordinarily will enter into a reinsurance agreement only if it can obtain credit for the reinsurance ceded on its statutory financial statements. In general, credit for reinsurance is allowed in the following circumstances:
 
  •  if the reinsurer is licensed in the state in which the primary insurer is domiciled or, in some instances, in certain states in which the primary insurer is licensed;
 
  •  if the reinsurer is an “accredited” or otherwise approved reinsurer in the state in which the primary insurer is domiciled or, in some instances, in certain states in which the primary insurer is licensed;
 
  •  in some instances, if the reinsurer (1) is domiciled in a state that is deemed to have substantially similar credit for reinsurance standards as the state in which the primary insurer is domiciled and (2) meets financial requirements; or
 
  •  if none of the above apply, to the extent that the reinsurance obligations of the reinsurer are secured appropriately, typically through the posting of a letter of credit for the benefit of the primary insurer or the deposit of assets into a trust fund established for the benefit of the primary insurer.


45


Table of Contents

 
As a result of the requirements relating to the provision of credit for reinsurance, our U.S. Insurers and our insurers domiciled outside the U.S., when reinsuring risks from cedants domiciled or licensed in U.S. jurisdictions in which our reinsurers are not domiciled or admitted, may be indirectly subject to some regulatory requirements imposed by jurisdictions in which ceding companies are licensed. Because our non-U.S. insurers are not licensed, accredited or otherwise approved by or domiciled in any state in the U.S., and because our U.S. Insurers are not admitted in all U.S. jurisdictions, primary insurers are only willing to cede business to such insurers if we provide adequate security to allow the primary insurer to take credit on its balance sheet for the reinsurance it purchased. Such security may be provided by various means, including the posting of a letter of credit or deposit of assets into a trust fund for the benefit of the primary insurer. There can be no assurance that we will be able to continue to post letters of credit or provide other forms of security on favorable terms.
 
Statutory Accounting Principles.  Statutory accounting principles, or SAP, are a basis of accounting developed to assist insurance regulators in monitoring and regulating the solvency of insurance companies. It is primarily concerned with measuring an insurer’s surplus to policyholders and ensuring solvency. Accordingly, statutory accounting focuses on valuing assets and liabilities of insurers at financial reporting dates in accordance with appropriate insurance law and regulatory provisions applicable in each insurer’s domiciliary state.
 
U.S. GAAP is concerned with a company’s solvency, but it is also concerned with other financial measurements, such as income and cash flows. Accordingly, U.S. GAAP gives more consideration to appropriate matching of revenue and expenses and accounting for management’s stewardship of assets than does SAP. As a result, different assets and liabilities and different amounts of assets and liabilities will be reflected in financial statements prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP as opposed to SAP.
 
Statutory accounting practices established by the NAIC and adopted, in part, by state insurance departments, will determine, among other things, the amount of statutory surplus and statutory net income of our U.S. Insurers, which will affect, in part, the amount of funds they have available to pay dividends to us.
 
Federal Regulation.  We are subject to numerous federal regulations, including the Securities Act of 1933, or the Securities Act, the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, or the Exchange Act, and other federal securities laws. As we continue with our business, including the run-off of our insurance companies, we must monitor our compliance with these laws, including our maintenance of any available exemptions from registration as an investment company under the Investment Company Act of 1940. Any failure to comply with these laws or maintain our exemption could have a material adverse effect on our operations and on the market price of our ordinary shares.
 
Although state regulation is the dominant form of U.S. regulation for insurance and reinsurance business, from time to time Congress has shown concern over the adequacy and efficiency of the state regulation. It is not possible to predict the future impact of any potential federal regulations or other possible laws or regulations on our U.S. subsidiaries’ capital and operations, and such laws or regulations could materially adversely affect their business.
 
Other
 
In addition to Bermuda, the United Kingdom, Australia and the United States, we have subsidiaries in various other countries, including Belgium, Denmark, Ireland, Sweden and Switzerland, and in the future could acquire new subsidiaries in other countries. Our subsidiaries in these other jurisdictions are also regulated. Typically, such regulation is for the protection of policyholders and ceding insurance companies rather than shareholders. While the degree and type of regulation to which we are subject in each country may differ, regulatory authorities generally have broad supervisory and administrative powers over such matters as licenses, standards of solvency, investments, reporting requirements relating to capital structure, ownership, financial condition and general business operations, special reporting and prior approval requirements with respect to certain transactions among affiliates, methods of accounting, form and content of the consolidated financial statements, reserves for unpaid loss and LAE, reinsurance, minimum capital and surplus requirements, dividends and other distributions to shareholders, periodic examinations and annual and other report filings.


46


Table of Contents

Competition
 
We compete in international markets with domestic and international reinsurance companies to acquire and manage reinsurance companies in run-off. The acquisition and management of reinsurance companies in run-off is highly competitive. Some of these competitors have greater financial resources than we do, have been operating for longer than we have and have established long-term and continuing business relationships throughout the reinsurance industry, which can be a significant competitive advantage. As a result, we may not be able to compete successfully in the future for suitable acquisition candidates or run-off portfolio management engagements.
 
Employees
 
As of December 31, 2010, we had 335 employees, 4 of whom were executive officers. All non-Bermudian employees who operate out of our Bermuda office are subject to approval of any required work permits. None of our employees are covered by collective bargaining agreements, and our management believes that our relationship with our employees is excellent.
 
Operating Segments and Geographic Areas
 
See Note 21 to our consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2010 included in Item 8 of this annual report for a discussion of segment reporting and geographic areas.
 
Available Information
 
We maintain a website with the address http://www.enstargroup.com. The information contained on our website is not included as a part of, or incorporated by reference into, this filing. We make available free of charge (other than an investor’s own Internet access charges) on or through our website our annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and all amendments to these reports, as soon as reasonably practicable after the material is electronically filed with or otherwise furnished to the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission, or the SEC. Our annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports are also available on the SEC’s website at http://www.sec.gov. In addition, copies of our corporate governance guidelines, codes of business conduct and ethics and the governing charters for the audit and compensation committees of our board of directors are available free of charge on our website. The public may read and copy any materials we file with the SEC at the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC 20549. The public may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330.


47


Table of Contents

ITEM 1A.   RISK FACTORS
 
You should carefully consider these risks along with the other information included in this document, including the matters addressed under “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements,” as well as risks included elsewhere in our documents filed with the SEC, before investing in any of our securities. We may amend, supplement or add to the risk factors described below from time to time in future reports filed with the SEC.
 
Risks Relating to Our Business
 
If we are unable to implement our business strategies, our business and financial condition may be adversely affected.
 
Our future results of operations will depend in significant part on the extent to which we can implement our business strategies successfully, including our ability to realize the anticipated growth opportunities, expanded market visibility and increased access to capital. Our business strategies include continuing to operate our portfolio of run-off insurance and reinsurance companies and related management engagements, as well as pursuing additional acquisitions and management engagements in the run-off segment of the insurance and reinsurance market. We may not be able to implement our strategies fully or realize the anticipated results of our strategies as a result of significant business, economic and competitive uncertainties, many of which are beyond our control.
 
The effects of emerging claims and coverage issues may result in increased provisions for loss reserves and reduced profitability in our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries. Such adverse business issues may also reduce the level of incentive-based fees generated by our consulting operations. Adverse global economic conditions, such as rising interest rates and volatile foreign exchange rates, may cause widespread failure of our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries’ reinsurers to satisfy their obligations, as well as failure of companies to meet their obligations under debt instruments held by our subsidiaries. If the run-off industry becomes more attractive to investors, competition for runoff acquisitions and management and consultancy engagements may increase and, therefore, reduce our ability to continue to make profitable acquisitions or expand our consultancy operations. If we are unable to successfully implement our business strategies, we may not be able to achieve future growth in our earnings and our financial condition may suffer and, as a result, holders of our ordinary shares may receive lower returns.
 
We may require additional capital in the future that may not be available or may only be available on unfavorable terms.
 
Our future capital requirements depend on many factors, including our ability to manage the run-off of our assumed policies and to establish reserves at levels sufficient to cover losses. We may need to raise additional funds through financings in the future. Any equity or debt financing, if available at all, may be on terms that are not favorable to us. In the case of equity financings, dilution to our shareholders could result, and, in any case, such securities may have rights, preferences and privileges that are senior to those of our already outstanding securities. If we cannot obtain adequate capital, our business, results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected by, among other things, our inability to finance future acquisitions.
 
Our inability to successfully manage our portfolio of insurance and reinsurance companies in run-off may adversely impact our ability to grow our business and may result in losses.
 
We were founded to acquire and manage companies and portfolios of insurance and reinsurance in run-off. Our run-off business differs from the business of traditional insurance and reinsurance underwriting in that our insurance and reinsurance companies in run-off no longer underwrite new policies and are subject to the risk that their stated provisions for losses and loss adjustment expense, or LAE, will not be sufficient to cover future losses and the cost of run-off. Because our companies in run-off no longer collect underwriting premiums, our sources of capital to cover losses are limited to our stated reserves, reinsurance coverage and retained earnings. As of December 31, 2010, our gross reserves for losses and loss adjustment expense totaled $3.29 billion, and our reinsurance receivables totaled $961.4 million.


48


Table of Contents

In order for us to achieve positive operating results, we must first price acquisitions on favorable terms relative to the risks posed by the acquired businesses and then successfully manage the acquired businesses. Our inability to price acquisitions on favorable terms, efficiently manage claims, collect from reinsurers and control run-off expenses could result in us having to cover losses sustained under assumed policies with retained earnings, which would materially and adversely impact our ability to grow our business and may result in material losses.
 
If our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries’ loss reserves are inadequate to cover their actual losses, our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries’ net income and capital and surplus would be reduced.
 
Our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries are required to maintain reserves to cover their estimated ultimate liability for losses and loss adjustment expenses for both reported and unreported incurred claims. These reserves are only estimates of what our subsidiaries think the settlement and administration of claims will cost based on facts and circumstances known to the subsidiaries. Our commutation activity and claims settlement and development in recent years has resulted in net reductions in provisions for loss and loss adjustment expenses of $311.8 million, $259.6 million and $242.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. Although this recent experience indicates that our loss reserves have been more than adequate to meet our liabilities, because of the uncertainties that surround estimating loss reserves and loss adjustment expenses, our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries cannot be certain that ultimate losses will not exceed these estimates of losses and loss adjustment expenses. If our subsidiaries’ reserves are insufficient to cover their actual losses and loss adjustment expenses, our subsidiaries would have to augment their reserves and incur a charge to their earnings. These charges could be material and would reduce our net income and capital and surplus.
 
The difficulty in estimating the subsidiaries’ reserves is increased because our subsidiaries’ loss reserves include reserves for potential asbestos and environmental, or A&E, liabilities. At December 31, 2010, our insurance and reinsurance companies had recorded gross A&E loss reserves of $825.2 million, or 25.1% of the total gross loss reserves. Net A&E loss reserves at December 31, 2010 amounted to $736.2 million, or 26.6% of total net loss reserves. A&E liabilities are especially hard to estimate for many reasons, including the long waiting periods between exposure and manifestation of any bodily injury or property damage, the difficulty in identifying the source of the asbestos or environmental contamination, long reporting delays and the difficulty in properly allocating liability for the asbestos or environmental damage. Developed case law and adequate claim history do not always exist for such claims, especially because significant uncertainty exists about the outcome of coverage litigation and whether past claim experience will be representative of future claim experience. In view of the changes in the legal and tort environment that affect the development of such claims, the uncertainties inherent in valuing A&E claims are not likely to be resolved in the near future. Ultimate values for such claims cannot be estimated using traditional reserving techniques and there are significant uncertainties in estimating the amount of our subsidiaries’ potential losses for these claims. Our subsidiaries have not made any changes in reserve estimates that might arise as a result of any proposed U.S. federal legislation related to asbestos. To further understand this risk, see “Business — Reserves for Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expense” on page 13.
 
Our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries’ reinsurers may not satisfy their obligations to our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries.
 
Our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries are subject to credit risk with respect to their reinsurers because the transfer of risk to a reinsurer does not relieve our subsidiaries of their liability to the insured. In addition, reinsurers may be unwilling to pay our subsidiaries even though they are able to do so. As of December 31, 2010, the balances receivable from reinsurers amounted to $961.4 million, of which $398.8 million were associated with two reinsurers which each represented 10% or more of total reinsurance balances receivable. The two reinsurers had credit ratings, as provided by a major rating agency, of AA- or higher. In addition, many reinsurance companies have been negatively impacted by the deteriorating financial and economic conditions, including unprecedented financial market disruption. A number of these companies, including some of those with which we conduct business, have been downgraded and/or have been placed on negative outlook by various rating agencies. The failure of one or more of our subsidiaries’ reinsurers to honor their obligations in a timely fashion may affect our cash flows, reduce our net income or cause us to incur a significant loss. Disputes with our reinsurers may also result in unforeseen expenses relating to litigation or arbitration proceedings.


49


Table of Contents

The value of our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries’ investment portfolios and the investment income that our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries receive from these portfolios may decline as a result of market fluctuations and economic conditions.
 
We derive a significant portion of our income from our invested assets. The net investment income that our subsidiaries realize from investments in fixed maturity securities will generally increase or decrease with interest rates. The fair market value of our subsidiaries’ fixed maturity securities generally increases or decreases in an inverse relationship with fluctuations in interest rates and can also decrease as a result of any downturn in the business cycle that causes the credit quality of those securities to deteriorate. The fair market value of our subsidiaries’ fixed maturity securities classified as trading or available-for-sale in our subsidiaries’ investment portfolios amounted to $2.13 billion at December 31, 2010. The changes in the market value of our subsidiaries’ securities that are classified as trading or available-for-sale are reflected in our financial statements. Permanent impairments in the value of our subsidiaries’ fixed maturity securities are also reflected in our financial statements. As a result, a decline in the value of the securities in our subsidiaries’ investment portfolios may reduce our net income or cause us to incur a loss.
 
In addition to fixed maturity securities, we have invested, and may from time to time continue to invest, in private equities, equities and bond and hedge funds. These and other similar investments may be illiquid and have different risk characteristics than our investments in fixed maturity securities. As of December 31, 2010, we had an aggregate of $294.8 million of such investments. In 2010, the fair value of our private equity investments increased by $12.5 million due primarily to mark-to-market adjustments in the fair value of their underlying assets, which are primarily investments in financial institutions. For more information, see “Business — Investment Portfolio” on page 28.
 
Uncertain conditions in the economy generally may materially adversely affect our business and results of operations.
 
The recent severe downturn in the public debt and equity markets, reflecting uncertainties associated with the mortgage crisis, worsening economic conditions, widening of credit spreads, bankruptcies and government intervention in large financial institutions, resulted in significant unrealized losses in our investment portfolio. While many governments, including the U.S. federal government, have taken substantial steps to stabilize economic conditions in an effort to increase liquidity and capital availability, there continues to be significant uncertainty regarding the timeline for global economic recovery. Depending on market conditions going forward, we could incur substantial realized and additional unrealized losses in future periods, which could have an adverse impact on our results of operations and financial condition. Disruptions, uncertainty and volatility in the global credit markets may also impact our ability to obtain financing for future acquisitions. If financing is available, it may only be available at an unattractive cost of capital, which would decrease our profitability.
 
Fluctuations in currency exchange rates may cause us to experience losses.
 
We maintain a portion of our investments, insurance liabilities and insurance assets denominated in currencies other than U.S. dollars. Consequently, we and our subsidiaries may experience foreign exchange losses. We publish our consolidated financial statements in U.S. dollars. Therefore, fluctuations in exchange rates used to convert other currencies, particularly Australian dollars, Euros, British pounds and other European currencies, into U.S. dollars will impact our reported consolidated financial condition, results of operations and cash flows from year to year. We recorded, for the year ended December 31, 2010, foreign currency translation adjustment gains of $22.4 million, net of noncontrolling interest of $9.6 million, upon conversion of Gordian’s net Australian dollar assets to U.S. dollars due primarily to the increase in the Australian to U.S. dollar foreign exchange rate.
 
We have made, and expect to continue to make, strategic acquisitions of insurance and reinsurance companies in run-off, and these activities may not be financially beneficial to us or our shareholders.
 
We have pursued and, as part of our strategy, we will continue to pursue growth through acquisitions and/or strategic investments in insurance and reinsurance companies in run-off. We have made 30 acquisitions and several investments and we expect to continue to make such acquisitions and investments. We cannot be certain that any of these acquisitions or investments will be financially advantageous for us or our shareholders.


50


Table of Contents

The negotiation of potential acquisitions or strategic investments, as well as the integration of an acquired business or portfolio, could result in a substantial diversion of management resources. Acquisitions could involve numerous additional risks such as potential losses from unanticipated litigation or levels of claims, an inability to generate sufficient revenue to offset acquisition costs and financial exposures in the event that the sellers of the entities we acquire are unable or unwilling to meet their indemnification, reinsurance and other obligations to us.
 
Our ability to manage our growth through acquisitions or strategic investments will depend, in part, on our success in addressing these risks. Any failure by us to effectively implement our acquisition or strategic investment strategies could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
 
Our past and future acquisitions may expose us to operational risks such as cash flow shortages, challenges to recruit appropriate levels of personnel, financial exposures to foreign currencies, additional integration costs and management time and effort.
 
We have made 30 acquisitions of insurance and reinsurance businesses in run-off and entered into 15 acquisitions of portfolios of insurance and reinsurance businesses in run-off, and we may in the future make additional strategic acquisitions. These acquisitions may expose us to operational challenges and risks, including:
 
  •  funding cash flow shortages that may occur if anticipated revenues are not realized or are delayed, whether by general economic or market conditions or unforeseen internal difficulties;
 
  •  funding cash flow shortages that may occur if expenses are greater than anticipated;
 
  •  the value of assets being lower than expected or diminishing because of credit defaults or changes in interest rates, or liabilities assumed being greater than expected;
 
  •  integrating financial and operational reporting systems, including assurance of compliance with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and our Exchange Act reporting requirements;
 
  •  establishing satisfactory budgetary and other financial controls;
 
  •  funding increased capital needs and overhead expenses;
 
  •  obtaining management personnel required for expanded operations; and
 
  •  the assets and liabilities we may acquire may be subject to foreign currency exchange rate fluctuation.
 
Our failure to manage successfully these operational challenges and risks could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
 
Fluctuations in the reinsurance industry may cause our operating results to fluctuate.
 
The reinsurance industry historically has been subject to significant fluctuations and uncertainties. Factors that affect the industry in general may also cause our operating results to fluctuate. The industry’s profitability may be affected significantly by:
 
  •  fluctuations in interest rates, inflationary pressures and other changes in the investment environment, which affect returns on invested capital and may affect the ultimate payout of loss amounts and the costs of administering books of reinsurance business;
 
  •  volatile and unpredictable developments, such as those that have occurred recently in the world-wide financial and credit markets, which may adversely affect the recoverability of reinsurance from our reinsurers;
 
  •  changes in reserves resulting from different types of claims that may arise and the development of judicial interpretations relating to the scope of insurers’ liability; and
 
  •  the overall level of economic activity and the competitive environment in the industry.


51


Table of Contents

 
The effects of emerging claim and coverage issues on our business are uncertain.
 
As industry practices and legal, judicial, social and other environmental conditions change, unexpected and unintended issues related to claims and coverage may emerge. These issues may adversely affect the adequacy of our provision for losses and loss adjustment expenses by either extending coverage beyond the intent of insurance policies and reinsurance contracts envisioned at the time they were written, or by increasing the number or size of claims. In some instances, these changes may not become apparent until some time after we have acquired companies or portfolios of insurance or reinsurance contracts that are affected by the changes. As a result, the full extent of liability under these insurance or reinsurance contracts may not be known for many years after a contract has been issued. To further understand this risk, see “Business — Reserves for Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expense” on page 13.
 
Insurance laws and regulations restrict our ability to operate, and any failure to comply with these laws and regulations, or any investigations by government authorities, may have a material adverse effect on our business.
 
We are subject to extensive regulation under insurance laws of a number of jurisdictions, and compliance with legal and regulatory requirements is expensive. These laws limit the amount of dividends that can be paid to us by our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries, prescribe solvency standards that they must meet and maintain, impose restrictions on the amount and type of investments that they can hold to meet solvency requirements and require them to maintain reserves. Failure to comply with these laws may subject our subsidiaries to fines and penalties and restrict them from conducting business. The application of these laws may affect our liquidity and ability to pay dividends on our ordinary shares and may restrict our ability to expand our business operations through acquisitions. At December 31, 2010, the required statutory capital and surplus of our insurance and reinsurance companies amounted to $377.0 million compared to the actual statutory capital and surplus of $2.01 billion. As of December 31, 2010, $85.3 million of our total investments of $2.43 billion were not admissible for statutory solvency purposes. To further understand this risk, see “Business — Regulation” beginning on page 32.
 
The insurance industry has experienced substantial volatility as a result of current investigations, litigation and regulatory activity by various insurance, governmental and enforcement authorities, including the SEC concerning certain practices within the insurance industry. These practices include the sale and purchase of finite reinsurance or other non-traditional or loss mitigation insurance products and the accounting treatment for those products. Insurance and reinsurance companies that we have acquired, or may acquire in the future, may have been or may become involved in these investigations and have lawsuits filed against them. Our involvement in any investigations and related lawsuits would cause us to incur legal costs and, if we were found to have violated any laws, we could be required to pay fines and damages, perhaps in material amounts.
 
If we fail to comply with applicable insurance laws and regulations, we may be subject to disciplinary action, damages, penalties or restrictions that may have a material adverse effect on our business.
 
Our subsidiaries may not have maintained or be able to maintain all required licenses and approvals or that their businesses fully comply with the laws and regulations to which they are subject, or the relevant insurance regulatory authority’s interpretation of those laws and regulations. In addition, some regulatory authorities have relatively broad discretion to grant, renew or revoke licenses and approvals. If our subsidiaries do not have the requisite licenses and approvals or do not comply with applicable regulatory requirements, the insurance regulatory authorities may preclude or suspend our subsidiaries from carrying on some or all of their activities, place one of more of them into rehabilitation or liquidation proceedings, or impose monetary penalties on them. These types of actions may have a material adverse effect on our business and may preclude us from making future acquisitions or obtaining future engagements to manage companies and portfolios in run-off.


52


Table of Contents

Exit and finality opportunities provided by solvent schemes of arrangement may not continue to be available, which may result in the diversion of our resources to settle policyholder claims for a substantially longer run-off period and increase the associated costs of run-off of our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries.
 
With respect to our U.K., Bermudian and Australian insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries, we are able to pursue strategies to achieve complete finality and conclude the run-off of a company by promoting solvent schemes of arrangement. Solvent schemes of arrangement have been a popular means of achieving financial certainty and finality for insurance and reinsurance companies incorporated or managed in the U.K., Bermuda and Australia, by making a one-time full and final settlement of an insurance and reinsurance company’s liabilities to policyholders. A solvent scheme of arrangement is an arrangement between a company and its creditors or any class of them. For a solvent scheme of arrangement to become binding on the creditors, a meeting of each class of creditors must be called, with the permission of the local court, to consider and, if thought fit, approve the solvent scheme of arrangement. The requisite statutory majority of creditors of not less than 75% in value and 50% in number of those creditors actually attending the meeting, either in person or by proxy, must vote in favor of a solvent scheme of arrangement. Once the solvent scheme of arrangement has been approved by the statutory majority of voting creditors of the company, it requires the sanction of the local court at a hearing at which creditors may appear. The court must be satisfied that the scheme is fair.
 
In July 2005, the case of British Aviation Insurance Company, or BAIC, was the first solvent scheme of arrangement to fail to be sanctioned by the English High Court, following opposition by certain creditors. The primary reason for the failure of the BAIC arrangement was the failure to adequately provide for different classes of creditors to vote separately on the arrangement. However, since BAIC, approximately 42 solvent schemes of arrangement have been sanctioned, including one relating to one of our subsidiaries, such that the prevailing view is that the BAIC judgment was very fact-specific to the case in question, and solvent schemes generally should continue to be promoted and sanctioned as a viable means for achieving finality for our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries Following the BAIC judgment, insurance and reinsurance companies must take more care in drafting a solvent scheme of arrangement to fit the circumstances of the company including the determination of the appropriate classes of creditors. This remains so after the January 2010 decision of the Inner House of the Scottish Court of Session in the Scottish Lion case to the effect that solvent schemes are to be considered on their individual merits following a full consideration of the relevant evidence, and that the existence of opposition to a scheme is not, without a full hearing of the evidence, fatal to an application for sanction. Should a solvent scheme of arrangement promoted by any of our insurance or reinsurance subsidiaries fail to receive the requisite approval by creditors or sanction by the court, we will have to run off these liabilities until expiry, which may result in the diversion of our resources to settle policyholder claims for a substantially longer run-off period and increase the associated costs of run-off, resulting potentially in a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
 
We are dependent on our executive officers, directors and other key personnel and the loss of any of these individuals could adversely affect our business.
 
Our success substantially depends on our ability to attract and retain qualified employees and upon the ability of our senior management and other key employees to implement our business strategy. We believe that there are only a limited number of available qualified personnel in the business in which we compete. We rely substantially upon the services of Dominic F. Silvester, our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, Paul J. O’Shea and Nicholas A. Packer, our Executive Vice Presidents and Joint Chief Operating Officers, Richard J. Harris, our Chief Financial Officer, and our subsidiaries’ executive officers and directors to identify and consummate the acquisition of insurance and reinsurance companies and portfolios in run-off on favorable terms and to implement our run-off strategy. Each of Messrs. Silvester, O’Shea, Packer and Harris has an employment agreement with us. The loss of the services of any of our management or other key personnel, or the loss of the services of or our relationships with any of our directors could have a material adverse effect on our business.
 
Under Bermuda law, non-Bermudians (other than spouses of Bermudians, holders of permanent resident’s certificates or holders of a working resident’s certificate) may not engage in any gainful occupation in Bermuda without an appropriate governmental work permit. Work permits may be granted or extended by the Bermuda government upon showing that, after proper public advertisement in most cases, no Bermudian (or spouse of a


53


Table of Contents

Bermudian, holder of a permanent resident’s certificate or holders of a working resident’s certificate) is available who meets the minimum standard requirements for the advertised position. The Bermuda government’s policy limits the duration of work permits to six years, with certain exemptions for key employees and job categories where there is a worldwide shortage of qualified employees. As a result, if we were to lose any of our key employees the work permit laws and policies may hinder our ability to replace them.
 
Conflicts of interest might prevent us from pursuing desirable investment and business opportunities.
 
Our directors and executive officers may have ownership interests or other involvement with entities that could compete against us, either in the pursuit of acquisition targets or in general business operations. On occasion, we have also participated in transactions in which one or more of our directors or executive officers had an interest. In particular, we have invested, and expect to continue to invest, in or with entities that are affiliates of or otherwise related to Mr. Flowers. The interests of our directors and executive officers in such transactions or such entities may result in a conflict of interest for those directors and officers. The independent members of our board of directors review any material transactions involving a conflict of interest and may take appropriate actions as may be deemed appropriate by them in the particular circumstances. We may not be able to pursue all advantageous transactions that we would otherwise pursue in the absence of a conflict should our board of directors be unable to determine that any such transaction is on terms as favorable as we could otherwise obtain in the absence of a conflict.
 
Our inability to successfully manage the companies and portfolios for which we have been engaged as a third-party manager may adversely impact our financial results and our ability to win future management engagements.
 
In addition to acquiring insurance and reinsurance companies in run-off, we have entered into several management agreements with third parties to manage their companies or portfolios of business in run-off. The terms of these management engagements typically include incentive payments to us based on our ability to successfully manage the run-off of these companies or portfolios. We may not be able to accomplish our objectives for these engagements as a result of unforeseen circumstances such as the length of time for claims to develop, the extent to which losses may exceed reserves, changes in the law that may require coverage of additional claims and losses, our ability to commute reinsurance policies on favorable terms and our ability to manage run-off expenses. If we are not successful in meeting our objectives for these management engagements, we may not receive incentive payments under our management agreements, which could adversely impact our financial results, and we may not win future engagements to provide these management services, which could slow the growth of our business. Consulting fees generated from management agreements amounted to $23.0 million, $16.1 million and $25.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.
 
We are a holding company, and we are dependent on the ability of our subsidiaries to distribute funds to us.
 
We are a holding company and conduct substantially all of our operations through subsidiaries. Our only significant assets are the capital stock of our subsidiaries. As a holding company, we are dependent on distributions of funds from our subsidiaries to pay dividends, fund acquisitions or fulfill financial obligations in the normal course of our business. Our subsidiaries may not generate sufficient cash from operations to enable us to make dividend payments, acquire additional companies or insurance or reinsurance portfolios or fulfill other financial obligations. The ability of our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries to make distributions to us is limited by applicable insurance laws and regulations, and the ability of all of our subsidiaries to make distributions to us may be restricted by, among other things, other applicable laws and regulations and the terms of our subsidiaries’ bank loans.


54


Table of Contents

Risks Relating to Ownership of Our Ordinary Shares
 
Our stock price may experience volatility, thereby causing a potential loss of value to our investors.
 
The market price for our ordinary shares may fluctuate substantially due to, among other things, the following factors:
 
  •  announcements with respect to an acquisition or investment;
 
  •  changes in the value of our assets;
 
  •  our quarterly and annual operating results;
 
  •  sales, or the possibility or perception of future sales, by our existing shareholders;
 
  •  changes in general conditions in the economy and the insurance industry;
 
  •  the financial markets; and
 
  •  adverse press or news announcements.
 
A few significant shareholders may influence or control the direction of our business. If the ownership of our ordinary shares continues to be highly concentrated, it may limit your ability and the ability of other shareholders to influence significant corporate decisions.
 
The interests of Messrs. Flowers, Silvester, Packer and O’Shea, Advisory Research, Inc., or Advisory, and Beck Mack & Oliver LLC, or Beck Mack, may not be fully aligned with your interests, and this may lead to a strategy that is not in your best interest. As of December 31, 2010, Messrs. Flowers, Silvester, Packer and O’Shea, Advisory and Beck Mack beneficially owned approximately 11.3%, 11.9%, 3.6%, 3.9%, 6.9% and 9.0%, respectively, of our outstanding ordinary shares. Although they do not act as a group, Advisory, Beck Mack and each of Messrs. Flowers, Silvester, Packer and O’Shea exercise significant influence over matters requiring shareholder approval, and their concentrated holdings may delay or deter possible changes in control of Enstar, which may reduce the market price of our ordinary shares. For further information on aspects of our bye-laws that may discourage changes of control of Enstar, see “— Some aspects of our corporate structure may discourage third-party takeovers and other transactions or prevent the removal of our board of directors and management” below.
 
Some aspects of our corporate structure may discourage third-party takeovers and other transactions or prevent the removal of our board of directors and management.
 
Some provisions of our bye-laws have the effect of making more difficult or discouraging unsolicited takeover bids from third parties or preventing the removal of our current board of directors and management. In particular, our bye-laws make it difficult for any U.S. shareholder or Direct Foreign Shareholder Group (a shareholder or group of commonly controlled shareholders of Enstar that are not U.S. persons) to own or control ordinary shares that constitute 9.5% or more of the voting power of all of our ordinary shares. The votes conferred by such shares will be reduced by whatever amount is necessary so that after any such reduction the votes conferred by such shares will constitute 9.5% of the total voting power of all ordinary shares entitled to vote generally. The primary purpose of this restriction is to reduce the likelihood that we will be deemed a “controlled foreign corporation” within the meaning of Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or the Code, for U.S. federal tax purposes. However, this limit may also have the effect of deterring purchases of large blocks of our ordinary shares or proposals to acquire us, even if some or a majority of our shareholders might deem these purchases or acquisition proposals to be in their best interests. In addition, our bye-laws provide for a classified board, whose members may be removed by our shareholders only for cause by a majority vote, and contain restrictions on the ability of shareholders to nominate persons to serve as directors, submit resolutions to a shareholder vote and request special general meetings.
 
These bye-law provisions make it more difficult to acquire control of us by means of a tender offer, open market purchase, proxy contest or otherwise. These provisions may encourage persons seeking to acquire control of us to negotiate with our directors, which we believe would generally best serve the interests of our shareholders. However, these provisions may have the effect of discouraging a prospective acquirer from making a tender offer or otherwise attempting to obtain control of us. In addition, these bye-law provisions may prevent the removal of our


55


Table of Contents

current board of directors and management. To the extent these provisions discourage takeover attempts, they may deprive shareholders of opportunities to realize takeover premiums for their shares or may depress the market price of the shares.
 
The market value of our ordinary shares may decline if large numbers of shares are sold, including pursuant to existing registration rights.
 
We have entered into a registration rights agreement with Mr. Flowers and Mr. Silvester and certain other of our shareholders. This agreement provides that Mr. Flowers and Mr. Silvester may request that we effect a registration under the Securities Act of certain of their ordinary shares. In addition, they and the other shareholders party to the agreement have “piggyback” registration rights, which may result in their participation in an offering initiated by us. As of December 31, 2010, an aggregate of approximately 3.0 million ordinary shares held by Mr. Flowers and Mr. Silvester are subject to the agreement. By exercising their registration rights, these holders could cause a large number of ordinary shares to be registered and generally become freely tradable without restrictions under the Securities Act immediately upon the effectiveness of the registration. Our ordinary shares have in the past been, and may from time to time continue to be, thinly traded, and significant sales, pursuant to the existing registration rights or otherwise, could adversely affect the market price for our ordinary shares and impair our ability to raise capital through offerings of our equity securities.
 
Because we are incorporated in Bermuda, it may be difficult for shareholders to serve process or enforce judgments against us or our directors and officers.
 
We are a Bermuda company. In addition, certain of our officers and directors reside in countries outside the United States. All or a substantial portion of our assets and the assets of these officers and directors are or may be located outside the United States. Investors may have difficulty effecting service of process within the United States on our directors and officers who reside outside the United States or recovering against us or these directors and officers on judgments of U.S. courts based on civil liabilities provisions of the U.S. federal securities laws even though we have appointed an agent in the United States to receive service of process.
 
Further, no claim may be brought in Bermuda against us or our directors and officers for violation of U.S. federal securities laws, as such laws do not have force of law in Bermuda. A Bermuda court may, however, impose civil liability, including the possibility of monetary damages, on us or our directors and officers if the facts alleged in a complaint constitute or give rise to a cause of action under Bermuda law.
 
We believe that there is doubt as to whether the courts of Bermuda would enforce judgments of U.S. courts obtained in actions against us or our directors and officers, as well as our independent auditors, predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the U.S. federal securities laws or original actions brought in Bermuda against us or these persons predicated solely upon U.S. federal securities laws. Further, there is no treaty in effect between the United States and Bermuda providing for the enforcement of judgments of U.S. courts, and there are grounds upon which Bermuda courts may not enforce judgments of U.S. courts.
 
Some remedies available under the laws of U.S. jurisdictions, including some remedies available under the U.S. federal securities laws, may not be allowed in Bermuda courts as contrary to that jurisdiction’s public policy. Because judgments of U.S. courts are not automatically enforceable in Bermuda, it may be difficult for you to recover against us based upon such judgments.
 
Shareholders who own our ordinary shares may have more difficulty in protecting their interests than shareholders of a U.S. corporation.
 
The Bermuda Companies Act, or the Companies Act, which applies to us, differs in certain material respects from laws generally applicable to U.S. corporations and their shareholders. As a result of these differences, shareholders who own our shares may have more difficulty protecting their interests than shareholders who own shares of a U.S. corporation. For example, class actions and derivative actions are generally not available to shareholders under Bermuda law. Under Bermuda law, only shareholders holding 5% or more of our outstanding ordinary shares or numbering 100 or more are entitled to propose a resolution at our general meeting.


56


Table of Contents

We do not intend to pay cash dividends on our ordinary shares.
 
We do not intend to pay a cash dividend on our ordinary shares. Rather, we intend to use any retained earnings to fund the development and growth of our business. From time to time, our board of directors will review our alternatives with respect to our earnings and seek to maximize value for our shareholders. In the future, we may decide to commence a dividend program for the benefit of our shareholders. Any future determination to pay dividends will be at the discretion of our board of directors and will be limited by our position as a holding company that lacks direct operations, the results of operations of our subsidiaries, our financial condition, cash requirements and prospects and other factors that our board of directors deems relevant. In addition, there are significant regulatory and other constraints that could prevent us from paying dividends in any event. As a result, capital appreciation, if any, on our ordinary shares may be your sole source of gain for the foreseeable future.
 
Our board of directors may decline to register a transfer of our ordinary shares under certain circumstances.
 
Our board of directors may decline to register a transfer of ordinary shares under certain circumstances, including if it has reason to believe that any non-de minimis adverse tax, regulatory or legal consequences to us, any of our subsidiaries or any of our shareholders may occur as a result of such transfer. Further, our bye-laws provide us with the option to repurchase, or to assign to a third party the right to purchase, the minimum number of shares necessary to eliminate any such non-de minimis adverse tax, regulatory or legal consequence. In addition, our board of directors may decline to approve or register a transfer of shares unless all applicable consents, authorizations, permissions or approvals of any governmental body or agency in Bermuda, the United States or any other applicable jurisdiction required to be obtained prior to such transfer shall have been obtained. The proposed transferor of any shares will be deemed to own those shares for dividend, voting and reporting purposes until a transfer of such shares has been registered on our shareholders register.
 
It is our understanding that while the precise form of the restrictions on transfer contained in our bye-laws is untested, as a matter of general principle, restrictions on transfers are enforceable under Bermuda law and are not uncommon. These restrictions on transfer may also have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control.
 
Risks Relating to Taxation
 
We might incur unexpected U.S., U.K. or Australia tax liabilities if companies in our group that are incorporated outside those jurisdictions are determined to be carrying on a trade or business there.
 
We and a number of our subsidiaries are companies formed under the laws of Bermuda or other jurisdictions that do not impose income taxes; it is our contemplation that these companies will not incur substantial income tax liabilities from their operations. Because the operations of these companies generally involve, or relate to, the insurance or reinsurance of risks that arise in higher tax jurisdictions, such as the United States, United Kingdom and Australia, it is possible that the taxing authorities in those jurisdictions may assert that the activities of one or more of these companies creates a sufficient nexus in that jurisdiction to subject the company to income tax there. There are uncertainties in how the relevant rules apply to insurance businesses, and in our eligibility for favorable treatment under applicable tax treaties. Accordingly, it is possible that we could incur substantial unexpected tax liabilities.
 
U.S. persons who own our ordinary shares might become subject to adverse U.S. tax consequences as a result of “related person insurance income,” or RPII, if any, of our non-U.S. insurance company subsidiaries.
 
If the RPII rules of the Code were to apply to us, a U.S. person who owns our ordinary shares directly or indirectly through foreign entities on the last day of the taxable year would be required to include in income for U.S. federal income tax purposes the shareholder’s pro rata share of our non-U.S. subsidiaries’ RPII for the entire taxable year, determined as if that RPII were distributed proportionately to the U.S. shareholders at that date regardless whether any actual distribution is made. In addition, any RPII that is includible in the income of a U.S. tax-exempt organization would generally be treated as unrelated business taxable income. Although we and


57


Table of Contents

our subsidiaries intend to generally operate in a manner so as to qualify for certain exceptions to the RPII rules, there can be no assurance that these exceptions will be available. Accordingly, there can be no assurance that U.S. persons who own our ordinary shares will not be required to recognize gross income inclusions attributable to RPII.
 
In addition, the RPII rules provide that if a shareholder who is a U.S. person disposes of shares in a foreign insurance company that has RPII and in which U.S. persons collectively own 25% or more of the shares, any gain from the disposition will generally be treated as dividend income to the extent of the shareholder’s share of the corporation’s undistributed earnings and profits that were accumulated during the period that the shareholder owned the shares (whether or not those earnings and profits are attributable to RPII). Such a shareholder would also be required to comply with certain reporting requirements, regardless of the amount of shares owned by the shareholder. These rules should not apply to dispositions of our ordinary shares because we will not be directly engaged in the insurance business. The RPII rules, however, have not been interpreted by the courts or the U.S. Internal Revenue Service, or the IRS, and regulations interpreting the RPII rules exist only in proposed form. Accordingly, there is no assurance that our views as to the inapplicability of these rules to a disposition of our ordinary shares will be accepted by the IRS or a court.
 
U.S. persons who own our ordinary shares would be subject to adverse tax consequences if we or one or more of our non-U.S. subsidiaries were considered a “passive foreign investment company,” or PFIC, for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
 
We believe that we and our non-U.S. subsidiaries will not be PFICs for U.S. federal income purposes for the current year. Moreover, we do not expect to conduct our activities in a manner that will cause us or any of our non-U.S. subsidiaries to become a PFIC in the future. However, there can be no assurance that the IRS will not challenge this position or that a court will not sustain such challenge. Accordingly, it is possible that we or one or more of our non-U.S. subsidiaries might be deemed a PFIC by the IRS or a court for the current year or any future year. If we or one or more of our non-U.S. subsidiaries were a PFIC, it could have material adverse tax consequences for an investor that is subject to U.S. federal income taxation, including subjecting the investor to a substantial acceleration and/or increase in tax liability. There are currently no regulations regarding the application of the PFIC provisions of the Code to an insurance company, so the application of those provisions to insurance companies remains unclear in certain respects.
 
We may become subject to taxes in Bermuda after March 28, 2016.
 
The Bermuda Minister of Finance, under the Exempted Undertakings Tax Protection Act 1966, as amended, of Bermuda, has given us and each of our Bermuda subsidiaries an assurance that if any legislation is enacted in Bermuda that would impose tax computed on profits or income, or computed on any capital asset, gain or appreciation, or any tax in the nature of estate duty or inheritance tax, then the imposition of any such tax will not be applicable to us or our Bermuda subsidiaries or any of our or their respective operations, shares, debentures or other obligations until March 28, 2016. Given the limited duration of the Minister of Finance’s assurance, we cannot be certain that we will not be subject to any Bermuda tax after March 28, 2016. In the event that we become subject to any Bermuda tax after such date, it could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. The Bermuda Minister of Finance announced, in November 2010, that the assurance will be extended to 2035, however, the required legislation for this has not yet been brought before the Bermuda legislature.
 
U.S. persons who own 10 percent or more of our shares may be subject to taxation under the “controlled foreign corporation,” or CFC, rules.
 
A U.S. person that is a “10% U.S. Shareholder” of a non-U.S. corporation (i.e., a U.S. person who owns or is treated as owning at least 10% of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock entitled to vote of the non-U.S. corporation) that is a CFC for an uninterrupted period of 30 days or more during a taxable year, that owns shares in the CFC directly or indirectly through non-U.S. entities on the last day of the CFC’s taxable year, must include in its gross income for U.S. federal income tax purposes its pro rata share of the CFC’s “subpart F income,” even if the subpart F income is not distributed. “Subpart F income” of a non-U.S. insurance corporation typically includes foreign personal holding company income (such as interest, dividends and other types of passive income), as well as insurance and reinsurance income (including underwriting and investment income).


58


Table of Contents

A non-U.S. corporation is considered a CFC if “10% U.S. Shareholders” own (directly, indirectly through non-U.S. entities or by attribution by application of the constructive ownership rules of section 958(b) of the Code (i.e., “constructively”)) more than 50% of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock of that foreign corporation, or the total value of all stock of that foreign corporation. For purposes of taking into account insurance income, a CFC also includes a non-U.S. insurance company in which more than 25% of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock (or more than 25% of the total value of the stock) is owned directly, indirectly through non-U.S. entities or constructively by 10% U.S. Shareholders on any day during the taxable year of such corporation, if the gross amount of premiums or other consideration for the reinsurance or the issuing of insurance (other than certain insurance or reinsurance related to same country risks written by certain insurance companies not applicable here) exceeds 75% of the gross amount of all premiums or other consideration in respect of all risks.
 
We believe that because of the dispersion of our share ownership, and provisions in our organizational documents that limit voting power, no U.S. Person (including our subsidiary Enstar USA, Inc., which owns certain of our non-voting shares) should be treated as owning (directly, indirectly through non-U.S. entities or constructively) 10% or more of the total voting power of all classes of our shares. However, the IRS could successfully challenge the effectiveness of these provisions in our organizational documents. Accordingly, no assurance can be given that a U.S. person who owns our shares will not be characterized as a 10% U.S. Shareholder.
 
Changes in U.S. federal income tax law could materially affect us or our shareholders.
 
Legislation has been proposed on various occasions to eliminate perceived tax advantages of insurance companies that have legal domiciles outside the United States but have certain U.S. connections. For example, proposed legislation was introduced in Congress in 2010 to limit the deductibility of reinsurance premiums paid by U.S. companies to non-U.S. affiliates, although no such provision was enacted. It is possible that similar legislation could be introduced in and enacted by the current Congress or future Congresses and enactment of some version of such legislation, or other changes in U.S. tax laws, regulations or interpretations thereof, could have an adverse impact on us or our shareholders.
 
ITEM 1B.   UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
 
Not applicable


59


Table of Contents

ITEM 2.   PROPERTIES.
 
We lease office space in the locations set forth below. We believe that this office space is sufficient for us to conduct our current operations for the foreseeable future.
 
                 
        Square
    Lease
Entity   Location   Feet     Expiration
 
Enstar Limited
  Hamilton, Bermuda     8,250     August 7, 2014
Enstar (EU) Limited
  Guildford, England     22,712     August 15, 2016
Enstar (EU) Limited
  London, England     12,453     March 24, 2016
Enstar (EU) Limited
  London, England     2,192     March 24, 2011
Enstar (EU) Limited
  London, England     3,822     September 26, 2015
River Thames Insurance Company
  London, England     6,329     March 24, 2015
Enstar Australia Limited
  Sydney, Australia     8,094     April 30, 2013
Enstar (US) Inc. 
  Tampa, FL     8,859     October 31, 2011
Enstar (US) Inc. 
  E Providence, RI     13,628     September 30, 2012
Enstar (US) Inc. 
  Warwick, RI     3,000     May 31, 2011
Enstar USA, Inc. 
  Montgomery, AL     2,500     December 31, 2012
 
We also own, through various of our subsidiaries, the following properties: 1) two apartments in Guildford, England; 2) a building in Norwich, England and 3) an apartment in New York, NY. In addition, we also lease two residential apartments in Bermuda with leases expiring in April 2011 and April 2012.
 
See Note 20 to our consolidated financial statements for further discussion of our lease commitments for real property.


60


Table of Contents

ITEM 3.   LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
 
We are, from time to time, involved in various legal proceedings in the ordinary course of business, including litigation regarding claims. We do not believe that the resolution of any currently pending legal proceedings, either individually or taken as a whole, will have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations or financial condition. Nevertheless, we cannot assure you that lawsuits, arbitrations or other litigation will not have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations. We anticipate that, similar to the rest of the insurance and reinsurance industry, we will continue to be subject to litigation and arbitration proceedings in the ordinary course of business, including litigation generally related to the scope of coverage with respect to asbestos and environmental claims. There can be no assurance that any such future litigation will not have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.


61


Table of Contents

 
PART II
 
ITEM 5.   MARKET FOR THE REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
 
Market for the Registrant’s Common Equity
 
Our ordinary shares trade on the Nasdaq Global Select Market under the ticker symbol ESGR.
 
                                 
    2010     2009  
    High     Low     High     Low  
 
First Quarter
  $ 74.87     $ 61.03     $ 76.63     $ 41.41  
Second Quarter
  $ 69.74     $ 54.03     $ 75.20     $ 50.11  
Third Quarter
  $ 76.29     $ 65.01     $ 64.41     $ 55.10  
Fourth Quarter
  $ 89.92     $ 70.26     $ 75.00     $ 58.03  
 
On March 1, 2011 the number of holders of record of our ordinary shares was 2,266. This figure does not represent the actual number of beneficial owners of our ordinary shares because shares are frequently held in “street name” by securities dealers and others for the benefit of beneficial owners who may vote the shares.
 
We are a holding company and have no direct operations. Our ability to pay dividends or distributions depends almost exclusively on the ability of our subsidiaries to pay dividends to us. Under applicable law, our subsidiaries may not declare or pay a dividend if there are reasonable grounds for believing that they are, or would after the payment be, unable to pay their liabilities as they become due, or the realizable value of their assets would thereby be less than the aggregate of their liabilities and their issued share capital and share premium accounts. Additional restrictions apply to our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries. We do not intend to pay a dividend on our ordinary shares. Rather, we intend to reinvest any earnings back into the company. For a further description of the restrictions on the ability of our subsidiaries to pay dividends, see “Risk Factors — Risks Relating to Ownership of Our Ordinary Shares — We do not intend to pay cash dividends on our ordinary shares” and “Business — Regulation” beginning on pages 57 and 32, respectively. We did not pay any dividends on our ordinary shares in 2010 or 2009.
 
On January 31, 2007, we completed the merger, or the Merger, of CWMS Subsidiary Corp., a Georgia corporation and our wholly-owned subsidiary, with and into The Enstar Group Inc., a Georgia corporation, or EGI. As a result of the Merger, EGI, renamed Enstar USA, Inc., is now our wholly-owned subsidiary. Prior to the completion of the Merger, EGI’s common stock traded on the Nasdaq Global Select Market under the ticker symbol ESGR. Because our ordinary shares did not commence trading until after the Merger, the graph below reflects the cumulative shareholder return on the common stock of EGI, our predecessor, compared to the cumulative shareholder return of the NASDAQ Composite Index (the Nasdaq index for U.S. companies used in prior years was discontinued in 2006) and the Nasdaq Insurance Index, through January 31, 2007. Thereafter, the graph below reflects the same comparison for Enstar. The graph reflects the investment of $100.00 on December 31, 2005 (assuming the reinvestment of dividends) in EGI common stock, the NASDAQ Composite Index, and the Nasdaq Insurance Index).


62


Table of Contents

COMPARISON OF 5 YEAR CUMULATIVE TOTAL RETURN*
Among Enstar Group Limited, the NASDAQ Composite Index
and the NASDAQ Insurance Index
 
(PERFORMANCE GRAPH)
 
Source: Research Data Group, Inc.
 
* $100 invested on 12/31/05 in stock or index, including reinvestment of dividends.
 
                                                             
      12/05       12/06       12/07       12/08       12/09       12/10  
Enstar Group Limited
      100.00         144.75         189.93         91.75         113.29         131.22  
NASDAQ Composite
      100.00         111.74         124.67         73.77         107.12         125.93  
NASDAQ Insurance
      100.00         110.09         108.18         87.79         91.16         107.03  
                                                             
 
Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
 
The table below lists our repurchases of ordinary shares during the fourth quarter of 2010.
 
                                 
                      Maximum Number (or
 
                Total Number of
    Approximate Dollar
 
                Shares Purchased as
    Value) of Shares
 
                part of Publicly
    that May Yet Be
 
    Total Number of
    Average Price Paid
    Announced Plans or
    Purchased Under the
 
Period   Shares Purchased     per Share     Programs     Plans or Programs  
 
October 1 — October 31, 2010
    800,000 (1)   $ 70.00              
November 1 — November 30, 2010
                       
December 1 —
December 31, 2010
                       
                                 
Total
    800,000     $ 70.00              
                                 
 
 
(1) On October 1, 2010, we entered into the Repurchase Agreements with three of our executives and certain trusts and a corporation affiliated with the executives to repurchase an aggregate of 800,000 of our ordinary shares at a price of $70.00 per share. The repurchase transactions closed on October 14, 2010.


63


Table of Contents

ITEM 6.   SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
 
The following selected historical financial information for each of the past five fiscal years has been derived from our audited historical financial statements. This information is only a summary and should be read in conjunction with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our audited consolidated financial statements and notes thereto included elsewhere in this annual report. The results of operations for past accounting periods are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for any future accounting period.
 
Since our inception, we have made several acquisitions which impact the comparability between periods of the information reflected below. See “Business — Recent Transactions,” beginning on page 6 for information about our acquisitions.
 
                                         
    Years Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009     2008     2007     2006  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars, except share and per share data)  
 
Summary Consolidated Statements of Earnings Data:
                                       
Consulting fees
  $ 23,015     $ 16,104     $ 25,151     $ 31,918     $ 33,908  
Net investment income and net realized and unrealized gains (losses)
    113,043       85,608       24,946       64,336       48,001  
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
    311,834       259,627       242,104       24,482       31,927  
Total other expenses
    (242,865 )     (184,331 )     (194,837 )     (67,904 )     (49,838 )
Share of earnings (loss) of partly owned companies
    10,704             (201 )           518  
                                         
Net earnings from continuing operations
    215,731       177,008       97,163       52,832       64,516  
Extraordinary gain -
                                       
Negative goodwill
                50,280       15,683       35,367  
                                         
Net earnings
  $ 215,731     $ 177,008     $ 147,443     $ 68,515     $ 99,883  
Less: Net earnings attributable to noncontrolling interests (including share of extraordinary gain of $nil, $nil, $15,084, $nil and $4,329)
    (41,645 )     (41,798 )     (65,892 )     (6,730 )     (17,537 )
                                         
Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited
  $ 174,086     $ 135,210     $ 81,551     $ 61,785     $ 82,346  
                                         
Per Share Data(1)(2):
                                       
Earnings per share before extraordinary gain attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders — basic
  $ 12.91     $ 10.01     $ 3.67     $ 3.93     $ 5.21  
Extraordinary gain per share attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders — basic
                2.78       1.34       3.15  
                                         
Net earnings per share attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders — basic
  $ 12.91     $ 10.01     $ 6.45     $ 5.27     $ 8.36  
                                         
Earnings per share before extraordinary gain attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders — diluted
  $ 12.66     $ 9.84     $ 3.59     $ 3.84     $ 5.15  
Extraordinary gain per share attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders — diluted
                2.72       1.31       3.11  
                                         
Net earnings per share attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders — diluted
  $ 12.66     $ 9.84     $ 6.31     $ 5.15     $ 8.26  
                                         
Weighted average shares outstanding — basic
    13,489,221       13,514,207       12,638,333       11,731,908       9,857,914  
Weighted average shares outstanding — diluted
    13,751,256       13,744,661       12,921,475       12,009,683       9,966,960  
Cash dividends paid per share
  $     $     $     $     $ 2.92  
 


64


Table of Contents

                                         
    December 31,
    2010   2009   2008   2007   2006
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars, except per share data)
 
Summary Balance Sheet Data:
                                       
Total investments
  $ 2,429,106     $ 1,620,992     $ 1,278,055     $ 637,196     $ 747,529  
Cash and cash equivalents
    1,455,354       1,700,105       2,209,873       1,163,333       513,563  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    961,442       638,262       672,696       465,277       408,142  
Total assets
    5,235,904       4,170,842       4,358,151       2,417,143       1,774,252  
Loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
    3,291,275       2,479,136       2,798,287       1,591,449       1,214,419  
Loans payable
    245,278       254,961       391,534       60,227       62,148  
Total Enstar Group Limited shareholders’ equity
    948,421       801,881       615,209       450,599       318,610  
Book Value per Share(3):
                                       
Basic
  $ 73.29     $ 59.05     $ 46.14     $ 37.80     $ 32.15  
Diluted
  $ 71.68     $ 58.06     $ 45.18     $ 36.92     $ 31.85  
 
 
(1) Earnings per share is a measure based on net earnings divided by weighted average ordinary shares outstanding. Basic earnings per share is defined as net earnings available to ordinary shareholders divided by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding for the period, giving no effect to dilutive securities. Diluted earnings per share is defined as net earnings available to ordinary shareholders divided by the weighted average number of shares and share equivalents outstanding calculated using the treasury stock method for all potentially dilutive securities. When the effect of dilutive securities would be anti-dilutive, these securities are excluded from the calculation of diluted earnings per share.
 
(2) The weighted average ordinary shares outstanding shown for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006 reflect the conversion of Class A, B, C and D shares to ordinary shares on January 31, 2007, as part of the recapitalization completed in connection with the Merger, as if the conversion occurred on January 1, 2007 and 2006. As a result, both the book value per share and the earnings per share calculations for 2006, previously reported, have been amended to reflect this change.
 
(3) Basic book value per share is defined as total Enstar Group Limited shareholders’ equity available to ordinary shareholders divided by the number of ordinary shares outstanding as at the end of the period, giving no effect to dilutive securities. Diluted book value per share is defined as total shareholders’ equity available to ordinary shareholders divided by the number of ordinary shares and ordinary share equivalents outstanding at the end of the period, calculated using the treasury stock method for all potentially dilutive securities. When the effect of dilutive securities would be anti-dilutive, these securities are excluded from the calculation of diluted book value per share.

65


Table of Contents

ITEM 7.   MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.
 
Cautionary Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Statements
 
This annual report and the documents incorporated by reference contain statements that constitute “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the Exchange Act, with respect to our financial condition, results of operations, business strategies, operating efficiencies, competitive positions, growth opportunities, plans and objectives of our management, as well as the markets for our ordinary shares and the insurance and reinsurance sectors in general. Statements that include words such as “estimate,” “project,” “plan,” “intend,” “expect,” “anticipate,” “believe,” “would,” “should,” “could,” “seek,” and similar statements of a future or forward-looking nature identify forward-looking statements for purposes of the federal securities laws or otherwise. All forward-looking statements are necessarily estimates or expectations, and not statements of historical fact, reflecting the best judgment of our management and involve a number of risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results to differ materially from those suggested by the forward-looking statements. These forward-looking statements should, therefore, be considered in light of various important factors, including those set forth in and incorporated by reference in this annual report.
 
Factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those suggested by the forward-looking statements include:
 
  •  risks associated with implementing our business strategies and initiatives;
 
  •  the adequacy of our loss reserves and the need to adjust such reserves as claims develop over time;
 
  •  risks relating to the availability and collectability of our reinsurance;
 
  •  risks that we may require additional capital in the future, which may not be available or may be available only on unfavorable terms;
 
  •  changes and uncertainty in economic conditions, including interest rates, inflation, currency exchange rates, equity markets and credit conditions, which could affect our investment portfolio, our ability to finance future acquisitions and our profitability;
 
  •  losses due to foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations;
 
  •  tax, regulatory or legal restrictions or limitations applicable to us or the insurance and reinsurance business generally;
 
  •  increased competitive pressures, including the consolidation and increased globalization of reinsurance providers;
 
  •  emerging claim and coverage issues;
 
  •  lengthy and unpredictable litigation affecting assessment of losses and/or coverage issues;
 
  •  loss of key personnel;
 
  •  changes in our plans, strategies, objectives, expectations or intentions, which may happen at any time at management’s discretion;
 
  •  operational risks, including system or human failures;
 
  •  the risk that ongoing or future industry regulatory developments will disrupt our business, or mandate changes in industry practices in ways that increase our costs, decrease our revenues or require us to alter aspects of the way we do business;
 
  •  changes in Bermuda law or regulation or the political stability of Bermuda;


66


Table of Contents

 
  •  changes in tax laws or regulations applicable to us or our subsidiaries, or the risk that we or one of our non-U.S. subsidiaries become subject to significant, or significantly increased, income taxes in the United States or elsewhere; and
 
  •  changes in accounting policies or practices.
 
The factors listed above should not be construed as exhaustive. Certain of these factors are described in more detail in “Item 1A. Risk Factors” above. We undertake no obligation to release publicly the results of any future revisions we may make to forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances after the date hereof or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events.
 
The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this annual report. Some of the information contained in this discussion and analysis or included elsewhere in this annual report, including information with respect to our plans and strategy for its business, includes forward-looking statements that involve risks, uncertainties and assumptions. Our actual results and the timing of events could differ materially from those anticipated by these forward-looking statements as a result of many factors, including those discussed under “Risk Factors,” “Forward-Looking Statements” and elsewhere in this annual report.
 
Business Overview
 
We were formed in August 2001 under the laws of Bermuda to acquire and manage insurance and reinsurance companies in run-off and portfolios of insurance and reinsurance business in run-off, and to provide management, consulting and other services to the insurance and reinsurance industry.
 
On January 31, 2007, we completed the merger, or the Merger, of CWMS Subsidiary Corp, a Georgia corporation and our wholly-owned subsidiary, with and into The Enstar Group, Inc., a Georgia corporation. As a result of the Merger, The Enstar Group, Inc., renamed Enstar USA, Inc., is now our wholly-owned subsidiary. The Enstar Group, Inc. owned an approximate 32% economic and a 50% voting interest in us prior to the Merger.
 
Since our formation, we, through our subsidiaries, have completed 30 acquisitions of insurance and reinsurance companies and 15 acquisitions of portfolios of insurance and reinsurance business and are now administering those businesses in run-off.
 
We operate our business internationally through our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries and our consulting subsidiaries in Bermuda, the United Kingdom, the United States, Europe and Australia. We had a total of 335 employees as at December 31, 2010.
 
2010 summary:
 
  •  We completed the acquisitions of six companies and eight portfolios of insurance and reinsurance business;
 
  •  We repaid or paid down a number of our existing loan facilities and entered into two new bank loan facilities that remained outstanding as at December 31, 2010; and
 
  •  On October 1, 2010, we repurchased 800,000 shares at a price of $70.00 per share from three of our executives and certain trusts and a corporation affiliated with the executives. We issued promissory notes for the aggregate purchase price of $56.0 million, of which $37.3 million was outstanding at December 31, 2010, and is payable over approximately two years.
 
2010 results of operations:
 
  •  Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited amounted to $174.1 million, or $12.91 per basic share and $12.66 per diluted share;
 
  •  Net investment income and net realized gains amounted to $113.0 million; and
 
  •  Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities amounted to $311.8 million.


67


Table of Contents

 
2010 financial condition:
 
  •  Total cash and investments of $3.88 billion;
 
  •  Total assets of $5.24 billion;
 
  •  Reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses of $3.29 billion and reinsurance recoverables of $961.4 million; and
 
  •  Total shareholders’ equity attributable to Enstar Group Limited of $948.4 million; net book value per basic share of $73.29 and per diluted share of $71.68.
 
Outlook for 2011:
 
  •  In February 2011, we entered into RITC agreements with two Lloyd’s syndicates with total gross insurance reserves of approximately $129.6 million;
 
  •  During 2010, we signed definitive agreements for the acquisitions of both Clarendon and Citilife Financial Limited for a total purchase price of approximately $240.2 million. These acquisitions are expected to close in the second and first quarter of 2011, respectively;
 
  •  On March 4, 2011, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Clarendon Holdings, Inc., entered into a $106.5 million term facility agreement, or the Clarendon Facility, with a London-based bank, which will be available to be drawn to fund up to 50% of the purchase price of Clarendon;
 
  •  We expect our employee head count to increase by approximately 40 due primarily to the acquisition of Clarendon along with continued growth of our operations;
 
  •  We will continue to work with our regulators to facilitate the release of surplus capital from our regulated subsidiaries; and
 
  •  We will continue to source and complete, where appropriate, the acquisition of companies and portfolios of insurance and reinsurance business in run-off.
 
Financial Statement Overview
 
Consulting Fee Income
 
We generate consulting fees based on a combination of fixed and success-based fee arrangements. Consulting income will vary from period to period depending on the timing of completion of success-based fee arrangements. Success-based fees are recorded when targets related to overall project completion or profitability goals are achieved. Our consulting segment, in addition to providing services to third parties, also provides management services to the reinsurance segment based on agreed terms set out in management agreements between the parties. The fees charged by the consulting segment to the reinsurance segment are eliminated against the cost incurred by the reinsurance segment on consolidation.
 
Net Investment Income and Net Realized and Unrealized Gains/(Losses)
 
Our net investment income is principally derived from interest earned primarily on cash and investments offset by investment management fees paid. Our investment portfolio currently consists of the following: (1) fixed maturity investments that are classified as both available-for-sale and trading and are carried at fair value; (2) short-term investments that are classified as both available-for-sale and trading and are carried at fair value; (3) equities that are carried at fair value; and (4) other investments that are accounted for at estimated fair values determined by our proportionate share of the net asset value of the investee reduced by any impairment charges.
 
Our current investment strategy seeks to preserve principal and maintain liquidity while trying to maximize investment return through a high-quality, diversified portfolio. The volatility of claims and the effect they have on the amount of cash and investment balances, as well as the level of interest rates and other market factors, affect the return we are able to generate on our investment portfolio. When we make a new acquisition we will often restructure the acquired investment portfolio, which may generate one-time realized gains or losses.


68


Table of Contents

Net Reduction in Ultimate Loss and Loss Adjustment Expense Liabilities
 
Our insurance-related earnings are comprised primarily of reductions, or potential increases, of net ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities. These liabilities are comprised of:
 
  •  outstanding loss or case reserves, or OLR, which represent management’s best estimate of the likely settlement amount for known claims, less the portion that can be recovered from reinsurers;
 
  •  reserves for losses incurred but not reported, or IBNR reserves, which are reserves established by us for claims that are not yet reported but can reasonably be expected to have occurred based on industry information, management’s experience and actuarial evaluation, less the portion that can be recovered from reinsurers; and
 
  •  reserves for unallocated loss adjustment expenses, which represent management’s best estimate of the future costs to be incurred by us in managing the run-off of claims liabilities not specific, or allocated, to individual claims or policies.
 
Net ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities are reviewed by our management each quarter and by independent actuaries annually as of year end. Reserves reflect management’s best estimate of the remaining unpaid portion of these liabilities. Prior period estimates of net ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities may change as our management considers the combined impact of commutations, policy buy-backs, settlement of losses on carried reserves and the trend of incurred loss development compared to prior forecasts.
 
Commutations provide an opportunity for us to exit exposures to entire policies with insureds and reinsureds at a discount to the previously estimated ultimate liability. To the extent possible, our internal and external actuaries eliminate all prior historical loss development that relates to commuted exposures and apply their actuarial methodologies to the remaining aggregate exposures and revised historical loss development information to reassess estimates of ultimate liabilities.
 
Policy buy-backs provide an opportunity for us to settle individual policies and losses usually at a discount to carried advised loss reserves. As part of our routine claims settlement operations, claims will settle at either below or above the carried advised loss reserve. The impact of policy buy-backs and the routine settlement of claims updates historical loss development information to which actuarial methodologies are applied, often resulting in revised estimates of ultimate liabilities. Our actuarial methodologies include industry benchmarking, which, under certain methodologies (discussed further under “— Critical Accounting Policies” below), compares the trend of our loss development to that of the industry. To the extent that the trend of our loss development compared to the industry changes in any period, it is likely to have an impact on the estimate of ultimate liabilities. Additionally, consolidated net reductions, or potential increases, in net ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities include reductions, or potential increases, in the provisions for future losses and loss adjustment expenses related to the current period’s run-off activity. Net reductions in net ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities are reported as negative expenses by us in our reinsurance segment. The unallocated loss adjustment expenses paid by the reinsurance segment comprise management fees paid to the consulting segment and are eliminated on consolidation. The consulting segment costs in providing run-off services are classified as salaries and general and administrative expenses. For more information on how the reserves are calculated, see “— Critical Accounting Policies — Loss and Loss Adjustment Expenses” on page 72.
 
As our reinsurance subsidiaries are in run-off, our premium income is insignificant, consisting primarily of adjustment premiums triggered by loss payments.
 
Salaries and Benefits
 
We are a service-based company and, as such, employee salaries and benefits are our largest expense. We have experienced significant increases in our salaries and benefits expenses as we have grown our operations, and we expect that trend to continue if we are able to expand our operations successfully.
 
The Enstar Group Limited 2006 Equity Incentive Plan, or the Equity Incentive Plan, and the Enstar Group Limited 2006-2010 Annual Incentive Compensation Plan, or the Annual Incentive Plan, which are administered by the Compensation Committee of our board of directors, provide for the annual grant of bonus compensation to our


69


Table of Contents

officers and employees, including our senior executive officers. In February 2011, we adopted the Enstar Group Limited 2011-2015 Annual Incentive Compensation Program. Bonus awards for each calendar year from 2006 through 2010 were determined, and for calendar year 2011 will be determined, based on our consolidated net after-tax profits. The Compensation Committee determines the amount of bonus awards in any calendar year, based on a percentage of our consolidated net after-tax profits. The percentage is 15% unless the Compensation Committee exercises its discretion to change the percentage no later than 30 days after our year end. For the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 the percentage was left unchanged by the Compensation Committee. The Compensation Committee determines, in its sole discretion, the amount of bonus awards payable to each participant.
 
Bonus awards are payable in cash, ordinary shares or a combination of both. Ordinary shares issued in connection with a bonus award will be issued pursuant to the terms and subject to the conditions of the Equity Incentive Plan.
 
For information on the awards made under both the Annual and Equity Incentive plans for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, see Note 14 to our consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2010, included in Item 8 of this annual report.
 
General and Administrative Expenses
 
General and administrative expenses include rent and rent-related costs, professional fees (legal, investment, audit and actuarial) and travel expenses. We have operations in multiple jurisdictions and our employees travel frequently in connection with the search for acquisition opportunities and in the general management of the business. While certain general and administrative expenses, such as professional fees, are incurred directly by the reinsurance segment, the remaining general and administrative expenses are incurred by the consulting segment. To the extent that such costs incurred by the consulting segment relate to the management of the reinsurance segment, they are recovered by the consulting segment through the management fees charged to the reinsurance segment.
 
Foreign Exchange Gain/(Loss)
 
Our reporting currency is U.S. dollars. Our functional currency is U.S. dollars for all of our subsidiaries with the exception of Gordian, whose functional currency is Australian dollars. Through our subsidiaries whose functional currency is the U.S. dollar, we hold a variety of foreign (non-U.S.) currency assets and liabilities, the principal exposures being Euros, British pounds and Australian dollars. At each balance sheet date, recorded balances that are denominated in a currency other than U.S. dollars are adjusted to reflect the current exchange rate. Revenue and expense items are translated into U.S. dollars at average rates of exchange for the applicable period. The resulting exchange gains or losses are included in our net income.
 
For Gordian, whose functional currency is Australian dollars, at each reporting period the balance sheet and income statement are translated at period end and average rates of exchange, respectively, with any foreign exchange gains or losses on translation recorded as a component of our accumulated other comprehensive income in the shareholders’ equity section of our balance sheet.
 
We seek to manage our exposure to foreign currency exchange, where possible, by broadly matching our foreign currency assets against our foreign currency liabilities and to selectively use foreign currency exchange contracts. Subject to regulatory constraints, the net assets of our subsidiaries are maintained in U.S. dollars.
 
Income Tax/(Recovery)
 
Under current Bermuda law, we and our Bermuda subsidiaries are not required to pay taxes in Bermuda on either income or capital gains. These companies have received an undertaking from the Bermuda government that, in the event of income or capital gains taxes being imposed, they will be exempted from such taxes until the year 2016.
 
Income taxes have been provided, in accordance with the provisions of the Income Taxes topic of FASB ASC, on our operations in other jurisdictions which are subject to income tax. The calculation of our tax liabilities


70


Table of Contents

involves dealing with uncertainties in the application of complex tax laws and regulations in a multitude of jurisdictions across our global operations.
 
Deferred income taxes arise from temporary differences between the tax and financial statement recognition of revenue and expense. Such temporary differences are due primarily to the tax basis discount on unpaid losses and loss expenses, net operating loss carryforwards, and certain investments. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date. A valuation allowance against deferred tax assets is recorded if it is more likely than not that all, or some portion, of the benefits related to deferred tax assets will not be realized.
 
At each balance sheet date, we assess the need to establish a valuation allowance that reduces the net deferred tax asset when it is more likely than not that all, or some portion, of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. The valuation allowance is based on all available information including projections of future U.S. GAAP taxable income from each tax-paying component in each tax jurisdiction. Projections of future U.S. GAAP taxable income incorporate several assumptions of future business and operations that are likely to differ from actual experience. We also, in accordance with the Income Taxes topic of FASB ASC, record tax liabilities for unrecognized tax benefits related to uncertain tax positions.
 
Noncontrolling Interest
 
The acquisitions of Hillcot Re (formerly Toa-Re Insurance Company (UK) Limited) in March 2003 and of Brampton (formerly Aioi Insurance Company of Europe Limited) in March 2006 were effected through Hillcot, a Bermuda-based company in which we had a 50.1% economic interest until October 27, 2008. The results of operations of Hillcot were included in our consolidated statements of operations with the remaining 49.9% economic interest in the results of Hillcot reflected as a noncontrolling interest until October 27, 2008 when we acquired the 49.9% interest in Hillcot Re that we previously did not own. As a result, the noncontrolling interest in the earnings of Hillcot Re was recorded only through September 30, 2008. On November 2, 2010, we acquired the 49.9% of the shares of Hillcot that we did not previously own. At the time of acquisition, Hillcot owned 100% of the shares of Brampton. As a result, the noncontrolling interest in the earnings of Hillcot was recorded only through September 30, 2010.
 
During 2008, we completed the following acquisitions having a noncontrolling interest: 1) Guildhall, a U.K.-based insurance and reinsurance company in run-off; 2) Gordian, AMP Limited’s Australian-based closed reinsurance and insurance operations; 3) EPIC, a Bermuda-based reinsurance company; 4) Goshawk, which owns Rosemont Reinsurance Limited, a Bermuda-based reinsurer in run-off; and 5) Unionamerica, a U.K.-based insurance and reinsurance company in run-off. We have a 70% economic interest in all of the above listed acquired subsidiaries with the exception of Goshawk, in which we have a 75% economic interest. The results of the operations of the acquired subsidiaries are included in our consolidated statements of earnings with the remaining noncontrolling interests’ share of the economic interest of the respective subsidiaries reflected as a noncontrolling interest.
 
We own approximately 56.8% of Shelbourne, which in turn owns 100% of Shelbourne Syndicate Services Limited, the Managing Agency for Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008, a syndicate approved by Lloyd’s of London on December 16, 2007. We have committed to provide approximately 83.0% of the capital required by Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008, which is authorized to undertake RITC transactions with Lloyd’s syndicates in run-off.
 
During 2010, we completed the transfer of a specific portfolio of run-off business underwritten by Mitsui to our 50.1% owned subsidiary, Bosworth. The results of operations of Bosworth are included in our consolidated statements of earnings with the remaining noncontrolling interests’ share of the economic interest of Bosworth reflected as a noncontrolling interest.
 
Negative Goodwill
 
Negative goodwill represents the excess of the fair value of businesses acquired by us over the cost of such businesses. In accordance with the Business Combinations topic of FASB ASC, or ASC 805, this amount is recognized upon the acquisition of the businesses as an extraordinary gain. The fair values of the reinsurance assets


71


Table of Contents

and liabilities acquired are derived from probability-weighted ranges of the associated projected cash flows, based on actuarially prepared information and our management’s run-off strategy. Any amendment to the fair values resulting from changes in such information or strategy will be recognized when they occur. For more information on how the goodwill is determined, see “— Critical Accounting Policies — Goodwill” on page 83.
 
Critical Accounting Policies
 
Certain amounts in our consolidated financial statements require the use of best estimates and assumptions to determine reported values. These amounts could ultimately be materially different than what has been provided for in our consolidated financial statements. We consider the assessment of loss reserves and reinsurance recoverable to be the values requiring the most inherently subjective and complex estimates. In addition, the fair value measurement of our investments and the assessment of the possible impairment of goodwill involves certain estimates and assumptions. As such, the accounting policies for these amounts are of critical importance to our consolidated financial statements.
 
Loss and Loss Adjustment Expenses
 
The following table provides a breakdown of gross loss and loss adjustment expense reserves by type of exposure as of December 31, 2010 and 2009:
 
                                                 
    2010     2009  
    OLR     IBNR     Total     OLR     IBNR     Total  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Asbestos
  $ 221,567     $ 492,772     $ 714,339     $ 191,238     $ 470,113     $ 661,351  
Environmental
    62,592       48,281       110,873       46,252       43,369       89,621  
All other
    1,567,454       720,360       2,287,814       1,065,160       530,444       1,595,604  
                                                 
Total
  $ 1,851,613     $ 1,261,413     $ 3,113,026     $ 1,302,650     $ 1,043,926     $ 2,346,576  
                                                 
Unallocated loss adjustment expenses
                    178,249                       132,560  
                                                 
Total
                  $ 3,291,275                     $ 2,479,136  
                                                 
 
The following table provides a breakdown of loss and loss adjustment expense reserves (net of reinsurance balances recoverable) by type of exposure as of December 31, 2010 and 2009:
 
                                 
    2010     2009  
    Total     % of Total     Total     % of Total  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Asbestos
  $ 640,063       23.2 %   $ 588,411       27.6 %
Environmental
    96,109       3.5       79,221       3.7  
All other
    1,851,414       66.9       1,331,216       62.5  
Unallocated loss adjustment expenses
    178,249       6.4       132,560       6.2  
                                 
Total
  $ 2,765,835       100 %   $ 2,131,408       100 %
                                 
 
Our “All other” exposure category consists of a mix of general casualty (approximately 40% of “All other” net reserves), marine and aviation (approximately 11% of “All other” net reserves), workers compensation/personal accident (approximately 16% of “All other” net reserves) and other miscellaneous exposures, which are generally long-tailed in nature.
 
As of December 31, 2010, the IBNR reserves (net of reinsurance balances receivable) accounted for $1,119.9 million, or 40.5%, of our total net loss reserves. The reserve for IBNR (net of reinsurance balance receivable) accounted for $953.1 million, or 44.7%, of our total net loss reserves at December 31, 2009.


72


Table of Contents

Annual Loss and Loss Adjustment Reviews
 
Because a significant amount of time can lapse between the assumption of risk, the occurrence of a loss event, the reporting of the event to an insurance or reinsurance company and the ultimate payment of the claim on the loss event, the liability for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses is based largely upon estimates. Our management must use considerable judgment in the process of developing these estimates. The liability for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses for property and casualty business includes amounts determined from loss reports on individual cases and amounts for IBNR reserves. Such reserves, including IBNR reserves, are estimated by management based upon loss reports received from ceding companies, supplemented by our own estimates of losses for which no ceding company loss reports have yet been received.
 
In establishing reserves, management also considers independent actuarial estimates of ultimate losses. Our independent actuaries employ generally accepted actuarial methodologies to estimate ultimate losses and loss adjustment expenses. A loss reserve study prepared by an independent actuary provides the basis of our reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses.
 
Nearly all of our unpaid claims liabilities are considered to have a longtail claims payout. Gross loss reserves relate primarily to casualty exposures, including latent claims, of which approximately 25.1% relate to asbestos and environmental, or A&E, exposures.
 
Within the annual loss reserve studies produced by our external actuaries, exposures for each subsidiary are separated into homogeneous reserving categories for the purpose of estimating IBNR. Each reserving category contains either direct insurance or assumed reinsurance reserves and groups relatively similar types of risks and exposures (for example, asbestos, environmental, casualty, property) and lines of business written (for example, marine, aviation, non-marine). Based on the exposure characteristics and the nature of available data for each individual reserving category, a number of methodologies are applied. Recorded reserves for each category are selected from the indications produced by the various methodologies after consideration of exposure characteristics, data limitations and strengths and weaknesses of each method applied. This approach to estimating IBNR has been consistently adopted in the annual loss reserve studies for each period presented.
 
The ranges of gross loss and loss adjustment expense reserves implied by the various methodologies used by each of our insurance subsidiaries as of December 31, 2010 were:
 
                         
    Low     Selected     High  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Asbestos
  $ 612,272     $ 714,339     $ 784,486  
Environmental
    97,139       110,873       123,848  
All other
    2,087,565       2,287,814       2,578,426  
Unallocated loss adjustment expenses
    178,249       178,249       178,249  
                         
Total
  $ 2,975,225     $ 3,291,275     $ 3,665,009  
                         
 
Latent Claims
 
Our loss reserves are related largely to casualty exposures including latent exposures relating primarily to A&E. In establishing the reserves for unpaid claims, management considers facts currently known and the current state of the law and coverage litigation. Liabilities are recognized for known claims (including the cost of related litigation) when sufficient information has been developed to indicate the involvement of a specific insurance policy, and management can reasonably estimate its liability. In addition, reserves are established to cover loss development related to both known and unasserted claims.
 
The estimation of unpaid claim liabilities is subject to a high degree of uncertainty for a number of reasons. First, unpaid claim liabilities for property and casualty exposures in general are impacted by changes in the legal environment, jury awards, medical cost trends and general inflation. Moreover, for latent exposures in particular, developed case law and adequate claim history do not exist. There is significant coverage litigation related to these exposures, which creates further uncertainty in the estimation of the liabilities. As a result, for these types of exposures, it is especially unclear whether past claim experience will be representative of future claim experience.


73


Table of Contents

Ultimate values for such claims cannot be estimated using reserving techniques that extrapolate losses to an ultimate basis using loss development factors, and the uncertainties surrounding the estimation of unpaid claim liabilities are not likely to be resolved in the near future. There can be no assurance that the reserves established by us will be adequate or will not be adversely affected by the development of other latent exposures.
 
Our asbestos claims are primarily products liability claims submitted by a variety of insureds who operated in different parts of the asbestos distribution chain. While most such claims arise from asbestos mining and primary asbestos manufacturers, we have also been receiving claims from tertiary defendants such as smaller manufacturers, and the industry has seen an emerging trend of non-products claims arising from premises exposures. Unlike products claims, primary policies generally do not contain aggregate policy limits for premises claims, which, accordingly, remain at the primary layer and, thus, rarely impact excess insurance policies. As the vast majority of our policies are excess policies, this trend has had only a marginal effect on our asbestos exposures thus far.
 
Asbestos reform efforts have been underway at both the federal and state level to address the cost and scope of asbestos claims to the American economy. While congressional efforts to create a federal trust fund that would replace the tort system for asbestos claims failed, several states, including Texas and Florida, have passed reforms based on “medical criteria” requiring certain levels of medically documented injury before a lawsuit can be filed, generally resulting in a drop of case filings in those states adopting this reform measure.
 
Asbestos claims primarily fall into two general categories: impaired and unimpaired bodily injury claims. Property damage claims represent only a small fraction of asbestos claims. Impaired claims primarily include individuals suffering from mesothelioma or a cancer such as lung cancer. Unimpaired claims include asbestosis and those whose lung regions contain pleural plaques.
 
Unlike traditional property and casualty insurers that either have large numbers of individual claims arising from personal lines such as auto, or small numbers of high value claims as in medical malpractice insurance lines, our primary exposures arise from A&E claims that do not follow a consistent pattern. For instance, we may encounter a small insured with one large environmental claim due to significant groundwater contamination, while a Fortune 500 company may submit numerous claims for relatively small values. Moreover, there is no set pattern for the life of an environmental or asbestos claim. Some of these claims may resolve within two years whereas others have remained unresolved for nearly two decades. Therefore, our open and closed claims data do not follow any identifiable or discernible pattern.
 
Furthermore, because of the reinsurance nature of the claims we manage, we focus on the activities at the reinsured level rather than at the individual claims level. The counterparties with whom we typically interact are generally insurers or large industrial concerns and not individual claimants. Claims do not follow any consistent pattern. They arise from many insureds or locations and in a broad range of circumstances. An insured may present one large claim or hundreds or thousands of small claims. Plaintiffs’ counsel frequently aggregate thousands of claims within one lawsuit. The deductibles to which claims are subject vary from policy to policy and year to year. Often claims data is only available to reinsurers, such as us, on an aggregated basis. Accordingly, we have not found claim count information or average reserve amounts to be reliable indicators of exposure for our reserve estimation process or for management of our liabilities. We have found data accumulation and claims management more effective and meaningful at the reinsured level rather than at the underlying claim level. As a result, we have designed our reserving methodologies to be independent of claim count information. As the level of exposures to a reinsured can vary substantially, we focus on the aggregate exposures and pursue commutations and policy buy-backs with the larger reinsureds.
 
We employ approximately 27 full time equivalent employees, including a U.S. attorney, actuaries, and experienced claims-handlers, to directly administer our A&E liabilities. We have established a provision for future expenses of $47.3 million, which reflects the total anticipated costs to administer these claims to expiration.
 
Our future environmental loss development may be influenced by other factors including:
 
  •  Existence of currently undiscovered polluted sites eligible for clean-up under the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and Liability Act (CERCLA) and related legislation.


74


Table of Contents

 
  •  Costs imposed due to joint and several liability if not all potentially reliable parties (PRPs) are capable of paying their share.
 
  •  Success of legal challenges to certain policy terms such as the “absolute” pollution exclusion.
 
  •  Potential future reforms and amendments to CERCLA, particularly as the resources of Superfund — the funding vehicle, established as part of CERCLA, to provide financing for cleanup of polluted sites where no PRP can be identified — become exhausted.
 
The influence of each of these factors is not easily quantifiable and, as with asbestos-related exposures, our historical environmental loss development is of limited value in determining future environmental loss development using traditional actuarial reserving techniques.
 
There have been recent positive developments concerning lead paint liability, an area previously viewed as an emerging trend in latent claim activity with the potential to adversely affect reserves. After a series of successful defense efforts by defendant lead pigment manufacturers in lead paint litigation, in 2005, a Rhode Island trial court ruled in favor of the government in a nuisance claim against the defendant manufacturers. Since the Rhode Island decision, other government entities have employed the same theory for recovery against these manufacturers. In 2008, the Rhode Island Supreme Court reversed the sole legal liability loss experienced by lead pigment manufacturers in lead paint litigation. The court rejected public nuisance as a viable theory of liability for use by the government against the defendants and thus invalidated the entire claim against the lead pigment manufacturers. Subsequent to the Rhode Island Supreme Court decision at least one other government entity, an Ohio municipality, voluntarily dropped its lead paint suit. Thereafter, the State of Ohio, voluntarily dismissed its pending action against lead pigment manufacturers. Other state supreme courts equally rejected the public nuisance theory of liability, whereas no highest state court has ever adopted this theory as an acceptable cause of action.
 
We believe that lead paint claims now pose a lower risk to adverse reserve adjustment than previously thought, as the only trial court decision against lead pigment manufacturers to date was reversed on the basis that public nuisance is an improper liability theory by which a plaintiff may seek recovery against the lead pigment manufacturers. Even if adverse rulings under alternative theories succeed or if other states ultimately permit recovery under a public nuisance theory, it is questionable whether insureds have coverage under their policies under which they seek indemnity. Insureds have yet to meet policy terms and conditions to establish coverage for lead paint public nuisance claims, as opposed to traditional bodily injury and property damage claims. Still, there is the potential for significant impact to excess insurers should plaintiffs prevail in successive nuisance claims pending in other jurisdictions and coverage is established.
 
Our independent, external actuaries use industry benchmarking methodologies to estimate appropriate IBNR reserves for our A&E exposures. These methods are based on comparisons of our loss experience on A&E exposures relative to industry loss experience on A&E exposures. Estimates of IBNR are derived separately for each of our relevant subsidiaries and, for some subsidiaries, separately for distinct portfolios of exposure. The discussion that follows describes, in greater detail, the primary actuarial methodologies used by our independent actuaries to estimate IBNR for A&E exposures.
 
In addition to the specific considerations for each method described below, many general factors are considered in the application of the methods and the interpretation of results for each portfolio of exposures. These factors include the mix of product types (e.g., primary insurance versus reinsurance of primary versus reinsurance of reinsurance), the average attachment point of coverages (e.g., first-dollar primary versus umbrella over primary versus high-excess), payment and reporting lags related to the international domicile of our subsidiaries, payment and reporting pattern acceleration due to large “wholesale” settlements (e.g., policy buy-backs and commutations) pursued by us, lists of individual risks remaining and general trends within the legal and tort environments.
 
1. Paid Survival Ratio Method.  In this method, our expected annual average payment amount is multiplied by an expected future number of payment years to get an indicated reserve. Our historical calendar year payments are examined to determine an expected future annual average payment amount. This amount is multiplied by an expected number of future payment years to estimate a reserve. Trends in calendar year payment activity are considered when selecting an expected future annual average payment amount. Accepted industry benchmarks are


75


Table of Contents

used in determining an expected number of future payment years. Each year, annual payments data is updated, trends in payments are re-evaluated and changes to benchmark future payment years are reviewed. This method has advantages of ease of application and simplicity of assumptions. A potential disadvantage of the method is that results could be misleading for portfolios of high excess exposures where significant payment activity has not yet begun.
 
2. Paid Market Share Method.  In this method, our estimated market share is applied to the industry estimated unpaid losses. The ratio of our historical calendar year payments to industry historical calendar year payments is examined to estimate our market share. This ratio is then applied to the estimate of industry unpaid losses. Each year, calendar year payment data is updated (for both us and industry), estimates of industry unpaid losses are reviewed and the selection of our estimated market share is revisited. This method has the advantage that trends in calendar year market share can be incorporated into the selection of company share of remaining market payments. A potential disadvantage of this method is that it is particularly sensitive to assumptions regarding the time-lag between industry payments and our payments.
 
3. Reserve-to-Paid Method.  In this method, the ratio of estimated industry reserves to industry paid-to-date losses is multiplied by our paid-to-date losses to estimate our reserves. Specific considerations in the application of this method include the completeness of our paid-to-date loss information, the potential acceleration or deceleration in our payments (relative to the industry) due to our claims handling practices, and the impact of large individual settlements. Each year, paid-to-date loss information is updated (for both us and the industry) and updates to industry estimated reserves are reviewed. This method has the advantage of relying purely on paid loss data and so is not influenced by subjectivity of case reserve loss estimates. A potential disadvantage is that the application to our portfolios which do not have complete inception-to-date paid loss history could produce misleading results. To address this potential disadvantage, a variation of the method is also considered by multiplying the ratio of estimated industry reserves to industry losses paid during a recent period of time (e.g., 5 years) times our paid losses during that period.
 
4. IBNR:Case Ratio Method.  In this method, the ratio of estimated industry IBNR reserves to industry case reserves is multiplied by our case reserves to estimate our IBNR reserves. Specific considerations in the application of this method include the presence of policies reserved at policy limits, changes in overall industry case reserve adequacy and recent loss reporting history for us. Each year, our case reserves are updated, industry reserves are updated and the applicability of the industry IBNR:Case Ratio is reviewed. This method has the advantage that it incorporates the most recent estimates of amounts needed to settle open cases included in current case reserves. A potential disadvantage is that results could be misleading where our case reserve adequacy differs significantly from overall industry case reserve adequacy.
 
5. Ultimate-to-Incurred Method.  In this method, the ratio of estimated industry ultimate losses to industry incurred-to-date losses is applied to our incurred-to-date losses to estimate our IBNR reserves. Specific considerations in the application of this method include the completeness of our incurred-to-date loss information, the potential acceleration or deceleration in our incurred losses (relative to the industry) due to our claims handling practices and the impact of large individual settlements. Each year incurred-to-date loss information is updated (for both us and the industry) and updates to industry estimated ultimate losses are reviewed. This method has the advantage that it incorporates both paid and case reserve information in projecting ultimate losses. A potential disadvantage is that results could be misleading where cumulative paid loss data is incomplete or where our case reserve adequacy differs significantly from overall industry case reserve adequacy.
 
Under the Paid Survival Ratio Method, the Paid Market Share Method and the Reserve-to-Paid Method, we first determine the estimated total reserve and then deduct the reported outstanding case reserves to arrive at an estimated IBNR reserve. The IBNR:Case Ratio Method first determines an estimated IBNR reserve which is then added to the advised outstanding case reserves to arrive at an estimated total loss reserve. The Ultimate-to-Incurred Method first determines an estimate of the ultimate losses to be paid and then deducts paid-to-date losses to arrive at an estimated total loss reserve and then deducts outstanding case reserves to arrive at the estimated IBNR reserve.
 
Within the annual loss reserve studies produced by our external actuaries, exposures for each subsidiary are separated into homogeneous reserving categories for the purpose of estimating IBNR. Each reserving category contains either direct insurance or assumed reinsurance reserves and groups relatively similar types of risks and


76


Table of Contents

exposures (e.g., asbestos, environmental, casualty and property) and lines of business written (e.g., marine, aviation and non-marine). Based on the exposure characteristics and the nature of available data for each individual reserving category, a number of methodologies are applied. Recorded reserves for each category are selected from the indications produced by the various methodologies after consideration of exposure characteristics, data limitations, and strengths and weaknesses of each method applied. This approach to estimating IBNR has been consistently adopted in the annual loss reserve studies for each period presented.
 
As of December 31, 2010, we had 35 separate insurance and/or reinsurance subsidiaries whose reserves are categorized into approximately 276 reserve categories in total, including 40 distinct asbestos reserving categories and 27 distinct environmental reserving categories.
 
To the extent that data availability allows, the five methodologies described above are applied for each of the 40 asbestos reserving categories and each of the 27 environmental reserving categories. As is common in actuarial practice, no one methodology is exclusively or consistently relied upon when selecting a recorded reserve. Consistent reliance on a single methodology to select a recorded reserve would be inappropriate in light of the dynamic nature of both the A&E liabilities in general, and our actual exposure portfolios in particular.
 
In selecting a recorded reserve, management considers the range of results produced by the methods, and the strengths and weaknesses of the methods in relation to the data available and the specific characteristics of the portfolio under consideration. Trends in both our data and industry data are also considered in the reserve selection process. Recent trends or changes in the relevant tort and legal environments are also considered when assessing methodology results and selecting an appropriate recorded reserve amount for each portfolio.
 
The following key assumptions were used to estimate A&E reserves at December 31, 2010:
 
1. $65 Billion Ultimate Industry Asbestos Losses — This level of industry-wide losses and its comparison to industry-wide paid, incurred and outstanding case reserves is the base benchmarking assumption applied to Paid Market Share, Reserve-to-Paid, IBNR:Case Ratio and the Ultimate-to-Incurred asbestos reserving methodologies.
 
2. $35 Billion Ultimate Industry Environmental Losses — This level of industry-wide losses and its comparison to industry-wide paid, incurred and outstanding case reserves is the base benchmarking assumption applied to Paid Market Share, Reserve-to-Paid, IBNR:Case Ratio and the Ultimate-to-Incurred environmental reserving methodologies.
 
3. Loss Reporting Lag — Our subsidiaries assumed a mix of insurance and reinsurance exposures generally through the London market. As the available industry benchmark loss information, as supplied by our independent consulting actuaries, is compiled largely from U.S. direct insurance company experience, our loss reporting is expected to lag relative to available industry benchmark information. This time-lag used by each of our insurance subsidiaries varies from 1 to 5 years depending on the relative mix of domicile, percentages of product mix of insurance, reinsurance and retrocessional reinsurance, primary insurance, excess insurance, reinsurance of direct, and reinsurance of reinsurance within any given exposure category. Exposure portfolios written from a non-U.S. domicile are assumed to have a greater time-lag than portfolios written from a U.S. domicile. Portfolios with a larger proportion of reinsurance exposures are assumed to have a greater time-lag than portfolios with a larger proportion of insurance exposures.
 
The assumptions above as to Ultimate Industry Asbestos and Environmental losses have not changed from the immediately preceding period. For our company as a whole, the average selected lag for asbestos has increased slightly from 2.8 years to 2.9 years and the average selected lag for environmental has decreased slightly from 2.5 years to 2.4 years. The changes to the selected lags arose largely as a result of the acquisition of new portfolios of A&E exposures.


77


Table of Contents

The following tables provide a summary of the impact of changes in industry ultimate losses, from the selected $65 billion for asbestos and $35 billion for environmental, and changes in the time-lag, from the selected averages of 2.9 years for asbestos and 2.4 years for environmental, for us behind industry development that it is assumed relates to our insurance and reinsurance companies. Please note that the table below demonstrates sensitivity to changes to key assumptions using methodologies selected for determining loss and allocated loss adjustment expenses, or ALAE, at December 31, 2010 and differs from the table on page 73, which demonstrates the range of outcomes produced by the various methodologies.
 
         
    Asbestos
Sensitivity to Industry Asbestos Ultimate Loss Assumption   Loss Reserves
    (in thousands
    of U.S. dollars)
 
Asbestos — $70 billion
  $ 830,228  
Asbestos — $65 billion (selected)
    714,339  
Asbestos — $60 billion
    598,450  
 
         
    Environmental
Sensitivity to Industry Environmental Ultimate Loss Assumption   Loss Reserves
    (in thousands
    of U.S. dollars)
 
Environmental — $40 billion
  $ 170,227  
Environmental — $35 billion (selected)
    110,873  
Environmental — $30 billion
    51,519  
 
                 
    Asbestos
  Environmental
Sensitivity to Time-Lag Assumption*   Loss Reserves   Loss Reserves
    (in thousands
    of U.S. dollars)
 
Selected average of 2.9 years asbestos, 2.4 years environmental
  $ 714,339     $ 110,873  
Increase all portfolio lags by six months
    787,964       114,922  
Decrease all portfolio lags by six months
    630,826       106,046  
 
 
* Using $65 billion/$35 billion Asbestos/Environmental Industry Ultimate Loss assumptions.
 
Industry publications have, since 2001, indicated that the range of ultimate industry losses is estimated to be between approximately $55 billion and $65 billion for asbestos losses. One commonly-referenced benchmark estimate has recently increased its estimate of ultimate industry asbestos losses from $65 billion to $75 billion. One of the reasons cited for the increase in estimated industry ultimate asbestos losses is a shift of losses away from products liability claims to non-products claims. In considering the impact of this issue, it is important to understand how asbestos claims attach to policies issued by the insurance industry in general and the policies issued by the companies owned by us in particular.
 
Historically, asbestos claims have been presented as “products liability” claims brought against manufacturers and distributors of asbestos-containing products. For a given manufacturer, distributor, or other entity involved in asbestos litigation, multiple claims are filed by numerous individuals. There is typically an allocation of the settlement costs for asbestos claims over time based on exposure to asbestos by the injured claimants. Many asbestos claims will aggregate within each individual policy period to exhaust the annual aggregate policy limits which exist within policies sold to cover products liability claims.
 
Beginning in the mid-1990’s, a trend began to emerge whereby certain policyholders began to assert that their asbestos claims should not fall within the “products liability” section of their policies and, therefore, should not be subject to the aggregate limits of products liability claims. Instead, the policyholder would assert that each individual bodily injury claim should be treated as a separate occurrence under the “premises/operations” section of their policies. Under such presentation, individual claim or occurrence limits apply separately to each claim and there is no aggregate limit for the amount of “premises” or “non-products” claims within a particular policy.


78


Table of Contents

Our exposure to asbestos losses arises largely from direct excess policies and assumed reinsurance policies written through the London market. With respect to direct excess policies, our companies typically participated on policies whereby liability would only attach in excess of primary and umbrella policy limits. As non-products asbestos losses are not aggregated and are generally confined to the limits of the primary and other lower layer insurance policies, we believe we have very little exposure to non-products asbestos losses through direct insurance policies issued by our owned subsidiary companies. To date, we have seen no material reporting of non-products asbestos claims on direct insurance policies. The trend of asbestos losses shifting from products to non-products is not a new phenomenon. As our insurance entities have not received any material reporting of non-products claims to date and their direct insurance exposures are generally in excess of the layers of insurance impacted by non-products asbestos losses, we do not expect any material future liability in respect of non-products asbestos claims.
 
Losses with respect to assumed reinsurance exposures to non-products asbestos claims are unlikely to be aggregated and are generally confined to the limits of the primary and other lower layer insurance policies. There is limited ability for such claims to exceed retained levels. Our assumed reinsurance portfolio with respect to asbestos exposures is largely excess of loss in nature and, therefore, not especially subject to non-products asbestos liabilities. To date, we have seen no material reporting of non-products asbestos claims on assumed reinsurance policies.
 
As stated above, the trend of asbestos losses shifting from products to non-products is not a new phenomenon. As our assumed reinsurance entities have not received any material reporting of non-products claims to date and their assumed reinsurance exposures generally cover layers of insurance not impacted by non-products asbestos losses, management does not expect any material future liability in respect of non-products asbestos claims.
 
Other reasons cited for the increase in estimated industry ultimate asbestos losses include the ongoing uncertainty surrounding insurance coverage of asbestos claims and the ongoing reporting of significant numbers and values of malignant mesothelioma claims. As we do not view these issues as new information any impact has already been factored into our actuarial reserving methodologies with no need for any change in assumptions.
 
Furthermore, in recent years, the overall asbestos loss development trend within our portfolio has been favorable. Our asbestos exposures are reviewed by independent actuaries on an annual basis as part of the overall annual loss reserve review. Actual loss reporting for asbestos claims in recent years has been below actuarial estimated expectations.
 
Having considered the recent increase in one commonly-referenced benchmark estimate of ultimate net asbestos losses in the context of our portfolio of loss exposures and actual asbestos loss reporting in recent years for us in particular, as well as for the insurance industry generally, we believe there is no need to increase the $65 billion asbestos ultimate industry loss assumption.
 
Guidance from industry publications is more varied in respect of estimates of ultimate industry environmental losses. Consistent with an industry published estimate, we believe the reasonable range for ultimate industry environmental losses is between $30 billion and $40 billion. We have selected the midpoint of this range as the basis for our environmental loss reserving based on advice supplied by our independent consulting actuaries. Another industry publication has recently reduced its estimate of ultimate industry environmental losses from $56 billion to $42 billion. Based on our own loss experience, including successful settlement activity by us, the decline in new claims notified in recent years, improvements in environmental clean-up technology and the reduced industry estimate, we believe that $35 billion remains a reasonable basis for inclusion in our methodologies for reserving for environmental losses.
 
Our current estimate of the time lag that relates to our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries compared to the industry is considered reasonable given the analysis performed by our internal and external actuaries to date.
 
Over time, additional information regarding such exposure characteristics may be developed for any given portfolio. This additional information could cause a shift in the lag assumed.


79


Table of Contents

Non-Latent Claims
 
For non-latent loss exposure, a range of traditional loss development extrapolation techniques is applied. Incremental paid and incurred loss development methodologies are the most commonly used methods. Traditional cumulative paid and incurred loss development methods are used where inception-to-date, cumulative paid and reported incurred loss development history is available.
 
These methods assume that cohorts, or groups, of losses from similar exposures will increase over time in a predictable manner. Historical paid and incurred loss development experience is examined for earlier accident years to make inferences about how later accident years’ losses will develop. Where company-specific loss information is not available or not reliable, industry loss development information published by industry sources such as the Reinsurance Association of America is considered. These methods calculate an estimate of ultimate losses and then deduct paid-to-date losses to arrive at an estimated total loss reserve. Outstanding losses are then deducted from estimated total loss reserves to calculate the estimated IBNR reserve. Management does not expect changes in underlying reserving assumptions to have a material impact on net loss and loss adjustment expense reserves as they are primarily sensitive to changes due to loss development.
 
Quarterly Reserve Reviews
 
In addition to an in-depth annual review, we also perform quarterly reserve reviews. This is done by examining quarterly paid and incurred loss development to determine whether it is consistent with reserves established during the preceding annual reserve review and with expected development. Loss development is reviewed separately for each major exposure type (e.g., asbestos, environmental, etc.), for each of our relevant subsidiaries, and for large “wholesale” commutation settlements versus “routine” paid and advised losses. This process is undertaken to determine whether loss development experience during a quarter warrants any change to held reserves.
 
Loss development is examined separately by exposure type because different exposures develop differently over time. For example, the expected reporting and payout of losses for a given amount of asbestos reserves can be expected to take place over a different time frame and in a different quarterly pattern from the same amount of environmental reserves.
 
In addition, loss development is examined separately for each of our relevant subsidiaries. Companies can differ in their exposure profile due to the mix of insurance versus reinsurance, the mix of primary versus excess insurance, the underwriting years of participation and other criteria. These differing profiles lead to different expectations for quarterly and annual loss development by company.
 
Our quarterly paid and incurred loss development is often driven by large, “wholesale” settlements — such as commutations and policy buy-backs — which settle many individual claims in a single transaction. This allows for monitoring of the potential profitability of large settlements which, in turn, can provide information about the adequacy of reserves on remaining exposures which have not yet been settled. For example, if it were found that large settlements were consistently leading to large negative, or favorable, incurred losses upon settlement, it might be an indication that reserves on remaining exposures are redundant. Conversely, if it were found that large settlements were consistently leading to large positive, or adverse, incurred losses upon settlement, it might be an indication — particularly if the size of the losses were increasing — that certain loss reserves on remaining exposures are deficient. Moreover, removing the loss development resulting from large settlements allows for a review of loss development related only to those contracts which remain exposed to losses. Were this not done, it is possible that savings on large wholesale settlements could mask significant underlying development on remaining exposures.
 
Once the data has been analyzed as described above, an in-depth review is performed on classes of exposure with significant loss development. Discussions are held with appropriate personnel, including individual company managers, claims handlers and attorneys, to better understand the causes. If it were determined that development differs significantly from expectations, reserves would be adjusted.
 
Quarterly loss development is expected to be fairly erratic for the types of exposure insured and reinsured by us. Several quarters of low incurred loss development can be followed by spikes of relatively large incurred losses. This is characteristic of latent claims and other insurance losses which are reported and settled many years after the


80


Table of Contents

inception of the policy. Given the high degree of statistical uncertainty, and potential volatility, it would be unusual to adjust reserves on the basis of one, or even several, quarters of loss development activity. As a result, unless the incurred loss activity in any one quarter is of such significance that management is able to quantify the impact on the ultimate liability for loss and loss adjustment expenses, reductions or increases in loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities are carried out in the fourth quarter based on the annual reserve review described above.
 
As described above, our management regularly reviews and updates reserve estimates using the most current information available and employing various actuarial methods. Adjustments resulting from changes in our estimates are recorded in the period when such adjustments are determined. The ultimate liability for loss and loss adjustment expenses is likely to differ from the original estimate due to a number of factors, primarily consisting of the overall claims activity occurring during any period, including the completion of commutations of assumed liabilities and ceded reinsurance receivables, policy buy-backs and general incurred claims activity.
 
Reinsurance Balances Receivable
 
Our acquired reinsurance subsidiaries, prior to acquisition by us, used retrocessional agreements to reduce their exposure to the risk of insurance and reinsurance they assumed. Loss reserves represent total gross losses, and reinsurance receivables represent anticipated recoveries of a portion of those unpaid losses as well as amounts receivable from reinsurers with respect to claims that have already been paid. While reinsurance arrangements are designed to limit losses and to permit recovery of a portion of direct unpaid losses, reinsurance does not relieve us of our liabilities to our insureds or reinsureds. Therefore, we evaluate and monitor concentration of credit risk among our reinsurers, including companies that are insolvent, in run-off or facing financial difficulties. Provisions are made for amounts considered potentially uncollectible.
 
At December 31, 2010 and 2009, the provision for uncollectible reinsurance relating to losses recoverable was $381.4 million and $397.6 million, respectively. To estimate the provision for uncollectible reinsurance recoverable, the reinsurance recoverable is first allocated to applicable reinsurers. This determination is based on a detailed process rather than an estimate, although an element of judgment is applied. As part of this process, ceded IBNR is allocated by reinsurer.
 
We use a detailed analysis to estimate uncollectible reinsurance. The primary components of the analysis are reinsurance recoverable balances by reinsurer and bad debt provisions applied to these balances to determine the portion of a reinsurer’s balance deemed to be uncollectible. These provisions require considerable judgment and are determined using the current rating, or rating equivalent, of each reinsurer (in order to determine its ability to settle the reinsurance balances) as well as other key considerations and assumptions, such as claims and coverage issues.
 
See Note 8 to our consolidated financial statements for an analysis of reinsurance recoverables.
 
Provisions for Unallocated Loss Adjustment Expense Liabilities
 
Provisions for unallocated loss adjustment expense liabilities are estimated by management by determining the future annual costs to be incurred by us, comprising staff costs, consultancy and professional fees and overheads, in managing the run-off of claims liabilities for each of our insurance and reinsurance entities. The provision is reviewed quarterly and reduced in accordance with the related costs incurred each period.
 
Fair Value Measurements
 
The following is a summary of valuation techniques or models we use to measure fair value by asset and liability classes, which have not changed significantly since December 31, 2009.
 
Fixed Maturity Investments
 
Our fixed maturity portfolio is managed by our Chief Investment Officer and our outside investment advisors. We use inputs from nationally recognized pricing services, including pricing vendors, index providers and broker-dealers to estimate fair value measurements for all of our fixed maturity investments. These pricing services include FT Interactive Data, Barclays Capital Aggregate Index (formerly Lehman Index), Reuters Pricing Service and others.


81


Table of Contents

In general, the independent pricing services use observable market inputs including, but not limited to, investment yields, credit risks and spreads, benchmark curves, benchmarking of like securities, non-binding broker-dealer quotes, reported trades and sector groupings to determine the fair value. In addition, pricing services use valuation models, such as an Option Adjusted Spread model, to develop prepayment and interest rate scenarios. The Option Adjusted Spread model is commonly used to estimate fair value for securities such as mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities.
 
With the exception of two securities held within our trading portfolio, the fair value estimates of our fixed maturity investments are based on observable market data. We have therefore included these as Level 2 investments within the fair value hierarchy. The two securities in our trading portfolio that do not have observable inputs have been included as Level 3 investments within the fair value hierarchy.
 
To validate the techniques or models used by the pricing services, we compare the fair value estimates to our knowledge of the current market and will challenge any prices deemed not to be representative of fair value.
 
As of December 31, 2010, there were no material differences between the prices obtained from the pricing services and the fair value estimates developed by us.
 
In evaluating credit losses, we consider a variety of factors in the assessment of a fixed maturity investment including: (1) the time period during which there has been a significant decline below cost; (2) the extent of the decline below cost and par; (3) the potential for the fixed maturity investment to recover in value; (4) an analysis of the financial condition of the issuer; (5) the rating of the issuer; and (6) failure of the issuer of the fixed maturity investment to make scheduled interest or principal payments.
 
Based on the factors described above, we determined that, as of December 31, 2010, no credit losses existed.
 
Equity Securities
 
Our equity securities are managed by two external advisors. Through these third parties, we use nationally recognized pricing services, including pricing vendors, index providers and broker-dealers to estimate fair value measurements for all of our equity securities. These pricing services include FT Interactive Data and others.
 
We have categorized all of our investments in common stock as Level 1 investments because the fair values of these securities are based on quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. We have categorized all of our investments in preferred stock as Level 2 (except one which was categorized as Level 3) because their fair value estimates are based on observable market data.
 
Other Investments
 
For our investments in private equities, we measure fair value by obtaining the most recently published net asset value as advised by the external fund manager or third-party administrator. The use of net asset value as an estimate of the fair value for investments in certain entities that calculate net asset value is a permitted practical expedient. Our private equity investments are mainly in the financial services industry. The fund advisors continue to evaluate the overall market environment, as well as specific areas in the financial services sector, in order to identify segments that they believe will offer the most attractive investment opportunities. The financial statements of each fund generally are audited annually under U.S. GAAP, using fair value measurement for the underlying investments. For all publicly-traded companies within the funds, we have valued those investments based on the latest share price. The value of Affirmative Investment LLC (in which we own a non-voting 7% membership interest) is based on the market value of the shares of Affirmative Insurance Holdings, Inc., a publicly-traded company.
 
All of our investments in private equities are subject to restrictions on redemptions and sales that are determined by the governing documents and limit our ability to liquidate those investments in the short term. The capital commitments are discussed in detail in Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements.
 
We have classified our private equities as Level 3 investments because they reflect our own judgment about the assumptions that market participants might use.


82


Table of Contents

For our investment in the hedge fund, we measure fair value by obtaining the most recently published net asset value as advised by the external fund manager or third-party administrator. The use of net asset value as an estimate of the fair value for investments in certain entities that calculate net asset value is a permitted practical expedient. The adviser of the fund intends to seek attractive risk-adjusted total returns for the fund’s investors by acquiring, originating, and actively managing a diversified portfolio of debt securities, with a focus on various forms of asset-backed securities and loans. The fund will focus on investments that the adviser believes to be fundamentally undervalued with current market prices that are believed to be compelling relative to intrinsic value. The units of account that are valued by us are our interests in the fund and not the underlying holdings of the fund. Thus, the inputs used to value our investments in the fund may differ from the inputs used to value the underlying holdings of the fund. The hedge fund is not currently eligible for redemption due to imposed lock-up periods of three years from the time of the initial investment. Once eligible, redemptions will be permitted quarterly with 90 days notice. There are no unfunded capital commitments in relation to the hedge fund. The investment in the fund is classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.
 
The bond funds have been classified as Level 2 investments because their fair value is estimated using the net asset value reported by Bloomberg and they have daily liquidity.
 
For the year ended December 31, 2010, the share of net earnings on our other investments was $21.4 million as compared to $5.2 million for the year-ended December 31, 2009. Any unrealized losses or gains on our other investments are included as part of our net investment income.
 
The following table summarizes all of our financial assets and liabilities recorded at fair value at December 31, 2010, by hierarchy established by the Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure topic of FASB ASC:
 
                                 
    December 31, 2010  
    Quoted Prices in
    Significant
    Significant
       
    Active Markets for
    Other Observable
    Unobservable
       
    Identical Assets
    Inputs
    Inputs
    Total Fair
 
    (Level 1)     (Level 2)     (Level 3)     Value  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
U.S. government and agency
  $     $ 227,803     $     $ 227,803  
Non-U.S. government
          386,866             386,866  
Corporate
          1,346,854       530       1,347,384  
Municipal
          2,297             2,297  
Residential mortgage-backed
          102,506             102,506  
Commercial mortgage-backed
          37,927       914       38,841  
Asset backed
          28,613             28,613  
Equities
    56,369       138       3,575       60,082  
Other investments
          102,279       132,435       234,714  
                                 
Total investments
  $ 56,369     $ 2,235,283     $ 137,454     $ 2,429,106  
                                 
As a percentage of total assets
    1.1 %     42.7 %     2.6 %     46.4 %
 
Goodwill
 
We follow the provisions of the Intangibles — Goodwill and Other topic of FASB ASC, which requires that recorded goodwill be assessed for impairment on at least an annual basis. In determining goodwill, we must determine the fair value of the assets of an acquired company. The determination of fair value necessarily involves many assumptions. Fair values of reinsurance assets and liabilities acquired are derived from probability-weighted ranges of the associated projected cash flows, based on actuarially prepared information and our management run-off strategy. Fair value adjustments are based on the estimated timing of loss and loss adjustment expense payments and an assumed interest rate, and are amortized over the estimated payout period, as adjusted for accelerations on commutation settlements, using the constant yield method option. Interest rates used to determine the fair value of gross loss reserves are based upon risk free rates applicable to the average duration of the loss reserves. Interest rates used to determine the fair value of reinsurance receivables are increased to reflect the credit risk associated with the


83


Table of Contents

reinsurers from which the receivables are, or will become, due. If the assumptions made in initially valuing the assets change significantly in the future, we may be required to record impairment charges which could have a material impact on our financial condition and results of operations.
 
ASC 805 also requires that negative goodwill be recorded in earnings. During 2008, we took negative goodwill into earnings upon the completion of the acquisition of certain companies and presented it as an extraordinary gain.
 
ASC 805 requires an acquirer to recognize the assets acquired, the liabilities assumed and any noncontrolling interest in the acquiree at the acquisition date, measured at their fair values as of that date. ASC 805 also requires the acquirer to recognize acquisition-related costs separately from the acquisition, recognize assets acquired and liabilities assumed arising from contractual contingencies at their acquisition-date fair values and recognize goodwill as the excess of the consideration transferred plus the fair value of any noncontrolling interest in the acquiree at the acquisition date over the fair values of the identifiable net assets acquired. ASC 805 applies prospectively to business combinations for which the acquisition date is on or after the beginning of the first annual reporting period beginning on or after December 15, 2008 (January 1, 2009 for calendar year-end companies).
 
Recent Accounting Pronouncements
 
See Note 2 to our consolidated financial statements for a discussion of new accounting standards we have adopted as well as standards not yet adopted.


84


Table of Contents

Results of Operations
 
The following table sets forth our selected consolidated statements of earnings data for each of the periods indicated.
 
                         
    Years Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009     2008  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
INCOME
                       
Consulting fees
  $ 23,015     $ 16,104     $ 25,151  
Net investment income
    99,906       81,371       26,601  
Net realized and unrealized gains (losses)
    13,137       4,237       (1,655 )
                         
      136,058       101,712       50,097  
                         
EXPENSES
                       
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities:
                       
Reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses
    (278,065 )     (274,825 )     (161,437 )
Reduction in provisions for bad debt
    (49,556 )     (11,718 )     (36,136 )
Reduction in provisions for unallocated loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
    (39,651 )     (50,412 )     (69,056 )
Amortization of fair value adjustments
    55,438       77,328       24,525  
                         
      (311,834 )     (259,627 )     (242,104 )
Salaries and benefits
    86,677       68,454       56,270  
General and administrative expenses
    59,201       46,902       53,357  
Interest expense
    10,253       17,583       23,370  
Net foreign exchange (gain) loss
    (398 )     23,787       14,986  
                         
      (156,101 )     (102,901 )     (94,121 )
                         
Earnings before income taxes and share of net earnings (loss) of partly owned company
    292,159       204,613       144,218  
Income taxes
    (87,132 )     (27,605 )     (46,854 )
Share of net earnings (loss) of partly owned company
    10,704             (201 )
                         
Earnings before extraordinary gain
    215,731       177,008       97,163  
Extraordinary gain — negative goodwill
                50,280  
                         
NET EARNINGS
    215,731       177,008       147,443  
Less: Net earnings attributable to noncontrolling interest (including share of extraordinary gain of $nil, $nil and $15,084)
    (41,645 )     (41,798 )     (65,892 )
                         
NET EARNINGS ATTRIBUTABLE TO ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
  $ 174,086     $ 135,210     $ 81,551  
                         
 
Comparison of Years Ended December 31, 2010 and 2009
 
We reported consolidated net earnings, before extraordinary item and net earnings attributable to noncontrolling interest, of approximately $215.7 million and $177.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The increase in earnings of approximately $38.7 million was attributable primarily to the following:
 
  (i)     an increase in net investment income of $18.5 million primarily as a result of an increase, in 2010, in the fair value of our private equity portfolio classified as other investments of $8.6 million along with an increase in net investment income due to an increase in cash and investment balances held during 2010;


85


Table of Contents

 
  (ii)    an increase in net realized and unrealized gains of $8.9 million due primarily to mark-to-market changes in the market value of our equity investments along with realized gains on the sale of our fixed maturity securities;
 
  (iii)   a larger net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities of $52.2 million;
 
  (iv)    an increase in consulting fee income of $6.9 million;
 
  (v)     reduced interest expense of $7.3 million due primarily to an overall reduction in loan facility balances outstanding during 2010;
 
  (vi)    an increase of $10.7 million in income earned from our investment in partly owned company; and
 
  (vii)   a decrease in net foreign exchange losses of $24.2 million due primarily to eliminating our excess U.S. dollar exposure that we held in 2009 within one of our subsidiaries whose functional currency is Australian dollars; partially offset by
 
  (viii)  an increase in general and administrative expenses of $12.3 million due primarily to an increase in loan structure fees and letter of credit fees that were paid in 2010 along with an overall increase in other professional fees;
 
  (ix)    an increase in income taxes of $59.5 million due to increased tax liabilities recorded on the results of our taxable subsidiaries along with an additional tax liability arising in our Australian subsidiary from the formation of an Australian tax consolidated group; and
 
  (x)     an increase in salaries and benefits costs of $18.2 million due primarily to our increased overall headcount from 287 at December 31, 2009 to 335 at December 31, 2010 along with increased salary costs related to our discretionary bonus plan as a result of increased net earnings in the year.
 
We recorded noncontrolling interest in earnings of $41.6 million and $41.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited increased from $135.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2009 to $174.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2010.
 
Consulting Fees:
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $ 84,054     $ 49,617     $ 34,437  
Reinsurance
    (61,039 )     (33,513 )     (27,526 )
                         
Total
  $ 23,015     $ 16,104     $ 6,911  
                         
 
Our consulting companies earned fees of approximately $84.1 million and $49.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The increase in consulting fees related primarily to the combination of additional fees received from our reinsurance segment and increased incentive fees earned from third-party agreements.
 
Internal management fees of $61.0 million and $33.5 million were paid for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively, by our reinsurance companies to our consulting companies. The increase in internal fees paid to the consulting segment was due primarily to additional fees paid by reinsurance companies relating to allocated charges for increases in salary and general and administrative expenses.


86


Table of Contents

Net Investment Income and Net Realized and Unrealized Gains:
 
                                                 
    Year Ended December 31,  
    Net Investment Income     Net Realized and Unrealized Gains  
    2010     2009     Variance     2010     2009     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $ 461     $ 1,894     $ (1,433 )   $     $     $  
Reinsurance
    99,445       79,477       19,968       13,137       4,237       8,900  
                                                 
Total
  $ 99,906     $ 81,371     $ 18,535     $ 13,137     $ 4,237     $ 8,900  
                                                 
 
Net investment income for the year ended December 31, 2010 increased by $18.5 million to $99.9 million, as compared to $81.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2009. The increase was attributable primarily to the combination of the following items:
 
  (i)   an increase of $8.6 million, for the year ended December 31, 2010, in the fair value of our private equity investments classified as other investments over that recorded for the year ended December 31, 2009; and
 
  (ii)  higher investment income from our fixed maturities and cash and cash equivalents, reflecting the increase in the amount of cash and investment balances held by us in 2010 as compared to 2009. The increased cash and investments arose primarily as a result of the completion of the purchase of six companies along with the acquisition of eight portfolios of business in run-off during the year ended December 31, 2010.
 
The average return on the cash and fixed maturities investments (excluding any writedowns or appreciation related to our other investments) for the year ended December 31, 2010 was 2.38% as compared to the average return of 2.13% for the year ended December 31, 2009. The average credit rating of our fixed maturity investments at December 31, 2010 was AA-.
 
Net realized and unrealized gains for the year ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 were $13.1 million and $4.2 million, respectively. The increase was due primarily to mark-to-market gains earned on our equity securities.
 
Fair Value Measurements
 
In accordance with the provisions of the Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure topic of the Codification, we have categorized our investments that are recorded at fair value among levels as follows:
 
                                 
    December 31, 2010  
    Quoted Prices in
                   
    Active Markets
    Significant Other
    Significant
       
    for Identical Assets
    Observable Inputs
    Unobservable Inputs
    Total Fair
 
    (Level 1)     (Level 2)     (Level 3)     Value  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
U.S. government and agency
  $     $ 227,803     $     $ 227,803  
Non-U.S. government
          386,866             386,866  
Corporate
          1,346,854       530       1,347,384  
Municipal
          2,297             2,297  
Residential mortgage-backed
          102,506             102,506  
Commercial mortgage-backed
          37,927       914       38,841  
Asset backed
          28,613             28,613  
Equities
    56,369       138       3,575       60,082  
Other investments
          102,279       132,435       234,714  
                                 
Total investments
  $ 56,369     $ 2,235,283     $ 137,454     $ 2,429,106  
                                 
 


87


Table of Contents

                                 
    December 31, 2009  
    Quoted Prices in
                   
    Active Markets
    Significant Other
    Significant
       
    for Identical Assets
    Observable Inputs
    Unobservable Inputs
    Total Fair
 
    (Level 1)     (Level 2)     (Level 3)     Value  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
U.S. government and agency
  $     $ 76,226     $     $ 76,226  
Non-U.S. government
          37,186             37,186  
Corporate
          87,083             87,083  
Residential mortgage-backed
          2,012             2,012  
Commercial mortgage-backed
                641       641  
Equities
    21,203             3,300       24,503  
Other investments
                81,801       81,801  
                                 
Total investments
  $ 21,203     $ 202,507     $ 85,742     $ 309,452  
                                 
 
Net Reduction in Ultimate Loss and Loss Adjustment Expense Liabilities:
 
The following table shows the components of the movement in the net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009:
 
                 
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Net losses paid
  $ (294,996 )   $ (257,414 )
Net change in case and LAE reserves
    336,141       214,079  
Net change in IBNR
    236,920       318,160  
                 
Reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses
    278,065       274,825  
Reduction in provisions for bad debt
    49,556       11,718  
Reduction in provisions for unallocated loss adjustment expense liabilities
    39,651       50,412  
Amortization of fair value adjustments
    (55,438 )     (77,328 )
                 
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
  $ 311,834     $ 259,627  
                 
 
Net reduction in case and LAE reserves comprises the movement during the year in specific case reserve liabilities as a result of claims settlements or changes advised to us by our policyholders and attorneys, less changes in case reserves recoverable advised by us to our reinsurers as a result of the settlement or movement of assumed claims. Net reduction in IBNR represents the change in our actuarial estimates of losses incurred but not reported.
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2010 of $311.8 million was attributable to a reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $278.1 million, a reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debts of $49.6 million and a reduction in estimates of unallocated loss adjustment expense liabilities of $39.7 million, relating to 2010 run-off activity, partially offset by the amortization, over the estimated payout period, of fair value adjustments relating to companies acquired amounting to $55.4 million.
 
The reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $278.1 million comprised net incurred favorable loss development of $41.1 million and reductions in IBNR reserves of $236.9 million. The decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $236.9 million was comprised of $67.8 million relating to asbestos liabilities, $4.2 million relating to environmental liabilities and $164.9 million relating to all other remaining liabilities. The reduction in IBNR was a result of the application, on a basis consistent with the assumptions applied in the prior period, of our actuarial methodologies to loss data to estimate loss reserves required to cover liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses. The prior period estimate of net IBNR liabilities was reduced as a result of the combined impact of loss development activity during 2010, including commutations and the favorable trend of loss development related to non-commuted policies compared to prior forecasts. The net incurred favorable loss development of $41.1 million, resulting from settlement of net advised case and LAE reserves of $336.1 million for net paid losses of $295.0 million, related to the settlement of non-commuted losses in the year and approximately 90 commutations of assumed and ceded exposures.

88


Table of Contents

Commutations provide an opportunity for us to exit exposures to entire policies with insureds and reinsureds at a discount to the previous estimated ultimate liability. As a result of exiting all exposures to such policies, all advised case reserves and IBNR liabilities relating to that insured or reinsured are eliminated. This often results in a net gain irrespective of whether the settlement exceeds the advised case reserves. We adopt a disciplined approach to the review and settlement of non-commuted claims through claims adjusting and the inspection of underlying policyholder records such that settlements of assumed exposures may often be achieved below the level of the originally advised loss, and settlements of ceded receivables may often be achieved at levels above carried balances. Of the 90 commutations completed during 2010, three related to our top ten insured and/or reinsured exposures, including one commutation completed shortly after December 31, 2009 whereby the related reduction in IBNR reserves was recorded in the reduction in net ultimate losses for the year ended December 31, 2009, and one related to the commutation of one of our largest ceded reinsurance assets. The remaining 86 commutations, of which approximately 43% were completed during the three months ended December 31, 2010, were of a smaller size, consistent with our approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships, as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships. The combination of the claims settlement activity in 2010, including commutations (but excluding the impact of the commutation that was completed subsequent to the year ended December 31, 2009) and the actuarial estimation of IBNR reserves required for the remaining non-commuted exposures (which took into account the favorable trend of loss development in 2010 related to such exposures compared to prior forecasts), resulted in our management concluding that the loss development activity that occurred subsequent to the prior reporting period provided sufficient new information to warrant a reduction in IBNR reserves of $236.9 million in 2010.
 
The reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debt of $49.6 million was a result of the collection, primarily during the three months ended December 31, 2010, of certain reinsurance receivables against which bad debt provisions had been provided in earlier periods.
 
The table below provides a reconciliation of the beginning and ending reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009. Losses incurred and paid are reflected net of reinsurance recoverables.
 
                 
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Balance as of January 1
  $ 2,479,136     $ 2,798,287  
Less: total reinsurance reserves recoverable
    347,728       394,575  
                 
      2,131,408       2,403,712  
Effect of exchange rate movement
    (3,836 )     73,512  
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
    (311,854 )     (259,627 )
Net losses paid
    (294,996 )     (257,414 )
Acquired on purchase of subsidiaries
    459,362       114,595  
Retroactive reinsurance contracts assumed
    785,731       56,630  
                 
Net balance as at December 31
    2,765,835       2,131,408  
Plus: total reinsurance reserves recoverable
    525,440       347,728  
                 
Balance as at December 31
  $ 3,291,275     $ 2,479,136  
                 
 
Salaries and Benefits:
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $ 50,684     $ 37,283     $ (13,401 )
Reinsurance
    35,993       31,171       (4,822 )
                         
Total
  $ 86,677     $ 68,454     $ (18,223 )
                         


89


Table of Contents

Salaries and benefits, which include expenses relating to our discretionary bonus and employee share plans, were $86.7 million and $68.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
 
The increase in salaries and benefits was attributable primarily to:
 
  (i)    an increase in the discretionary bonus expense for the year ended December 31, 2010 of $6.8 million. Expenses relating to our discretionary bonus plan will be variable and are dependent on our overall profitability;
 
  (ii)   increased staff costs due to an increase in average staff numbers from 287 for the year ended December 31, 2009 to 335 for the year ended December 31, 2010;
 
  (iii)  a payment of $1.25 million to our former Executive Chairman, John J. Oros, in accordance with the terms of his separation agreement; and
 
  (iv)   amortization of unrecognized compensation costs of $1.5 million relating to the restricted shares that were awarded to certain employees in 2010 under the 2006 Equity Incentive Plan.
 
General and Administrative Expenses:
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $ 28,288     $ 19,870     $ (8,418 )
Reinsurance
    30,913       27,032       (3,881 )
                         
Total
  $ 59,201     $ 46,902     $ (12,299 )
                         
 
General and administrative expenses attributable to the consulting segment increased by $8.4 million during the year ended December 31, 2010, as compared to the year ended December 31, 2009. The increased expenses in 2010 related primarily to: (i) increased loan structure fees incurred primarily related to the Enstar Facility; (ii) increased legal fees relating to ongoing litigation costs; and (iii) increased audit and actuarial tax fees due primarily to growth of the group and increased tax fees relating to the work done in connection with our Australian tax consolidation.
 
General and administrative expenses attributable to the reinsurance segment increased by $3.9 million during the year ended December 31, 2010, as compared to the year ended December 31, 2009. The increased expenses in 2010 related primarily to increased costs associated with new companies of approximately $3.0 million and additional letters of credit costs associated with portfolios of run-off business acquired during 2010.
 
Interest Expense:
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $     $     $  
Reinsurance
    10,253       17,583       7,330  
                         
Total
  $ 10,253     $ 17,583     $ 7,330  
                         
 
Interest expense of $10.3 million and $17.6 million was recorded for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The decrease in interest expense was attributable primarily to the reduction and then elimination of the principal balance of the Cumberland Facility partially offset by interest expense incurred on both the Knapton Facility and the loan associated with the Repurchase Agreements.


90


Table of Contents

Net Foreign Exchange Gain/(Loss):
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $ (420 )   $ 920     $ (1,340 )
Reinsurance
    818       (24,707 )     25,525  
                         
Total
  $ 398     $ (23,787 )   $ 24,185  
                         
 
We recorded a foreign exchange gain of $0.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2010, as compared to a foreign exchange loss of $23.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2009.
 
In October 2010, we entered into a foreign currency forward exchange contract as part of our overall foreign currency risk management strategy. The terms of the contract are that on the value date, June 30, 2011, we will sell AU$45 million and receive $42.5 million. The contract exchange rate is AU$1 for $0.9439. As at December 31, 2010, the fair value of the contract was $(3.6) million, the effect of which we have recognized as a foreign exchange loss included as part of our net earnings. This loss was offset by foreign exchange gains of approximately $4.0 million arising primarily from our holdings of surplus British pounds and Australian dollars at a time when these currencies were appreciating against the U.S. dollar.
 
For the year ended December 31, 2009, $35.6 million (including noncontrolling interest’s share of $10.7 million) of the foreign exchange loss arose primarily as a result of holding surplus U.S. dollar denominated assets by Gordian, our Australian subsidiary, at a time when the U.S. dollar had weakened significantly against the Australian dollar.
 
Excluding the foreign exchange loss in Gordian of $35.6 million, exchange gains of $11.8 million were generated during the year ended December 31, 2009 primarily as a result of our holding surplus British pounds relating to cash collateral required to support British pound denominated letters of credit required by U.K. regulators at a time when the British pound exchange rate to the U.S. dollar had increased from approximately £1 = $1.4593 as at January 1, 2009 to £1 = $1.6170 as at December 31, 2009. Since letters of credit were in excess of the British pound liabilities held by our subsidiaries, the subsidiary companies were unable to match the surplus assets against liabilities during the year, resulting in the foreign exchange gain.
 
In addition to the foreign exchange gain we recorded in our consolidated statement of earnings for the year ended December 31, 2010, we recorded in our consolidated statement of comprehensive income foreign currency translation adjustment gains for the year ended December 31, 2010 of approximately $22.5 million, as compared to gains of approximately $48.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2009. We have concluded that under the Foreign Currency Matters topic of the FASB ASC the functional currency of Gordian is Australian dollars. As a result, upon conversion of the net Australian dollar assets of Gordian to U.S. dollars, we recorded $22.4 million, net of noncontrolling interest of $9.6 million, of U.S. dollar foreign currency translation adjustment gains through accumulated other comprehensive income. This gain was due primarily to the appreciation in the Australian to U.S. dollar foreign exchange rate from AU$1 = $0.8977 as at December 31, 2009, to AU$1 = $1.0233 at December 31, 2010.
 
As our functional currency is the U.S. dollar, we seek to manage our exposure to foreign currency exchange by broadly matching foreign currency assets against foreign currency liabilities, subject to regulatory constraints.
 
The net impact on shareholders’ equity of foreign exchange movements relating specifically to Gordian are summarized in the table below:
 
                 
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Foreign exchange gains (losses) recorded through earnings (net of noncontrolling interest of $(0.4) million and $10.7 million)
  $ 1,035     $ (24,888 )
Foreign exchange loss recorded through earnings related to the forward foreign exchange contract (net of noncontrolling interest of $1.1 million)
    (2,501 )      
Foreign exchange gains recorded through accumulated other comprehensive income (net of noncontrolling interest of $(9.6) million and $(20.9) million, respectively)
    22,403       48,753  
                 
Combined increase in shareholders’ equity
  $ 20,937     $ 23,865  
                 


91


Table of Contents

Income Tax (Expense)/Recovery:
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $ 33     $ (2,402 )   $ 2,435  
Reinsurance
    (87,165 )     (25,203 )     (61,962 )
                         
Total
  $ (87,132 )   $ (27,605 )   $ (59,527 )
                         
 
We recorded income tax expense of $87.1 million and $27.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
 
Income tax expense of $87.2 million and $25.2 million were recorded in the reinsurance segment for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The increase in tax arose due primarily to increased income from our U.K. subsidiaries and our Australian subsidiaries, which recorded increased taxes in 2010 of $27.2 million and $12.4 million, respectively.
 
In addition, during the three months ended December 31, 2010, in order to mitigate the tax impacts of inter-group transactions, the boards of our Australian group of companies elected to form a consolidated tax group. The impact of this tax consolidation resulted in resetting the cost base of certain assets, which is estimated to result in an additional tax liability of approximately $30.3 million.
 
Noncontrolling Interest
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2010     2009     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $     $     $  
Reinsurance
    41,645       41,798       153  
                         
Total
  $ 41,645     $ 41,798     $ 153  
                         
 
We recorded a noncontrolling interest in earnings of $41.6 million and $41.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The increase for the year ended December 31, 2010 related to the increase in earnings for those entities that have noncontrolling interests.
 
Comparison of Years Ended December 31, 2009 and 2008
 
We reported consolidated net earnings, before extraordinary item and net earnings attributable to noncontrolling interest, of approximately $177.0 million and $97.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. The increase in earnings of approximately $79.8 million was attributable primarily to the following:
 
(i) an increase in investment income (net of realized and unrealized gains/(losses)) of $60.7 million primarily as a result of an increase, in 2009, in the fair value of our private equity portfolio classified as other investments of $5.2 million as compared to a writedown in 2008 of $84.1 million, partially offset by lower investment income reflecting the impact of lower global short-term and intermediate interest rates;
 
(ii) a larger net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities of $17.5 million;
 
(iii) reduced interest expense of $5.8 million due primarily to an overall reduction in loan facility balances outstanding as at December 31, 2009 along with lower interest rates on outstanding term loan facility agreements;
 
(iv) a reduction in general and administrative expenses of $6.5 million primarily due to elimination of loan structure fees that were paid in 2008, partially offset by increased professional fees; and
 
(v) a reduction in income taxes of $19.2 million due to lower tax liabilities recorded on the results of our taxable subsidiaries; partially offset by


92


Table of Contents

(vi) an increase in net foreign exchange losses of $8.8 million primarily due to our holding of surplus U.S. dollars in one of our subsidiaries whose functional currency is Australian dollars at a time when the U.S. dollar has weakened against the Australian dollar; and
 
(vii) an increase in salary and benefits costs of $12.2 million due primarily to increased salary costs related to our discretionary bonus plan as a result of increased net earnings in the year.
 
We recorded noncontrolling interest in earnings of $41.8 million and $65.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. Included within the December 31, 2008 noncontrolling interest balance of $65.9 million was $15.1 million of noncontrolling interest relating to the extraordinary gain of $50.3 million. Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited increased from $81.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2008 to $135.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2009.
 
Consulting Fees
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2009     2008     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $ 49,617     $ 54,158     $ (4,541 )
Reinsurance
    (33,513 )     (29,007 )     (4,506 )
                         
Total
  $ 16,104     $ 25,151     $ (9,047 )
                         
 
Our consulting companies earned consulting fees of approximately $49.6 million and $54.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. The decrease in consulting fees related primarily to decreased management and incentive fees earned from third-party agreements.
 
Internal management fees of $33.5 million and $29.0 million were paid for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, by our reinsurance companies to our consulting companies. The increase in internal management fees was due to increased management fees received from reinsurance companies we acquired during 2008.
 
Net Investment Income and Net Realized and Unrealized Gains/(Losses):
 
                                                 
    Year Ended December 31,  
          Net Realized and Unrealized
 
    Net Investment Income     Gains/(Losses)  
    2009     2008     Variance     2009     2008     Variance  
          (in thousands of U.S. dollars)        
 
Consulting
  $ 1,894     $ (20,248 )   $ 22,142     $     $     $  
Reinsurance
    79,477       46,849       32,628       4,237       (1,655 )     5,892  
                                                 
Total
  $ 81,371     $ 26,601     $ 54,770     $ 4,237     $ (1,655 )   $ 5,892  
                                                 
 
Net investment income for the year ended December 31, 2009 increased by $54.8 million to $81.4 million, as compared to $26.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2008. The increase was primarily attributable the combination of the following items:
 
(i) an increase of $5.2 million, for the year ended December 31 2009, in the fair value of our private equity investments classified as other investments as compared to a writedown of $84.1 million for the year ended December 31 2008; partially offset by
 
(ii) lower investment income from fixed maturities and cash and cash equivalents, reflecting the impact of lower global short-term and intermediate interest rates — the average U.S. Federal Funds Rate decreased from 2.09% for the year ended December 31, 2008 to 0.25% for the year ended December 31, 2009.
 
The average return on the cash, equities and fixed maturities investments (excluding any writedowns or appreciation related to our other investments) for the year ended December 31, 2009 was 2.13%, as compared to the average return of 4.62% for the year ended December 31, 2008. The average credit rating of Enstar’s fixed maturity investments at December 31, 2009 was AA.


93


Table of Contents

Net realized and unrealized gains (losses) for the year ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 were $4.2 million and $(1.7) million, respectively. The increase was due primarily to mark-to-market gains earned during 2009 on our equity portfolios.
 
Fair Value Measurements
 
In accordance with the provisions of the Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure topic of the Codification, we have categorized our investments recorded at fair value among levels as follows:
 
                                 
    December 31, 2009  
    Quoted Prices in
    Significant
    Significant
       
    Active Markets for
    Other Observable
    Unobservable
       
    Identical Assets
    Inputs
    Inputs
    Total Fair
 
    (Level 1)     (Level 2)     (Level 3)     Value  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
U.S. government and agency
  $     $ 76,226     $     $ 76,226  
Non-U.S. government
          37,186             37,186  
Corporate
          87,083             87,083  
Residential mortgage-backed
          2,012             2,012  
Commercial mortgage-backed
                641       641  
Equities
    21,203             3,300       24,503  
Other investments
                81,801       81,801  
                                 
Total investments
  $ 21,203     $ 202,507     $ 85,742     $ 309,452  
                                 
 
                                 
    December 31, 2008  
    Quoted Prices in
    Significant
    Significant
       
    Active Markets for
    Other Observable
    Unobservable
       
    Identical Assets
    Inputs
    Inputs
    Total Fair
 
    (Level 1)     (Level 2)     (Level 3)     Value  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
U.S. government and agency
  $     $ 326,404     $     $ 326,404  
Non-U.S. government
          25,479             25,479  
Corporate
          259,299             259,299  
Residential mortgage-backed
          2,349             2,349  
Commercial mortgage-backed
                352       352  
Asset backed
          13,472             13,472  
Equities
    3,747                   3,747  
Other investments
                60,237       60,237  
                                 
Total investments
  $ 3,747     $ 627,003     $ 60,589     $ 691,339  
                                 


94


Table of Contents

Net Reduction in Ultimate Loss and Loss Adjustment Expense Liabilities:
 
The following table shows the components of the movement in the net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008:
 
                 
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2009     2008  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Net losses paid
  $ (257,414 )   $ (174,013 )
Net change in case and LAE reserves
    214,079       147,576  
Net change in IBNR
    318,160       187,874  
                 
Reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses
    274,825       161,437  
Reduction in provisions for bad debt
    11,718       36,136  
Reduction in provisions for unallocated loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
    50,412       69,056  
Amortization of fair value adjustments
    (77,328 )     (24,525 )
                 
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
  $ 259,627     $ 242,104  
                 
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2009 of $259.6 million was attributable to a reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $274.8 million, a reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debts of $11.7 million and a reduction in estimates of loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities of $50.4 million, relating to 2009 run-off activity, partially offset by the amortization, over the estimated payout period, of fair value adjustments relating to companies acquired amounting to $77.3 million.
 
The reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $274.8 million comprised net incurred loss development of $43.3 million and reductions in IBNR reserves of $318.2 million. The decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $318.2 million was comprised of $158.4 million relating to asbestos liabilities, $17.0 million relating to environmental liabilities and $142.8 million relating to all other remaining liabilities. The reduction in IBNR is a result of the application, on a basis consistent with the assumptions applied in the prior period, of our actuarial methodologies to loss data to estimate loss reserves required to cover liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses. The prior period estimate of net IBNR liabilities was reduced as a result of the combined impact of loss development activity during 2009, including commutations and the favorable trend of loss development related to non-commuted policies compared to prior forecasts. The net incurred loss development of $43.3 million resulting from settlement of net advised case and LAE reserves of $214.1 million for net paid losses of $257.4 million, related to the settlement of non-commuted losses in the year and approximately 79 commutations of assumed and ceded exposures. Of the 79 commutations completed during 2009, two related to our top ten insured and/or reinsured exposures. The remaining 77 were of a smaller size, consistent with our approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships, as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships. Approximately 76% of commutations completed in 2009 related to commutations completed during the three months ended December 31, 2009. Subsequent to the year end, one of our insurance entities completed a commutation of another of one of our top ten reinsured exposures. The combination of the claims settlement activity in 2009, including commutations, and the actuarial estimation of IBNR reserves required for the remaining non-commuted exposures (which took into account the favorable trend of loss development in 2009 related to such exposures compared to prior forecasts as well as the impact of the commutation that was completed subsequent to the year end), resulted in our management concluding that the loss development activity that occurred subsequent to the prior reporting period provided sufficient new information to warrant a reduction in IBNR reserves of $318.2 million in 2009.
 
The reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debt of $11.7 million was as a result of the collection, primarily during the three months ended March 31, 2009, of certain reinsurance receivables against which bad debt provisions had been provided in earlier periods.


95


Table of Contents

The table below provides a reconciliation of the beginning and ending reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008. Losses incurred and paid are reflected net of reinsurance recoverables.
 
                 
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2009     2008  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Balance as of January 1
  $ 2,798,287     $ 1,591,449  
Less: total reinsurance reserves recoverable
    394,575       427,964  
                 
      2,403,712       1,163,485  
Effect of exchange rate movement
    73,512       (124,989 )
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
    (259,627 )     (242,104 )
Net losses paid
    (257,414 )     (174,013 )
Acquired on purchase of subsidiaries
    114,595       1,408,046  
Retroactive reinsurance contracts assumed
    56,630       373,287  
                 
Net balance as at December 31
    2,131,408       2,403,712  
Plus: total reinsurance reserves recoverable
    347,728       394,575  
                 
Balance as at December 31
  $ 2,479,136     $ 2,798,287  
                 
 
Salaries and Benefits:
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2009     2008     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $ 37,281     $ 33,196     $ (4,085 )
Reinsurance
    31,173       23,074       (8,099 )
                         
Total
  $ 68,454     $ 56,270     $ (12,184 )
                         
 
Salaries and benefits, which include expenses relating to our discretionary bonus and employee share plans, were $68.5 million and $56.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively.
 
The increase in salaries and benefits was primarily attributable to:
 
(i) an increase in the discretionary bonus expense in our reinsurance segment for the year ended December 31, 2009 of $9.5 million. Expenses relating to our discretionary bonus plan will be variable and are dependent on our overall profitability; and
 
(ii) increased staff costs due to an increase in average staff numbers from 248 for the year ended December 31, 2008 to 287 for the year ended December 31, 2009; partially offset by
 
(iii) lower U.S. dollar costs of our U.K.-based staff following a reduction in the average British pound exchange rate from approximately 1.8524 to 1.5670 for the years ended December 31, 2008 and 2009, respectively. Of our total headcount as at December 31, 2009 and December 31, 2008, approximately 67% and 65%, respectively, were paid in British pounds.
 
General and Administrative Expenses:
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2009     2008     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $ 19,870     $ 17,289     $ (2,581 )
Reinsurance
    27,032       36,068       9,036  
                         
Total
  $ 46,902     $ 53,357     $ 6,455  
                         


96


Table of Contents

General and administrative expenses attributable to the reinsurance segment decreased by $9.0 million during the year ended December 31, 2009, as compared to the year ended December 31, 2008. For the year ended December 31, 2008, we incurred approximately $13.0 million of bank loan structure fees in respect of acquisitions we completed during 2008. For the year ended December 31, 2009 we did not incur any such fees. The reduced expenses in 2009 relating to lower bank loan structure fees were partially offset by increased costs associated with new companies acquired during 2008 along with increased professional fees due in part to legal fees incurred in respect of a lawsuit that was settled pursuant to a Mutual Release Agreement dated as of April 7, 2010.
 
Interest Expense:
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2009     2008     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $     $     $  
Reinsurance
    17,583       23,370       5,787  
                         
Total
  $ 17,583     $ 23,370     $ 5,787  
                         
 
Interest expense of $17.6 million and $23.4 million was recorded for the year ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. The decrease in interest expense was primarily attributable to the combination of:
 
(i) a reduction in the principal balance on the loan facilities of our subsidiary, Cumberland Holdings Limited, relating to the Gordian acquisition, or the Cumberland Loan Facilities. During 2009, we repaid approximately $148.3 million of the outstanding principal on the Cumberland Loan Facilities reducing the outstanding principal balance from approximately $222.6 million as at December 31, 2008 to $74.3 million as of December 31, 2009;
 
(ii) a reduction in the average Australian LIBOR interest rate on the Cumberland Loan Facilities between the years ended December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2009; and
 
(iii) a reduction in the average Australian dollar exchange rate from approximately 0.8521 to 0.7934 between the years ended December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2009; partially offset by
 
(iv) an increase in interest costs associated with the loan facilities of our subsidiary, Royston, relating to the Unionamerica acquisition, which we entered into on December 30, 2008.
 
Net Foreign Exchange (Loss):
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2009     2008     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $ 920     $ (1,167 )   $ 2,087  
Reinsurance
    (24,707 )     (13,819 )     (10,888 )
                         
Total
  $ (23,787 )   $ (14,986 )   $ (8,801 )
                         
 
We recorded a foreign exchange loss of $23.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2009, as compared to a foreign exchange loss of $15.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2008. For the year ended December 31, 2009, $35.6 million (including noncontrolling interests’ share of $10.7 million) of the foreign exchange loss arose primarily due to Gordian’s holdings of surplus U.S. dollar denominated assets at a time when the U.S. dollar had weakened significantly against the Australian dollar.
 
Excluding the foreign exchange loss in Gordian of $35.6 million, exchange gains of $11.8 million were generated during the year primarily as a result of our holding surplus British pounds relating to cash collateral required to support British pound denominated letters of credit required by U.K. regulators at a time when the British pound exchange rate to the U.S. dollar had increased from approximately £1 = $1.4593 as at January 1, 2009 to £1 = $1.6170 as at December 31, 2009. Since letters of credit are in excess of the British pound liabilities held by


97


Table of Contents

our subsidiaries, the subsidiary companies were unable to match the surplus assets against liabilities during the year, resulting in the foreign exchange gain.
 
In addition to the foreign exchange losses recorded in our consolidated statement of earnings for the year ended December 31, 2009, we recorded in our consolidated statement of comprehensive income foreign currency translation adjustment gains for the year ended December 31, 2009 of $48.9 million, as compared to losses of $51.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2008. For the year ended December 31, 2009, these gains arose primarily as a result of foreign currency translation adjustments of $48.8 million, net of noncontrolling interest of $20.9 million, relating to Gordian. We have concluded that under the Foreign Currency Matters topic of FASB ASC, or ASC 830, the functional currency of Gordian is Australian dollars. As a result, upon conversion of the net Australian dollar assets of Gordian to U.S. dollars, we recorded $48.8 million, net of noncontrolling interest of $20.9 million, of U.S. dollar foreign currency translation adjustment gains through accumulated other comprehensive income. This gain was due primarily to the appreciation in the Australian to U.S. dollar foreign exchange rate from AU$1 = $0.7026 as at December 31, 2008, to AU$1 = $0.8977 at December 31, 2009.
 
As our functional currency is the U.S. dollar, we seek to manage our exposure to foreign currency exchange by broadly matching foreign currency assets against foreign currency liabilities, subject to regulatory constraints.
 
The net impact on shareholders’ equity of foreign exchange movements relating to Gordian in 2009 is summarized in the table below:
 
                 
    Year Ended
    Year Ended
 
    December 31, 2009     December 31, 2008  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Foreign exchange (losses) gains recorded through earnings (related primarily to the holding of surplus U.S. dollar denominated short-term investments) (net of noncontrolling interest of $10.7 million and $11.0 million, respectively)
  $ (24,888 )   $ 25,598  
Foreign exchange gains (losses) recorded through accumulated other comprehensive income (net of noncontrolling interest of $20.9 million and $18.4 million, respectively)
    48,753       (42,793 )
                 
Combined increase (decrease) in shareholders’ equity
  $ 23,865     $ (17,195 )
                 
 
Income Tax (Expense)/Recovery:
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2009     2008     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $ (2,402 )   $ 511     $ (2,913 )
Reinsurance
    (25,203 )     (47,365 )     22,162  
                         
Total
  $ (27,605 )   $ (46,854 )   $ 19,249  
                         
 
We recorded income tax expense of $27.6 million and $46.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively.
 
Income tax expense of $25.2 million and $47.4 million were recorded in the reinsurance segment for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. The decrease arose due primarily to a reduction in tax expense for the Cumberland group, which owns our Australian subsidiary, Gordian, from $46.3 million in 2008 down to $7.9 million in 2009, due primarily to a reduction in income earned in 2009 as compared to 2008. Reduced income at the local Gordian level for the year ended December 31, 2009 was attributable primarily to foreign exchange losses on surplus U.S. dollars. The reduction in tax expense attributable to Gordian for the year ended December 31, 2009 was partially offset by tax expense recorded by Unionamerica of approximately $20.4 million.


98


Table of Contents

Negative Goodwill:
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2009     2008     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $     $     $  
Reinsurance
          50,280       (50,280 )
                         
Total
  $     $ 50,280     $ (50,280 )
                         
 
Negative goodwill of $nil and $50.3 million, was recorded for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. For the year ended December 31, 2008, the negative goodwill of $50.3 million was earned in connection with our acquisition of Gordian and represents the excess of the cumulative fair value of net assets acquired of $455.7 million over the cost of $405.4 million. This excess was, in accordance with ASC 805, recognized as an extraordinary gain in 2008. The negative goodwill arose primarily as a result of the income earned by Gordian between the date of the balance sheet on which the agreed purchase price was based, September 30, 2007, and the date the acquisition closed, March 5, 2008.
 
Noncontrolling Interest:
 
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2009     2008     Variance  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Consulting
  $     $     $  
Reinsurance
    41,798       50,808       9,010  
Reinsurance — extraordinary gain
          15,084       15,084  
                         
Total
  $ 41,798     $ 65,892     $ 24,094  
                         
 
We recorded a noncontrolling interest in earnings of $41.8 million and $65.9 million (including $15.1 million of an extraordinary gain related to negative goodwill) for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. The decrease for the year ended December 31, 2009, excluding the noncontrolling interest in negative goodwill of $15.1 million relating to the Gordian acquisition, related to the decrease in earnings for those entities that have noncontrolling interests.
 
Liquidity and Capital Resources
 
As we are a holding company and have no substantial operations of our own, our assets consist primarily of investments in subsidiaries. The potential sources of the cash flows to the holding company consist of dividends, advances and loans from our subsidiary companies.
 
Our future cash flows depend upon the availability of dividends or other statutorily permissible payments from our subsidiaries. The ability to pay dividends and make other distributions is limited by the applicable laws and regulations of the jurisdictions in which our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries operate, including Bermuda, the United Kingdom, United States, Australia and Europe, which subject these subsidiaries to significant regulatory restrictions. These laws and regulations require, among other things, certain of our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries to maintain minimum solvency requirements and limit the amount of dividends and other payments that these subsidiaries can pay to us, which in turn may limit our ability to pay dividends and make other payments. As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, one of our U.S. insurance companies was not in compliance with its applicable risk-based capital level. We do not believe this company’s non-compliance will have a material impact on our ability to meet our cash obligations. With the exception of the above, all of our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries’ solvency and liquidity were in excess of the minimum levels required as of December 31, 2010 and 2009. Retained earnings of our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries are not currently restricted as minimum capital solvency margins are covered by share capital and additional paid-in-capital.
 
Our capital management strategy is to preserve sufficient capital to enable us to make future acquisitions while maintaining a conservative investment strategy. We believe that restrictions on liquidity resulting from restrictions


99


Table of Contents

on the payments of dividends by our subsidiary companies will not have a material impact on our ability to meet our cash obligations.
 
Our sources of funds primarily consist of the cash and investment portfolios acquired on the completion of the acquisition of an insurance or reinsurance company in run-off. These acquired cash and investment balances are classified as cash provided by investing activities. We expect to use these funds acquired, together with collections from reinsurance debtors, consulting income, investment income and proceeds from sales and redemption of investments, to pay losses and loss expenses, salaries and benefits and general and administrative expenses, with the remainder used for acquisitions and additional investments. We expect that our reinsurance segment will have a net use of cash from operations as total net claim settlements and operating expenses will generally be in excess of investment income earned. We expect that our consulting segment operating cash flows will generally be breakeven. We expect our operating cash flows, together with our existing capital base and cash and investments acquired on the acquisition of our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries, to be sufficient to meet cash requirements and to operate our business. We currently do not intend to pay cash dividends on our ordinary shares.
 
We maintain a short duration conservative investment strategy whereby, as of December 31, 2010, 45.2% of our fixed maturity portfolio classified as available-for-sale or trading was held with a maturity of less than one year and 89.3% had maturities of less than five years. Excluding the impact of commutations and any schemes of arrangement, should they be completed, we expect approximately 16.3% of the gross reserves to be settled within one year and approximately 64.1% of the reserves to be settled within five years. However, our strategy of commuting our liabilities has the potential to accelerate the natural payout of losses to less than five years. Therefore, the relatively short-duration investment portfolio is maintained in order to provide liquidity for commutation opportunities and preclude us from having to liquidate longer dated securities. As a result, we do not anticipate having to sell longer dated investments in order to meet future policyholder liabilities.
 
At December 31, 2010, total cash and investments were $3.88 billion, compared to $3.32 billion at December 31, 2009.
 
Reinsurance Recoverables
 
Our acquired reinsurance subsidiaries, prior to acquisition by us, used retrocessional agreements to reduce their exposure to the risk of reinsurance assumed. We remain liable to the extent that retrocessionaires do not meet their obligations under these agreements, and therefore, we evaluate and monitor concentration of credit risk. Provisions are made for amounts considered potentially uncollectible. The allowance for uncollectible reinsurance recoverable was $381.4 million and $397.6 million at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
 
As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, we had total reinsurance recoverables of $961.4 million and $638.3 million, respectively, of which $398.8 million and $409.6 million, respectively, were associated with two and three reinsurers rated AA- or higher by a major rating agency, respectively, which each represented 10% or more of total reinsurance balances receivable. In the event that all or any of the reinsuring companies are unable to meet their obligations under existing reinsurance agreements, we will be liable for such defaulted amounts. One major AA- rated reinsurer was included in the 2009 figure for reinsurers each representing 10% or more of total reinsurance balances receivable but, for the year ended December 31, 2010, is now excluded as its balance receivable is now less than 10% of the total reinsurance balance receivable.
 
During 2010 and 2009, we completed six and two acquisitions, respectively, of insurance companies in run-off and entered into eight and one acquisitions of portfolios of insurance and reinsurance businesses in run-off, respectively. These transactions included the acquisition of additional reinsurance balances receivable together with the related provisions for uncollectible reinsurance. The aggregate provision for uncollectible reinsurance recoverable at December 31, 2010 amounted to approximately 28.4% of the total reinsurance recoverables balance, before provisions for uncollectible reinsurance, compared to approximately 38.4% at December 31, 2009.
 
The overall bad debt provision percentage on the reinsurance asset has decreased as new acquisitions during 2010 have lower bad debt provisions than that established as at December 31, 2009.


100


Table of Contents

Source of Funds
 
We primarily generate our cash from the acquisitions we complete. These acquired cash and investment balances are classified as cash provided by investing activities.
 
We expect that for the reinsurance segment there will be a net use of cash from operations due to total claim settlements and operating expenses being in excess of investment income earned and that for the consulting segment operating cash flows will be breakeven. As a result, the net operating cash flows for us, to expiry, are expected to be negative as we pay out cash in claims settlements and expenses in excess of cash generated via investment income and consulting fees.
 
The following table summarizes our consolidated cash flows from operating, investing and financing activities in the last three years:
 
                         
    Years Ended December 31,  
Total cash (used in) provided by:   2010     2009     2008  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Operating activities
  $ (609,211 )   $ (198,055 )   $ 157,187  
Investing activities
    253,461       (259,814 )     245,062  
Financing activities
    (124,697 )     (199,684 )     624,584  
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash
    13,156       57,452       (155,524 )
                         
(Decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents
  $ (467,291 )   $ (600,101 )   $ 871,309  
                         
 
See “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data — Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008” for further information.
 
Operating
 
Net cash used in our operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2010 was $609.2 million compared to $198.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2009. This $411.1 million increase in cash used in operating activities was due primarily to the following:
 
1) an increase of $838.5 million in the net purchases of trading securities between 2010 and 2009 due to the decision of our investment committee to increase the allocation of our investment portfolio to trading securities;
 
2) an increase of $206.0 million in funds withheld by clients on our behalf between 2010 and 2009 due primarily to us entering into quota share reinsurance agreements with Allianz and IICH with respect to specific portfolios of run-off business; partially offset by
 
3) an increase of $654.4 million in losses and loss adjustment expenses between 2010 and 2009.
 
Net cash (used in) provided by our operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2009 was $(198.1) million compared to $157.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2008. This $355.3 million increase in cash used in operating activities was due primarily to the following:
 
1) a reduction of $179.1 million in the net sales of trading securities on behalf of policyholders between 2008 and 2009 due primarily to the funding of the 2008 commutation settlement relating to one such policyholder;
 
2) a reduction of $90.3 million in net losses from other investments between 2009 and 2008; and
 
3) a reduction of $236.1 million in losses and loss adjustment expenses between 2009 and 2008 partially offset by $91.7 million of associated changes in net reinsurance balances payable and receivable.
 
Investing
 
Investing cash flows consist primarily of cash acquired net of acquisitions along with net proceeds on the sale and purchase of investments. Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities was $253.5 million during the year


101


Table of Contents

ended December 31, 2010 compared to $(259.8) million during the year ended December 31, 2009. The increase of $513.3 million in investing cash flows between 2010 and 2009 was due primarily to the following:
 
1) a decrease of $315.7 million in the purchases of available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities between 2010 and 2009 due to the decision of our investment committee to increase the allocation of our investment portfolio to trading securities;
 
2) an increase of $259.6 million in the sales and maturity of available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities between 2010 and 2009 due to the decision of our investment committee to increase the allocation of our investment portfolio to trading securities; and
 
3) an increase of $98.9 million in the funding of other investments between 2010 and 2009 due to the increased investment in our private equity investments; partially offset by
 
4) $31.6 million received on the sale of a partly owned company.
 
Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities was $(259.8) million during the year ended December 31, 2009 compared to $245.1 million during the year ended December 31, 2008. The decrease of $504.9 million in the investing cash flows between 2009 and 2008 was due primarily to the following:
 
1) a reduction in the number of acquisitions in 2009 as compared to 2008, which resulted in a net reduction of cash flows related to acquisitions of $186.8 million; and
 
2) an increase of $409.6 million in the net purchases of available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities between 2009 and 2008 due to the decision of our investment committee to increase the allocation to short-duration securities from available cash balances.
 
Financing
 
Net cash used in financing activities was $124.7 million during the year ended December 31, 2010 compared to $199.7 million during the year ended December 31, 2009. The decrease of $75.0 million in cash used in financing activities was primarily attributable to the following:
 
1) an increase of $161.4 million in cash received attributable to bank loans between 2010 and 2009, offset partially by an increase of $62.7 million in the repayment of bank loans; and
 
2) an increase of $49.2 million in dividends paid to noncontrolling interest in 2010, offset partially by contributions of $28.7 million to surplus of subsidiary by noncontrolling interest.
 
Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities was $(199.7) million during the year ended December 31, 2009 compared to $624.6 million during the year ended December 31, 2008. The increase of $824.3 million in cash used in financing activities was attributable primarily to the following:
 
1) a reduction in cash received attributable to bank loans from $572.8 million in 2008 to $nil in 2009 due to the significant reduction in the number and size of acquisitions completed in 2009. All of the 2009 acquisitions that were completed were funded from available cash on hand;
 
2) a reduction in cash contributions received from noncontrolling interests from $163.8 million in 2008 to $nil in 2009 due to none of the acquisitions completed in 2009 having a third-party participation; and
 
3) a reduction of $112.6 million in proceeds from issuance of ordinary shares from 2008 to 2009.


102


Table of Contents

Investments
 
The maturity distribution for our fixed maturity securities held as of December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2009 was as follows:
 
                                 
    December 31, 2010     December 31, 2009  
    Fair Value     % of Total     Fair Value     % of Total  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Due in one year or less
  $ 966,319       45.3 %   $ 639,191       41.7 %
Due after one year through five years
    940,017       44.0 %     680,630       44.4 %
Due after five years through ten years
    47,627       2.2 %     101,868       6.6 %
Due after ten years
    10,387       0.5 %     28,682       1.9 %
                                 
      1,964,350       92.0 %     1,450,371       94.6 %
Residential mortgage-backed
    102,506       4.8 %     17,644       1.2 %
Commercial mortgage-backed
    38,841       1.8 %     30,409       2.0 %
Asset backed
    28,613       1.4 %     33,991       2.2 %
                                 
Total
  $ 2,134,310       100.0 %   $ 1,532,415       100.0 %
                                 
 
Long-Term Debt
 
Our long-term debt consists of loan facilities used to partially finance certain of our acquisitions or significant new business transactions along with a loan outstanding in relation to the Repurchase Agreements entered into with three of our executives and certain trusts and a corporation affiliated with the executives. We draw down on the loan facilities at the time of the acquisition or significant new business transaction, although in some circumstances we have made additional draw-downs to refinance existing debt of the acquired company. We incurred interest expense on our loan facilities and loan outstanding relating to the Repurchase Agreements of $10.3 million and $17.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
 
Total amounts of loans payable outstanding as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 totaled $245.3 million and $255.0 million, respectively, and were comprised as follows:
 
                     
Facility   Date of Facility   December 31, 2010     December 31, 2009  
        (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Cumberland — Facility B
  March 4, 2008   $     $ 67,071  
Unionamerica — Facility A
  December 30, 2008     71,259       155,268  
Unionamerica — Facility B
  December 30, 2008     154       32,622  
Knapton
  April 20, 2010     21,532        
Enstar Group — Facility A
  December 29, 2010     52,100        
Enstar Group — Facility B
  December 29, 2010     62,900        
                     
Total long-term bank debt
        207,945       254,961  
Repurchase Agreements
  October 1, 2010     37,333        
                     
Total loans payable
      $ 245,278     $ 254,961  
                     
 
Cumberland
 
In February 2008, our wholly-owned subsidiary, Cumberland Holdings Limited, or Cumberland, entered into a term facility agreement jointly with a London-based bank and a German bank, or the Cumberland Facility. On March 4, 2008, Cumberland drew down AU$215.0 million (approximately $197.5 million) from the Facility A commitment, or Cumberland Facility A, and AU$86.0 million (approximately $79.0 million) from the Facility B commitment, or Cumberland Facility B, to partially fund the Gordian acquisition.
 
Cumberland had fully repaid Cumberland Facility A as of December 31, 2009.


103


Table of Contents

The interest rate on Cumberland Facility B was LIBOR plus 2.75%. The outstanding Cumberland Facility B loan balance as of December 31, 2009 was AU$74.7 million (approximately $67.1 million). On September 10, 2010, Cumberland fully repaid the remaining outstanding principal and accrued interest on Cumberland Facility B of AU$76.4 million ($70.8 million).
 
Unionamerica
 
On December 30, 2008, in connection with the Unionamerica Holdings Limited acquisition, Royston Run-off Limited, or Royston, borrowed the full amount of $184.6 million available under a term facilities agreement, or the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement, with National Australia Bank Limited, or NABL. Of that amount, Royston borrowed $152.6 million under Facility A, or Unionamerica Facility A, and $32.0 million under Facility B, or Unionamerica Facility B. Unionamerica Facility A was partially repaid in December 2010 and, as of December 31, 2010, the remaining outstanding loan balance was $71.3 million compared to $155.3 million as of December 31, 2009. Unionamerica Facility B was fully repaid in December 2010 and, as of December 31, 2010, the remaining outstanding balance of $0.2 million related to accrued interest outstanding. As of December 31, 2009, the outstanding Unionamerica Facility B loan balance was $32.6 million.
 
The loans are secured by a lien covering all of the assets of Royston. Unionamerica Facility A is repayable within three years from October 3, 2008, the date of the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement. Unionamerica Facility B was repayable within four years from October 3, 2008. On August 4, 2009, Royston entered into an amendment and restatement of the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement pursuant to which: (1) NABL’s participation in the original $184.6 million facility was reduced from 100% to 50%, with Barclays Bank PLC providing the remaining 50%; (2) the guarantee provided by us of all of the obligations of Royston under the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement was terminated; and (3) the interest rate on the Facility A portion was reduced from LIBOR plus 3.50% to LIBOR plus 2.75% and the interest rate on the Facility B portion was reduced from LIBOR plus 4.00% to LIBOR plus 3.25%.
 
During the existence of a payment default, the interest rates will be increased by 1.00%. During the existence of any event of default (as specified in the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement), the lenders may declare that all amounts outstanding under the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement are immediately due and payable, declare that all borrowed amounts be paid upon demand, or proceed against the security. Amounts outstanding under the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement are also subject to acceleration by the lenders in the event of a change of control of Royston, successful application by Royston or certain of its affiliates (other than us) for listing on a stock exchange, or total amounts outstanding under the facilities decreasing below $10.0 million. The Unionamerica Facilities Agreement contains various financial and business covenants for Unionamerica Facilities A and B. As of December 31, 2010, all of the financial covenants relating to the Unionamerica facilities were met. The Flowers Fund has a 30% non-voting equity interest in Royston Holdings Ltd., the direct parent company of Royston.
 
In January 2011, the accrued interest outstanding of $0.2 million relating to Unionamerica Facility B was settled. In addition, on March 3, 2011, we repaid an additional $40.5 million of the outstanding loan balance of Unionamerica Facility A. As of March 3, 2011, the remaining outstanding loan balance of Unionamerica Facility A, inclusive of accrued interest, was $30.6 million.
 
Knapton
 
In April 2010, Knapton Holdings entered into the Knapton Facility, a term facility agreement with a London-based bank. On April 20, 2010, Knapton Holdings drew down $21.4 million from the Knapton Facility to partially fund the acquisition of Knapton. The interest rate on the Knapton Facility is LIBOR plus 2.75%. The Knapton Facility is repayable in three years and is secured by a first charge over Knapton Holding’s shares in Knapton. The Knapton Facility contains various financial and business covenants, including limitations on mergers and consolidations involving Knapton Holdings and its subsidiaries. As of December 31, 2010, all of the covenants relating to the Knapton Facility were met and the outstanding loan balance, inclusive of accrued interest, was $21.5 million.


104


Table of Contents

EGL Facility
 
On July 16, 2010, we entered into the EGL Facility, an unsecured term facility agreement with a London-based bank. On July 19, 2010, we drew down $25.0 million from the EGL Facility to fund the acquisition of PWAC. The EGL Facility accrued interest at an interest rate of LIBOR plus 2.75% and was repayable in three months. It contained various financial and business undertakings. On September 13, 2010, we fully repaid the EGL Facility.
 
Enstar Group Facility
 
On December 29, 2010, we, as borrower, and certain of our subsidiaries, as guarantors, borrowed the full amount of $115.0 million available under a term facilities agreement, or the Enstar Facilities Agreement, with Barclays Corporate, as mandated lead arranger, and Barclays Bank PLC, as lender, agent and security agent. Of that amount, we borrowed $52.1 million under Facility A, or Enstar Facility A, and $62.9 million under Facility B, or Enstar Facility B. The drawdown of Enstar Facility B was used to partially fund the obligations of one of our subsidiaries under the CIGNA reinsurance transaction, with the remainder being used for general corporate purposes. The drawdown of Enstar Facility A was used to repay internal group loans. As of December 31, 2010, the remaining outstanding loan balances, inclusive of accrued interest, related to Enstar Facilities A and B were $52.1 million and $62.9 million, respectively.
 
The loans are secured by a pledge of the shares of certain of our subsidiaries. Both Enstar Facilities A and B must be repaid in three equal annual installments on the anniversary date of the Enstar Facilities Agreement. Interest is payable quarterly and the interest rate on both Enstar Facilities A and B is LIBOR plus 3.00%. The Enstar Facilities Agreement terminates on December 29, 2013.
 
During the existence of a payment default, the interest rates will be increased by 1.00%. During the existence of any event of default (as specified in the Enstar Facilities Agreement), the lenders may declare that all or a portion of amounts outstanding under the Enstar Facilities Agreement are immediately due and payable, declare that all or a portion of borrowed amounts be paid upon demand, or proceed against the security. The Enstar Facilities Agreement contains various financial and business covenants for Enstar Facilities A and B. As of December 31, 2010, all of the financial covenants relating to the Enstar Facilities A and B were met.
 
Clarendon Facility
 
On March 4, 2011, we, through Clarendon Holdings, Inc., entered into a $106.5 million term facility agreement, or the Clarendon Facility, with a London-based bank. The Clarendon Facility provides for a four-year term loan facility, which will be available to be drawn to fund up to 50% of the purchase price of Clarendon. As of March 4, 2011, Clarendon Holdings, Inc. has not borrowed any of the amount available under the Clarendon Facility.
 
The Clarendon Facility will be secured by a security interest in all of the assets of Clarendon Holdings, Inc., as well as a first priority lien on the stock of both Clarendon Holdings, Inc. and Clarendon. Interest is payable at the end of each interest period chosen by Clarendon Holdings, Inc. or, at the latest, each six months. The interest rate is LIBOR plus 2.75%. The Clarendon Facility is subject to various financial and business covenants, including limitations on mergers and consolidations, restrictions as to disposition of stock and limitations of liens on the stock.
 
During the existence of any payment default, the interest rate is increased by 1.0%. During the existence of any event of default (as specified in the term facility agreement), the lenders may declare all or a portion of outstanding amounts immediately due and payable, declare all or a portion of borrowed amounts payable upon demand, or proceed against the security. The Clarendon Facility terminates and all amounts borrowed must be repaid on the fourth anniversary of the date the term loan is made.
 
Share repurchase agreements
 
On October 1, 2010, we entered into the Repurchase Agreements with three of our executives and certain trusts and a corporation affiliated with the executives to repurchase an aggregate of 800,000 of our ordinary shares at a price of $70.00 per share. We repurchased, in aggregate, 600,000 ordinary shares from Dominic F. Silvester (our Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board of Directors) and a trust of which he and his immediate family


105


Table of Contents

are the sole beneficiaries, 100,000 ordinary shares from a trust of which Paul J. O’Shea (our Joint Chief Operating Officer, Executive Vice President and a member of our Board of Directors) and his immediate family are the sole beneficiaries and 100,000 ordinary shares from a corporation owned by a trust of which Nicholas A. Packer (our Joint Chief Operating Officer and Executive Vice President) and his immediate family are the sole beneficiaries. The repurchase transactions closed on October 14, 2010. The aggregate purchase price of $56.0 million is payable by us through promissory notes to the selling shareholders. The annual interest rate for the notes is fixed at 3.5%, and the notes are repayable in three equal installments on December 31, 2010, December 1, 2011 and December 1, 2012. In connection with the Repurchase Agreements, we entered into lock-up agreements with each of Messrs. Silvester, O’Shea and Packer, and their respective family trusts and corporation. The lock-up agreements prohibit future sales and transfers of shares now owned or subsequently acquired for two years from the date of the Repurchase Agreements. On December 31, 2010, we repaid $18.7 million of the promissory notes and $0.4 million of accrued interest.
 
Aggregate Contractual Obligations
 
The following table shows our aggregate contractual obligations and commitments by time period remaining to due date as at December 31, 2010. The table does not reflect certain acquisition-related payments potentially due in the future.
 
                                                 
    Payment Due by Period        
          Less than
                More than
       
    Total     1 year     1 - 3 years     3 - 5 years     5 years        
    (in millions of U.S. dollars)        
 
Operating Activities
                                               
Estimated gross reserves for loss and loss adjustment expenses(1)
  $ 3,291.3     $ 610.0     $ 1,053.2     $ 572.0     $ 1,056.1          
Operating lease obligations(2)
    10.3       3.2       4.6       2.3       0.2          
Investing Activities
                                               
Investment commitments(3)
    84.7       26.0       34.1       24.6                
Financing Activities
                                               
Loan repayments (including interest payments)(4)
    256.9       156.8       100.1                      
                                                 
Total
  $ 3,643.2     $ 796.0     $ 1,192.0     $ 598.9     $ 1,056.3          
                                                 
 
 
(1) We are obligated to pay claims for specified loss events covered by the insurance and reinsurance contracts we have. Such loss payments represent our most significant future payment obligation. In contrast to our other contractual obligations, our cash payments are not determinable from the terms specified within the underlying contracts. The total amount in the table above reflects our best estimate of our reserve for losses and loss expenses. However, the actual amounts and timing may differ materially. See “— Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Critical Accounting Policies — Loss and Loss Adjustment Expenses” beginning on page 72 for further information. We have not taken into account corresponding reinsurance recoverable amounts that would be due to us.
 
 
(2) We lease office space in a number of locations, with such leases expiring at varying dates. We renew and enter into new leases in the ordinary course of business, as required.
 
(3) For further details on the terms of our investment commitments, refer to Note 20 to our consolidated financial statements.
 
(4) For further details on the terms of on our loan repayments, refer to Note 11 to our consolidated financial statements.
 
We have an accrued liability of approximately $5.6 million for unrecognized tax benefits as of December 31, 2010. We are uncertain as to if or when such amounts may be settled with any tax authorities. Therefore the liability for unrecognized tax benefits is not included in the table above.


106


Table of Contents

Commitments and Contingencies
 
In 2006, we committed to invest up to $100.0 million in the Flowers Fund. As of December 31, 2010, the capital contributed to the Flowers Fund was $97.1 million, with the remaining commitment being approximately $2.9 million.
 
As at December 31, 2010, we guaranteed the obligations of two of our subsidiaries in respect of letters of credit issued on their behalf by London-based banks in the amount of £19.5 million (approximately $30.4 million) in respect of capital commitments to Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 and insurance contract requirements of one of the subsidiaries. The guarantees will be triggered should losses incurred by the subsidiaries exceed available cash on hand resulting in the letters of credit being drawn. As at December 31, 2010, we had not recorded any liabilities associated with the guarantees. As of February 28, 2011, our total guarantee has increased to £26.5 million (approximately $41.4 million) in respect of our increased capital commitment to Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008.
 
As at December 31, 2010, we provided guarantees supporting the obligations of one of our subsidiaries in respect of the acquisition, by the subsidiary, of two portfolios of insurance and reinsurance businesses in run-off. The total guarantees provided are approximately $198.4 million and will increase or decrease over time in line with relevant independent actuarial assessments, but will always be subject to an overall maximum cap with respect to reinsurance liabilities.
 
On September 10, 2008, we made a commitment to invest an aggregate of $100.0 million in J.C. Flowers Fund III L.P., or Fund III. Our commitment may be drawn down by Fund III over approximately the next five years. As of December 31, 2010, the capital contributed to the fund was $18.3 million with the remaining outstanding commitment being $81.7 million. Fund III is a private investment fund advised by J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC. J. Christopher Flowers, a member of our board of directors and one of our largest shareholders, is the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC. John J. Oros, who served as our Executive Chairman and a member of our board of directors until his resignation on August 20, 2010, is a Managing Director of J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC.
 
We have made a capital commitment of up to $10.0 million in the GSC European Mezzanine Fund II, LP, or GSC. GSC invests in mezzanine securities of middle and large market companies throughout Western Europe. As of December 31, 2010, the capital contributed to GSC was $9.9 million, with the remaining commitment being $0.1 million.
 
On November 8, 2010, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Kenmare, entered into a definitive agreement for the purchase of CitiLife Financial Limited from Citigroup Insurance Holding Corporation, an affiliate of Citigroup Inc. The purchase price is €30 million (approximately $40.2 million) and is expected to be financed from available cash on hand. Completion of the transaction is conditioned on, among other things, regulatory approval and satisfaction of various customary closing conditions. The transaction is expected to close in the first quarter of 2011.
 
On December 22, 2010, we, through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Clarendon Holdings, Inc., entered into a definitive agreement for the purchase of Clarendon for a purchase price of approximately $200 million. The purchase price will be financed in part by a bank loan facility provided by a London-based bank entered into on March 4, 2011 and in part from available cash on hand. Completion of the transaction is conditioned on, among other things, regulatory approval and satisfaction of various customary closing conditions. The transaction is expected to close in the second quarter of 2011.
 
In February 2011, Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 entered into RITC agreements with two Lloyd’s syndicates with total gross insurance reserves of approximately $129.6 million. Our capital commitment to Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 with respect to these two RITC agreements amounted to £21.3 million (approximately $33.3 million).
 
Off-Balance Sheet and Special Purpose Entity Arrangements
 
At December 31, 2010, we do not have any off-balance sheet arrangements, as defined by Item 303(a)(4) of Regulation S-K.


107


Table of Contents

ITEM 7A.   QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE INFORMATION ABOUT MARKET RISK
 
Interest Rate Risk
 
Our balance sheets include a substantial amount of assets and, to a lesser extent, liabilities whose fair values are subject to market risks. Market risk represents the potential for an economic loss due to adverse changes in the fair value of a financial instrument. Our most significant market risks are associated primarily with changes in interest rates and foreign currency exchange rates. The following provides an analysis of the potential effects that these market risk exposures could have on our future earnings.
 
We have calculated the effect that an immediate parallel shift in the U.S. interest rate yield curve would have on our cash and investments at December 31, 2010. The modeling of this effect was performed on our investments classified as trading and available-for-sale. The results of this analysis are summarized in the table below.
 
Interest Rate Movement Analysis on Market Value
of Investments Classified as Trading and Available-for-Sale
 
                                         
    Interest Rate Shift in Basis Points
    −50   −25   0   +25   +50
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 
Total Market Value
  $ 2,151,944     $ 2,143,127     $ 2,134,310     $ 2,125,493     $ 2,116,676  
Market Value Change from Base
    0.8 %     0.4 %     0 %     (0.4 )%     (0.8 )%
Change in Unrealized Value
  $ 17,634     $ 8,817     $ 0     $ 8,817     $ 17,634  
 
As a holder of fixed maturity securities and mutual funds, we also have exposure to credit risk. At December 31, 2010, approximately 59.2% of our fixed maturity investment portfolio was rated AA or higher by a major rating agency.
 
At December 31, 2010, reinsurance receivables of $398.8 million were associated with two reinsurers and represented 41.5% of reinsurance balances receivable. These reinsurers are rated AA- or higher by a major rating agency. In the event that all or any of the reinsuring companies are unable to meet their obligations under existing reinsurance agreements, we will be liable for such defaulted amounts.
 
Effects of Inflation
 
We do not believe that inflation has had a material effect on our consolidated results of operations. Loss reserves are established to recognize likely loss settlements at the date payment is made. Those reserves inherently recognize the anticipated effects of inflation. The actual effects of inflation on our results cannot be accurately known, however, until claims are ultimately resolved.
 
Foreign Currency Risk
 
Through our subsidiaries located in various foreign countries, we conduct our insurance and reinsurance operations in a variety of non-U.S. currencies. As the functional currency for the majority of our subsidiaries is the U.S. dollar, fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates related to these subsidiaries will have a direct impact on the valuation of our assets and liabilities denominated in local currencies. All changes in foreign exchange rates, with the exception of non-U.S. dollar denominated investments classified as available-for-sale, are recognized currently in foreign exchange gains (losses) in our consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Certain of our subsidiaries have the Australian dollar as their functional currency. Fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates related to these subsidiaries have a direct impact on the valuation of their assets and liabilities denominated in local currencies. All changes in foreign exchange rates, with the exception of our U.S. dollar denominated investments classified as available-for-sale held by our Australian subsidiaries, are recognized currently in foreign exchange gains (losses) in our consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Our foreign currency policy is to broadly manage, where possible, our foreign currency risk by seeking to match our liabilities under insurance and reinsurance policies that are payable in foreign currencies with assets that


108


Table of Contents

are denominated in such currencies, subject to regulatory constraints, and to selectively use foreign currency exchange contracts. The matching process is carried out quarterly in arrears and therefore any mismatches occurring in the period may give rise to foreign exchange gains and losses, which could adversely affect our operating results. We are, however, required to maintain assets in non-U.S. dollars to meet certain local country branch and regulatory requirements, which restricts our ability to manage these exposures through the matching of our assets and liabilities. In October 2010, we also entered into a foreign currency forward exchange contract pursuant to which we will sell AU$45.0 million for $42.5 million on June 30, 2011.
 
Regarding our investments, we are currently exposed to currency fluctuations through our investments in respect of: 1) non-U.S. dollar fixed maturities held by our subsidiaries whose functional currency is U.S. dollars; and 2) non-Australian dollar fixed maturities held by our subsidiaries whose functional currency is Australian dollars. The unrealized foreign exchange gains (losses) arising from non-Australian fixed maturities classified as available-for-sale are recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income in our shareholders’ equity.
 
The tables below summarize our gross and net exposure as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 to foreign currencies for our subsidiaries whose functional currency is U.S. dollars:
 
                                                 
2010   GBP     Euro     AUD     CDN     Other     Total  
    (in millions of U.S. dollars)  
 
Total assets
  $ 751.1     $ 270.9     $ 57.6     $ 58.7     $ 48.7     $ 1,187.0  
Total liabilities
    795.7       267.7       82.7       41.5       31.6       1,219.2  
                                                 
Net foreign currency exposure
  $ (44.6 )   $ 3.2     $ (25.1 )   $ 17.2     $ 17.1     $ (32.2 )
                                                 
Pre-tax impact of a 10% movement of the U.S. dollar(1)
  $ (4.4 )   $ 0.3     $ (2.5 )   $ 1.7     $ 1.7     $ (3.2 )
                                                 
 
 
(1) Assumes 10% change in U.S. dollar relative to other currencies
 
                                                 
2009   GBP     Euro     AUD     CDN     Other     Total  
    (in millions of U.S. dollars)  
 
Total assets
  $ 572.0     $ 225.3     $ 57.4     $ 64.2     $ 23.1     $ 942.0  
Total liabilities
    536.1       181.8       40.9       41.4       20.8       821.0  
                                                 
Net foreign currency exposure
  $ 35.9     $ 43.5     $ 16.5     $ 22.8     $ 2.3     $ 121.0  
                                                 
Pre-tax impact of a 10% movement of the U.S. dollar(1)
  $ 3.6     $ 4.4     $ 1.6     $ 2.3     $ 0.2     $ 12.1  
                                                 
 
 
(1) Assumes 10% change in U.S. dollar relative to other currencies
 
The tables below summarize our gross and net exposure as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 to foreign currencies for our subsidiaries whose functional currency is Australian dollars:
 
                                                 
2010   GBP     Euro     USD     CDN     Other     Total  
    (in millions of U.S. dollars)  
 
Total assets
  $ 5.3     $ 5.1     $ 128.9     $ 0.1     $ 2.4     $ 141.8  
Total liabilities
    8.2       7.0       73.2       0.8       0.1       89.3  
                                                 
Net foreign currency exposure
  $ (2.9 )   $ (1.9 )   $ 55.7     $ (0.7 )   $ 2.3     $ 52.5  
                                                 
Pre-tax impact of a 10% movement of the Australian dollar(1)
  $ (0.3 )   $ (0.2 )   $ 5.6     $     $ 0.2     $ 5.3  
                                                 
 
 
(1) Assumes 10% change in Australian dollar relative to other currencies
 


109


Table of Contents

                                                 
2009   GBP     Euro     USD     CDN     Other     Total  
    (in millions of U.S. dollars)  
 
Total assets
  $ 16.0     $ 5.3     $ 204.5     $ (0.1 )   $ 2.3     $ 228.0  
Total liabilities
    11.2       12.4       115.3       0.2       0.3       139.4  
                                                 
Net foreign currency exposure
  $ 4.8     $ (7.1 )   $ 89.2     $ (0.3 )   $ 2.0     $ 88.6  
                                                 
Pre-tax impact of a 10% movement of the Australian dollar(1)
  $ 0.5     $ (0.7 )   $ 8.9     $     $ 0.2     $ 8.9  
                                                 
 
 
(1) Assumes 10% change in Australian dollar relative to other currencies

110


 

ITEM 8.   FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
 
INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SCHEDULES
 
         
    Page
 
December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
       
    112  
    113  
    114  
    115  
    116  
    117  
    118  
    174  
    180  


111


Table of Contents

 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
 
To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of
Enstar Group Limited
 
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Enstar Group Limited and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the related consolidated statements of earnings, comprehensive income, changes in shareholders’ equity and cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008. Our audits also included the financial statement schedule listed in the Index at Item 15. These consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule based on our audits.
 
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Enstar Group Limited and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also, in our opinion, such financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein.
 
As described in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, effective January 1, 2009, the Company adopted the new guidance issued by the United States Financial Accounting Standards Board on the accounting for noncontrolling interests.
 
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, based on Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated March 4, 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.
 
/s/  Deloitte & Touche

Hamilton, Bermuda
March 4, 2011


112


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
As of December 31, 2010 and 2009
 
                 
    2010     2009  
    (expressed in thousands of U.S. dollars, except
 
    share data)  
 
ASSETS
               
Short-term investments, available-for-sale, at fair value (amortized cost: 2010 — $7,209; 2009 — $45,046)
  $ 7,263     $ 45,206  
Short-term investments, held-to-maturity, at amortized cost (fair value: 2010 — $nil; 2009 — $159,333)
          159,210  
Short-term investments, trading, at fair value
    507,978        
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale, at fair value (amortized cost: 2010 — $1,068,540; 2009 — $69,976)
    1,094,947       69,892  
Fixed maturities, held-to-maturity, at amortized cost (fair value: 2010 — $nil; 2009 — $1,169,934)
          1,152,330  
Fixed maturities, trading, at fair value
    524,122       88,050  
Equities, trading, at fair value
    60,082       24,503  
Other investments, at fair value
    234,714       81,801  
                 
Total investments
    2,429,106       1,620,992  
Cash and cash equivalents
    799,154       1,266,445  
Restricted cash and cash equivalents
    656,200       433,660  
Accrued interest receivable
    19,980       16,108  
Accounts receivable
    24,790       17,657  
Income taxes recoverable
    7,968       3,277  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    961,442       638,262  
Funds held by reinsured companies
    274,699       68,660  
Investment in partly owned company
          20,850  
Goodwill
    21,222       21,222  
Other assets
    41,343       63,709  
                 
TOTAL ASSETS
  $ 5,235,904     $ 4,170,842  
                 
                 
LIABILITIES                
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
  $ 3,291,275     $ 2,479,136  
Reinsurance balances payable
    231,435       162,576  
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
    94,390       60,878  
Income taxes payable
    50,075       51,854  
Loans payable
    245,278       254,961  
Other liabilities
    107,630       85,285  
                 
TOTAL LIABILITIES
    4,020,083       3,094,690  
                 
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
               
SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
               
Share capital
               
Authorized issued and fully paid, par value $1 each (authorized 2010: 156,000,000; 2009: 156,000,000)
               
Ordinary shares (issued and outstanding 2010: 12,940,021; 2009: 13,580,793)
    12,940       13,581  
Non-voting convertible ordinary shares (issued 2010: 2,972,892; 2009: 2,972,892)
    2,973       2,973  
Treasury shares at cost (non-voting convertible ordinary shares 2010: 2,972,892; 2009: 2,972,892)
    (421,559 )     (421,559 )
Additional paid-in capital
    667,907       721,120  
Accumulated other comprehensive income
    35,017       8,709  
Retained earnings
    651,143       477,057  
                 
Total Enstar Group Limited Shareholders’ Equity
    948,421       801,881  
Noncontrolling interest
    267,400       274,271  
                 
TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
    1,215,821       1,076,152  
                 
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
  $ 5,235,904     $ 4,170,842  
                 
 
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements


113


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF EARNINGS
For the Years Ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
    (expressed in thousands of U.S.
 
    dollars, except share and per share data)  
 
INCOME
                       
Consulting fees
  $ 23,015     $ 16,104     $ 25,151  
Net investment income
    99,906       81,371       26,601  
Net realized and unrealized gains (losses)
    13,137       4,237       (1,655 )
                         
      136,058       101,712       50,097  
                         
EXPENSES
                       
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities:
                       
Reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses
    (278,065 )     (274,825 )     (161,437 )
Reduction in provisions for bad debt
    (49,556 )     (11,718 )     (36,136 )
Reduction in provisions for unallocated loss adjustment expense liabilities
    (39,651 )     (50,412 )     (69,056 )
Amortization of fair value adjustments
    55,438       77,328       24,525  
                         
      (311,834 )     (259,627 )     (242,104 )
Salaries and benefits
    86,677       68,454       56,270  
General and administrative expenses
    59,201       46,902       53,357  
Interest expense
    10,253       17,583       23,370  
Net foreign exchange (gain) loss
    (398 )     23,787       14,986  
                         
      (156,101 )     (102,901 )     (94,121 )
                         
EARNINGS BEFORE INCOME TAXES AND SHARE OF NET EARNINGS (LOSS) OF PARTLY OWNED COMPANY
    292,159       204,613       144,218  
INCOME TAXES
    (87,132 )     (27,605 )     (46,854 )
SHARE OF NET EARNINGS (LOSS) OF PARTLY OWNED COMPANY
    10,704             (201 )
                         
EARNINGS BEFORE EXTRAORDINARY GAIN
    215,731       177,008       97,163  
Extraordinary gain — Negative goodwill
                50,280  
                         
NET EARNINGS
    215,731       177,008       147,443  
Less: Net earnings attributable to noncontrolling interest (including share of extraordinary gain of $nil, $nil and $15,084, respectively)
    (41,645 )     (41,798 )     (65,892 )
                         
NET EARNINGS ATTRIBUTABLE TO ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
  $ 174,086     $ 135,210     $ 81,551  
                         
EARNINGS PER SHARE — BASIC:
                       
Earnings before extraordinary gain attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
  $ 12.91     $ 10.01     $ 3.67  
Extraordinary gain attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
                2.78  
                         
Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
  $ 12.91     $ 10.01     $ 6.45  
                         
EARNINGS PER SHARE — DILUTED:
                       
Earnings before extraordinary gain attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
  $ 12.66     $ 9.84     $ 3.59  
Extraordinary gain attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
                2.72  
                         
Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
  $ 12.66     $ 9.84     $ 6.31  
                         
Weighted average ordinary shares outstanding — basic
    13,489,221       13,514,207       12,638,333  
Weighted average ordinary shares outstanding — diluted
    13,751,256       13,744,661       12,921,475  
AMOUNTS ATTRIBUTABLE TO ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED ORDINARY SHAREHOLDERS:
                       
Earnings before extraordinary gain
  $ 174,086     $ 135,210     $ 46,355  
Extraordinary gain — Negative goodwill
                35,196  
                         
Net earnings
  $ 174,086     $ 135,210     $ 81,551  
                         
 
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements


114


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
For the Years Ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
    (expressed in thousands of
 
    U.S. dollars)  
 
NET EARNINGS
  $ 215,731     $ 177,008     $ 147,443  
                         
Other comprehensive income:
                       
Unrealized holding gains (losses) on investments arising during the period
    19,722       (3,332 )     8,525  
Reclassification adjustment for net realized and unrealized (gains) losses included in net earnings
    (13,137 )     (4,237 )     1,655  
Increase in defined benefit pension liability
    (1,000 )            
Currency translation adjustment
    32,077       69,833       (66,411 )
                         
Total other comprehensive income (loss)
    37,662       62,264       (56,231 )
                         
Comprehensive income
    253,393       239,272       91,212  
                         
Less comprehensive income attributable to noncontrolling interest
    (53,000 )     (64,483 )     (46,567 )
                         
COMPREHENSIVE INCOME ATTRIBUTABLE TO ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
  $ 200,393     $ 174,789     $ 44,645  
                         
 
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements


115


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
For the Years Ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
    (expressed in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
Share Capital — Ordinary Shares
                       
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 13,581     $ 13,334     $ 11,920  
Issue of shares
    80       170       1,375  
Shares repurchased
    (800 )            
Share awards granted/vested
    79       77       39  
                         
Balance, end of year
  $ 12,940     $ 13,581     $ 13,334  
                         
Share Capital — Non-Voting Convertible Ordinary Shares
                       
Balance, beginning and end of year
  $ 2,973     $ 2,973     $ 2,973  
                         
Treasury Shares
                       
Balance, beginning and end of year
  $ (421,559 )   $ (421,559 )   $ (421,559 )
                         
Additional Paid-in Capital
                       
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 721,120     $ 709,485     $ 590,934  
Equity attributable to Enstar Group Limited on acquisition of noncontrolling shareholders’ interest in subsidiary
    (3,229 )     2,716        
Issue of shares
    514       5,352       115,392  
Shares repurchased
    (55,200 )            
Share awards granted/vested
    3,202       3,567       2,551  
Amortization of share awards
    1,500             608  
                         
Balance, end of year
  $ 667,907     $ 721,120     $ 709,485  
                         
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) Attributable to Enstar Group Limited
                       
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 8,709     $ (30,871 )   $ 6,035  
Foreign currency translation adjustments
    22,476       48,939       (47,086 )
Increase in defined benefit pension liability
    (1,000 )            
Net movement in unrealized holding gains (losses) on investments
    4,832       (9,359 )     10,180  
                         
Balance, end of year
  $ 35,017     $ 8,709     $ (30,871 )
                         
Retained Earnings
                       
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 477,057     $ 341,847     $ 260,296  
Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited
    174,086       135,210       81,551  
                         
Balance, end of year
  $ 651,143     $ 477,057     $ 341,847  
                         
Noncontrolling Interest
                       
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 274,271     $ 256,022     $ 63,437  
Return of capital
    (39,381 )     (38,010 )      
Contribution of capital
    28,742             161,409  
Equity attributable to noncontrolling interest on acquisition of noncontrolling shareholders’ interest in subsidiary
          (7,244 )      
Dividends paid
    (49,232 )     (980 )     (15,392 )
Net earnings attributable to noncontrolling interest
    41,645       41,798       65,892  
Foreign currency translation adjustments
    9,602       20,894       (19,324 )
Net movement in unrealized holding gains on investments
    1,753       1,791        
                         
Balance, end of year
  $ 267,400     $ 274,271     $ 256,022  
                         
 
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements


116


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
For the Years Ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
    (expressed in thousands of
 
    U.S. dollars)  
 
OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
                       
Net earnings
  $ 215,731     $ 177,008     $ 147,443  
Adjustments to reconcile net earnings to cash flows provided by operating activities:
                       
Negative goodwill
                (50,280 )
Share of undistributed net (earnings) loss of partly owned company
    (10,704 )           201  
Net realized and unrealized investment (gain) loss
    (13,137 )     (4,237 )     1,655  
Share of net (gain) loss from other investments
    (18,645 )     (5,157 )     85,157  
Share-based compensation expense
    1,562             608  
Other items
    (550 )     6,765       7,656  
Depreciation and amortization
    1,516       1,138       808  
Amortization of bond premiums and discounts
    10,275       5,926       (1,278 )
Net movement of trading securities held on behalf of policyholders
    44,766       28,054       207,132  
Sales and maturities of trading securities
    563,729       13,289        
Purchases of trading securities
    (1,406,547 )     (17,598 )      
Changes in assets and liabilities:
                       
Reinsurance balances receivable
    (13,899 )     70,166       24,270  
Other assets
    (186,247 )     (877 )     45,301  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    150,009       (504,378 )     (268,333 )
Reinsurance balances payable
    19,175       (28,268 )     (74,042 )
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
    18,557       11,428       (11,349 )
Other liabilities
    15,198       48,686       42,238  
                         
Net cash flows (used in) provided by operating activities
    (609,211 )     (198,055 )     157,187  
                         
INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
                       
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
  $ 173,740     $ 67,804     $ 254,613  
Purchase of available-for-sale securities
          (222,891 )     (212,342 )
Sales and maturities of available-for-sale securities
    347,214       688,180       263,299  
Purchase of held-to-maturity securities
    (780,889 )     (873,679 )      
Sales and maturity of held-to-maturity securities
    786,651       186,092       136,305  
Movement in restricted cash and cash equivalents
    (187,025 )     (85,005 )     (141,475 )
Funding of other investments
    (116,720 )     (17,863 )     (33,488 )
Purchase of investment in partly owned company
                (21,387 )
Sale of investment in partly owned company
    31,554              
Other investing activities
    (1,064 )     (2,452 )     (463 )
                         
Net cash flows provided by (used in) investing activities
    253,461       (259,814 )     245,062  
                         
FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
                       
Distribution of capital to noncontrolling interest
  $ (39,381 )   $ (38,990 )   $ (27,146 )
Contribution to surplus of subsidiary by noncontrolling interest
    28,742             163,848  
Dividends paid to noncontrolling interest
    (49,231 )            
Receipt of loans
    161,400             572,791  
Repayment of loans
    (226,227 )     (163,490 )     (200,301 )
Proceeds from issuance of ordinary shares
          2,796       115,392  
                         
Net cash flows (used in) provided by financing activities
    (124,697 )     (199,684 )     624,584  
                         
TRANSLATION ADJUSTMENT
    13,156       57,452       (155,524 )
                         
NET (DECREASE) INCREASE IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS
    (467,291 )     (600,101 )     871,309  
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF YEAR
    1,266,445       1,866,546       995,237  
                         
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF YEAR
  $ 799,154     $ 1,266,445     $ 1,866,546  
                         
 
Supplemental Cash Flow Information
                       
Net income taxes paid
  $ 73,368     $ 20,143     $ 6,195  
Interest paid
  $ 10,404     $ 11,846     $ 14,853  
 
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements


117


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
(Tabular information expressed in thousands of U.S. dollars except share and per share data)
 
1.   DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS
 
Enstar Group Limited (“Enstar” or the “Company”) was formed in August 2001 under the laws of Bermuda to acquire and manage insurance and reinsurance companies in run-off and portfolios of insurance and reinsurance business in run-off, and to provide management, consulting and other services to the insurance and reinsurance industry.
 
2.   SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
Basis of preparation — The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”). The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amount of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. The major estimates reflected in the Company’s financial statements include, but are not limited to, the reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses and reinsurance balances receivable.
 
Basis of consolidation — The consolidated financial statements include the assets, liabilities and results of operations of the Company as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 and for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008. Results of operations for subsidiaries acquired are included from the dates of their acquisition by the Company. Intercompany transactions are eliminated on consolidation.
 
Cash and cash equivalents — The Company considers all highly liquid debt instruments purchased with an initial maturity of ninety-two days or less to be cash and cash equivalents.
 
Investments  —
 
a) Short-term investments:  Short-term investments comprise securities with a maturity greater than ninety-two days but less than one year from the date of purchase. Short-term investments classified as available-for-sale are carried at fair value, with unrealized gains and losses excluded from net earnings and reported as a separate component of accumulated other comprehensive income. Short-term investments classified as held-to-maturity are carried at purchase cost adjusted for amortization of premiums and discounts. Short-term investments classified as trading are carried at fair value, with realized and unrealized holding gains and losses included in net earnings and reported as net realized and unrealized gains and losses. Amortization expenses derive from the difference between the nominal value and purchase cost and they are spread over the time to maturity of the debt securities using an effective yield method. Realized gains and losses on the sale of investments are based upon specific identification of the cost of investments. For mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities, and any other holdings for which there is a prepayment risk, prepayment assumptions are evaluated and revised on a regular basis.
 
b) Fixed maturities:  Debt securities classified as held-to-maturity investments are carried at purchase cost adjusted for amortization of premiums and discounts. Debt investments classified as trading securities are carried at fair value, with realized and unrealized holding gains and losses included in net earnings and reported as net realized and unrealized gains and losses. Debt securities classified as available-for-sale are carried at fair value, with unrealized gains and losses excluded from net earnings and reported as a separate component of accumulated other comprehensive income. Amortization expenses derive from the difference between the nominal value and purchase cost and they are spread over the time to maturity of the debt securities using an effective yield method. Realized gains and losses on the sale of investments are based upon specific identification of the cost of investments. For mortgage-backed and asset backed securities, and any other holdings for which there is a prepayment risk, prepayment assumptions are evaluated and revised on a regular basis.


118


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
c) Equity securities:  Equity investments are classified as trading securities and are carried at fair value with realized and unrealized holding gains and losses included in net earnings and reported as net realized and unrealized gains and losses.
 
d) Other investments:  Other investments include investments in limited partnerships and limited liability companies (collectively “private equities”), bond and hedge funds which value their investments at fair value. The Company has no significant influence and does not participate in the management of these investments. Other investments are accounted for at estimated fair values, determined by the Company’s proportionate share of the net asset value of the investee reduced by any impairment charges. The Company records movement in the value of its other investments through earnings. Significant estimates are involved in the valuation of other investments. Because of the inherent uncertainty of valuation, the estimates of fair value may differ significantly from the values that would have been used had a ready market for the other investments existed. The differences could be significant.
 
Investments classified as held-to-maturity and available-for-sale are reviewed quarterly to determine if they have sustained an impairment of value that is considered to be other than temporary. The process includes reviewing each fixed maturity investment that is impaired and: (1) determining if the Company has the intent to sell the fixed maturity investment; (2) determining if it is more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the fixed maturity investment before its anticipated recovery; and (3) assessing whether a credit loss exists, that is, where the Company expects that the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected from the fixed maturity investment are less than the amortized cost basis of the investment. In evaluating credit losses, the Company considers a variety of factors in the assessment of a fixed maturity investment including: (1) the time period during which there has been a significant decline below cost; (2) the extent of the decline below cost and par; (3) the potential for the fixed maturity investment to recover in value; (4) an analysis of the financial condition of the issuer; (5) the rating of the issuer; and (6) failure of the issuer of the fixed maturity investment to make scheduled interest or principal payments. If management concludes a security is other-than-temporarily impaired (“OTTI”) then the difference between the fair value and the amortized cost of the security is presented as an OTTI charge in the consolidated statements of earnings, with an offset for any noncredit-related loss component of the OTTI charge to be recognized in other comprehensive income. Accordingly, only the credit loss component of the OTTI amount will have an impact on the Company’s earnings. Realized gains and loss on sales of investments classified as available-for-sale and trading securities are recognized in the consolidated statements of earnings. Investment purchases and sales are recorded on a trade-date basis.
 
Derivative instruments — The Company may enter into derivative instruments such as futures, options, interest rate swaps and foreign currency forward contracts as part of its overall foreign currency risk management strategy or to obtain exposure to a particular financial market and for yield enhancement. All derivative instruments are measured at fair value and recognized as either assets or liabilities in the consolidated balance sheets. Change in fair value and realized gains or losses on derivative instruments are recorded in the consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Investment in partly owned company — An investment in a partly owned company, in which the Company has significant influence, is carried on the equity basis whereby the investment is initially recorded at cost and adjusted to reflect the Company’s share of after-tax earnings or losses and unrealized investment gains and losses and reduced by dividends.
 
Loss and loss adjustment expenses — The liability for loss and loss adjustment expenses includes an amount determined from loss reports and individual cases and an amount, based on historical loss experience and industry statistics, for losses incurred but not reported. These estimates are continually reviewed and are necessarily subject to the impact of future changes in such factors as claim severity and frequency. While management believes that the amount is adequate, the ultimate liability may be significantly in excess of, or less than, the amounts provided. Adjustments will be reflected as part of net increase or reduction in loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities in the periods in which they become known. Premium and commission adjustments may be triggered by incurred


119


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
losses and any amounts are reflected in net loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities at the same time the related incurred loss is recognized.
 
The Company’s insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries establish provisions for loss adjustment expenses relating to run-off costs for the estimated duration of the run-off. These provisions are assessed at each reporting date and provisions relating to future periods are adjusted to reflect any changes in estimates of the periodic run-off costs or the duration of the run-off. Provisions relating to the current period together with any adjustments to future run-off provisions are included in loss and loss adjustment expenses in the consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Reinsurance balances receivable — Amounts receivable from reinsurers are estimated in a manner consistent with the loss reserve associated with the underlying policy.
 
Retroactive reinsurance contracts — Premiums on ceded retroactive contracts are earned upon inception of the contract with corresponding reinsurance recoverable established for the amount of reserves ceded. The initial gain, if applicable, is deferred and amortized into income over an actuarially determined expected payout period.
 
Consulting fee income — Fixed fee income is recognized in accordance with the term of the agreements. Fees based on hourly charge rates are recognized as services are provided. Performance fees are recognized when all of the contractual requirements specified in the agreement are met.
 
Foreign currencies — At each balance sheet date, recorded balances that are denominated in a currency other than the functional currency of the Company are adjusted to reflect the current exchange rate. Revenue and expense items are translated into U.S. dollars at average rates of exchange for the applicable year. The resulting exchange gains or losses are included in net earnings.
 
Assets and liabilities of subsidiaries are translated into U.S. dollars at the year-end rates of exchange. Revenues and expenses of subsidiaries are translated into U.S. dollars at the average rates of exchange for the applicable year.
 
The resultant translation adjustment for self-sustaining subsidiaries is classified as a separate component of other comprehensive income and for integrated operations is included in net earnings.
 
Earnings per share — Basic earnings per share is defined as net earnings available to ordinary shareholders divided by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding for the period, giving no effect to dilutive securities. Diluted earnings per share is defined as net earnings available to ordinary shareholders divided by the weighted average number of ordinary and ordinary share equivalents outstanding calculated using the treasury stock method for all potentially dilutive securities. When the effect of dilutive securities would be anti-dilutive, these securities are excluded from the calculation of diluted earnings per share.
 
Acquisitions — Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of the net assets received related to the acquisition of Enstar Limited (formerly “Castlewood Limited”) by Enstar in 2001. The Company performed an initial valuation of its goodwill assets and updates this analysis on an annual basis. If, as a result of the assessment, the Company determines the value of its goodwill asset is impaired, goodwill is written down in the period in which the determination is made. An annual impairment valuation has concluded that there is no impairment to the value of the Company’s goodwill asset. Negative goodwill arises where the fair value of net assets acquired exceeds the purchase price of those acquired assets and has been recognized as an extraordinary gain.
 
Stock based compensation — Compensation costs related to share-based payment transactions are recognized in the financial statements based on the grant date fair value of the award. On May 23, 2006, Enstar entered into an agreement and plan of merger and a recapitalization agreement. As a result of the execution of these agreements, the accounting treatment for share-based awards issued under Enstar’s employee share plan changed from book value to fair value.


120


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
Adoption of New Accounting Standards
 
In June 2009, the United States Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) established the Accounting Standards Codification (“the Codification”) as the source of authoritative U.S. GAAP for non-governmental entities, in addition to guidance issued by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”). The Codification supersedes all then-existing, non-SEC accounting and reporting standards and reorganizes existing U.S. GAAP into authoritative accounting topics and sub-topics. The Company adopted the Codification as of September 30, 2009, and it impacted the Company’s disclosures by eliminating all references to pre-Codification standards.
 
The Company adopted the new guidance issued by FASB on the accounting for noncontrolling interests, effective January 1, 2009. The new guidance clarifies that a noncontrolling interest in a subsidiary is an ownership interest that should be reported as equity in the consolidated financial statements. The new guidance requires consolidated net income to be reported at the amounts that include the amounts attributable to both the parent and the noncontrolling interest. The new guidance also establishes a method of accounting for changes in a parent’s ownership interest in a subsidiary that results in deconsolidation. The presentation and disclosure of the new guidance have been applied retrospectively for all periods presented.
 
In January 2010, the Company adopted the revised guidance issued by FASB for the consolidation of variable interest entities. The revised guidance requires an entity to perform an analysis to determine whether the entity’s variable interest or interests give it a controlling financial interest in a variable interest entity. It prescribes the determination of whether a reporting entity is required to consolidate another entity based on, among other things, the other entity’s purpose and design and the reporting entity’s ability to direct the activities of the other entity that most significantly impact the other entity’s economic performance. The adoption of the revised guidance did not have any impact on the consolidated financial statements.
 
The Company adopted the revised guidance issued by FASB for the accounting for transfers of financial assets in January 2010. The revised guidance eliminates the concept of a “qualifying special-purpose entity”; changes the requirements for derecognizing financial assets; and enhances information reported to financial statement users by increasing the transparency of disclosures about transfers of financial assets and an entity’s continuing involvement with transferred financial assets. The adoption of the revised guidance did not have any impact on the consolidated financial statements.
 
In January 2010, the Company adopted the revised guidance issued by FASB for the disclosures about fair value measurements. The revised guidance requires additional disclosures about transfers into and out of Levels 1 and 2 and separate disclosures about purchases, sales, issuances and settlements relating to Level 3 measurements. The revised guidance also clarifies existing fair value disclosures about the level of disaggregation and about inputs and valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The revised guidance is effective for the first reporting period (including interim periods) beginning after December 15, 2009, except for the requirement to provide the Level 3 activity of purchases, sales, issuances and settlements on a gross basis, which will be effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2010, and for interim periods within those fiscal years. The adoption of the revised guidance did not have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.
 
In February, 2010, FASB amended its guidance on subsequent events in order to alleviate potential conflicts between FASB’s guidance and the SEC’s filing requirements. Companies filing periodic reports with the SEC are no longer required to disclose the date through which subsequent events have been evaluated in originally issued and revised financial statements. This guidance was effective immediately upon issuance. The adoption of this guidance had no impact on the Company’s results of operations or financial condition. While the Company’s consolidated financial statements no longer disclose the date through which it has evaluated subsequent events, the Company continues to be required to evaluate subsequent events through the date when its financial statements are issued.


121


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
Recently Issued Accounting Standards Not Yet Adopted
 
In December 2010, FASB provided additional guidance for performing Step 1 of the test for goodwill impairment when an entity has reporting units with zero or negative carrying values. Under the new guidance, Step 2 of the goodwill impairment test must be performed when adverse qualitative factors indicate that goodwill is more likely than not impaired. This guidance will be effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2010, and for interim periods within those fiscal years. The adoption of the revised guidance will not have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.
 
In December 2010, FASB issued new guidance specifying that if a public entity presents comparative financial statements, the entity should disclose, in its supplementary pro-forma information, revenue and earnings of the combined entity as though the business combination that occurred during the current year had occurred as of the beginning of the comparable prior annual reporting period only. The new guidance is effective prospectively for business combinations that are consummated in fiscal years beginning on or after December 15, 2010, with earlier application permitted. The adoption of the revised guidance will not have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.
 
On October 1, 2010, the Company adopted new guidance issued by FASB requiring disclosures about the nature of credit risk in financing receivables and how that risk is analyzed in determining the related allowance for credit losses, as well as details on changes in the allowance for credit losses during the reporting period. Additional disclosures with respect to this guidance have been provided in Note 8.
 
The Company has determined that all other recently issued accounting pronouncements will not have a material impact on its consolidated financial statements, or do not apply to its operations.
 
3.   ACQUISITIONS
 
The Company accounts for acquisitions using the purchase method of accounting, which requires that the acquirer record the assets and liabilities acquired at their estimated fair value. The fair values of reinsurance assets and liabilities acquired are derived from probability weighted ranges of the associated projected cash flows, based on actuarially prepared information and management’s run-off strategy. Any amendment to the fair values resulting from changes in such information or strategy will be recognized when the changes occur.
 
2008
 
Guildhall
 
On February 29, 2008, the Company completed the acquisition of Guildhall Insurance Company Limited (“Guildhall”), a U.K.-based reinsurance company that has been in run-off since 1986, for total purchase price of approximately £33.4 million (approximately $65.9 million). The purchase price was financed by the drawdown of approximately £16.5 million (approximately $32.5 million) from a facility loan agreement with a London-based bank; approximately £5.0 million (approximately $10.0 million) from J.C. Flowers II, L.P. (the “Flowers Fund”), by way of non-voting equity participation; and the balance of approximately £11.9 million (approximately $23.5 million) from available cash on hand. In September 2008, the facility loan was repaid in full.
 
The purchase price and fair value of the assets acquired in the Guildhall acquisition were as follows:
 
         
Purchase price
  $ 65,571  
Direct costs of acquisition
    303  
         
Total purchase price
  $ 65,874  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 65,874  
         


122


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 104,888  
Restricted cash
    4,106  
Accounts receivable and accrued interest
    4,631  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    33,298  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (79,107 )
Accounts payable
    (1,942 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 65,874  
         
 
Gordian
 
On March 5, 2008, the Company completed the acquisition of AMP Limited’s Australian-based closed reinsurance and insurance operations (“Gordian”). The total purchase price was approximately AU$436.9 million (approximately $405.4 million) and was financed by approximately AU$301.0 million (approximately $276.5 million), including an arrangement fee of AU$4.5 million (approximately $4.2 million), from bank financing provided jointly by a London-based bank and a German bank (the Flowers Fund is a significant shareholder of the German bank); approximately AU$41.6 million (approximately $39.5 million) from the Flowers Fund, by way of non-voting equity participation; and approximately AU$98.7 million (approximately $93.6 million) from available cash on hand. In September 2010, the facility was repaid in full.
 
The purchase price and fair value of the assets acquired in the Gordian acquisition were as follows:
 
         
Purchase price
  $ 401,086  
Direct costs of acquisition
    4,326  
         
Total purchase price
  $ 405,412  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 455,692  
         
Excess of net assets over purchase price (negative goodwill)
  $ 50,280  
Less noncontrolling interests share of negative goodwill
    (15,084 )
         
Negative goodwill attributable to the Company
  $ 35,196  
         
 
The negative goodwill arose primarily as a result of income earned by Gordian between the date of the balance sheet on which the agreed purchase price was based, June 30, 2007, and the date the acquisition closed, March 5, 2008, and the desire of the vendors to achieve a substantial reduction in regulatory capital requirements and therefore to dispose of Gordian at a discount to fair value.


123


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 341,879  
Restricted cash
    28,237  
Investments:
       
Short-term investments, available-for-sale
    50,930  
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale
    416,355  
Other investments
    35,354  
         
Total investments
    502,639  
Accounts receivable and accrued interest
    31,253  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    99,645  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (509,638 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (22,660 )
Accounts payable
    (15,663 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 455,692  
         
 
Seaton and Stonewall
 
On June 13, 2008, the Company’s indirect subsidiary, Virginia Holdings Ltd. (“Virginia”), completed the acquisition of 44.4% of the outstanding capital stock of Stonewall Acquisition Corporation (“Stonewall”) from Dukes Place Holdings, L.P., a portfolio company of GSC European Mezzanine Fund II, L.P. At that time, Stonewall Acquisition Corporation was the parent of two Rhode Island-domiciled insurers, Stonewall Insurance Company and Seaton Insurance Company, both of which are in run-off. The total purchase price of $21.4 million was funded from available cash on hand.
 
The purchase price of the Company’s 44.4% share of Stonewall and the fair value of the assets acquired were as follows:
 
         
Purchase price
  $ 20,444  
Direct costs of acquisition
    987  
         
Total purchase price
  $ 21,431  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 21,431  
         


124


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The following summarizes the Company’s 44.4% share of the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed as of the date of acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 17,873  
Investments:
       
Short-term investments, available-for-sale
    1,302  
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale
    37,917  
Equities
    425  
Other investments
    604  
         
Total investments
    40,248  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    187,964  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (217,044 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (3,049 )
Accounts payable
    (4,561 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 21,431  
         
 
Stonewall entered into a definitive agreement on December 3, 2009 for the sale of its shares in Stonewall Insurance Company to Columbia Insurance Company, an affiliate of National Indemnity Company (an indirect subsidiary of Berkshire Hathaway, Inc.), for a sale price of $56.0 million, subject to certain post-closing purchase price adjustments that brought the total consideration received to $60.4 million. The transaction received the required regulatory approval on March 31, 2010 and subsequently closed on April 7, 2010. The proceeds received by Stonewall and certain other assets were later distributed between Dukes Place Holdings, L.P. and Virginia.
 
Goshawk
 
On June 20, 2008, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Enstar Acquisitions Limited (“EAL”), announced a cash offer to all of the shareholders of Goshawk Insurance Holdings Plc (“Goshawk”), at 5.2 pence (approximately $0.103) for each share (the “Offer”), conditioned on, among other things, receiving acceptance from shareholders owning 90% of the shares of Goshawk. Goshawk owns Rosemont Reinsurance Limited, a Bermuda-based reinsurer that wrote primarily property and marine business, which was placed into run-off in October 2005. The Offer valued Goshawk at approximately £45.7 million in the aggregate.
 
On July 17, 2008, after acquiring more than 30% of the shares of Goshawk through market purchases, EAL was obligated to remove all of the conditions of the Offer except for receipt of acceptances from shareholders owning 50% of the shares of Goshawk. On July 25, 2008, the acceptance condition was met and the Offer became unconditional. On August 19, 2008, the Offer closed with shareholders representing approximately 89.44% of Goshawk accepting the Offer for total consideration of £40.9 million (approximately $80.9 million).
 
The total purchase price of approximately $82.0 million was financed by a drawdown of $36.1 million from a credit facility provided by a London-based bank, a contribution of $11.7 million of the acquisition price from the Flowers Fund, by way of non-voting equity participation, and the remainder from available cash on hand.
 
In connection with the acquisition, Goshawk’s existing bank loan of $16.3 million was refinanced by the drawdown of $12.2 million (net of fees) from a credit facility provided by a London-based bank and $4.1 million from the Flowers Fund. On December 22, 2009, the outstanding principal and interest on the Goshawk facility was fully repaid.


125


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The purchase price of the Company’s 89.44% share of Goshawk and the fair value of the assets acquired were as follows:
 
         
Purchase price
  $ 80,861  
Direct costs of acquisition
    1,106  
         
Total purchase price
  $ 81,967  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 81,967  
         
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 159,301  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    32,532  
Other assets
    15,703  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (80,051 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (20,634 )
Accounts payable
    (24,884 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 81,967  
         
 
On November 26, 2009, the Company acquired an additional 10.01% of the outstanding shares of Goshawk that it did not previously own, for a purchase price of approximately $4.7 million. The Company has accounted for the acquisition of the shares in accordance with the provisions of the Consolidation topic of the Codification. The Company now owns 99.45% of Goshawk’s outstanding shares.
 
EPIC
 
On August 14, 2008, the Company completed the purchase of all of the outstanding capital stock of Electricity Producers Insurance Company (Bermuda) Limited (“EPIC”) for a total purchase price of approximately £36.8 million (approximately $69.0 million). The purchase price was financed by approximately $32.8 million from a credit facility provided by a London-based bank; approximately $10.2 million from the Flowers Fund, by way of non-voting equity participation; and the remainder from available cash on hand. On October 6, 2008, the Company fully repaid the outstanding principal and accrued interest on the facility.
 
The purchase price and fair value of the assets acquired in the EPIC acquisition were as follows:
 
         
Purchase price
  $ 68,792  
Direct costs of acquisition
    173  
         
Total purchase price
  $ 68,965  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 68,965  
         


126


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 169,401  
Restricted cash
    15,929  
Fixed maturity investments, available-for-sale
    771  
Other assets
    733  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (108,616 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (312 )
Accounts payable
    (8,941 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 68,965  
         
 
Capital Assurance
 
On August 18, 2008, the Company completed the acquisition of all of the outstanding capital stock of Capital Assurance Company Inc. and Capital Assurance Services, Inc. (collectively “Capital Assurance”) for a total purchase price of approximately $5.6 million. Capital Assurance Company, Inc. is a Florida-domiciled insurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.
 
The purchase price and fair value of the assets acquired in the Capital Assurance acquisition were as follows:
 
         
Purchase price
  $ 5,338  
Direct costs of acquisition
    282  
         
Total purchase price
  $ 5,620  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 5,620  
         
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 1,162  
Investments:
       
Short-term investments, available-for-sale
    28,220  
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale
    1,686  
         
Total investments
    29,906  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    332  
Other assets
    1,244  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (26,265 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (30 )
Accounts payable
    (729 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 5,620  
         
 
Hillcot Re
 
On October 27, 2008, Kenmare Holdings Ltd. (“Kenmare”), a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, completed the purchase of the entire share capital of Hillcot Re Ltd. (“Hillcot Re”), the wholly-owned subsidiary of Hillcot Holdings Ltd. (“Hillcot”), for a total purchase price of $54.7 million. Hillcot Re is a U.K.-based reinsurer that is in run-off. Prior to this transaction, the Company owned 50.1% of the outstanding share capital of Hillcot and


127


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
Shinsei Bank, Ltd. (“Shinsei”) owned the remaining 49.9%. Upon completion of the transaction, Hillcot paid a distribution to Shinsei of approximately $27.1 million representing its 49.9% share of the consideration received by Hillcot. J. Christopher Flowers, a member of the Company’s board of directors and one of its largest shareholders, is a director and the largest shareholder of Shinsei. The total purchase price of $54.7 million was funded from available cash on hand.
 
The purchase price and the fair value of the assets acquired of Hillcot Re was as follows:
 
         
Purchase price
  $ 54,400  
Direct costs of acquisition
    272  
         
Total purchase price
  $ 54,672  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 54,672  
         
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 77,611  
Restricted cash
    630  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    7,114  
Other assets
    1,336  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (28,531 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (630 )
Accounts payable
    (2,858 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 54,672  
         
 
Unionamerica
 
On December 30, 2008, Royston Run-Off Limited (“Royston”), the Company’s indirect subsidiary, completed the purchase of all of the outstanding capital stock of Unionamerica Holdings Limited (“Unionamerica”) for total purchase price of approximately $343.4 million. Unionamerica is comprised of the discontinued operations of St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company’s U.K.-based London Market business, which were placed into run-off between 1992 and 2003. The purchase price was financed by approximately $184.6 million from a credit facility provided by a London-based bank; approximately $49.8 million from the Flowers Fund, by way of its non-voting equity interest in Royston Holdings Ltd., the direct parent company of Royston, and the remainder from available cash on hand. Under the facilities agreement for the bank loan, which was amended and restated on August 4, 2009, the Company borrowed $152.6 million under Facility A and $32.0 million under Facility B. In December 2010, the Company repaid $114.0 million of the credit facility and, in March 2011, repaid another $40.5 million of the credit facility.
 
The purchase price and fair value of the assets acquired in the Unionamerica acquisition were as follows:
 
         
Purchase price
  $ 341,266  
Direct costs of acquisition
    2,160  
         
Total purchase price
  $ 343,426  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 343,426  
         


128


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 404,411  
Restricted cash
    7,298  
Investments:
       
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale
    388,008  
Fixed maturities, held-to-maturity
    229,925  
Other investments
    2,007  
         
Total investments
    619,940  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    128,615  
Other assets
    35,735  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (828,338 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (22,681 )
Accounts payable
    (1,554 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 343,426  
         
 
2009
 
Constellation Reinsurance
 
On January 31, 2009, the Company, through its indirect subsidiary, Sun Gulf Holdings Inc., completed the acquisition of all of the outstanding capital stock of Constellation Reinsurance Company Limited (“Constellation”) for a total purchase price of approximately $2.5 million. Constellation is a New York-domiciled reinsurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.
 
The purchase price and fair value of the assets acquired in the Constellation acquisition were as follows:
 
         
Total purchase price
  $ 2,500  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 2,500  
         
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 11,004  
Fixed maturity investments, available-for-sale
    250  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    3,374  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (12,128 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 2,500  
         
 
Copenhagen Re
 
On October 15, 2009, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Marlon Insurance Company Limited, completed the acquisition of Copenhagen Reinsurance Company Ltd. (“Copenhagen Re”) from Alm. Brand Forsikring A/S for a total purchase price of DKK149.2 million (approximately $29.9 million). Copenhagen Re is a Danish-domiciled reinsurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.


129


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The purchase price and fair value of the assets acquired in the Copenhagen Re acquisition were as follows:
 
         
Total purchase price
  $ 29,884  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 29,884  
         
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 93,710  
Restricted cash
    5,327  
Fixed maturity investments, available-for-sale
    39,848  
Accounts receivable and accrued interest
    747  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    23,905  
Other assets
    5,365  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (115,286 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (8,089 )
Accounts payable
    (15,643 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 29,884  
         
 
2010
 
Knapton Insurance (formerly British Engine)
 
On March 2, 2010, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Knapton Holdings Limited (“Knapton Holdings”), completed the acquisition of Knapton Insurance Limited, formerly British Engine Insurance Limited (“Knapton”), from RSA Insurance Group plc for a total purchase price of approximately £28.8 million (approximately $44.0 million). Knapton is a U.K.-domiciled reinsurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.
 
The purchase price and fair value of the assets acquired in the Knapton acquisition were as follows:
 
         
Total purchase price
  $ 44,031  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 44,031  
         


130


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 153,286  
Restricted cash
    35,515  
Investments:
       
Short-term investments, trading
    5,990  
Fixed maturity investments, trading
    27,923  
         
Total investments
    33,913  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    50,942  
Other assets
    5,840  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (216,871 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (12,347 )
Accounts payable
    (6,247 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 44,031  
         
 
From March 2, 2010, the date of acquisition, to December 31, 2010, the Company has recorded in its consolidated statement of earnings, revenues and net earnings related to Knapton of $2.4 million and $11.9 million, respectively.
 
In April 2010, Knapton Holdings entered into a term facility agreement with a London-based bank (the “Knapton Facility”). On April 20, 2010, Knapton Holdings drew down $21.4 million from the Knapton Facility.
 
Assuransinvest
 
On March 30, 2010, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Nordic Run-Off Limited, completed the acquisition of Forsakringsaktiebolaget Assuransinvest MF (“Assuransinvest”) for a purchase price of SEK 78.8 million (approximately $11.0 million). Assuransinvest is a Swedish-domiciled reinsurer that is in run-off. The purchase price was funded from available cash on hand.
 
The purchase price and fair value of the assets acquired in the Assuransinvest acquisition were as follows:
 
         
Total purchase price
  $ 11,042  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 11,042  
         
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 58,971  
Fixed maturity investments, trading
    579  
Other assets
    5  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (45,021 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (3,130 )
Accounts payable
    (362 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 11,042  
         
 
From March 30, 2010, the date of acquisition, to December 31, 2010, the Company has recorded in its consolidated statement of earnings, revenues and net losses related to Assuransinvest of $0.1 million and $(0.8) million, respectively.


131


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
Providence Washington
 
On July 20, 2010, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, PWAC Holdings, Inc., completed the acquisition of PW Acquisition Company (“PWAC”) for a purchase price of $25.0 million. PWAC owns the entire share capital of Providence Washington Insurance Company. Providence Washington Insurance Company and its two subsidiaries are Rhode Island-domiciled insurers that are in run-off. The purchase price was financed by a term facility provided by a London-based bank (the “EGL Facility”), which was fully repaid on September 13, 2010.
 
The purchase price and fair value of the assets acquired in the PWAC acquisition were as follows:
 
         
Total purchase price
  $ 25,000  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 25,000  
         
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 19,278  
Investments:
       
Short-term investments, trading
    4,181  
Fixed maturity investments, trading
    97,756  
Equities
    37  
Other investments
    4,985  
         
Total investments
    106,959  
Accounts receivable and accrued interest
    813  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    31,718  
Other assets
    1,276  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (120,745 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (3,597 )
Accounts payable
    (10,702 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 25,000  
         
 
From July 20, 2010, the date of acquisition, to December 31, 2010, the Company has recorded in its consolidated statement of earnings, revenues and net losses related to PWAC of $1.5 million and $(1.5) million, respectively.
 
Seaton Insurance
 
On August 3, 2010, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Virginia, acquired 55.6% of the shares of Seaton Insurance Company (“Seaton”) that it previously did not own for a $nil purchase price, resulting in Virginia owning 100% of Seaton. Seaton is a Rhode Island-domiciled insurer that is in run-off. The acquisition of the Seaton shares was a result of the distribution by Stonewall to Virginia of proceeds and certain other assets following its sale of Stonewall Insurance Company to Columbia Insurance Company, an affiliate of National Indemnity Company (an indirect subsidiary of Berkshire Hathaway, Inc.). Prior to the distribution, Virginia had indirectly owned 44.4% of Seaton through its holding in Stonewall. The fair value of the assets acquired in the Seaton acquisition was $nil.


132


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of 100% of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 3,949  
Fixed maturity investments, trading
    22,745  
Accounts receivable and accrued interest
    270  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    170,344  
Other assets
    3,759  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (171,010 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (28,670 )
Accounts payable
    (1,387 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $  
         
 
From August 3, 2010, the date of acquisition, to December 31, 2010, the Company has recorded in its consolidated statement of earnings, revenues and net losses related to Seaton of $0.2 million and $(5.3) million, respectively.
 
Brampton
 
On November 2, 2010, the Company acquired the 49.9% of the shares of Hillcot from Shinsei that it did not previously own for a purchase price of $38.0 million, resulting in the Company owning 100% of Hillcot. At the time of acquisition, Hillcot owned 100% of the shares of Brampton. The fair value of the assets acquired that the Company did not previously own was $34.9 million. The excess of the purchase price over the fair value of assets acquired in the amount of $3.1 million was recorded as a charge to additional paid-in capital in accordance with the applicable U.S. GAAP guidance.
 
CitiLife
 
On November 8, 2010, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Kenmare, entered into a definitive agreement for the purchase of CitiLife Financial Limited from Citigroup Insurance Holding Corporation, an affiliate of Citigroup Inc. CitiLife Financial Limited is a Dublin, Ireland-based life insurer that is in run-off. The purchase price is €30 million (approximately $40.2 million) and is expected to be financed from available cash on hand. Completion of the transaction is conditioned on, among other things, regulatory approval and satisfaction of various customary closing conditions. The transaction is expected to close in the first quarter of 2011.
 
New Castle
 
On December 3, 2010, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Kenmare, completed the acquisition of New Castle Reinsurance Company Ltd. (“New Castle”), for an aggregate purchase price of $22.0 million. New Castle is a Bermuda-domiciled insurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.
 
The purchase price and fair value of the assets acquired in the New Castle acquisition were as follows:
 
         
Total purchase price
  $ 21,950  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 21,950  
         


133


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 57,026  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    4,818  
Other assets
    99  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (38,603 )
Insurance and reinsurance balances payable
    (1,316 )
Accounts payable
    (74 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 21,950  
         
 
From December 3, 2010, the date of acquisition, to December 31, 2010, the Company has recorded in its consolidated statement of earnings, revenues and net losses related to New Castle of $nil and $(0.1) million, respectively.
 
Clarendon
 
On December 22, 2010, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Clarendon Holdings, Inc., entered into a definitive agreement for the purchase of Clarendon National Insurance Company (“Clarendon”) from Clarendon Insurance Group, Inc., an affiliate of Hannover Re. Clarendon is a New Jersey-domiciled insurer that is in run-off. The purchase price is approximately $200 million and will be financed in part by a bank loan facility provided by a London-based bank entered into on March 4, 2011 and in part from available cash on hand. Completion of the transaction is conditioned on, among other things, regulatory approval and satisfaction of various customary closing conditions. The transaction is expected to close in the second quarter of 2011.
 
Claremont
 
On December 31, 2010, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, CLIC Holdings, Inc., completed the acquisition of Claremont Liability Insurance Company (“Claremont”), for an aggregate purchase price of $13.9 million. Claremont is a California-domiciled insurer that is in run-off. The acquisition was funded from available cash on hand.
 
The purchase price and fair value of the assets acquired in the Claremont acquisition were as follows:
 
         
Total purchase price
  $ 13,936  
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 13,936  
         


134


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The following summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition:
 
         
Cash
  $ 394  
Investments:
       
Fixed maturity investments, trading
    15,990  
Equities
    138  
         
Total investments
    16,128  
Accounts receivable and accrued interest
    196  
Reinsurance balances receivable
    44,966  
Other assets
    19  
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
    (47,516 )
Accounts payable
    (251 )
         
Net assets acquired at fair value
  $ 13,936  
         
 
No revenues or net earnings related to Claremont were recorded in the Company’s consolidated statement of earnings for the year ended December 31, 2010.
 
4.   SIGNIFICANT NEW BUSINESS
 
Shelbourne RITC Transactions
 
In December 2007, the Company, in conjunction with JCF FPK I L.P. (“JCF FPK”) and a newly-hired executive management team, formed U.K.-based Shelbourne Group Limited (“Shelbourne”) to invest in Reinsurance to Close or “RITC” transactions (the transferring of liabilities from one Lloyd’s syndicate to another) with Lloyd’s of London insurance and reinsurance syndicates in run-off. The Company owns approximately 56.8% of Shelbourne, which in turn owns 100% of Shelbourne Syndicate Services Limited, the Managing Agency for Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008, a syndicate approved by Lloyd’s of London on December 16, 2007 to undertake RITC transactions with Lloyd’s syndicates in run-off.
 
JCF FPK is a joint investment program between Fox-Pitt, Kelton, Cochran, Caronia & Waller (USA) LLC (“FPK”) and the Flowers Fund. The Flowers Fund is a private investment fund advised by J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC. J. Christopher Flowers, a member of the Company’s board of directors and one of the Company’s largest shareholders, is the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC. John J. Oros who was the Company’s Executive Chairman and a member of the Company’s board of directors until his resignation on August 20, 2010, is a Managing Director of J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC. In addition, an affiliate of the Flowers Fund controlled approximately 41% of FPK until its sale of FPK in December 2009.
 
In February 2008, Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 entered into RITC agreements with four Lloyd’s syndicates with total gross insurance reserves of approximately $471.2 million. In February 2009, Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 entered into a RITC agreement with a Lloyd’s syndicate with total gross insurance reserves of approximately $67.0 million.
 
During 2010, Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 entered into RITC agreements with three Lloyd’s syndicates with total gross insurance reserves of approximately $192.6 million. The capital commitment to Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008, as at February 28, 2011, with respect to these three RITC agreements amounted to approximately £24.3 million (approximately $37.9 million), which was fully funded by the Company from available cash on hand.
 
In February 2011, Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 entered into RITC agreements with two Lloyd’s syndicates with total gross insurance reserves of approximately $129.6 million. The capital commitment to Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008, as at February 28, 2011, with respect to these two RITC agreements amounted to £21.3 million (approximately $33.3 million).


135


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
Fitzwilliam
 
In February 2010, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary Fitzwilliam Insurance Limited (“Fitzwilliam”), entered into a 100% quota share reinsurance agreement with Allianz Global Corporate & Specialty AG (UK) Branch (“Allianz”) with respect to a specific portfolio of run-off business of Allianz. Fitzwilliam received total assets and assumed total gross reinsurance reserves of approximately $112.6 million.
 
In July 2010, following the acquisition of the entire issued share capital of Glacier Insurance AG by Torus Insurance (Bermuda) Limited (“Torus”), Fitzwilliam entered into two quota share reinsurance agreements with Torus protecting the prior year reserve development of two portfolios of business reinsured by them: a 79% quota share of Torus’ 95% quota share reinsurance of Glacier Insurance AG, and a 75% quota share of Torus’ 100% quota share reinsurance of Glacier Reinsurance AG. Fitzwilliam received total assets and assumed total gross reinsurance reserves of approximately $105.0 million.
 
On December 3, 2010, Fitzwilliam entered into a 100% quota share reinsurance agreement with International Insurance Company of Hannover (“IICH”) with respect to a specific portfolio of run-off business. Fitzwilliam received total assets and assumed total net reinsurance reserves of approximately $137.1 million. In addition, the Company has provided a parental guarantee supporting the IICH obligations of Fitzwilliam in the amount of approximately £76.0 million (approximately $118.7 million). The amount of the guarantee will decrease over time in line with relevant independent actuarial assessments.
 
On December 31, 2010, Fitzwilliam entered into a 100% reinsurance agreement, administrative services agreement, and related transaction documents with three affiliates of CIGNA Corporation (“CIGNA affiliates”) pursuant to which Fitzwilliam has reinsured all of the run-off workers compensation and personal accident reinsurance business of those CIGNA affiliates. Pursuant to the transaction documents, the CIGNA affiliates have transferred assets into three reinsurance collateral trusts securing the obligations of Fitzwilliam under the reinsurance agreement and administrative services agreement. Fitzwilliam received total assets and assumed total net reinsurance reserves of approximately $190.5 million. Fitzwilliam transferred approximately $50 million of additional funds to the trusts to further support these obligations. The Company funded the contribution to the trusts through a draw on a new $115 million credit facility entered into with Barclays Bank PLC on December 29, 2010 (the “Enstar Facility”).
 
In addition to the trusts, the Company has provided a limited parental guarantee supporting certain obligations of Fitzwilliam in the amount of $79.7 million. The amount of the guarantee will increase or decrease over time under certain circumstances, but will always be subject to an overall maximum cap with respect to reinsurance liabilities.
 
Bosworth
 
In May 2010, a specific portfolio of run-off business underwritten by Mitsui Sumitomo Insurance Co., Ltd. of Japan was transferred to the Company’s 50.1% owned subsidiary, Bosworth Run-off Limited (“Bosworth”). This transfer, which occurred under Part VII of the U.K. Financial Services and Markets Act 2000, was approved by the U.K. Court and took effect on May 31, 2010. As a result of the transfer, Bosworth received total assets and assumed net reinsurance reserves of approximately $117.5 million. Shinsei owns the remaining 49.9% of Bosworth.
 
5.   RESTRICTED CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS
 
Restricted cash and cash equivalents were $656.2 million and $433.7 million as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The restricted cash and cash equivalents are used as collateral against letters of credit and as guarantee under trust agreements. Letters of credit are issued to ceding insurers as security for the obligations of insurance subsidiaries under reinsurance agreements with those ceding insurers.


136


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
6.   INVESTMENTS
 
Available-for-sale
 
The amortized cost and estimated fair value of the Company’s fixed maturity securities and short-term investments classified as available-for-sale were as follows:
 
                                 
                Gross
       
          Gross
    Unrealized
       
          Unrealized
    Holding
       
    Amortized
    Holding
    Losses
    Fair
 
    Cost     Gain     Non-OTTI     Value  
 
As at December 31, 2010
                               
U.S. government and agency
  $ 65,115     $ 766     $ (92 )   $ 65,789  
Non-U.S. government
    248,487       8,832       (314 )     257,005  
Corporate
    695,372       16,513       (1,615 )     710,270  
Residential mortgage-backed
    20,036       305       (234 )     20,107  
Commercial mortgage-backed
    19,667       2,083       (11 )     21,739  
Asset backed
    27,072       574       (346 )     27,300  
                                 
    $ 1,075,749     $ 29,073     $ (2,612 )   $ 1,102,210  
                                 
 
                                 
                Gross
       
          Gross
    Unrealized
       
          Unrealized
    Holding
       
    Amortized
    Holding
    Losses
    Fair
 
    Cost     Gain     Non-OTTI     Value  
 
As at December 31, 2009
                               
U.S. government and agency
  $ 14,079     $ 227     $     $ 14,306  
Non-U.S. government
    37,166       33       (13 )     37,186  
Corporate
    62,092       825       (867 )     62,050  
Residential mortgage-backed
    1,685       31       (160 )     1,556  
                                 
    $ 115,022     $ 1,116     $ (1,040 )   $ 115,098  
                                 
 
The following tables summarize the Company’s fixed maturity securities and short-term investments classified as available-for-sale in an unrealized loss position as well as the aggregate fair value and gross unrealized loss by length of time the security has continuously been in an unrealized loss position:
 
                                                 
    12 Months or Greater     Less Than 12 Months     Total  
    Fair
    Unrealized
    Fair
    Unrealized
    Fair
    Unrealized
 
As at December 31, 2010   Value     Losses     Value     Losses     Value     Losses  
 
U.S. government and agency
  $ 801     $     $ 22,976     $ (92 )   $ 23,777     $ (92 )
Non-U.S. government
    7,710       (32 )     31,128       (282 )     38,838       (314 )
Corporate
    22,039       (318 )     107,735       (1,297 )     129,774       (1,615 )
Residential mortgage-backed
    2,368       (168 )     11,274       (66 )     13,642       (234 )
Commercial mortgage-backed
    530       (10 )     1,516       (1 )     2,046       (11 )
Asset backed
    10,554       (346 )     87             10,641       (346 )
                                                 
    $ 44,002     $ (874 )   $ 174,716     $ (1,738 )   $ 218,718     $ (2,612 )
                                                 
 


137


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
                                                 
    12 Months or Greater     Less Than 12 Months     Total  
    Fair
    Unrealized
    Fair
    Unrealized
    Fair
    Unrealized
 
As at December 31, 2009   Value     Losses     Value     Losses     Value     Losses  
 
Non-U.S. government
  $     $     $ 782     $ (13 )   $ 782     $ (13 )
Corporate
    10,894       (786 )     5,348       (81 )     16,242       (867 )
Residential mortgage-backed
    369       (160 )                 369       (160 )
                                                 
    $ 11,263     $ (946 )   $ 6,130     $ (94 )   $ 17,393     $ (1,040 )
                                                 
 
As at December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2009, the number of securities classified as available-for-sale in an unrealized loss position was 136 and 20, respectively, with a fair value of $218.7 million and $17.3 million, respectively. Of these securities, the number of securities that had been in an unrealized loss position for twelve months or longer was 32 and 11, respectively.
 
The contractual maturities of the Company’s fixed maturity securities and short-term investments, classified as available-for-sale, are shown below. Actual maturities may differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.
 
                                 
    Amortized
    Fair
    % of Total
 
As at December 31, 2010   Cost     Value     Fair Value  
 
Due in one year or less
  $ 373,683     $ 379,203               34.4 %
Due after one year through five years
    625,463       643,252               58.3 %
Due after five years through ten years
    5,307       5,539               0.5 %
Due after ten years
    4,521       5,070               0.5 %
                                 
      1,008,974       1,033,064               93.7 %
Residential mortgage-backed
    20,036       20,107               1.8 %
Commercial mortgage-backed
    19,667       21,739               2.0 %
Asset backed
    27,072       27,300               2.5 %
                                 
    $ 1,075,749     $ 1,102,210               100.0 %
                                 
 
                                 
    Amortized
    Fair
    % of Total
 
As at December 31, 2009   Cost     Value     Fair Value  
 
Due in one year or less
  $ 64,202     $ 64,606               56.1 %
Due after one year through five years
    39,951       40,305               35.0 %
Due after five years through ten years
    5,811       5,783               5.0 %
Due after ten years
    3,373       2,848               2.5 %
                                 
      113,337       113,542               98.6 %
Residential mortgage-backed
    1,685       1,556               1.4 %
                                 
    $ 115,022     $ 115,098               100.0 %
                                 

138


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The following tables set forth certain information regarding the credit ratings (provided by major rating agencies) of the Company’s fixed maturity securities and short-term investments classified as available-for-sale:
 
                                 
    Amortized
    Fair
    % of Total
 
As at December 31, 2010   Cost     Value     Fair Value  
 
AAA
  $ 405,682     $ 416,526               37.8 %
AA
    267,917       273,500               24.8 %
A
    332,401       341,447               31.0 %
BBB or lower
    69,359       70,274               6.4 %
Not Rated
    390       463               0.0 %
                                 
    $ 1,075,749     $ 1,102,210               100.0 %
                                 
 
                         
    Amortized
    Fair
    % of Total
 
As at December 31, 2009   Cost     Value     Fair Value  
 
AAA
  $ 54,157     $ 54,229       47.1 %
AA
                %
A
    32,764       32,886       28.6 %
BBB or lower
    13,848       13,596       11.8 %
Not Rated
    14,253       14,387       12.5 %
                         
    $ 115,022     $ 115,098       100.0 %
                         
 
Held-to-maturity
 
As of September 30, 2010, the Company redesignated $1.33 billion in investment securities from the held-to-maturity category to the available-for-sale category, following the disposition of certain held-to-maturity securities in one of the Company’s Australian insurance subsidiaries. The speed of settlement of the liabilities in this subsidiary had been notably greater than was originally anticipated, prompting the Company to apply to the subsidiary’s regulator for a reduction in required capital levels. Upon the approval, on September 1, 2010, of the capital reduction in the amount of $148.2 million, the Company evaluated the funding alternatives relating to the capital distribution and, as a result, reconsidered its intent to hold certain securities to maturity and sold securities with a carrying value of $33.4 million that had previously been designated held-to-maturity. The proceeds from these sales were $36.5 million, resulting in a realized gain of $3.1 million.
 
During September 2010, requests were made to regulators, that are pending approval, for capital releases, in certain of the Company’s other insurance subsidiaries, for amounts that are also greater than was originally anticipated. Further to both approved and pending requests for capital releases greater than originally anticipated in certain of the Company’s insurance subsidiaries, the Company reevaluated its intent with respect to its remaining held-to-maturity securities. The Company concluded that, as of September 30, 2010, it no longer had the positive intent to hold its held-to-maturity securities to maturity. The Company does not plan to designate securities as held-to-maturity for at least two years and believes that maintaining its securities in the available-for-sale category provides greater flexibility in the management of the overall investment portfolio.
 
As a result of redesignation, the held-to-maturity securities with amortized cost of $1.15 billion as of September 30, 2010, were transferred to the available-for-sale category at the fair value of $1.33 billion, with unrealized gains of $18.0 million recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income.


139


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The amortized cost and estimated fair value of the Company’s fixed maturity securities and short-term investments classified as held-to-maturity as at December 31, 2009 were as follows:
 
                                 
                Gross
       
          Gross
    Unrealized
       
          Unrealized
    Holding
       
    Amortized
    Holding
    Losses
    Fair
 
    Cost     Gain     Non-OTTI     Value  
 
U.S. government and agency
  $ 164,706     $ 1,659     $ (196 )   $ 166,169  
Non-U.S. government
    276,506       3,069       (131 )     279,444  
Corporate
    780,099       15,794       (1,284 )     794,609  
Municipal
    9,649       6       (1 )     9,654  
Residential mortgage-backed
    15,894       165       (427 )     15,632  
Commercial mortgage-backed
    30,608       1,130       (1,970 )     29,768  
Asset backed
    34,078       477       (564 )     33,991  
                                 
    $ 1,311,540     $ 22,300     $ (4,573 )   $ 1,329,267  
                                 
 
The following table summarizes the Company’s fixed maturity securities and short-term investments classified as held-to-maturity in an unrealized loss position as at December 31, 2009 and the aggregate fair value and gross unrealized loss by length of time the security has continuously been in an unrealized loss position:
 
                                                 
    12 Months or Greater     Less Than 12 Months     Total  
    Fair
    Unrealized
    Fair
    Unrealized
    Fair
    Unrealized
 
    Value     Losses     Value     Losses     Value     Losses  
 
U.S. government and agency
  $     $     $ 53,674     $ (196 )   $ 53,674     $ (196 )
Non-U.S. government
                44,477       (131 )     44,477       (131 )
Corporate
    3,892       (249 )     153,220       (1,034 )     157,112       (1,283 )
Municipal
                8,641       (1 )     8,641       (1 )
Residential mortgage-backed
    2,109       (277 )     6,494       (151 )     8,603       (428 )
Commercial mortgage-backed
                11,931       (1,970 )     11,931       (1,970 )
Asset backed
    889       (86 )     21,817       (478 )     22,706       (564 )
                                                 
    $ 6,890     $ (612 )   $ 300,254     $ (3,961 )   $ 307,144     $ (4,573 )
                                                 
 
As at December 31, 2009, the number of fixed maturity securities classified as held-to-maturity in an unrealized loss position was 135, with a fair value of $307.1 million. Of these securities, the number of securities that had been in an unrealized loss position for 12 months or longer was 19.


140


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
Trading
 
The estimated fair value of investments in fixed maturity securities, short-term investments and equities classified as trading securities were as follows:
 
                 
    December 31,
    December 31,
 
    2010     2009  
 
U.S. government and agency
  $ 162,014     $ 61,920  
Non-U.S. government
    129,861        
Corporate
    637,114       25,033  
Municipal
    2,297        
Residential mortgage-backed
    82,399       456  
Commercial mortgage-backed
    17,102       641  
Asset backed
    1,313        
Equities
    60,082       24,503  
                 
    $ 1,092,182     $ 112,553  
                 
 
The following tables set forth certain information regarding the credit ratings (provided by major rating agencies) of the Company’s fixed maturity securities and short-term investments classified as trading:
 
                         
          % of Total
 
As at December 31, 2010   Fair Value     Fair Value  
 
AAA
  $ 395,881               38.4 %
AA
    177,302               17.2 %
A
    400,314               38.8 %
BBB or lower
    51,983               5.0 %
Not Rated
    6,620               0.6 %
                         
    $ 1,032,100               100.0 %
                         
 
Other Investments
 
                 
    December 31,
    December 31,
 
    2010     2009  
 
Private equities
  $ 104,109     $ 77,359  
Bond funds
    102,279        
Hedge fund
    22,037        
Other
    6,289       4,442  
                 
    $ 234,714     $ 81,801  
                 
 
As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, the Company had $104.1 million and $77.4 million, respectively, of other investments recorded in private equities which represented 2.4% and 2.3% of total investments and cash and cash equivalents as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. All of the Company’s investments in private equities are subject to restrictions on redemptions and sales that are determined by the governing documents and limit the Company’s ability to liquidate these investments in the short term. Due to a lag in the valuations reported by the managers, the Company records changes in the investment value with up to a three-month lag. These investments are accounted for at estimated fair value, determined by the Company’s proportionate share of the net asset value of the investee reduced by any impairment charges. As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, the Company had unfunded


141


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
capital commitments relating to its other investments of $84.7 million and $101.1 million, respectively. See Note 16 for details of other investments with related parties.
 
Our bond fund holdings comprise a number of positions in diversified bond mutual funds managed by third-party managers.
 
Other-Than-Temporary Impairment Process
 
The Company assesses whether declines in the fair value of its fixed maturity investments, both available-for-sale and held-to-maturity, represent impairments that are other-than-temporary by reviewing each fixed maturity investment that is impaired and: (1) determining if the Company has the intent to sell the fixed maturity investment or (2) determining if it is more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the fixed maturity investment before its anticipated recovery; and (3) assessing whether a credit loss exists, that is, where the Company expects that the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected from the fixed maturity investment are less than the amortized cost basis of the investment.
 
The Company had no planned sales of its fixed maturity investments classified as available-for-sale as at December 31, 2010 and 2009. In assessing whether it is more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell a fixed maturity investment before its anticipated recovery, the Company considers various factors including its future cash flow requirements, legal and regulatory requirements, the level of its cash, cash equivalents, short term investments and fixed maturity investments available for sale in an unrealized gain position, and other relevant factors. For the year ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, the Company did not recognize any other-than-temporary impairments due to required sales.
 
In evaluating credit losses, the Company considers a variety of factors in the assessment of a fixed maturity investment including: (1) the time period during which there has been a significant decline below cost; (2) the extent of the decline below cost and par; (3) the potential for the fixed maturity investment to recover in value; (4) an analysis of the financial condition of the issuer; (5) the rating of the issuer; and (6) failure of the issuer of the fixed maturity investment to make scheduled interest or principal payments.
 
Based on the factors described above, the Company determined that, as at December 31, 2010, no credit losses existed. As at December 31, 2009, a credit loss existed for two fixed maturity investments. The impairment of $0.9 million was included as part of the Company’s net earnings.
 
Fair Value of Financial Instruments
 
Fair value is defined as the price at which to sell an asset or transfer a liability (i.e. the “exit price”) in an orderly transaction between market participants. The Company uses a fair value hierarchy that gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets and the lowest priority to unobservable data. The hierarchy is broken down into three levels as follows:
 
  •  Level 1— Valuations based on unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the Company has the ability to access. Valuation adjustments and block discounts are not applied to Level 1 instruments.
 
  •  Level 2— Valuations based on quoted prices in active markets for similar assets or liabilities, quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in inactive markets, or for which significant inputs are observable (e.g. interest rates, yield curves, prepayment speeds, default rates, loss severities, etc.) or can be corroborated by observable market data.
 
  •  Level 3— Valuations based on inputs that are unobservable and significant to the overall fair value measurement. The unobservable inputs reflect the Company’s own judgment about assumptions that market participants might use.


142


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
 
The following is a summary of valuation techniques or models the Company uses to measure fair value by asset and liability classes.
 
Fixed Maturity Investments
 
The Company’s fixed maturity portfolio is managed by the Company’s Chief Investment Officer and outside investment advisors. The Company uses inputs from nationally recognized pricing services, including pricing vendors, index providers and broker-dealers to estimate fair value measurements for all of its fixed maturity investments. These pricing services include FT Interactive Data, Barclays Capital Aggregate Index (formerly Lehman Index), Reuters Pricing Service and others.
 
In general, the independent pricing services use observable market inputs including, but not limited to, investment yields, credit risks and spreads, benchmark curves, benchmarking of like securities, non-binding broker-dealer quotes, reported trades and sector groupings to determine the fair value. In addition, pricing services use valuation models, such as an Option Adjusted Spread model, to develop prepayment and interest rate scenarios. The Option Adjusted Spread model is commonly used to estimate fair value for securities such as mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities.
 
The following describes the techniques generally used to determine the fair value of the Company’s fixed maturities by asset class.
 
  •  U.S. government and agency securities consist of securities issued by the U.S. Treasury and mortgage pass- through agencies such as the Federal National Mortgage Association, the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation and other agencies. The significant inputs include the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades and broker-dealer quotes. These are considered to be observable market inputs and, therefore, the fair values of these securities are classified within Level 2.
 
  •  Non-U.S. government securities consist of bonds issued by non-U.S. governments and agencies along with supranational organizations. The significant inputs include the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades and broker-dealer quotes. These are considered to be observable market inputs and, therefore, the fair values of these securities are classified within Level 2.
 
  •  Corporate securities consist primarily of investment-grade debt of a wide variety of corporate issuers and industries. The fair values of these securities are determined using the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, benchmark yields, and industry and market indicators. These are considered observable market inputs and, therefore, the fair values of these securities are classified within Level 2. Where pricing is unavailable from pricing services, the Company obtains non-binding quotes from broker-dealers. This is generally the case when there is a low volume of trading activity and current transactions are not orderly. In this event, securities are classified within Level 3. As at December 31, 2010, the Company had one corporate security classified as Level 3.
 
  •  Municipal securities consist primarily of bonds issued by U.S.-domiciled state and municipal entities. The fair values of these securities are determined using the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes and benchmark yields. These are considered observable market inputs and, therefore, the fair values of these securities are classified within Level 2.
 
  •  Asset-backed securities consist primarily of investment-grade bonds backed by pools of loans with a variety of underlying collateral. The significant inputs used to determine the fair value of these securities includes the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades, benchmark yields, broker-dealer quotes, prepayment speeds, and default rates. These are considered observable market inputs and, therefore, the fair values of these securities are classified within Level 2.
 
  •  Residential and commercial mortgage-backed securities include both agency and non-agency originated securities. The significant inputs used to determine the fair value of these securities include the spread above


143


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
  the risk-free yield curve, reported trades, benchmark yields, broker-dealer quotes, prepayment speeds, and default rates. These are considered observable market inputs and, therefore, the fair values of these securities are classified within Level 2. Where pricing is unavailable from pricing services, the Company obtains non-binding quotes from broker-dealers. This is generally the case when there is a low volume of trading activity and current transactions are not orderly. In this event, securities are classified within Level 3. As at December 31, 2010, the Company had one commercial mortgage-backed security classified as Level 3.
 
To validate the techniques or models used by the pricing services, the Company compares the fair value estimates to its knowledge of the current market and will challenge any prices deemed not to be representative of fair value.
 
As of December 31, 2010, there were no material differences between the prices obtained from the pricing services and the fair value estimates developed by the Company.
 
Equity Securities
 
The Company’s equity securities are managed by two external advisors. Through these third parties, the Company uses nationally recognized pricing services, including pricing vendors, index providers and broker-dealers to estimate fair value measurements for all of its equity securities. These pricing services include FT Interactive Data and others.
 
The Company has categorized all of its investments in common stock as Level 1 investments because the fair values of these securities are based on quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. The Company has categorized all of its investments in preferred stock as Level 2 (except one which was categorized as Level 3) because their fair value estimates are based on observable market data.
 
Other Investments
 
For its investments in private equities, the Company measures fair value by obtaining the most recently published net asset value as advised by the external fund manager or third-party administrator. The use of net asset value as an estimate of the fair value for investments in certain entities that calculate net asset value is a permitted practical expedient. The Company’s private equity investments are mainly in the financial services industry. The fund advisors continue to evaluate the overall market environment, as well as specific areas in the financial services sector, in order to identify segments they believe will offer the most attractive investment opportunities. The financial statements of each fund generally are audited annually under U.S. GAAP, using fair value measurement for the underlying investments. For all publicly-traded companies within the funds, the Company has valued those investments based on the latest share price. The value of Affirmative Investment LLC (in which the Company owns a non-voting 7% membership interest) is based on the market value of the shares of Affirmative Insurance Holdings, Inc., a publicly-traded company.
 
All of the Company’s investments in private equities are subject to restrictions on redemptions and sales that are determined by the governing documents and limit the Company’s ability to liquidate those investments in the short term. These restrictions have been in place since the initial investment. The capital commitments are discussed in detail in Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements.
 
The Company has classified private equities as Level 3 investments because they reflect the Company’s own judgment about the assumptions that market participants might use.
 
For its investment in the hedge fund, the Company measures fair value by obtaining the most recently published net asset value as advised by the external fund manager or third-party administrator. The use of net asset value as an estimate of the fair value for investments in certain entities that calculate net asset value is a permitted practical expedient. The adviser of the fund intends to seek attractive risk-adjusted total returns for the fund’s investors by acquiring, originating, and actively managing a diversified portfolio of debt securities, with a focus on


144


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
various forms of asset-backed securities and loans. The fund will focus on investments that the adviser believes to be fundamentally undervalued with current market prices that are believed to be compelling relative to intrinsic value. The units of account that are valued by the Company are its interests in the fund and not the underlying holdings of such fund. Thus, the inputs used by the Company to value its investment in the fund may differ from the inputs used to value the underlying holdings of such fund. The hedge fund is not currently eligible for redemption due to imposed lock-up periods of three years from the time of the initial investment. Once eligible, redemptions will be permitted quarterly with 90 days notice. There are no unfunded capital commitments in relation to the hedge fund. The investment in the fund is classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.
 
The bond funds in which the company invests have been classified as Level 2 investments because their fair value is estimated using the net asset value reported by Bloomberg and they have daily liquidity.
 
Fair Value Measurements
 
In accordance with the provisions of the Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure topic of the Codification, the Company has categorized its investments that are recorded at fair value among levels as follows:
 
                                 
    December 31, 2010  
    Quoted Prices in
                   
    Active Markets
    Significant Other
    Significant
       
    for Identical Assets
    Observable Inputs
    Unobservable Inputs
    Total Fair
 
    (Level 1)     (Level 2)     (Level 3)     Value  
 
U.S. government and agency
  $     $ 227,803     $     $ 227,803  
Non-U.S. government
          386,866             386,866  
Corporate
          1,346,854       530       1,347,384  
Municipal
          2,297             2,297  
Residential mortgage-backed
          102,506             102,506  
Commercial mortgage-backed
          37,927       914       38,841  
Asset backed
          28,613             28,613  
Equities
    56,369       138       3,575       60,082  
Other investments
          102,279       132,435       234,714  
                                 
Total investments
  $ 56,369     $ 2,235,283     $ 137,454     $ 2,429,106  
                                 
 
                                 
    December 31, 2009  
    Quoted Prices in
                   
    Active Markets
    Significant Other
    Significant
       
    for Identical Assets
    Observable Inputs
    Unobservable Inputs
    Total Fair
 
    (Level 1)     (Level 2)     (Level 3)     Value  
 
U.S. government and agency
  $     $ 76,226     $     $ 76,226  
Non-U.S. government
          37,186             37,186  
Corporate
          87,083             87,083  
Residential mortgage-backed
          2,012             2,012  
Commercial mortgage-backed
                641       641  
Equities
    21,203             3,300       24,503  
Other investments
                81,801       81,801  
                                 
Total investments
  $ 21,203     $ 202,507     $ 85,742     $ 309,452  
                                 


145


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The following table presents a reconciliation of the beginning and ending balances for all investments measured at fair value on a recurring basis using Level 3 inputs during the year ended December 31, 2010:
 
                                 
    Fixed
                   
    Maturity
    Other
    Equity
       
    Investments     Investments     Securities     Total  
 
Level 3 investments as of January 1, 2010
  $ 641     $ 81,801     $ 3,300     $ 85,742  
Net purchases (sales and distributions)
    579       36,052             36,631  
Total realized and unrealized losses
    224       14,582       275       15,081  
Net transfers in and/or (out) of Level 3
                       
                                 
Level 3 investments as of December 31, 2010
  $ 1,444     $ 132,435     $ 3,575     $ 137,454  
                                 
 
The amount of net gains/(losses) for the year included in earnings attributable to the fair value of changes in assets still held at December 31, 2010 was $16.3 million. Of this amount, $0.5 million was included in net realized and unrealized gains/(losses) and $15.8 million was included in net investment income.
 
The following table presents a reconciliation of the beginning and ending balances for all investments measured at fair value on a recurring basis using Level 3 inputs during the year ended December 31, 2009:
 
                                 
    Fixed
                   
    Maturity
    Other
    Equity
       
    Investments     Investments     Securities     Total  
 
Level 3 investments as of January 1, 2009
  $ 352     $ 60,237     $     $ 60,589  
Net purchases (sales and distributions)
          15,967       2,006       17,973  
Total realized and unrealized losses
    289       5,597       1,294       7,180  
Net transfers in and/or (out) of Level 3
                       
                                 
Level 3 investments as of December 31, 2009
  $ 641     $ 81,801     $ 3,300     $ 85,742  
                                 
 
The amount of net gains/(losses) for the year included in earnings attributable to the fair value of changes in assets still held at December 31, 2009 was $6.5 million. Of this amount, $1.6 million was included in net realized and unrealized gains/(losses) and $4.9 million was included in net investment income.
 
During the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, proceeds from sales and maturities of available-for-sale securities were $347.2 million, $688.2 million and $263.3 million, respectively. Gross realized gains on sale of available-for-sale securities were $1.6 million, $0.8 million and $0.3 million, respectively, and gross realized losses on sale of available-for-sale securities were $nil, $1.6 million and $0.1 million, respectively. Unrealized gains on trading securities were $5.3 million and $4.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
 
Major categories of net investment income are summarized as follows:
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
 
Interest from cash and cash equivalents and short-term investments
  $ 15,951     $ 27,938     $ 71,342  
Interest from fixed maturities
    59,187       42,842       26,549  
Other
    14,277       12,935       13,217  
Amortization of bond premiums and discounts
    (9,304 )     (5,716 )     1,278  
Other investments
    21,470       5,201       (84,117 )
Investment expenses
    (1,675 )     (1,829 )     (1,668 )
                         
    $ 99,906     $ 81,371     $ 26,601  
                         


146


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
Restricted Investments
 
The Company is required to maintain investments on deposit with various regulatory authorities to support its insurance and reinsurance operations. The investments on deposit are available to settle insurance and reinsurance liabilities. The Company also utilizes trust accounts to collateralize business with its insurance and reinsurance counterparties. These trust accounts generally take the place of letter of credit requirements. The investments in trust as collateral are primarily highly rated fixed maturity securities. The carrying value of the Company’s restricted investments as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 was as follows:
 
                 
    2010     2009  
 
Assets used for collateral in trust for third-party agreements
  $ 371,834     $ 214,149  
Deposits with regulatory authorities
    33,970       12,998  
Others
    62,437        
                 
    $ 468,241     $ 227,147  
                 
 
7.   DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS
 
In October 2010, the Company entered into a foreign currency forward exchange contract as part of its overall foreign currency risk management strategy. On the value date, June 30, 2011, the Company will sell AU$45.0 million for $42.5 million. The contract exchange rate is AU$1 for $0.9439. As at December 31, 2010, the fair value of the contract was $(3.6) million, the effect of which the Company has recognized as a foreign exchange loss included as part of its net earnings.
 
8.   REINSURANCE BALANCES RECEIVABLE
 
                 
    2010     2009  
 
Recoverable from reinsurers on:
               
Outstanding losses
  $ 425,336     $ 263,545  
Losses incurred but not reported
    141,118       102,220  
Fair value adjustments
    (41,014 )     (18,037 )
                 
Total reinsurance reserves recoverable
    525,440       347,728  
Paid losses
    436,002       290,534  
                 
    $ 961,442     $ 638,262  
                 
 
The fair value adjustment, determined on acquisition of reinsurance subsidiaries, was based on the estimated timing of loss and loss adjustment expense recoveries and an assumed interest rate equivalent to a risk free rate for securities with similar duration to the reinsurance receivables acquired plus a spread to reflect credit risk, and is amortized over the estimated recovery period, as adjusted for accelerations on commutation settlements, using the constant yield method.
 
The Company’s acquired reinsurance subsidiaries, prior to acquisition, used retrocessional agreements to reduce their exposure to the risk of insurance and reinsurance assumed. The Company remains liable to the extent that retrocessionaires do not meet their obligations under these agreements, and therefore, the Company evaluates and monitors concentration of credit risk among its reinsurers. Provisions are made for amounts considered potentially uncollectible.


147


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
At December 31, 2010, the Company’s top 10 reinsurers accounted for 75.5% of reinsurance recoverables (which includes loss reserves recoverable and recoverables on paid losses) and included $99.6 million of IBNR recoverable (December 31, 2009: $87.1 million). Reinsurance recoverables by reinsurer were as follows:
 
                                 
    2010     2009  
    Reinsurance           Reinsurance        
    Recoverable     % of Total     Recoverable     % of Total  
 
Top 10 reinsurers
  $ 726,201       75.5 %   $ 529,743       83.0 %
Other reinsurers’ balances > $1 million
    36,504       3.8 %     16,408       2.6 %
Other reinsurers’ balances < $1 million
    198,737       20.7 %     92,111       14.4 %
                                 
Total
  $ 961,442       100.0 %   $ 638,262       100.0 %
                                 
 
At December 31, 2010 and 2009, the provision for uncollectible reinsurance relating to losses recoverable was $381.4 million and $397.6 million, respectively. To estimate the provision for uncollectible reinsurance recoverables, the reinsurance recoverables are first allocated to applicable reinsurers. This determination is based on a detailed process rather than an estimate, although an element of judgment is applied. As part of this process, ceded IBNR is allocated by reinsurer.
 
The Company uses a detailed analysis to estimate uncollectible reinsurance. The primary components of the analysis are reinsurance recoverable balances by reinsurer and bad debt provisions applied to these balances to determine the portion of a reinsurer’s balance deemed to be uncollectible. These provisions require considerable judgment and are determined using the current rating, or rating equivalent, of each reinsurer (in order to determine their ability to settle the reinsurance balances) as well as other key considerations and assumptions, such as claims and coverage issues.
 
As at December 31, 2010 and 2009, reinsurance receivables with a carrying value of $398.8 million and $409.6 million, respectively, were associated with two and three reinsurers, respectively, which each represented 10% or more of total reinsurance balances receivable. As at December 31, 2010, the two reinsurers had credit ratings of AA- or higher. In the event that all or any of the reinsuring companies are unable to meet their obligations under existing reinsurance agreements, the Company will be liable for such defaulted amounts.
 
9.   INVESTMENT IN PARTLY OWNED COMPANY
 
On June 13, 2008, the Company’s indirect subsidiary Virginia completed the acquisition from Dukes Place Holdings, L.P. (a portfolio company of GSC European Mezzanine Fund II, L.P.) of 44.4% of the outstanding capital stock of Stonewall, which at that time was the parent of two Rhode Island-domiciled insurers in run-off, Stonewall Insurance Company and Seaton. The total purchase price, including acquisition costs, was $21.4 million and was funded from available cash on hand. Stonewall entered into a definitive agreement on December 3, 2009 for the sale of its shares in Stonewall Insurance Company to Columbia Insurance Company, an affiliate of National Indemnity Company (an indirect subsidiary of Berkshire Hathaway, Inc.), for a sale price of $56.0 million, subject to certain post-closing purchase price adjustments that brought the total consideration received to $60.4 million. The transaction received the required regulatory approval on March 31, 2010 and subsequently closed on April 7, 2010. The proceeds received by Stonewall were later distributed between Dukes Place Holdings, L.P. and Virginia. The investment was carried on the equity basis until the distribution. When the Company carries an investment on the equity basis, the investment is initially recorded at cost and adjusted to reflect the Company’s share of after-tax earnings or losses and unrealized investment gains and losses and reduced by dividends.
 
As discussed in Note 3 above, on August 3, 2010, Virginia acquired 55.6% of the shares of Seaton that it previously did not own for $nil consideration, resulting in Virginia owning 100% of Seaton. The acquisition of the Seaton shares was a result of the distribution by Stonewall of proceeds and certain other assets following its sale of Stonewall Insurance Company. Virginia received 100% of the final $1.4 million distribution from Stonewall.


148


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The balance of the investment in partly owned company was $nil and $20.9 million at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
 
10.   LOSSES AND LOSS ADJUSTMENT EXPENSES
 
                 
    2010     2009  
 
Outstanding
  $ 2,122,168     $ 1,555,112  
Incurred but not reported
    1,467,239       1,221,463  
Fair value adjustment
    (298,132 )     (297,439 )
                 
    $ 3,291,275     $ 2,479,136  
                 
 
The fair value adjustment, or FVA, represents the difference between the carrying value of reserves of acquired companies at the date of acquisition and the fair value of the reserves. The fair value of reserves is based on the estimated timing of reserve settlements discounted at a risk free rate and a risk margin determined by management. The FVA is amortized over the estimated payout period, as adjusted for accelerations on commutation settlements, using the constant yield method.
 
In establishing the reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses related to asbestos and environmental claims, management considers facts currently known and the current state of the law and coverage litigation. Liabilities are recognized for known claims (including the cost of related litigation) when sufficient information has been developed to indicate the involvement of a specific insurance policy, and management can reasonably estimate its liability. In addition, reserves have been established to cover additional exposures on both known and unasserted claims. Estimates of the reserves are reviewed and updated continually. Developed case law and adequate claim history do not exist for such claims, especially because significant uncertainty exists about the outcome of coverage litigation and whether past claim experience will be representative of future claim experience.
 
In view of the changes in the legal and tort environment that affect the development of such claims, the uncertainties inherent in valuing asbestos and environmental claims are not likely to be resolved in the near future. Ultimate values for such claims cannot be estimated using traditional reserving techniques and there are significant uncertainties in estimating the amount of the Company’s potential losses for these claims.
 
There can be no assurance that the reserves established by the Company will be adequate or will not be adversely affected by the development of other latent exposures. The Company’s liability for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 included $736.2 million and $667.6 million, respectively, that represented an estimate of its net ultimate liability for asbestos and environmental claims. The gross liability for such claims as at December 31, 2010 and 2009 was $825.2 million and $751.0 million, respectively.


149


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The table below provides a reconciliation of the beginning and ending reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008. Losses incurred and paid are reflected net of reinsurance recoverables.
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
 
Balance as at January 1
  $ 2,479,136     $ 2,798,287     $ 1,591,449  
Less: total reinsurance reserves recoverable
    347,728       394,575       427,964  
                         
      2,131,408       2,403,712       1,163,485  
Effect of exchange rate movement
    (3,836 )     73,512       (124,989 )
Net reduction in ultimate losses and loss adjustment expense liabilities
    (311,834 )     (259,627 )     (242,104 )
Net losses paid
    (294,996 )     (257,414 )     (174,013 )
Acquired on purchase of subsidiaries
    459,362       114,595       1,408,046  
Retroactive reinsurance contracts assumed
    785,731       56,630       373,287  
                         
Net balance as at December 31
    2,765,835       2,131,408       2,403,712  
Plus: total reinsurance reserves recoverable
    525,440       347,728       394,575  
                         
Balance as at December 31
  $ 3,291,275     $ 2,479,136     $ 2,798,287  
                         
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 was due to the following:
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
 
Net losses paid
  $ (294,996 )   $ (257,414 )   $ (174,013 )
Net change in case and LAE reserves
    336,141       214,079       147,576  
Net change in IBNR
    236,920       318,160       187,874  
                         
Reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses
    278,065       274,825       161,437  
Reduction in provisions for bad debt
    49,556       11,718       36,136  
Reduction in provisions for unallocated loss adjustment expense liabilities
    39,651       50,412       69,056  
Amortization of fair value adjustments
    (55,438 )     (77,328 )     (24,525 )
                         
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
  $ 311,834     $ 259,627     $ 242,104  
                         
 
Net reduction in case and loss adjustment expense reserves, or LAE reserves, comprises the movement during the year in specific case reserve liabilities as a result of claims settlements or changes advised to the Company by its policyholders and attorneys, less changes in case reserves recoverable advised by the Company to its reinsurers as a result of the settlement or movement of assumed claims. Net reduction in incurred but not reported, or IBNR, represents the change in the Company’s actuarial estimates of losses incurred but not reported.
 
Year Ended December 31, 2010
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2010 was $311.8 million, excluding the impact of foreign exchange rate movements of $3.8 million and including both net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities of $19.0 million relating to companies and portfolios acquired during the year and premium and commission adjustments triggered by incurred losses of $16.5 million.


150


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2010 of $311.8 million was attributable to a reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $278.1 million, a reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debts of $49.6 million and a reduction in estimates of unallocated loss adjustment expense liabilities of $39.7 million, relating to 2010 run-off activity, partially offset by the amortization, over the estimated payout period, of fair value adjustments relating to companies acquired amounting to $55.4 million.
 
The reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $278.1 million comprised net incurred favorable loss development of $41.1 million and reductions in IBNR reserves of $236.9 million. The decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $236.9 million was comprised of $67.8 million relating to asbestos liabilities, $4.2 million relating to environmental liabilities and $164.9 million relating to all other remaining liabilities. The reduction in IBNR was a result of the application, on a basis consistent with the assumptions applied in the prior period, of the Company’s actuarial methodologies to loss data to estimate loss reserves required to cover liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses. The prior period estimate of net IBNR liabilities was reduced as a result of the combined impact of loss development activity during 2010, including commutations and the favorable trend of loss development related to non-commuted policies compared to prior forecasts. The net incurred favorable loss development of $41.1 million, resulting from settlement of net advised case and LAE reserves of $336.1 million for net paid losses of $295.0 million, related to the settlement of non-commuted losses in the year and approximately 90 commutations of assumed and ceded exposures. Commutations provide an opportunity for the Company to exit exposures to entire policies with insureds and reinsureds at a discount to the previous estimated ultimate liability. As a result of exiting all exposures to such policies, all advised case reserves and IBNR liabilities relating to that insured or reinsured are eliminated. This often results in a net gain irrespective of whether the settlement exceeds the advised case reserves. The Company adopts a disciplined approach to the review and settlement of non-commuted claims through claims adjusting and the inspection of underlying policyholder records such that settlements of assumed exposures may often be achieved below the level of the originally advised loss, and settlements of ceded receivables may often be achieved at levels above carried balances. Of the 90 commutations completed during 2010, three related to the Company’s top ten insured and/or reinsured exposures, including one commutation completed shortly after December 31, 2009 whereby the related reduction in IBNR reserves was recorded in the reduction in net ultimate losses for the year ended December 31, 2009, and one related to the commutation of one of the Company’s largest ceded reinsurance assets. The remaining 86 commutations, of which approximately 43% were completed during the three months ended December 31, 2010, were of a smaller size, consistent with the Company’s approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships, as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships. The combination of the claims settlement activity in 2010, including commutations (but excluding the impact of the commutation that was completed subsequent to the year ended December 31, 2009) and the actuarial estimation of IBNR reserves required for the remaining non-commuted exposures (which took into account the favorable trend of loss development in 2010 related to such exposures compared to prior forecasts), resulted in the Company’s management concluding that the loss development activity that occurred subsequent to the prior reporting period provided sufficient new information to warrant a reduction in IBNR reserves of $236.9 million in 2010.
 
The reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debt of $49.6 million was a result of the collection, primarily during the three months ended December 31, 2010, of certain reinsurance receivables against which bad debt provisions had been provided in earlier periods.
 
Year Ended December 31, 2009
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2009 was $259.6 million, excluding the impact of adverse foreign exchange rate movements of $73.5 million and including both net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities of $4.8 million relating to companies acquired during the year and premium and commission adjustments of $5.5 million triggered by incurred losses.


151


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2009 of $259.6 million was attributable to a reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $274.8 million, a reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debts of $11.7 million and a reduction in estimates of loss adjustment expense liabilities of $50.4 million, relating to 2009 run-off activity, partially offset by the amortization, over the estimated payout period, of fair value adjustments relating to companies acquired amounting to $77.3 million.
 
The reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $274.8 million comprised net incurred loss development of $43.3 million and reductions in IBNR reserves of $318.2 million. The decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $318.2 million was comprised of $158.4 million relating to asbestos liabilities, $17.0 million relating to environmental liabilities and $142.8 million relating to all other remaining liabilities. The reduction in IBNR is a result of the application, on a basis consistent with the assumptions applied in the prior period, of the Company’s actuarial methodologies to loss data to estimate loss reserves required to cover liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses. The prior period estimate of net IBNR liabilities was reduced as a result of the combined impact of loss development activity during 2009, including commutations and the favorable trend of loss development related to non-commuted policies compared to prior forecasts. The net incurred loss development of $43.3 million resulting from settlement of net advised case and LAE reserves of $214.1 million for net paid losses of $257.4 million, related to the settlement of non-commuted losses in the year and approximately 79 commutations of assumed and ceded exposures. Of the 79 commutations completed during 2009, two related to the Company’s top ten insured and/or reinsured exposures. The remaining 77 were of a smaller size, consistent with the Company’s approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships, as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships. Approximately 76% of commutations completed in 2009 related to commutations completed during the three months ended December 31, 2009. Subsequent to the year end, one of the Company’s insurance entities completed a commutation of another of one of its top ten reinsured exposures. The combination of the claims settlement activity in 2009, including commutations, and the actuarial estimation of IBNR reserves required for the remaining non-commuted exposures (which took into account the favorable trend of loss development in 2009 related to such exposures compared to prior forecasts, as well as the impact of the commutation that was completed subsequent to the year end), resulted in the Company’s management concluding that the loss development activity that occurred subsequent to the prior reporting period provided sufficient new information to warrant a reduction in IBNR reserves of $318.2 million in 2009.
 
The reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debt of $11.7 million was a result of the collection, primarily during the three months ended March 31, 2009, of certain reinsurance receivables against which bad debt provisions had been provided in earlier periods.
 
Year Ended December 31, 2008
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2008 was $242.1 million, excluding the impacts of favorable foreign exchange rate movements of $36.1 million (relating to companies acquired in 2007 and earlier) and including both net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities of $149.4 million relating to companies acquired during the year and premium and commission adjustments of $0.1 million triggered by incurred losses.
 
The net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities for 2008 of $242.1 million was attributable to a reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $161.4 million, a reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debt of $36.1 million (excluding $3.1 million relating to one of the Company’s entities that benefited from substantial stop loss reinsurance protection discussed below) and a reduction in estimates of loss adjustment expense liabilities of $69.1 million, relating to 2008 run-off activity, partially offset by the amortization, over the estimated payout period, of fair value adjustments relating to companies acquired amounting to $24.5 million.


152


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $161.4 million comprised the following:
 
(i) A reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $21.7 million in one of the Company’s insurance entities that benefited from substantial stop loss reinsurance protection. Net incurred loss development relating to this entity of $21.6 million was offset by reductions in IBNR reserves of $94.8 million and reductions in provisions for bad debt of $3.1 million, resulting in a net reduction in estimates of ultimate losses of $76.3 million. The entity in question benefited, until December 18, 2008, from substantial stop loss reinsurance protection whereby $54.6 million of the net reduction in ultimate losses of $76.3 million was ceded to a single AA- rated reinsurer such that the Company retained a reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses relating to this entity of $21.7 million. On December 18, 2008, the Company commuted the stop loss reinsurance protection with the reinsurer for the receipt of $190.0 million payable by the reinsurer to it over four years together with interest compounded at 3.5% per annum. The commutation resulted in no significant financial impact to the Company. The decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $94.8 million for this one insurance entity was comprised of $77.7 million relating to asbestos liabilities, $9.0 million relating to environmental liabilities and $8.1 million relating to all other remaining liabilities. The reduction in IBNR is a result of the application, on a basis consistent with the assumptions applied in the prior period, of the Company’s actuarial methodologies to loss data to estimate loss reserves required to cover liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses. The prior period estimate of net IBNR liabilities was reduced as a result of the combined impact of loss development activity during 2008, which was comprised of the settlement of certain advised case reserves below their prior period carried amounts, commutations completed and the trend of loss development relating to non-commuted policies compared to prior forecasts. The net incurred loss development relating to this entity of $21.6 million, whereby advised net case reserves of $25.0 million were settled for net paid losses of $46.6 million, primarily related to six commutations of assumed and ceded liabilities completed during 2008. As a result of exiting all exposures to such policies, all advised case reserves and IBNR liabilities relating to that insured or reinsured were eliminated. This often results in a net gain irrespective of whether the settlement exceeds the advised case reserves. Of the six commutations completed for this entity, of which the three largest were completed during the three months ended December 31, 2008, one was among its top ten assumed exposures. The remaining five commutations were of a smaller size, consistent with the Company’s approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships, as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships. The combination of the claims settlement activity in 2008, including commutations, combined with the actuarial estimation of IBNR reserves required for the remaining non-commuted exposures (which took into account the favorable trend of loss development in 2008 related to such exposures compared to prior forecasts), resulted in the Company’s management concluding that the loss development activity that occurred subsequent to the prior reporting period provided sufficient new information to warrant a reduction in IBNR reserves of $94.8 million for this one insurance entity in 2008.
 
(ii) A reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses of $139.7 million in the Company’s other insurance and reinsurance entities comprised net favorable incurred loss development of $24.1 million and reductions in IBNR reserves of $115.6 million. The decrease in the estimate of IBNR loss reserves of $115.6 million was comprised of $23.8 million relating to asbestos liabilities, $1.8 million relating to environmental liabilities and $90.0 million relating to all other remaining liabilities. The reduction in IBNR is a result of the application, on a basis consistent with the assumptions applied in the prior period, of the Company’s actuarial methodologies to loss data to estimate loss reserves required to cover liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses. The prior period estimate of net IBNR liabilities was reduced as a result of the combined impact of favorable loss development activity during 2008, which was comprised of the settlement of advised case reserves below their prior period carried amounts, commutations completed and the favorable trend of loss development related to non-commuted policies compared to prior forecasts. The net favorable incurred loss development in the Company’s remaining insurance and reinsurance entities of $24.1 million, whereby net advised case and LAE reserves of $123.5 million were settled for net paid losses of $99.4 million, primarily


153


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
related to the settlement of non-commuted losses in the year below carried reserves and approximately 59 commutations of assumed and ceded exposures at less than case and LAE reserves. Of the 59 commutations completed during 2008 for the Company’s other reinsurance and insurance companies, two (both of which were completed during the three months ended December 31, 2008) were among its top ten insured and/or reinsured exposures. The remaining 57 were of a smaller size, consistent with the Company’s approach of targeting significant numbers of cedant and reinsurer relationships, as well as targeting significant individual cedant and reinsurer relationships.
 
Approximately 82% of commutations completed in 2008 related to commutations completed during the three months ended December 31, 2008. The combination of the claims settlement activity in 2008, including commutations, with the actuarial estimation of IBNR reserves required for the remaining noncommuted exposures (which took into account the favorable trend of loss development in 2008 related to such exposures compared to prior forecasts), resulted in the Company’s management concluding that the loss development activity that occurred subsequent to the prior reporting period provided sufficient new information to warrant a reduction in IBNR reserves of $115.6 million for the Company’s remaining insurance and reinsurance entities in 2008.
 
One of the Company’s reinsurance companies had retrocessional arrangements providing for full reinsurance of all risks assumed. During the year, this entity commuted its largest assumed liability and related retrocessional protection whereby the subsidiary paid net losses of $222.0 million and reduced net IBNR by the same amount, resulting in no gain or loss to the Company.
 
The reduction in aggregate provisions for bad debt of $36.1 million (excluding $3.1 million relating to one of the Company’s entities that benefited from substantial stop loss reinsurance protection discussed above) was comprised of: (1) $13.7 million as a result of the collection, primarily during the three months ended December 31, 2008, of certain reinsurance receivables against which bad debt provisions had been provided in earlier periods, (2) $8.5 million as a result of the revision of estimates of bad debt provisions following the receipt of new information during the three months ended December 31, 2008 and (3) $13.9 million as a result of reduced exposures to reinsurers with bad debt provisions following the commutation of assumed liabilities.
 
11.   LOANS PAYABLE
 
The Company’s long-term debt consists of loan facilities used to partially finance certain of the Company’s acquisitions or significant new business transactions along with a loan outstanding in relation to the share repurchase agreements (the “Repurchase Agreements”) entered into with three of its executives and certain trusts and a corporation affiliated with the executives. The Company draws down on the loan facilities at the time of the acquisition or significant new business transaction, although in some circumstances the Company has made additional draw-downs to refinance existing debt of the acquired company. The Company incurred interest expense on its loan facilities and loan outstanding relating to the Repurchase Agreements of $10.3 million and $17.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.


154


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
Total amounts of loans payable outstanding as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 totaled $245.3 million and $255.0 million, respectively, and were comprised as follows:
 
                         
          December 31,
    December 31,
 
Facility   Date of Facility     2010     2009  
 
Cumberland — Facility B
    March 4, 2008     $     $ 67,071  
Unionamerica — Facility A
    December 30, 2008       71,259       155,268  
Unionamerica — Facility B
    December 30, 2008       154       32,622  
Knapton
    April 20, 2010       21,532        
Enstar Group — Facility A
    December 29, 2010       52,100        
Enstar Group — Facility B
    December 29, 2010       62,900        
                         
Total long-term bank debt
            207,945       254,961  
Repurchase Agreements
    October 1, 2010       37,333        
                         
Total loans payable
          $ 245,278     $ 254,961  
                         
 
Cumberland
 
In February 2008, the Company’s wholly-owned subsidiary, Cumberland Holdings Limited (“Cumberland”) entered into a term facility agreement jointly with a London-based bank and a German bank (the “Cumberland Facility”). On March 4, 2008, Cumberland drew down AU$215.0 million (approximately $197.5 million) from the Facility A commitment (“Cumberland Facility A”) and AU$86.0 million (approximately $79.0 million) from the Facility B commitment (“Cumberland Facility B”) to partially fund the Gordian acquisition.
 
The interest rate on Cumberland Facility A was LIBOR plus 2.00% and was repayable in five years. Cumberland had fully repaid Cumberland Facility A as of December 31, 2009.
 
The interest rate on Cumberland Facility B was LIBOR plus 2.75% and was repayable in six years. The outstanding Cumberland Facility B loan balance as of December 31, 2009 was approximately AU$74.7 million (approximately $67.1 million). Cumberland had fully repaid Cumberland Facility B as of December 31, 2010.
 
Unionamerica
 
On December 30, 2008, in connection with the Unionamerica Holdings Limited acquisition, Royston borrowed the full amount of $184.6 million available under a term facilities agreement (the “Unionamerica Facilities Agreement”) with National Australia Bank Limited (“NABL”). Of that amount, Royston borrowed $152.6 million under Facility A (“Unionamerica Facility A”) and $32.0 million under Facility B (“Unionamerica Facility B”).
 
Unionamerica Facility A was partially repaid in December 2010, and as of December 31, 2010, the remaining outstanding loan balance, inclusive of accrued interest, was $71.3 million compared to $155.3 million as of December 31, 2009. Unionamerica Facility B was fully repaid in December 2010, and as of December 31, 2010, the remaining outstanding balance of $0.2 million related to accrued interest outstanding. As of December 31, 2009, the outstanding Unionamerica Facility B loan balance, inclusive of accrued interest, was $32.6 million.
 
The loans are secured by a lien covering all of the assets of Royston. Unionamerica Facility A is repayable within three years from October 3, 2008, the date of the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement. Unionamerica Facility B was repayable within four years from October 3, 2008. On August 4, 2009, Royston entered into an amendment and restatement of the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement pursuant to which: (1) NABL’s participation in the original $184.6 million facility was reduced from 100% to 50%, with Barclays Bank PLC providing the remaining 50%; (2) the guarantee provided by the Company of all of the obligations of Royston under the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement was terminated; and (3) the interest rate on the Facility A portion was reduced from LIBOR


155


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
plus 3.50% to LIBOR plus 2.75% and the interest rate on the Facility B portion was reduced from LIBOR plus 4.00% to LIBOR plus 3.25%.
 
During the existence of a payment default, the interest rates will be increased by 1.00%. During the existence of any event of default (as specified in the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement), the lenders may declare that all amounts outstanding under the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement are immediately due and payable, declare that all borrowed amounts be paid upon demand, or proceed against the security. Amounts outstanding under the Unionamerica Facilities Agreement are also subject to acceleration by the lenders in the event of a change of control of Royston, successful application by Royston or certain of its affiliates (other than the Company) for listing on a stock exchange, or total amounts outstanding under the facilities decreasing below $10.0 million. The Unionamerica Facilities Agreement contains various financial and business covenants for Unionamerica Facilities A and B. As of December 31, 2010, all of the financial covenants relating to the Unionamerica facilities were met. The Flowers Fund has a 30% non-voting equity interest in Royston Holdings Ltd., the direct parent company of Royston.
 
In January 2011, the accrued interest outstanding of $0.2 million relating to Unionamerica Facility B was settled. In addition, on March 3, 2011, the Company repaid an additional $40.5 million of the outstanding loan balance of Unionamerica Facility A. As of March 3, 2011, the remaining outstanding loan balance of Unionamerica Facility A, inclusive of accrued interest, was $30.6 million.
 
Knapton
 
In April 2010, Knapton Holdings entered into the Knapton Facility, a term facility agreement with a London-based bank. On April 20, 2010, Knapton Holdings drew down $21.4 million from the Knapton Facility to partially refinance the acquisition of Knapton. The interest rate on the Knapton Facility is LIBOR plus 2.75%. The Knapton Facility is repayable in three years and is secured by a first charge over Knapton Holding’s shares in Knapton. The Knapton Facility contains various financial and business covenants, including limitations on mergers and consolidations involving Knapton Holdings and its subsidiaries. As of December 31, 2010, all of the covenants relating to the Knapton Facility were met and the outstanding loan balance, inclusive of accrued interest, was $21.5 million.
 
EGL Facility
 
On July 16, 2010, the Company entered into the EGL Facility, an unsecured term facility agreement with a London-based bank. On July 19, 2010, the Company drew down $25.0 million from the EGL Facility to fund the acquisition of PWAC. The interest rate on the EGL Facility was LIBOR plus 2.75% and was repayable in three months. The EGL Facility contained various financial and business undertakings. On September 13, 2010, the Company fully repaid the EGL Facility.
 
Enstar Group
 
On December 29, 2010, the Company, as borrower, and certain of its subsidiaries, as guarantors, entered into a term facility agreement with a London-based bank (the “Enstar Facilities Agreement”). On December 30, 2010, the Company drew down $52.1 million from the Facility A commitment (“Enstar Facility A”) and $62.9 million from the Facility B commitment (“Enstar Facility B”). The drawdown of Enstar Facility B was used to partially fund the obligations of one of the Company’s subsidiaries under the CIGNA reinsurance transaction with the remainder being used for general corporate purposes. The drawdown of Enstar Facility A was used to repay internal group loans. As of December 31, 2010, the outstanding loan balances, inclusive of accrued interest, related to Enstar Facilities A and B were $52.1 million and $62.9 million, respectively.
 
The loans are secured by a pledge of the shares of certain of the Company’s subsidiaries. Both Enstar Facilities A and B must be repaid in three equal annual installments on the anniversary date of the Enstar Facilities Agreement. Interest is payable quarterly and the interest rate on both Enstar Facilities A and B is LIBOR plus 3.00%. The Enstar Facilities Agreement terminates on December 29, 2013.


156


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
During the existence of a payment default, the interest rates will be increased by 1.00%. During the existence of any event of default (as specified in the Enstar Facilities Agreement), the lenders may declare that all or a portion of amounts outstanding under the Enstar Facilities Agreement are immediately due and payable, declare that all or a portion of borrowed amounts be paid upon demand, or proceed against the security. The Enstar Facilities Agreement contains various financial and business covenants for Enstar Facilities A and B. As of December 31, 2010, all of the financial covenants relating to the Enstar Facilities A and B were met.
 
Clarendon
 
On March 4, 2011, the Company, through Clarendon Holdings, Inc., entered into a $106.5 million term facility agreement (the “Clarendon Facility”) with a London-based bank. The Clarendon Facility provides for a four-year term loan facility, which will be available to be drawn to fund up to 50% of the purchase price of Clarendon. As of March 4, 2011, Clarendon Holdings, Inc. has not borrowed any of the amount available under the Clarendon Facility.
 
The Clarendon Facility will be secured by a security interest in all of the assets of Clarendon Holdings, Inc., as well as a first priority lien on the stock of both Clarendon Holdings, Inc. and Clarendon. Interest is payable at the end of each interest period chosen by Clarendon Holdings, Inc. or, at the latest, each six months. The interest rate is LIBOR plus 2.75%. The Clarendon Facility is subject to various financial and business covenants, including limitations on mergers and consolidations, restrictions as to disposition of stock and limitations of liens on the stock.
 
During the existence of any payment default, the interest rate is increased by 1.0%. During the existence of any event of default (as specified in the term facility agreement), the lenders may declare all or a portion of outstanding amounts immediately due and payable, declare all or a portion of borrowed amounts payable upon demand, or proceed against the security. The Clarendon Facility terminates and all amounts borrowed must be repaid on the fourth anniversary of the date the term loan is made.
 
The fair values of the Company’s floating rate loans approximate their book value.
 
Share repurchase agreements
 
On October 1, 2010, the Company entered into the Repurchase Agreements with three of its executives and certain trusts and a corporation affiliated with the executives to repurchase an aggregate of 800,000 ordinary shares of the Company at a price of $70.00 per share. The Company repurchased an aggregate of 600,000 ordinary shares from Dominic F. Silvester (the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board of Directors) and a trust of which he and his immediate family are the sole beneficiaries, 100,000 ordinary shares from a trust of which Paul J. O’Shea (the Company’s Joint Chief Operating Officer, Executive Vice President and a member of its Board of Directors) and his immediate family are the sole beneficiaries and 100,000 ordinary shares from a corporation owned by a trust of which Nicholas A. Packer (the Company’s Joint Chief Operating Officer and Executive Vice President) and his immediate family are the sole beneficiaries. The repurchase transactions closed on October 14, 2010. The aggregate purchase price of $56.0 million is payable by the Company through promissory notes to the selling shareholders. The annual interest rate for the notes is fixed at 3.5%, and the notes are repayable in three equal installments on December 31, 2010, December 1, 2011 and December 1, 2012. In connection with the Repurchase Agreements, the Company entered into lock-up agreements with each of Messrs. Silvester, O’Shea and Packer, and their respective family trusts and corporation. The lock-up agreements prohibit future sales and transfers of shares now owned or subsequently acquired for two years from the date of the Repurchase Agreements. On December 31, 2010, the Company repaid $18.7 million of the promissory notes and $0.4 million of accrued interest.


157


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
12.   SHARE CAPITAL
 
As at December 31, 2010 and 2009, the authorized share capital was 156,000,000 ordinary shares, par value $1.00 per share. The following table is a summary of changes in ordinary shares issued and outstanding:
 
Issued and fully paid ordinary shares of par value $1.00 each —
 
                 
    2010     2009  
 
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 13,581     $ 13,334  
Issue of shares
    80       170  
Shares repurchased
    (800 )      
Share awards granted/vested
    79       77  
                 
Balance, end of year
  $ 12,940     $ 13,581  
                 
 
Issued and fully paid non-voting convertible ordinary shares of par value $1.00 each —
 
                 
    2010     2009  
 
Balance, beginning and end of year
  $ 2,973     $ 2,973  
                 
 
13.   ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
 
Accumulated other comprehensive income as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 was comprised of foreign currency translation adjustments and unrealized holding gains on investments arising during the year.
 
                 
    2010     2009  
 
Foreign currency translation adjustments
  $ 26,588     $ 4,112  
Defined benefit pension liability
    (1,000 )      
Unrealized holding gains on investments
    9,429       4,597  
                 
    $ 35,017     $ 8,709  
                 
 
14.   EMPLOYEE BENEFITS
 
a) Summary
 
Components of salaries and benefits are summarized as follows:
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
 
Salaries and benefits
  $ 50,978     $ 41,534     $ 38,675  
Defined contribution pension plan expense
    3,477       3,060       2,596  
2004-2005 employee share plan
                608  
2006 equity plan
    1,500              
Annual incentive plan
    30,722       23,860       14,391  
                         
Total salaries and benefits
  $ 86,677     $ 68,454     $ 56,270  
                         
 
b) Pension plan
 
The Company provides pension benefits to eligible employees through various plans sponsored by the Company. All pension plans, except as disclosed below, are structured as defined contribution plans. Pension expense for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 was $3.5 million, $3.1 million and $2.6 million, respectively.


158


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
The Company acquired, as part of the acquisition of PWAC, a noncontributory defined benefit pension plan (the “PWAC Plan”) that covers substantially all PWAC employees hired before April 1, 2003 and provides pension and certain death benefits. Effective April 1, 2004, PWAC froze the PWAC Plan. As at the date of acquisition of PWAC by the Company, the PWAC Plan had an unfunded liability of $6.7 million that had been accrued by PWAC. Subsequent to acquisition, an actuarial review was performed of the PWAC Plan which determined that the PWAC Plan’s unfunded liability, as at December 31, 2010, was $7.9 million. As at December 31, 2010, PWAC had an accrued liability of $7.9 million for the unfunded PWAC Plan liability.
 
The Company recorded pension expense relating to the PWAC Plan, for the period from the date of acquisition to December 31, 2010, of $0.6 million.
 
c) Employee share plans
 
Employee stock awards for 2010 are summarized as follows:
 
                 
          Weighted
 
          Average Fair
 
    Number of
    Value of
 
    Shares     the Award  
 
Nonvested — January 1
    1,636     $ 102  
Granted
    238,465       16,214  
Vested
    (86,171 )     (5,829 )
                 
Nonvested — December 31
    153,930     $ 13,019  
                 
 
i) 2006-2010 Annual Incentive Plan, 2011-2015 Annual Incentive Compensation Program and 2006 Equity Incentive Plan
 
For the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, 78,664, 64,378 and 27,140 shares were awarded to directors, officers and employees under the 2006 Equity Incentive Plan. The total value of the awards for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 was $5.4 million, $3.3 million and $2.6 million, respectively, and was charged against the 2006-2010 Annual Incentive Plan accrual established for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. On February 23, 2011, the Company adopted The Enstar Group Limited 2011-2015 Annual Incentive Compensation Program.
 
In addition, during the year ended December 31, 2010, 153,930 restricted shares were awarded to certain employees under the 2006 Equity Incentive Plan. The total unrecognized compensation cost related to the non-vested share awards as at December 31, 2010 was $9.0 million. These costs are expected to be recognized evenly over the next 4.9 years. Compensation costs of $1.5 million relating to the share awards were recognized in the Company’s statement of earnings for the year ended December 31, 2010.
 
The accrued expense relating to the 2006-2010 Annual Incentive Plan for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 was $30.7 million, $23.9 million and $14.4 million, respectively.
 
ii) Enstar Group Limited Employee Share Purchase Plan
 
On February 26, 2008, the Company’s board of directors approved the Amended and Restated Enstar Group Limited Employee Share Purchase Plan (the “Purchase Plan”), and subsequently, on June 11, 2008, the Company’s shareholders approved the Purchase Plan at the Annual General Meeting.
 
Compensation costs of less than $0.1 million relating to the shares issued have been recognized in the Company’s statement of earnings for each of the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008. As at December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, 5,871, 5,588 and 2,695 shares, respectively, have been issued to employees under the Purchase Plan.


159


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
(d) Options
 
                         
          Weighted
       
          Average
    Intrinsic
 
    Number of
    Exercise
    Value of
 
    Shares     Price     Shares  
 
Outstanding — January 1, 2010
    327,586     $ 29.49     $ 14,261  
Granted
                 
Exercised
    (175,571 )     25.11       (7,604 )
Forfeited
                 
                         
Outstanding — December 31, 2010
    152,015     $ 34.55     $ 7,606  
                         
 
Stock options outstanding and exercisable as of December 31, 2010 were as follows:
 
                         
            Weighted Average
    Number of
  Weighted Average
  Remaining
Ranges of Exercise Prices   Options   Exercise Price   Contractual Life
 
$10 — $20
    49,037     $ 19.63       0.7 years  
$40 — $60
    102,978       41.65       2.7 years  
 
(e) Deferred Compensation and Stock Plan for Non-Employee Directors
 
For the years ended December 31 2010, 2009 and 2008, 6,463, 7,147 and 4,631 restricted share units, respectively, were credited to the accounts of Non-Employee Directors under the Enstar Group Limited Deferred Compensation and Ordinary Share Plan for Non-Employee Directors (the “Deferred Compensation Plan”).
 
Following Gregory Curl’s resignation from the board of directors, 1,606 restricted share units previously credited to his account under the Deferred Compensation Plan were converted into the same number of the Company’s ordinary shares on September 10, 2010 with fractional shares paid in cash. Also on September 10, 2010, 1,383 restricted stock units previously credited to Mr. Curl’s account under a deferred compensation plan assumed in the Company’s merger with Enstar USA, Inc., now a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, were converted into the same number of the Company’s ordinary shares.
 
Following T. Wayne Davis’ resignation from the board of directors in 2009, 1,576 restricted share units previously credited to his account under the Deferred Compensation Plan were converted into the same number of the Company’s ordinary shares on April 1, 2009, with fractional shares paid in cash. Also on April 1, 2009, 14,146 restricted stock units previously credited to Mr. Davis’ account under a deferred compensation plan assumed in the Company’s merger with Enstar USA, Inc., now a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, were converted into the same number of the Company’s ordinary shares.


160


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
15.   EARNINGS PER SHARE
 
The following table sets forth the comparison of basic and diluted earnings per share for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008:
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
 
Basic earnings per share:
                       
Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited
  $ 174,086     $ 135,210     $ 81,551  
Weighted average shares outstanding — basic
    13,489,221       13,514,207       12,638,333  
                         
Earnings per share attributable to Enstar Group Limited — basic
  $ 12.91     $ 10.01     $ 6.45  
                         
Diluted earnings per share:
                       
Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited
  $ 174,086     $ 135,210     $ 81,551  
Weighted average shares outstanding — basic
    13,489,221       13,514,207       12,638,333  
Share equivalents:
                       
Unvested shares
    125,733       4,822       16,959  
Restricted share units
    16,423       8,988       3,889  
Options
    119,879       216,644       262,294  
                         
Weighted average shares outstanding — diluted
    13,751,256       13,744,661       12,921,475  
                         
Earnings per share attributable to Enstar Group Limited — diluted
  $ 12.66     $ 9.84     $ 6.31  
                         
 
16.   RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
 
The Company has entered into certain transactions with companies and partnerships that are affiliated with J. Christopher Flowers and John J. Oros. Mr. Flowers is a member of the Company’s board of directors and one of the largest shareholders of the Company. Mr. Oros was the Company’s Executive Chairman and a member of the Company’s board of directors until his resignation on August 20, 2010.
 
  •  The Company earned management fees for advisory services provided to the Flowers Fund, a private investment fund, for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 of $0.3 million, $0.7 million and $0.9 million, respectively.
 
  •  The Company had, as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, excluding its investment in Varadero International Ltd. (“Varadero”) investments in entities affiliated with Messers. Flowers and Oros with a total value of $96.1 million, $76.1 million and $54.5 million, respectively, and outstanding commitments to entities managed by Messers. Flowers and Oros, for the same periods, of $84.6 million, $98.1 million and $104.0 million, respectively. The Company’s outstanding commitments may be drawn down over approximately the next five years. As at December 31, 2010, the related party investments associated with Messrs. Flowers and Oros accounted for 99.9% of the total unfunded capital commitments of the Company and 50.3% of the total amount of investments classified as other investments by the Company.
 
  •  On October 1, 2010, the Company entered into the Repurchase Agreements with three of its executives and certain trusts and a corporation affiliated with the executives to repurchase an aggregate of 800,000 of the Company’s ordinary shares at a price of $70.00 per share. The Company repurchased an aggregate of 600,000 ordinary shares from Dominic F. Silvester (the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board of Directors) and a trust of which he and his immediate family are the sole beneficiaries, 100,000 ordinary shares from a trust of which Paul J. O’Shea (the Company’s Joint Chief Operating Officer, Executive Vice President and a member of its Board of Directors) and his immediate family are the sole


161


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
  beneficiaries and 100,000 ordinary shares from a corporation owned by a trust of which Nicholas A. Packer (the Company’s Joint Chief Operating Officer and Executive Vice President) and his immediate family are the sole beneficiaries. The repurchase transactions closed on October 14, 2010. The aggregate purchase price of $56.0 million is payable by the Company through promissory notes to the selling shareholders. The annual interest rate for the notes is fixed at 3.5%, and the notes are repayable in three equal installments on December 31, 2010, December 1, 2011 and December 1, 2012. In connection with the Repurchase Agreements, the Company entered into lock-up agreements with each of Messrs. Silvester, O’Shea and Packer, and their respective family trusts and corporation. The lock-up agreements prohibit future sales and transfers of shares now owned or subsequently acquired for two years from the date of the Repurchase Agreements.
 
  •  On August 9, 2010, the Company entered into a participation agreement for $1 million with Flowers National Bank, an entity owned by Mr. Flowers. Flowers National Bank purchased a pool of mortgage loans from the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.
 
  •  In March 2010, the Company committed to invest $20.0 million in Varadero, a hedge fund. The investment manager of Varadero is Varadero Capital, L.P., of which Varadero GP, LLC is the general partner. Both the investment manager and general partner are partially owned by an entity affiliated with Messrs. Flowers and Oros. As of December 31, 2010, the Company had funded 100% of its commitment to Varadero.
 
  •  On November 12, 2009, the Company invested approximately $4.0 million in Flowers Sego-Carrus Holdings, LLC (“FSC”), a joint venture between the Company, an unaffiliated third party and Flowers National Bank, an entity owned by Mr. Flowers. FSC purchased two mortgage loans from the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.
 
  •  On January 28, 2009, the Company invested approximately $8.7 million in JCF III Co-invest I L.P., an entity affiliated with J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC, in connection with its investment in certain of the operations, assets and liabilities of OneWest Bank FSB (formerly known as IndyMac Bank, F.S.B.).
 
  •  In July 2008, FPK acted as lead managing underwriter in the Company’s sale to the public of 1,372,028 ordinary shares, inclusive of the underwriters’ over-allotment, at a public offering price of $87.50 per share (the “Offering”). The underwriters purchased the shares at a 2% discount to the public offering price. The Company received net proceeds of approximately $116.8 million in the Offering. An affiliate of the Flowers Fund controlled approximately 41% of FPK until its sale of FPK in December 2009. In addition, the Flowers Fund and certain of its affiliated investment partnerships purchased 285,714 ordinary shares with a value of approximately $25.0 million in the Offering at the public offering price.
 
  •  In March 2006, Enstar and Shinsei Bank Limited (“Shinsei”), completed the acquisition of Brampton (formerly Aioi Insurance Company of Europe Limited). The acquisition was effected through Hillcot, in which Enstar held at that date a 50.1% economic interest and Shinsei held at that date the remaining 49.9%. Enstar and Shinsei made capital contributions to Hillcot to fund the acquisition in proportion to their economic interests. Mr. Flowers is a director and the largest shareholder of Shinsei. On October 27, 2008, the company distributed to Shinsei $27.1 million representing its 49.9% share of the consideration received on the sale of Hillcot Re.
 
  •  During 2008, the Flowers Fund funded approximately $145.0 million for its share of the economic interest in the acquisitions of Gordian, Guildhall, Shelbourne, Goshawk, EPIC and Unionamerica.
 
  •  In February 2008, the Company entered into an AU$301.0 million (approximately $285.0 million) joint loan facility with an Australian and a German bank. The Flowers Fund is a significant shareholder of the German bank.


162


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
 
In November 2008, Enstar (US) Inc. entered into a lease agreement for use of office space with one of its directors running to 2011. For the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, Enstar (US) Inc. incurred rent expense of $0.2 million, $0.2 million and $0.1 million, respectively.
 
17.   LITIGATION
 
The Company, in common with the insurance and reinsurance industry in general, is subject to litigation and arbitration in the normal course of its business operations. While the outcome of the litigation cannot be predicted with certainty, the Company is disputing and will continue to dispute all allegations that management believes are without merit. As of December 31, 2010, the Company was not a party to any material litigation or arbitration outside its normal course of business operations.
 
18.   TAXATION
 
Income tax expense for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 was $87.1 million, $27.6 million, and $46.9 million, respectively.
 
Under current Bermuda law, the Company and its Bermuda subsidiaries are not required to pay any taxes in Bermuda on their income or capital gains. The Company has received an undertaking from the Minister of Finance in Bermuda that, in the event of any taxes being imposed, the Company and its Bermuda subsidiaries will be exempt from taxation in Bermuda until March 2016.
 
The Company has operating subsidiaries and branch operations in the United Kingdom, Australia, the United States and Europe and is subject to federal, foreign, state and local taxes in those jurisdictions. In addition, certain distributions from some foreign sources may be subject to withholding taxes.
 
The expected income tax provision for the foreign operations computed on pre-tax income at the weighted-average tax rate has been calculated as the sum of the pre-tax income in each jurisdiction multiplied by that jurisdiction’s applicable statutory tax rate.
 
The actual income tax rate for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 differed from the amount computed by applying the effective rate of 0% under the Bermuda law to earnings before income taxes as shown in the following reconciliation:
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
 
Earnings before income tax
  $ 261,218     $ 162,815     $ 128,405  
                         
Expected tax rate
    0.0 %     0.0 %     0.0 %
Foreign taxes at local expected rates
    28.7 %     52.1 %     44.8 %
Benefit of loss carryovers
    (1.5 )%           (1.0 )%
Change in uncertain tax positions
    (0.1 )%     (0.8 )%     (2.6 )%
Change in valuation allowance
    (5.1 )%     (28.4 )%     (4.7 )%
Impact of Australian tax consolidation
    11.6 %            
Other
    (0.2 )%     (5.9 )%      
                         
Effective tax rate
    33.4 %     17.0 %     36.5 %
                         
 
During the three months ended December 31, 2010, in order to mitigate the tax impacts of inter-group transactions, the board of directors of the Company’s Australian subsidiaries elected to form a consolidated tax group. The impact of this tax consolidation resulted in the resetting of the cost base of certain assets of our Australian subsidiaries which is estimated to result in an additional tax liability of approximately $30.3 million.


163


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
Deferred income taxes arise from the recognition of temporary differences between income determined for financial reporting purposes and income tax purposes. The tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of the deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities are presented in the table below:
 
                 
    As of December 31,  
    2010     2009  
 
Deferred tax assets
               
Benefit of losses, deductions, and other carryforwards
  $ 143,680     $ 71,407  
Claims reserves, principally due to discounting for tax
    10,082       11,111  
Allowance for doubtful accounts receivable
          7,006  
Investments
          1,959  
                 
      153,762       91,483  
                 
Deferred tax liabilities
               
Investments
    (15,745 )      
Other
    (1,355 )     (2,672 )
                 
      (17,100 )     (2,672 )
                 
Net deferred tax asset before valuation allowance
    136,662       88,811  
Valuation allowance
    (133,506 )     (57,574 )
                 
Net deferred tax asset
  $ 3,156     $ 31,237  
                 
 
As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, U.K. insurance subsidiaries and branch operations had tax loss carryforwards, which do not expire, and deductions available for tax purposes of approximately $404.0 million and $212.7 million, respectively. Certain of the Company’s U.K. insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries have tax loss carryforwards that arose prior to acquisition. Under U.K. tax law, these tax loss carryforwards are available to offset future taxable income generated by the acquired company without time limit.
 
As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, U.S. subsidiaries had deductible losses for tax purposes of approximately $27.0 million and $21.0 million, respectively. Under U.S. tax law, these tax losses can be carried forward and could be available to offset future taxable income of the companies that experienced the losses.
 
The Company has made estimates of future taxable income of foreign subsidiaries and has provided a valuation allowance in respect of those loss carryforwards where it does not expect to realize a benefit. The Company has considered all available evidence using a “more likely than not” standard in determining the amount of the valuation allowance.
 
The Company has unrecognized tax benefits of $5.6 million, $5.7 million and $8.1 million relating to uncertain tax positions as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.
 
During the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, there were certain reductions to unrecognized tax benefits due to the expiration of statutes of limitations of $0.3 million, $3.5 million and $3.5 million, respectively, which were included in net earnings.


164


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of unrecognized tax benefits is as follows:
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
 
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 5,727     $ 8,056     $ 13,115  
Gross increases — tax positions related to the current year
          835       2,204  
Gross increases — tax positions related to prior years
    113       413       644  
Gross decreases — tax positions related to the current year
                (557 )
Gross decreases — tax positions related to prior years
                (3,297 )
Lapse of statute of limitations
    (274 )     (3,577 )     (4,053 )
                         
Balance, end of year
  $ 5,566     $ 5,727     $ 8,056  
                         
 
Included in the balances at December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 were $4.4 million, $5.1 million and $4.2 million, respectively, of tax positions for which the ultimate deductibility is highly certain but for which there is uncertainty about the timing of such deductibility. Because of the impact of deferred tax accounting, other than interest and penalties, the disallowance of the shorter deductibility period would not affect the annual effective tax rate but would accelerate the payment of cash to the taxing authority to an earlier period.
 
It is reasonably possible that the amount of unrecognized tax benefits with respect to certain of the unrecognized tax positions could decrease by up to approximately $70,000 within the next 12 months if the statute of limitations expires on certain tax periods.
 
The Company recognizes accrued interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits as a part of income tax expense. During the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009, and 2008 the Company recognized a benefit for the reversal of interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits due to the expiration of the statute of limitations in the amount of $0.1 million, $0.5 million and $0.8 million, respectively. The Company had approximately $1.0 million, $0.9 million and $1.2 million accrued for the payment of interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits at December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.
 
The Company’s operating subsidiaries in specific countries may be subject to audit by various tax authorities and may have different statutes of limitations expiration dates. With limited exceptions, the Company’s major subsidiaries that operate in the United States, United Kingdom and Australia are no longer subject to tax examinations for years before 2005, 2008 and 2005, respectively.
 
Because the Company operates in many jurisdictions, its net earnings are subject to risk due to changing tax laws and tax rates around the world. The current, rapidly changing economic environment may increase the likelihood of substantial changes to tax laws in the jurisdictions in which it operates. The Company cannot predict what, if any, legislation, will actually be proposed or enacted, or what the effect of any such legislation might be on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.
 
19.   STATUTORY REQUIREMENTS (Unaudited)
 
The Company’s insurance and reinsurance operations are subject to insurance laws and regulations in the jurisdictions in which they operate, including Bermuda, Australia, the United States, Europe and the United


165


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
Kingdom. Statutory capital and surplus as reported to the relevant regulatory authorities for the insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries of the Company as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 was as follows:
 
                                                                                 
    Bermuda   U.K.   Australia   U.S.   Europe
    December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
    2010   2009   2010   2009   2010   2009   2010   2009   2010   2009
 
Minimum required statutory capital and surplus
  $ 112,593     $ 54,022     $ 66,445     $ 54,777     $ 128,576     $ 186,107     $ 42,476     $ 9,205     $ 25,785     $ 52,523  
Actual statutory capital and surplus
  $ 613,867     $ 428,624     $ 945,451     $ 604,390     $ 224,256     $ 337,962     $ 94,543     $ 16,791     $ 126,392     $ 130,404  
 
                                                                                 
    Bermuda   UK   Australia   U.S.   Europe
    December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
  December 31,
    2010   2009   2010   2009   2010   2009   2010   2009   2010   2009
 
Statutory income
  $ 66,718     $ 43,534     $ 130,105     $ 45,986     $ (1,934 )   $ 30,614     $ 4,940     $ 5,609     $ 62,440     $ 134,517  
Maximum available for dividends
  $ 422,043     $ 272,686     $ 441,794     $ 80,652     $ 95,681     $ 151,793     $ 3,902     $     $ 8,361     $ 6,052  
 
The statutory capital and surplus required by the relevant regulatory authorities in any jurisdiction may be significantly in excess of the minimum required statutory capital and surplus and, as a result, the maximum available for dividends may be lower.
 
20.   COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
 
The Company leases office space under operating leases expiring in various years through 2016. The leases are renewable at the option of the lessee under certain circumstances. The following is a schedule of future minimum rental payments on non-cancellable leases as of December 31, 2010:
 
         
2011
  $ 3,205  
2012
    2,772  
2013
    1,819  
2014
    1,447  
2015
    852  
2016
    169  
         
    $ 10,264  
         
 
Rent expense for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 was $2.9 million, $2.7 million and $2.5 million, respectively.
 
In 2006, the Company committed to invest up to $100.0 million in the Flowers Fund. As of December 31, 2010, the capital contributed to the Flowers Fund was $97.1 million, with the remaining unfunded commitment being approximately $2.9 million.
 
As at December 31, 2010, the Company has guaranteed the obligations of two of its subsidiaries in respect of letters of credit issued on their behalf by London-based banks in the amount of £12.0 million (approximately $18.7 million) in respect of capital commitments to Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 and £7.5 million (approximately $11.7 million) in respect of insurance contract requirements of one of the subsidiaries. As of February 28, 2011, the Company’s total guarantee has increased to £19.0 million (approximately $29.7 million) in respect of its increased capital commitment to Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008. The guarantees will be triggered should losses incurred by the subsidiaries exceed available cash on hand resulting in the letters of credit being drawn. As at December 31, 2010, the Company had not recorded any liabilities associated with the guarantees.


166


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
As at December 31, 2010, the Company provided guarantees supporting the obligations of one of its subsidiaries in respect of the acquisition, by the subsidiary, of two portfolios of insurance and reinsurance businesses in run-off. The total guarantee provided is approximately $198.4 million and will increase or decrease over time in line with relevant independent actuarial assessments, but will always be subject to an overall maximum cap with respect to reinsurance liabilities.
 
On September 10, 2008, the Company made a commitment to invest in aggregate $100.0 million in J.C. Flowers Fund III L.P. (“Fund III”). The Company’s commitment may be drawn down by Fund III over approximately the next five years. As of December 31, 2010, the capital contributed to the fund was $18.3 million with the remaining outstanding commitment being $81.7 million. Fund III is a private investment fund advised by J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC. J. Christopher Flowers, a member of the Company’s board of directors and one of its largest shareholders, is the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC. John J. Oros, the Company’s Executive Chairman and a member of its board of directors until his resignation on August 20, 2010, is a Managing Director of J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC.
 
The Company has made a capital commitment of up to $10.0 million in the GSC European Mezzanine Fund II, LP (“GSC”). GSC invests in mezzanine securities of middle and large market companies throughout Western Europe. As of December 31, 2010, the capital contributed to GSC was $9.9 million, with the remaining commitment being $0.1 million.
 
On November 8, 2010, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Kenmare, entered into a definitive agreement for the purchase of CitiLife Financial Limited from Citigroup Insurance Holding Corporation, an affiliate of Citigroup Inc. The purchase price is €30 million (approximately $40.2 million) and is expected to be financed from available cash on hand. Completion of the transaction is conditioned on, among other things, regulatory approval and satisfaction of various customary closing conditions. The transaction is expected to close in the first quarter of 2011.
 
On December 22, 2010, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Clarendon Holdings, Inc., entered into a definitive agreement for the purchase of Clarendon from Clarendon Insurance Group, Inc., an affiliate of Hannover Re. The purchase price is approximately $200 million and will be financed in part by a bank loan facility provided by a London-based bank entered into on March 4, 2011 and in part from available cash on hand. Completion of the transaction is conditioned on, among other things, regulatory approval and satisfaction of various customary closing conditions. The transaction is expected to close in the second quarter of 2011.
 
In February 2011, Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 entered into RITC agreements with two Lloyd’s syndicates with total gross insurance reserves of approximately $129.6 million. The capital commitment to Lloyd’s Syndicate 2008 with respect to these two RITC agreements amounted to £21.3 million (approximately $33.3 million).
 
21.   SEGMENT INFORMATION
 
The determination of reportable segments is based on how senior management monitors the Company’s operations. The Company measures the results of its operations under two major business categories: consulting and reinsurance.
 
The Company’s consulting segment comprises the operations and financial results of those subsidiaries that provide management and consulting services, forensic claims inspections services and reinsurance collection services to third-party clients, as well as to the Company’s reinsurance segment, in return for management fees. The Company provides consulting and management services through its subsidiaries located in the United States, Bermuda and Europe to large multinational company clients with insurance and reinsurance companies and portfolios in run-off relating to risks spanning the globe. As a result, extracting and quantifying revenues attributable to certain geographic locations would be impracticable given the global nature of the business.


167


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
All of the consulting fees for the reinsurance segment relate to intercompany fees paid to the consulting segment.
 
                         
    Consulting     Reinsurance     Total  
 
2010
                       
Consulting fees
  $ 84,054     $ (61,039 )   $ 23,015  
Net investment income
    461       99,445       99,906  
Net realized and unrealized gains
          13,137       13,137  
                         
      84,515       51,543       136,058  
                         
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities:
                       
Reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses
          (278,065 )     (278,065 )
Reduction in provisions for bad debt
          (49,556 )     (49,556 )
Reduction in provisions for unallocated loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
          (39,651 )     (39,651 )
Amortization of fair value adjustments
          55,438       55,438  
                         
            (311,834 )     (311,834 )
Salaries and benefits
    50,684       35,993       86,677  
General and administrative expenses
    28,288       30,913       59,201  
Interest expense
          10,253       10,253  
Net foreign exchange loss (gain)
    420       (818 )     (398 )
                         
      79,392       (235,493 )     (156,101 )
                         
Earnings before income taxes and share of net earnings of party owned company
    5,123       287,036       292,159  
Income taxes
    33       (87,165 )     (87,132 )
Share of net earnings of partly owned company
          10,704       10,704  
                         
Net earnings
    5,156       210,575       215,731  
Less: Net earnings attributable to noncontrolling interest
          (41,645 )     (41,645 )
                         
Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited
  $ 5,156     $ 168,930     $ 174,086  
                         
 


168


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
                         
    Consulting     Reinsurance     Total  
 
2009
                       
Consulting fees
  $ 49,617     $ (33,513 )   $ 16,104  
Net investment income
    1,894       79,477       81,371  
Net realized and unrealized gains
          4,237       4,237  
                         
      51,511       50,201       101,712  
                         
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities:
                       
Reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses
          (274,825 )     (274,825 )
Reduction in provisions for bad debt
          (11,718 )     (11,718 )
Reduction in provisions for unallocated loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
          (50,412 )     (50,412 )
Amortization of fair value adjustments
          77,328       77,328  
                         
            (259,627 )     (259,627 )
Salaries and benefits
    37,281       31,173       68,454  
General and administrative expenses
    19,870       27,032       46,902  
Interest expense
          17,583       17,583  
Net foreign exchange (gain) loss
    (920 )     24,707       23,787  
                         
      56,231       (159,132 )     (102,901 )
                         
(Loss) earnings before income taxes
    (4,720 )     209,333       204,613  
Income taxes
    (2,402 )     (25,203 )     (27,605 )
                         
Net (loss) earnings
    (7,122 )     184,130       177,008  
Less: Net earnings attributable to noncontrolling interest
          (41,798 )     (41,798 )
                         
Net (loss) earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited
  $ (7,122 )   $ 142,332     $ 135,210  
                         
 

169


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
                         
    Consulting     Reinsurance     Total  
 
2008
                       
Consulting fees
  $ 54,158     $ (29,007 )   $ 25,151  
Net investment (loss) income
    (20,248 )     46,849       26,601  
Net realized and unrealized losses
          (1,655 )     (1,655 )
                         
      33,910       16,187       50,097  
                         
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities:
                       
Reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses
          (161,437 )     (161,437 )
Reduction in provisions for bad debt
          (36,136 )     (36,136 )
Reduction in provisions for unallocated loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
          (69,056 )     (69,056 )
Amortization of fair value adjustments
          24,525       24,525  
                         
            (242,104 )     (242,104 )
Salaries and benefits
    33,196       23,074       56,270  
General and administrative expenses
    17,289       36,068       53,357  
Interest expense
          23,370       23,370  
Net foreign exchange loss
    1,167       13,819       14,986  
                         
      51,652       (145,773 )     (94,121 )
                         
(Loss) earnings before income taxes and share of net loss of partly owned company
    (17,742 )     161,960       144,218  
Income taxes
    511       (47,365 )     (46,854 )
Share of net loss of partly owned company
          (201 )     (201 )
                         
(Loss) earnings before extraordinary gain
    (17,231 )     114,394       97,163  
Extraordinary gain — Negative goodwill
          50,280       50,280  
                         
Net (loss) earnings
    (17,231 )     164,674       147,443  
Less: Net earnings attributable to noncontrolling interest
          (65,892 )     (65,892 )
                         
Net (loss) earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited
  $ (17,231 )   $ 98,782     $ 81,551  
                         

170


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
22.   CONDENSED UNAUDITED QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA
 
                                 
    2010 Quarters Ended  
    December 31     September 30     June 30     March 31  
 
Consulting fees
  $ 3,268     $ 2,119     $ 3,500     $ 14,128  
Net investment income
    30,622       20,165       22,998       26,121  
Net realized and unrealized gains (losses)
    4,527       10,635       (4,227 )     2,202  
                                 
      38,417       32,919       22,271       42,451  
                                 
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities:
                               
Reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses
    (220,129 )     (20,890 )     (35,104 )     (1,942 )
Reduction in provisions for bad debt
    (35,145 )     (1,304 )     (7,768 )     (5,339 )
Reduction in provisions for unallocated loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
    (8,819 )     (10,171 )     (11,696 )     (8,965 )
Amortization of fair value adjustments
    30,336       6,250       12,202       6,650  
                                 
      (233,757 )     (26,115 )     (42,366 )     (9,596 )
Salaries and benefits
    39,221       18,012       14,254       15,190  
General and administrative expenses
    19,728       13,185       15,801       10,487  
Interest expense
    2,093       2,961       2,805       2,394  
Net foreign exchange (gain) loss
    (1,785 )     (586 )     (5,615 )     7,588  
                                 
      (174,500 )     7,457       (15,121 )     26,063  
                                 
EARNINGS BEFORE INCOME TAXES AND SHARE OF NET EARNINGS OF PARTLY OWNED COMPANY
    212,917       25,462       37,392       16,388  
Income taxes
    (64,116 )     (979 )     (16,115 )     (5,922 )
Share of net earnings of partly owned company
          1,351       2,203       7,150  
                                 
NET EARNINGS
    148,801       25,834       23,480       17,616  
Less: Net earnings attributable to noncontrolling interests
    (24,509 )     (4,391 )     (11,050 )     (1,695 )
                                 
NET EARNINGS ATTRIBUTABLE TO ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
  $ 124,292     $ 21,443     $ 12,430     $ 15,921  
                                 
EARNINGS PER SHARE — BASIC
                               
Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
  $ 9.61     $ 1.56     $ 0.91     $ 1.17  
                                 
EARNINGS PER SHARE — DILUTED
                               
Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
  $ 9.37     $ 1.53     $ 0.89     $ 1.15  
                                 
Weighted average shares outstanding — Basic
    12,934,638       13,704,832       13,702,832       13,619,741  
Weighted average shares outstanding — Diluted
    13,258,299       14,019,768       14,019,489       13,831,697  
 


171


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
                                 
    2009 Quarters Ended  
    December 31     September 30     June 30     March 31  
 
Consulting fees
  $ 4,477     $ 4,112     $ 4,179     $ 3,336  
Net investment income
    20,929       24,640       18,493       17,309  
Net realized and unrealized gains (losses)
    2,255       2,912       5,080       (6,010 )
                                 
      27,661       31,664       27,752       14,635  
                                 
Net reduction in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities:
                               
Reduction in estimates of net ultimate losses
    (182,523 )     (44,736 )     (17,742 )     (29,824 )
Reduction in provisions for bad debt
    (2,004 )                 (9,714 )
Reduction in provisions for unallocated loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
    (21,042 )     (9,830 )     (9,422 )     (10,118 )
Amortization of fair value adjustments
    32,572       12,008       9,771       22,977  
                                 
      (172,997 )     (42,558 )     (17,393 )     (26,679 )
Salaries and benefits
    27,126       16,997       11,914       12,417  
General and administrative expenses
    11,415       12,195       10,910       12,382  
Interest expense
    3,681       4,262       4,675       4,965  
Net foreign exchange loss (gain)
    30,964       (7,164 )     (1,611 )     1,598  
                                 
      (99,811 )     (16,268 )     8,495       4,683  
                                 
EARNINGS BEFORE INCOME TAXES AND SHARE OF NET (LOSS) EARNINGS OF PARTLY OWNED COMPANY
    127,472       47,932       19,257       9,952  
Income taxes
    (25,586 )     (2,660 )     23       618  
Share of net (loss) earnings of partly owned company
    (465 )     196             269  
                                 
NET EARNINGS
    101,421       45,468       19,280       10,839  
Less: Net (earnings) loss attributable to noncontrolling interests
    (21,480 )     (10,481 )     (10,529 )     692  
                                 
NET EARNINGS ATTRIBUTABLE TO ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
  $ 79,941     $ 34,987     $ 8,751     $ 11,531  
                                 
EARNINGS PER SHARE — BASIC
                               
Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
  $ 5.89     $ 2.58     $ 0.65     $ 0.86  
                                 
EARNINGS PER SHARE — DILUTED
                               
Net earnings attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
  $ 5.79     $ 2.53     $ 0.63     $ 0.84  
                                 
Weighted average shares outstanding — Basic
    13,579,971       13,578,555       13,532,608       13,363,507  
Weighted average shares outstanding — Diluted
    13,811,176       13,814,651       13,787,553       13,699,419  
 

172


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
                                 
    2008 Quarters Ended  
    December 31     September 30     June 30     March 31  
 
Consulting fees
  $ 8,108     $ 7,410     $ 3,578     $ 6,055  
Net investment income
    (2,057 )     6,849       21,219       590  
Net realized and unrealized (losses) gains
    (1,393 )     (192 )     1,014       (1,084 )
                                 
      4,658       14,067       25,811       5,561  
                                 
Net (reduction) increase in ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities:
                               
(Reduction) increase in estimates of net ultimate losses
    (134,467 )     (4,164 )     (24,091 )     1,285  
(Reduction) increase in provisions for bad debt
    (35,274 )     213       (1,075 )      
Reduction in provisions for unallocated loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities
    (36,132 )     (13,672 )     (12,165 )     (7,087 )
Amortization of fair value adjustments
    (7,964 )     14,154       11,848       6,487  
                                 
      (213,837 )     (3,469 )     (25,483 )     685  
Salaries and benefits
    24,953       6,013       13,947       11,357  
General and administrative expenses
    17,353       10,121       13,972       11,911  
Interest expense
    4,493       7,919       7,643       3,315  
Net foreign exchange (gain) loss
    (3,800 )     25,056       (4,935 )     (1,335 )
                                 
      (170,838 )     45,640       5,144       25,933  
                                 
EARNINGS (LOSS) BEFORE INCOME TAXES AND SHARE OF NET LOSS OF PARTLY OWNED COMPANY
    175,496       (31,573 )     20,667       (20,372 )
Income taxes
    (33,466 )     (10,434 )     (3,193 )     239  
Share of net loss of partly owned company
    (201 )                  
                                 
EARNINGS (LOSS) BEFORE EXTRAORDINARY GAIN
    141,829       (42,007 )     17,474       (20,133 )
Extraordinary gain — Negative goodwill
                      50,280  
NET EARNINGS (LOSS)
    141,829       (42,007 )     17,474       30,147  
Less: Net (earnings) loss attributable to noncontrolling interests (including share of extraordinary gain of $nil, $nil, $nil, and 15,084, respectively)
    (46,703 )     5,572       (6,301 )     (18,460 )
                                 
NET EARNINGS (LOSS) ATTRIBUTABLE TO ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
  $ 95,126     $ (36,435 )   $ 11,173     $ 11,687  
                                 
EARNINGS PER SHARE — BASIC
                               
Earnings (loss) before extraordinary gain attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
  $ 7.13     $ (2.74 )   $ 0.93     $ (1.97 )
Extraordinary gain attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
                      2.95  
                                 
Net earnings (loss) attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
  $ 7.13     $ (2.74 )   $ 0.93     $ 0.98  
                                 
EARNINGS PER SHARE — DILUTED
                               
Earnings (loss) before extraordinary gain attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
  $ 7.13     $ (2.74 )   $ 0.91     $ (1.97 )
Extraordinary gain attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
                      2.95  
                                 
Net earnings (loss) attributable to Enstar Group Limited ordinary shareholders
  $ 7.13     $ (2.74 )   $ 0.91     $ 0.98  
                                 
Weighted average shares outstanding — basic
    13,333,644       13,317,919       11,959,125       11,927,542  
Weighted average shares outstanding — diluted
    13,334,944       13,317,919       12,238,356       11,927,542  

173


Table of Contents

 
SCHEDULE II
 
ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
CONDENSED BALANCE SHEETS
As of December 31, 2010 and 2009
 
                 
    2010     2009  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars,
 
    except share data)  
 
ASSETS
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 25,498     $ 12,911  
Balances due from subsidiaries
    129,509       159,688  
Investments in subsidiaries
    1,388,529       1,196,687  
Goodwill
    21,222       21,222  
Accounts receivable and other assets
    253       8,644  
                 
TOTAL ASSETS
  $ 1,565,011     $ 1,399,152  
                 
 
LIABILITIES
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
  $ 10,009     $ 4,510  
Loans payable
    152,333        
Balances due to subsidiaries
    186,848       318,490  
                 
TOTAL LIABILITIES
    349,190       323,000  
                 
SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
               
Share capital
               
Authorized issued and fully paid, par value $1 each (Authorized 2010: 156,000,000; 2009: 156,000,000)
               
Ordinary shares (Issued 2010: 12,940,021; 2009: 13,580,793)
    12,940       13,581  
Non-voting convertible ordinary shares (Issued 2010: 2,972,892; 2009: 2,972,892)
    2,973       2,973  
Treasury stock at cost (non-voting convertible ordinary shares 2010: 2,972,892; 2009: 2,972,892)
    (421,559 )     (421,559 )
Additional paid-in capital
    667,907       721,120  
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)
    35,017       8,709  
Retained earnings
    651,143       477,057  
                 
Total Enstar Group Limited Shareholders’ Equity
    948,421       801,881  
Noncontrolling interest
    267,400       274,271  
                 
TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
    1,215,821       1,076,152  
                 
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
  $ 1,565,011     $ 1,399,152  
                 
 
See accompanying notes to the condensed financial statements.


174


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF EARNINGS
For the Years Ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
INCOME
                       
Net investment income
  $ 3,528     $ 1,122     $ 1,423  
Dividend income from subsidiaries
    8,872       1,019       22,454  
                         
      12,400       2,141       23,877  
                         
EXPENSES
                       
Salaries and benefits
    1,985       50       642  
General and administrative expenses
    11,028       6,780       3,708  
Interest expense
    8,182       15,977       16,022  
Foreign exchange losses (gains)
    17       (401 )     1,063  
                         
      21,212       22,406       21,435  
                         
(LOSS) EARNINGS BEFORE EQUITY IN UNDISTRIBUTED EARNINGS OF SUBSIDIARIES
    (8,812 )     (20,265 )     2,442  
EQUITY IN UNDISTRIBUTED EARNINGS OF SUBSIDIARIES
    224,543       197,273       129,917  
NONCONTROLLING INTEREST
    (41,645 )     (41,798 )     (50,808 )
                         
NET EARNINGS ATTRIBUTABLE TO ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
  $ 174,086     $ 135,210     $ 81,551  
                         
 
See accompanying notes to the condensed financial statements.


175


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
For the Years Ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
 
                         
    2010     2009     2008  
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)  
 
OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
                       
Net cash flows (used in) provided by operating activities
  $ (92,038 )   $ (35,610 )   $ 118,158  
                         
INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
                       
Return (contribution) of capital, net
    8,407       55,721       (245,900 )
                         
FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
                       
Repayment of loans
    (19,206 )     (12,482 )      
Receipt of loans
    115,000             12,482  
Proceeds from issuance of ordinary shares
    424       2,796       115,392  
                         
Net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities
    96,218       (9,686 )     127,874  
                         
NET INCREASE IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS
    12,587       10,425       132  
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF YEAR
    12,911       2,486       2,354  
                         
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF YEAR
  $ 25,498     $ 12,911     $ 2,486  
                         
 
See accompanying notes to the condensed financial statements.


176


Table of Contents

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
 
1.   DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS
 
Enstar Group Limited (“Enstar”) was incorporated under the laws of Bermuda on August 16, 2001 and with its subsidiaries (collectively the “Company”) acquires and manages insurance and reinsurance companies in run-off and portfolios of insurance and reinsurance business in run-off, and provides management, consultancy and other services to the insurance and reinsurance industry.
 
2.   SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
Basis of preparation — The condensed financial statements have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amount of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
 
The accompanying condensed financial statements have been prepared using the equity method to account for the investments in subsidiaries. Under the equity method, the investments in consolidated subsidiaries are stated at cost plus the equity in undistributed earnings of consolidated subsidiaries since the date of acquisition. These condensed financial statements should be read in conjunction with the Company’s consolidated financial statements.


177


Table of Contents

 
ITEM 9.   CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
 
Not applicable
 
ITEM 9A.   CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
 
Disclosure Controls and Procedures
 
Our management has performed an evaluation, with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) of the Exchange Act as of December 31, 2010. Based upon that evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures are effective to ensure that information required to be disclosed by us in reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the rules and forms of the SEC and is accumulated and communicated to management, including its principal executive and principal financial officers, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.
 
Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
 
Our management was responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) of the Exchange Act). Our management has performed an assessment, with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer, of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010. In making this assessment, our management used the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in Internal Control-Integrated Framework. As allowed by SEC guidance, management excluded from its assessment the 2010 acquisitions of PWAC, Seaton, New Castle and Claremont, whose total assets, net assets, total revenues and net income on a combined basis constituted approximately 9.1%, (0.7)%, 1.3% and (4.0)%, respectively, of the consolidated financial statement amounts as of and for the year ended December 31, 2010.
 
Based upon that assessment, our management believes that, as of December 31, 2010, our internal control over financial reporting is effective.
 
The effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010 has been audited by our independent registered public accounting firm as stated in its report. This report appears on page 180.
 
All internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations. As a result, even those internal control systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements.
 
Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
 
Our management has performed an evaluation, with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer, of changes in our internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the year ended December 31, 2010. Based upon that evaluation there were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the quarter ended December 31, 2010 that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
 
ITEM 9B.   OTHER INFORMATION
 
On March 4, 2011, Clarendon Holdings, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, as borrower, entered into a Term Facility Agreement with National Australia Bank Limited (the “Clarendon Facility”). The Clarendon


178


Table of Contents

Facility provides for a four-year term loan facility pursuant to which Clarendon Holdings, Inc. is permitted to borrow up to an aggregate of $106.5 million, which will be available to fund up to 50% of the purchase price of Clarendon National Insurance Company (“Clarendon”), an affiliate of Hannover Re. As of March 4, 2011, Clarendon Holdings, Inc. has not borrowed any of the amount available under the Clarendon Facility.
 
The Clarendon Facility is secured by a security interest in all of the assets of Clarendon Holdings, Inc., as well as a first priority lien on the stock of both Clarendon Holdings, Inc. and Clarendon. Interest is payable at the end of each interest period chosen by Clarendon Holdings, Inc. or, at the latest, each six months. The interest rate is LIBOR plus 2.75%. The Clarendon Facility is subject to various financial and business covenants, including limitations on mergers and consolidations, restrictions as to disposition of stock and limitations of liens on the stock.
 
During the existence of any payment default, the interest rate is increased by 1.0%. During the existence of any event of default (as specified in the Facility Agreement), the lenders may declare all or a portion of outstanding amounts immediately due and payable, declare all or a portion of borrowed amounts payable upon demand, or proceed against the security. The Facility Agreement terminates and all amounts borrowed must be repaid on the fourth anniversary of the date the term loan is made.


179


Table of Contents

 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
 
To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of
Enstar Group Limited
 
We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of Enstar Group Limited and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2010, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. As described in Management’s Report on Internal Controls over Financial Reporting, management excluded from its assessment the internal control over financial reporting at PW Acquisition Company (“PWAC”), Seaton Insurance Company (“Seaton), New Castle Reinsurance Company Ltd. (“New Castle”) and Claremont Liability Insurance Company (“Claremont”), which were acquired on July 20, 2010, August 3, 2010, December 3, 2010 and December 31, 2010, respectively. The financial statement amounts of PWAC, Seaton, New Castle and Claremont constitute approximately 9.1%, (0.7)%, 1.3% and (4.0)% of total assets, net assets, total revenues and net income, respectively, of the Company’s consolidated financial statement amounts as of and for the year ended December 31, 2010. Accordingly, our audit did not include the internal control over financial reporting at PWAC, Seaton, New Castle and Claremont. The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Controls over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.
 
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the company’s principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by the company’s board of directors, management, and other personnel to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
 
Because of the inherent limitations of internal control over financial reporting, including the possibility of collusion or improper management override of controls, material misstatements due to error or fraud may not be prevented or detected on a timely basis. Also, projections of any evaluation of the effectiveness of the internal control over financial reporting to future periods are subject to the risk that the controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
 
In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, based on the criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.
 
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule as of and for the year ended December 31, 2010 of the Company and our report dated March 4, 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule.
 
/s/ Deloitte & Touche
 
Hamilton, Bermuda
March 4, 2011


180


Table of Contents

 
PART III
 
ITEM 10.   DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT
 
The information required by this item is incorporated by reference from our definitive proxy statement for the 2011 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders that will be filed with the SEC not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010 pursuant to Regulation 14A.
 
ITEM 11.   EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
 
The information required by this item is incorporated by reference from our definitive proxy statement for the 2011 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders that will be filed with the SEC not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010 pursuant to Regulation 14A.
 
ITEM 12.   SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
 
The information required by this item is incorporated by reference from our definitive proxy statement for the 2011 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders that will be filed with the SEC not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010 pursuant to Regulation 14A.
 
ITEM 13.   CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS
 
The information required by this item is incorporated by reference from our definitive proxy statement for the 2011 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders that will be filed with the SEC not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010 pursuant to Regulation 14A.
 
ITEM 14.   PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES
 
The information required by this item is incorporated by reference from our definitive proxy statement for the 2011 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders that will be filed with the SEC not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010 pursuant to Regulation 14A.


181


Table of Contents

 
PART IV
 
ITEM 15.   EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
 
(a)   Financial Statements, Financial Statement Schedules and Exhibits.
 
1. Financial Statements
 
Included in Part II — See Item 8 of this report.
 
2. Financial Statement Schedules
 
Included in Part II — See Item 8 of this report.
 
3. Exhibits
 
The Exhibits listed below are filed as part of, or incorporated by reference into, this report.
 
         
Exhibit
   
No.   Description
 
  2 ..1u   Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of May 23, 2006, as amended on November 21, 2006, by and among Castlewood Holdings Limited, CWMS Subsidiary Corp. and The Enstar Group, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 (and Annex A) to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006).
  2 ..2u   Recapitalization Agreement, dated as of May 23, 2006, among Castlewood Holdings Limited, The Enstar Group, Inc. and the other parties signatory thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.2 (and Annex C) to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006).
  2 ..3u   Agreement relating to the Sale and Purchase of the Entire Issued Share Capital of Inter-Ocean Holdings Ltd. dated December 29, 2006, as amended on January 29, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 1, 2007).
  2 ..4u   Share Sale Agreement, dated December 10, 2007, by and between Enstar Group Limited, Enstar Australia Holdings Pty Limited, AMP Insurance Investment Holdings Pty Limited, AMP Holdings Limited, AMP Group Services Limited, AMP Group Holdings Limited and AMP Services Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.4 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on February 29, 2008).
  2 ..5u   Agreement for the Sale and Purchase of the Entire Issued Share Capital of Unionamerica Holdings Limited, dated October 7, 2008, by and between St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company, Royston Run-off Limited and Kenmare Holdings Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.5 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 5, 2009).
  3 .1   Memorandum of Association of Castlewood Holdings Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006).
  3 .2   Second Amended and Restated Bye-Laws of Enstar Group Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Company’s Form 8-K12B, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on January 31, 2007).
  10 .1   Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of January 31, 2007, by and among Castlewood Holdings Limited, Trident II, L.P., Marsh & McLennan Capital Professionals Fund, L.P., Marsh & McLennan Employees’ Securities Company, L.P., J. Christopher Flowers, Dominic F. Silvester and other parties thereto set forth on the Schedule of Shareholders attached thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Form 8-K12B, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on January 31, 2007).


182


Table of Contents

         
Exhibit
   
No.   Description
 
  10 .2+   Form of Director Indemnification Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-151461) initially filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 5, 2008).
  10 .3   Tax Indemnification Agreement, dated as of May 23, 2006, among Castlewood Holdings Limited, The Enstar Group, Inc. and J. Christopher Flowers (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006).
  10 .4+   Amended and Restated Employment Agreement, effective May 1, 2007 and amended and restated June 4, 2007, by and among Enstar Group Limited and Dominic F. Silvester (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 9, 2007).
  10 .5+   Employment Agreement, effective May 1, 2007, by and among Enstar Group Limited, Castlewood (US) Inc., and John J. Oros (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 3, 2007).
  10 .6+   Employment Agreement, effective May 1, 2007, by and among the Company and Paul J. O’Shea (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 3, 2007).
  10 .7+   Employment Agreement, effective May 1, 2007, by and among Enstar Group Limited and Nicholas A. Packer (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 3, 2007).
  10 .8+   Employment Agreement, effective May 1, 2007, by and among Enstar Group Limited and Richard J. Harris (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 3, 2007).
  10 .9+   Castlewood Holdings Limited 2006 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006), as amended by the First Amendment to Castlewood Holdings Limited 2006 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 6, 2007).
  10 .10+   Castlewood Holdings Limited 2006-2010 Annual Incentive Compensation Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006), as amended by the First Amendment to Castlewood Holdings Limited 2006-2010 Annual Incentive Compensation Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 6, 2007).
  10 .11+   Form of Award Agreement under the Castlewood Holdings Limited 2006 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 6, 2007).
  10 .12+   Enstar Group Limited Amended and Restated Employee Share Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A to the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 29, 2008).
  10 .13+   Enstar Group Limited Deferred Compensation and Ordinary Share Plan for Non-Employee Directors, effective as of June 5, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 11, 2007).
  10 .14+   The Enstar Group, Inc. 1997 Amended Omnibus Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to The Enstar Group, Inc.’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 14, 2001), as amended by the Amendment to the 1997 Omnibus Inventive Plan (incorporated by reference to Annex A to the Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Shareholders of The Enstar Group, Inc., as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 22, 2003).

183


Table of Contents

         
Exhibit
   
No.   Description
 
  10 .15+   The Enstar Group, Inc. 2001 Outside Directors’ Stock Option Plan (incorporated by reference to Annex B to the Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Shareholders of The Enstar Group, Inc., as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 8, 2001).
  10 .16   License Agreement, dated October 27, 2005, between Castlewood (US) Inc. and J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Registration Statement on Form S-4 of the Company, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006).
  10 .17   Term Facilities Agreement, dated October 3, 2008, by and between Royston Run-off Limited and National Australia Bank Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 5, 2009).
  10 .18   Amended and Restated Term Facilities Agreement, dated as of October 3, 2008, as amended and restated August 4, 2009, by and among Royston Run-off Limited, National Australia Bank Limited and Barclays Bank PLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on From 10-Q, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on November 6, 2009).
  10 .19+   The Enstar Group, Inc. Deferred Compensation and Stock Plan for Non-Employee Directors, as amended (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 8, 2009).
  10 .20+   Share Repurchase Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2010, by and among Enstar Group Limited, Dominic F. Silvester and R&H Trust Co. (NZ) Limited, as trustee of the Left Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 1, 2010).
  10 .21+   Share Repurchase Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2010, by and among Enstar Group Limited, Paul J. O’Shea and R&H Trust Co. (BVI) Limited, as trustee of the Elbow Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 1, 2010).
  10 .22+   Share Repurchase Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2010, by and among Enstar Group Limited, Nicholas A. Packer and Hove Investments Holding Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 1, 2010).
  10 .23+   Separation Agreement and General Release, dated as of August 20, 2010, by and among Enstar Group Limited, Enstar (US), Inc. and John J. Oros (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on November 5, 2010).
  10 .24*   Facilities Agreement, dated as of December 29, 2010, by and among Enstar Group Limited, certain of its subsidiaries, Barclays Corporate and Barclays Bank PLC.
  10 .25+*   Enstar Group Limited 2011-2015 Annual Incentive Compensation Program.
  21 .1*   List of Subsidiaries.
  23 .1*   Consent of Deloitte & Touche
  31 .1*   Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934 as adopted under Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  31 .2*   Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934 as adopted under Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  32 .1**   Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  32 .2**   Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
* filed herewith
 
** furnished herewith
 
+ denotes management contract or compensatory arrangement
 
u certain of the schedules and similar attachments are not filed but Enstar Group Limited undertakes to furnish a copy of the schedules or similar attachments to the Securities and Exchange Commission upon request

184


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES
 
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized on March 4, 2011.
 
ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
 
  By: 
/s/  Dominic F. Silvester
Dominic F. Silvester
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities indicated on March 4, 2011.
 
         
Signature   Title
 
/s/  Dominic F. Silvester

Dominic F. Silvester
  Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and Director
     
/s/  Richard J. Harris

Richard J. Harris
  Chief Financial Officer (signing in his capacity as both principal financial officer and principal accounting officer).
     
/s/  Paul J. O’Shea

Paul J. O’Shea
  Executive Vice President and Director
     
/s/  J. Christopher Flowers

J. Christopher Flowers
  Director
     
/s/  T. Whit Armstrong

T. Whit Armstrong
  Director
     
/s/  Charles T. Akre, Jr.

Charles T. Akre, Jr.
  Director
     
/s/  Paul J. Collins

Paul J. Collins
  Director
     
/s/  Robert J. Campbell

Robert J. Campbell
  Director


185


Table of Contents

EXHIBIT INDEX
 
         
Exhibit
   
No.   Description
 
  2 ..1u   Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of May 23, 2006, as amended on November 21, 2006, by and among Castlewood Holdings Limited, CWMS Subsidiary Corp. and The Enstar Group, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 (and Annex A) to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006).
  2 ..2u   Recapitalization Agreement, dated as of May 23, 2006, among Castlewood Holdings Limited, The Enstar Group, Inc. and the other parties signatory thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.2 (and Annex C) to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006).
  2 ..3u   Agreement relating to the Sale and Purchase of the Entire Issued Share Capital of Inter-Ocean Holdings Ltd. dated December 29, 2006, as amended on January 29, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 1, 2007).
  2 ..4u   Share Sale Agreement, dated December 10, 2007, by and between Enstar Group Limited, Enstar Australia Holdings Pty Limited, AMP Insurance Investment Holdings Pty Limited, AMP Holdings Limited, AMP Group Services Limited, AMP Group Holdings Limited and AMP Services Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.4 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on February 29, 2008).
  2 ..5u   Agreement for the Sale and Purchase of the Entire Issued Share Capital of Unionamerica Holdings Limited, dated October 7, 2008, by and between St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company, Royston Run-off Limited and Kenmare Holdings Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.5 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange on March 5, 2009).
  3 .1   Memorandum of Association of Castlewood Holdings Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006).
  3 .2   Second Amended and Restated Bye-Laws of Enstar Group Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Company’s Form 8-K12B, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on January 31, 2007).
  10 .1   Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of January 31, 2007, by and among Castlewood Holdings Limited, Trident II, L.P., Marsh & McLennan Capital Professionals Fund, L.P., Marsh & McLennan Employees’ Securities Company, L.P., J. Christopher Flowers, Dominic F. Silvester and other parties thereto set forth on the Schedule of Shareholders attached thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Form 8-K12B, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on January 31, 2007).
  10 .2+   Form of Director Indemnification Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-151461) initially filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 5, 2008).
  10 .3   Tax Indemnification Agreement, dated as of May 23, 2006, among Castlewood Holdings Limited, The Enstar Group, Inc. and J. Christopher Flowers (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006).
  10 .4+   Amended and Restated Employment Agreement, effective May 1, 2007 and amended and restated June 4, 2007, by and among Enstar Group Limited and Dominic F. Silvester (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 9, 2007).


186


Table of Contents

         
Exhibit
   
No.   Description
 
  10 .5+   Employment Agreement, effective May 1, 2007, by and among Enstar Group Limited, Castlewood (US) Inc., and John J. Oros (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 3, 2007).
  10 .6+   Employment Agreement, effective May 1, 2007, by and among the Company and Paul J. O’Shea (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 3, 2007).
  10 .7+   Employment Agreement, effective May 1, 2007, by and among Enstar Group Limited and Nicholas A. Packer (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 3, 2007).
  10 .8+   Employment Agreement, effective May 1, 2007, by and among Enstar Group Limited and Richard J. Harris (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 3, 2007).
  10 .9+   Castlewood Holdings Limited 2006 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006), as amended by the First Amendment to Castlewood Holdings Limited 2006 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 6, 2007).
  10 .10+   Castlewood Holdings Limited 2006-2010 Annual Incentive Compensation Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006), as amended by the First Amendment to Castlewood Holdings Limited 2006-2010 Annual Incentive Compensation Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 6, 2007).
  10 .11+   Form of Award Agreement under the Castlewood Holdings Limited 2006 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 6, 2007).
  10 .12+   Enstar Group Limited Amended and Restated Employee Share Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A to the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 29, 2008).
  10 .13+   Enstar Group Limited Deferred Compensation and Ordinary Share Plan for Non-Employee Directors, effective as of June 5, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 11, 2007).
  10 .14+   The Enstar Group, Inc. 1997 Amended Omnibus Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to The Enstar Group, Inc.’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 14, 2001), as amended by the Amendment to the 1997 Omnibus Inventive Plan (incorporated by reference to Annex A to the Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Shareholders of The Enstar Group, Inc., as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 22, 2003).
  10 .15+   The Enstar Group, Inc. 2001 Outside Directors’ Stock Option Plan (incorporated by reference to Annex B to the Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Shareholders of The Enstar Group, Inc., as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 8, 2001).
  10 .16   License Agreement, dated October 27, 2005, between Castlewood (US) Inc. and J.C. Flowers & Co. LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 to the proxy statement/prospectus that forms a part of the Registration Statement on Form S-4 of the Company, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and declared effective December 15, 2006).
  10 .17   Term Facilities Agreement, dated October 3, 2008, by and between Royston Run-off Limited and National Australia Bank Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 5, 2009).


187


Table of Contents

         
Exhibit
   
No.   Description
 
  10 .18   Amended and Restated Term Facilities Agreement, dated as of October 3, 2008, as amended and restated August 4, 2009, by and among Royston Run-off Limited, National Australia Bank Limited and Barclays Bank PLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on From 10-Q, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on November 6, 2009).
  10 .19+   The Enstar Group, Inc. Deferred Compensation and Stock Plan for Non-Employee Directors, as amended (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 8, 2009).
  10 .20+   Share Repurchase Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2010, by and among Enstar Group Limited, Dominic F. Silvester and R&H Trust Co. (NZ) Limited, as trustee of the Left Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 1, 2010).
  10 .21+   Share Repurchase Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2010, by and among Enstar Group Limited, Paul J. O’Shea and R&H Trust Co. (BVI) Limited, as trustee of the Elbow Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 1, 2010).
  10 .22+   Share Repurchase Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2010, by and among Enstar Group Limited, Nicholas A. Packer and Hove Investments Holding Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 1, 2010).
  10 .23+   Separation Agreement and General Release, dated as of August 20, 2010, by and among Enstar Group Limited, Enstar (US), Inc. and John J. Oros (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on November 5, 2010).
  10 .24*   Facilities Agreement, dated as of December 29, 2010, by and among Enstar Group Limited, certain of its subsidiaries, Barclays Corporate and Barclays Bank PLC.
  10 .25+*   Enstar Group Limited 2011-2015 Annual Incentive Compensation Program.
  21 .1*   List of Subsidiaries.
  23 .1*   Consent of Deloitte & Touche
  31 .1*   Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934 as adopted under Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  31 .2*   Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934 as adopted under Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  32 .1**   Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  32 .2**   Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
* filed herewith
 
** furnished herewith
 
+ denotes management contract or compensatory arrangement
 
u certain of the schedules and similar attachments are not filed but Enstar Group Limited undertakes to furnish a copy of the schedules or similar attachments to the Securities and Exchange Commission upon request


188

exv10w24
Exhibit 10.24
CONFORMED COPY
Dated   29 December   2010
 
Enstar Group Limited
The Parties Listed as Original Guarantors
Barclays Corporate
as Mandated Lead Arranger
Barclays Bank PLC
acting as Agent
- and -
Barclays Bank PLC
acting as Security Agent
US$115,000 000 Facilities Agreement
(HoganLovells logo)
001BB.59899
Ref: F3SM/CMM/2363436.2
Hogan Lovells International LLP
Atlantic House, Holborn Viaduct, London EC1A 2FG

 


 

Contents
             
Clause       Page
1.
  Definitions and interpretation     1  
2.
  The Facilities     21  
3.
  Purpose     22  
4.
  Conditions of utilisation     22  
5.
  Utilisation — Loans     24  
6.
  Repayment     25  
7.
  Illegality, voluntary prepayment and cancellation     26  
8.
  Mandatory prepayment     27  
9.
  Restrictions     27  
10.
  Interest     29  
11.
  Interest Periods     29  
12.
  Changes to the calculation of interest     30  
13.
  Fees     31  
14.
  Tax gross—up and indemnities     32  
15.
  Increased Costs     38  
16.
  Other indemnities     39  
17.
  Mitigation by the Lenders     40  
18.
  Costs and expenses     41  
19.
  Guarantee and indemnity     43  
20.
  Representations     47  
21.
  Information undertakings     54  
22.
  Financial covenants     60  
23.
  General undertakings     62  
24.
  Events of Default     70  
25.
  Changes to the Lenders     75  
26.
  Prohibition on Debt Purchase Transactions     79  
27.
  Changes to the Obligors     79  
28.
  Role of the Agent, the Security Agent, the Arranger and others     81  
29.
  Conduct of business by the Finance Parties     89  
30.
  Sharing among the Finance Parties     90  
31.
  Payment mechanics     92  
32.
  Set—off     95  
33.
  Notices     95  
34.
  Calculations and certificates     97  
35.
  Partial invalidity     98  
36.
  Remedies and waivers     98  
 
      Hogan Lovells

 


 

             
Clause       Page
37.
  Amendments and waivers     98  
38.
  Confidentiality     99  
39.
  Counterparts     103  
40.
  Governing law     104  
41.
  Enforcement     104  
Schedules        
1.
  The Original Obligors     106  
2.
  Conditions precedent     107  
 
  Parts        
 
  1A.Conditions precedent to first Utilisation     107  
 
  1B.Conditions precedent relating to the CIGNA Reinsurance Arrangements     110  
 
  2.Conditions precedent required to be delivered by an Additional Obligor     111  
3.
  Requests     114  
4.
  Mandatory Cost Formula     116  
5.
  Form of Transfer Certificate     119  
6.
  Form of Assignment Agreement     124  
7.
  Form of Accession Deed     128  
8.
  Form of Compliance Certificate     131  
9.
  Timetables     133  
10.
  Security provisions     134  
11.
  Group Structure Chart     137  
 
  Part 1     137  
 
  Part 2     138  
 
  Part 3     139  
 
  Part 4     140  
12.
  The Secured Group     141  
13.
  Intercompany Loans     142  
14.
  Existing Security     143  
 
      Hogan Lovells

-ii-


 

This Agreement is made on 29 December 2010
Between:
(1)   Enstar Group Limited, a company incorporated in Bermuda with registered number 30916 and its registered office at Clarendon House, 2 Church Street, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda (the “Parent” and the “Borrower”);
 
(2)   The Subsidiaries of the Parent listed in Schedule 1 (The Original Obligors) as original guarantors (together with the Parent, the “Original Guarantors”);
 
(3)   Barclays Corporate, the corporate banking division of Barclays Bank PLC as bookrunner and mandated lead arranger (the “Arranger”);
 
(4)   Barclays Bank PLC as lender (the “Original Lender”);
 
(5)   Barclays Bank PLC as agent of the other Finance Parties (the “Agent”);
 
(6)   Barclays Bank PLC as security trustee for the Secured Parties (the “Security Agent”);
It is agreed:
Section 1
Interpretation
1.   Definitions and interpretation
 
1.1   Definitions
 
    In this Agreement:
 
    “Acceptable Bank” means:
  (a)   A Lender;
 
  (b)   a bank or financial institution which has a rating for its long-term unsecured and non-credit-enhanced debt obligations of AA or higher by Standard & Poor’s Rating Services or Fitch Ratings Ltd or Aa2 or higher by Moody’s Investor Services Limited or a comparable rating from an internationally recognised credit rating agency; or
 
  (c)   any other bank or financial institution approved by the Agent.
    “Accession Deed” means a document substantially in the form set out in Schedule 7 (Form of Accession Deed).
 
    “Accounting Principles” means:
  (a)   in relation to any Obligor incorporated in Bermuda or in any state of the United States of America, generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America;
 
  (b)   in relation to any Obligor incorporated in the United Kingdom, generally accepted accounting principles in the United Kingdom including IFRS (as applicable); or
 
  (c)   in relation to any Obligor other than those mentioned in paragraphs (a) and (b) above, generally accepted accounting principles in its place of incorporation..
Hogan Lovells

 


 

    “Additional Chargor” means any member of the Group which has granted Security in favour of the Security Agent, on and from the date on which it enters into a Transaction Security Document.
 
    “Additional Cost Rate” has the meaning given to it in Schedule 4 (Mandatory Cost Formula).
 
    “Additional Guarantor” means a company which becomes a Guarantor in accordance with Clause 27 (Changes to the Obligors).
 
    “Additional Obligor” means an Additional Guarantor or an Additional Chargor.
 
    “Affiliate” means, in relation to any person, a Subsidiary of that person or a Holding Company of that person or any other Subsidiary of that Holding Company.
 
    “Agent’s Spot Rate of Exchange” means the Agent’s spot rate of exchange for the purchase of the relevant currency with the Base Currency in the London foreign exchange market at or about 11.00 a.m. on a particular day.
 
    “Assignment Agreement” means an agreement substantially in the form set out in Schedule 6 (Form of Assignment Agreement) or any other form agreed between the relevant assignor and assignee.
 
    “Auditors” means one of PricewaterhouseCoopers, Ernst & Young, KPMG or Deloitte & Touche or any other firm approved in advance by the Majority Lenders (such approval not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed).
 
    “Authorisation” means an authorisation, consent, approval, resolution, licence, exemption, filing, notarisation or registration.
 
    “Availability Period” means the period from and including the date of this Agreement to and including the date falling one month after the date of this Agreement;
 
    “Available Commitment” means, in relation to a Facility, a Lender’s Commitment under that Facility minus:
  (a)   the Base Currency Amount of its participation in any outstanding Utilisations under that Facility; and
 
  (b)   in relation to any proposed Utilisation, the Base Currency Amount of its participation in any other Utilisations that are due to be made under that Facility on or before the proposed Utilisation Date.
    “Available Facility” means, in relation to a Facility, the aggregate for the time being of each Lender’s Available Commitment in respect of that Facility.
 
    “Barclays Presentation” means the presentation entitled ‘Enstar Group Limited presentation to Barclays Capital London’ dated 23 November 2010 as amended by an email dated 22 December 2010 from Gareth Nokes to Richard Braham.
 
    “Base Currency” means US$.
 
    “Base Currency Amount” means in relation to a Utilisation, the amount specified in the Utilisation Request delivered by the Borrower for that Utilisation (or, if the amount requested is not denominated in the Base Currency, that amount converted into the Base Currency at the Agent’s Spot Rate of Exchange on the date which is three Business Days before the Utilisation Date or, if later, on the date the Agent receives the Utilisation Request in accordance with the terms of this Agreement).
Hogan Lovells

- 2 -


 

    “Base Currency Equivalent” means, the amount of the relevant currency required to purchase the relevant amount of the Base Currency at the Agent’s spot rate of exchange for such a purchase in the London foreign exchange market at or about 11.00 am on the relevant date.
 
    “Base Reference Bank Rate” means the arithmetic mean of the rates (rounded upwards to four decimal places) as supplied to the Agent at its request by the Base Reference Banks in relation to LIBOR, as the rate at which the relevant Base Reference Bank could borrow funds in the London Interbank market, in the relevant currency and for the relevant period, were it to do so by asking for and then accepting Interbank offers for deposits in reasonable market size in that currency and for that period.
 
    “Base Reference Banks” means the principal London offices of Barclays Bank PLC or such other banks as may be appointed by the Agent in consultation with the Parent.
 
    “Board Memorandum” means the Enstar memorandum dated 22 November 2010, reference: CIGNA Reinsurance Portfolio Transfer.
 
    “Borrowings” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 22.1 (Financial definitions).
 
    “Break Costs” means the amount (if any) by which:
  (a)   the interest (excluding the Margin), which a Lender should have received for the period from the date of receipt of all or any part of its participation in a Loan or Unpaid Sum to the last day of the current Interest Period in respect of that Loan or Unpaid Sum, had the principal amount or Unpaid Sum received been paid on the last day of that Interest Period;
    exceeds:
  (b)   the amount which that Lender would be able to obtain by placing an amount equal to the principal amount or Unpaid Sum received by it on deposit with a leading bank in the Relevant Interbank Market for a period starting on the Business Day following receipt or recovery and ending on the last day of the current Interest Period.
    “Budget” means:
  (a)   in relation to the period beginning on 1 January 2011 and ending on 31 December 2014, the financial model including profit and loss, balance sheet and cashflow projections relating to the Group as set out in the Barclays Presentation to be delivered by the Parent to the Agent pursuant to Clause 4.1 (Initial conditions precedent); and
 
  (b)   in relation to any other period, any annual Capital Release Schedule delivered by the Parent to the Agent in respect of that period pursuant to Clause 21.4 (Budget).
    “Business Day” means a day (other than a Saturday or Sunday) on which banks are open for general business in London, and:
  (a)   (in relation to any date for payment or purchase of a currency other than euro) also in the principal financial centre of the country of that currency; or
 
  (b)   (in relation to any date for payment or purchase of euro) which is also a TARGET Day.
    “Capital Release Amount” means, in respect of any member of the Group, any reduction in the amount of capital resources which that member of the Group is required
Hogan Lovells

- 3 -


 

    to hold in accordance with applicable law and applicable rules and guidance given by any governmental or regulatory authority.
 
    “Capital Release Schedule” means a schedule detailing the expected Capital Release Amounts in relation to each member of the Group.
 
    “Cash Equivalent Investments” means at any time:
  (a)   certificates of deposit maturing within one year after the relevant date of calculation and issued by an Acceptable Bank;
 
  (b)   any investment in marketable debt obligations issued or guaranteed by the government of the United States of America, the United Kingdom, any member state of the European Economic Area or any Participating Member State or by an instrumentality or agency of any of them having an equivalent credit rating, maturing within one year after the relevant date of calculation and not convertible or exchangeable to any other security;
 
  (c)   commercial paper not convertible or exchangeable to any other security:
  (i)   for which a recognised trading market exists;
 
  (ii)   issued by an issuer incorporated in the United States of America, the United Kingdom, any member state of the European Economic Area or any Participating Member State;
 
  (iii)   which matures within one year after the relevant date of calculation; and
 
  (iv)   which has a credit rating of either A-1 or higher by Standard & Poor’s Rating Services or F-1 or higher by Fitch Ratings Ltd or P-1 or higher by Moody’s Investor Services Limited, or, if no rating is available in respect of the commercial paper, the issuer of which has, in respect of its long-term unsecured and non-credit enhanced debt obligations, an equivalent rating;
  (d)   Sterling bills of exchange eligible for rediscount at the Bank of England and accepted by an Acceptable Bank (or their dematerialised equivalent);
 
  (e)   any investment in money market funds which:
  (i)   have a credit rating of either A-1 or higher by Standard & Poor’s Rating Services or F-1 or higher by Fitch Ratings Ltd or P-1 or higher by Moody’s Investor Services Limited;
 
  (ii)   invest substantially all their assets in securities of the types described in sub-paragraphs (a) to (d) above; and
 
  (iii)   can be turned into cash on not more than 30 days’ notice; or
  (f)   any other debt security approved by the Majority Lenders,
    in each case, denominated in US$, Sterling or Euro and to which any Obligor is alone (or together with other Obligors) beneficially entitled at that time and which is not issued or guaranteed by any member of the Group or subject to any Security (other than Security arising under the Transaction Security Documents).
 
    “Change of Control” means any person or group of persons acting in concert gaining Control of the Parent (where “acting in concert” has the meaning given to it in the City Code on Takeovers and Mergers).
Hogan Lovells

- 4 -


 

    “CRA Account Charge” means a fixed charge given by the Parent over each CRA Account.
 
    “CRA Accounts” means each US Dollar, Sterling and/or Australian Dollar bank account held with Barclays Bank PLC, in the name of the Parent and into which amounts received in respect of any Capital Release Amount are paid.
 
    “Charged Property” means all of the assets of the Group which from time to time are, or are expressed to be, the subject of the Transaction Security.
 
    “Chargor” means an Original Chargor or an Additional Chargor.
 
    “Chief Financial Officer” means the chief financial officer of the Parent from time to time (or any director of the Parent acting as such officer’s deputy in that capacity or performing those functions).
 
    “CIGNA” means CIGNA Global Reinsurance Company, Ltd. a Class 3A and Long Term insurance company domiciled in Bermuda.
 
    “CIGNA Actuarial Report” means the actuarial report dated 25 September 2010 relating to CIGNA, prepared by Cranmore and confirmed by Insurmath on 27 September 2010.
 
    “CIGNA Entities” means each of CIGNA, Connecticut General Life Insurance Company, a life insurance company domiciled in the State of Connecticut and Life Insurance Company of North America, a life insurance company domiciled in the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania.
 
    “CIGNA Reinsurance Arrangements” means the reinsurance agreement and related claims handling contract to be entered into on or around the date of this Agreement by Fitzwilliam Insurance Limited (as reinsurer) (and the related credit support for such reinsurance obligations by way of collateral trust deposits of up to US$62,900,000 and the Parent CIGNA Guarantee) as described in the Board Memorandum.
 
    “Close Links Report” means a report submitted by an insurer to the FSA under SUP 16.5.4 or under any rules amending or replacing it.
 
    “Compliance Certificate” means a certificate substantially in the form set out in Schedule 8 (Form of Compliance Certificate).
 
    “Commitment” means a Facility A Commitment or a Facility B Commitment.
 
    “Confidential Information” means all information relating to the Parent, any Obligor of the Group, the Finance Documents or a Facility of which a Finance Party becomes aware in its capacity as, or for the purpose of becoming, a Finance Party or which is received by a Finance Party in relation to, or for the purpose of becoming a Finance Party under the Finance Documents or a Facility from either:
  (a)   any member of the Group, or any of its advisers, or
 
  (b)   another Finance Party, if the information was obtained by that Finance Party directly or indirectly from any member of the Group or any of its advisers,
    in whatever form, and includes information given orally and any document, electronic file or any other way of representing or recording information which contains or is derived or copied from such information but excludes information that:
  (i)   is or becomes public information other than as a direct or indirect result of any breach by that Finance Party of Clause 38 (Confidentiality); or
Hogan Lovells

- 5 -


 

  (ii)   is identified in writing at the time of delivery as non-confidential by any member of the Group or any of its advisers; or
 
  (iii)   is known by that Finance Party before the date the information is disclosed to it in accordance with paragraphs (a) or (b) above or is lawfully obtained by that Finance Party after that date, from a source which is, as far as that Finance Party is aware, unconnected with the Group and which, in either case, as far as that Finance Party is aware, has not been obtained in breach of, and is not otherwise subject to, any obligation of confidentiality.
    “Confidentiality Undertaking” means a confidentiality undertaking substantially in a recommended form of the LMA for the relevant type of proposed transaction or in any other form agreed between the Parent and the Agent.
 
    “Control” means:
  (a)   the power (whether by way of ownership of shares, proxy, contract, agency or otherwise) to:
  (i)   cast, or control the casting of, more than 50% of the maximum number of votes that might be cast at a general meeting of the company;
 
  (ii)   appoint or remove all, or the majority, of the directors or other equivalent officers of the company; or
 
  (iii)   give directions with respect to the operating and financial policies of the company with which the directors or other equivalent officers of the company are obliged to comply; or
  (b)   the holding beneficially of more than 50% of the issued share capital of the company (excluding any part of that issued share capital that carries no right to participate beyond a specified amount in a distribution of either profits or capital).
    “CTA” means the Corporation Tax Act 2009.
 
    “Debt Purchase Transaction” means, in relation to a person, a transaction where such person:
  (a)   purchases by way of assignment or transfer;
 
  (b)   enters into any sub-participation in respect of; or
 
  (c)   enters into any other agreement or arrangement having an economic effect substantially similar to a sub-participation in respect of,
    any Commitment or amount outstanding under this Agreement.
 
    “Default” means an Event of Default or any event or circumstance specified in Clause 24 (Events of Default) which would (with the expiry of a grace period, the giving of notice, the making of any determination under the Finance Documents or any combination of any of the foregoing) be an Event of Default.
 
    “Delegate” means any delegate, agent, attorney or co-trustee appointed by the Security Agent.
 
    “Disruption Event” means either or both of:
  (a)   a material disruption to those payment or communications systems or to those financial markets which are, in each case, required to operate in order for
Hogan Lovells

- 6 -


 

      payments to be made in connection with the Facilities (or otherwise in order for the transactions contemplated by the Finance Documents to be carried out) which disruption is not caused by, and is beyond the control of, any of the Parties; or
 
  (b)   the occurrence of any other event which results in a disruption (of a technical or systems-related nature) to the treasury or payments operations of a Party preventing that, or any other Party:
  (i)   from performing its payment obligations under the Finance Documents; or
 
  (ii)   from communicating with other Parties in accordance with the terms of the Finance Documents,
    and which (in either such case) is not caused by, and is beyond the control of, the Party whose operations are disrupted.
 
    “Dormant Subsidiary” means a member of the Group which does not trade (and for the last 12 months has not traded) for itself or as agent for any person and does not own, legally or beneficially, assets (including indebtedness owed to it) which in aggregate have a value of US$1,000 or more (or its Base Currency Equivalent) or have liabilities in excess of US$1,000 (or its Base Currency Equivalent).
 
    “Event of Default” means any event or circumstance specified as such in Clause 24 (Events of Default).
 
    “Existing Security” means the security granted by members of the Group and listed in Schedule 14 (Existing Security).
 
    “euro”, “EUR” and “€” means the single currency unit of the Participating Member States.
 
    “Facility” means Facility A or Facility B.
 
    “Facility A” means the term loan facility made available under this Agreement as described in sub-paragraph (a)(i) of Clause 2.1 (The Facilities).
 
    “Facility A Commitment” means:
  (a)   in relation to the Original Lender, the Total Facility A Commitments; and
 
  (b)   in relation to any other Lender, the amount in the Base Currency of any Facility A Commitment transferred to it under this Agreement,
    to the extent not cancelled, reduced or transferred by it under this Agreement.
 
    “Facility A Loan” means a loan made or to be made under Facility A or the principal amount outstanding for the time being of that loan.
 
    “Facility A Repayment Date” means each date set out in paragraph (a) of Clause 6.1 (Repayment of Loans).
 
    “Facility B” means the term loan facility made available under this Agreement as described in sub-paragraph (a)(ii) of Clause 2.1 (The Facilities).
 
    “Facility B Commitment” means:
  (a)   in relation to the Original Lender, the Total Facility B Commitments; and
 
  (b)   in relation to any other Lender, the amount in the Base Currency of any Facility B Commitment transferred to it under this Agreement,
Hogan Lovells

- 7 -


 

    to the extent not cancelled, reduced or transferred by it under this Agreement.
 
    “Facility B Loan” means a loan made or to be made under Facility B or the principal amount outstanding for the time being of that loan.
 
    “Facility B Repayment Date” means each date set out in paragraph (b) of Clause 6.1 (Repayment of Loans).
 
    “Facility Office” means:
  (a)   in respect of a Lender, the office or offices notified by that Lender to the Agent in writing on or before the date it becomes a Lender (or, following that date, by not less than five Business Days’ written notice) as the office or offices through which it will perform its obligations under this Agreement; or
 
  (b)   in respect of any other Finance Party, the office in the jurisdiction in which it is resident for tax purposes.
    “Fee Letter” means:
  (a)   any letter or letters dated on or about the date of this Agreement between the Arranger and the Parent or the Agent and the Parent or the Security Agent and the Parent setting out any of the fees referred to in Clause 13 (Fees); and
 
  (b)   any agreement setting out fees payable to a Finance Party under any other Finance Document;
    “Finance Document” means this Agreement, any Accession Deed, any Compliance Certificate, any Fee Letter, any Resignation Letter, any Transaction Security Document, any Utilisation Request and any other document designated as a “Finance Document” by the Agent and the Parent.
 
    “Finance Lease” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 22.1 (Financial definitions).
 
    “Finance Party” means the Agent, the Arranger, the Security Agent or a Lender.
 
    “Financial Indebtedness” means any indebtedness for or in respect of:
  (a)   moneys borrowed and debit balances at banks or other financial institutions;
 
  (b)   any acceptance under any acceptance credit or bill discounting facility or dematerialised equivalent;
 
  (c)   any note purchase facility or the issue of bonds, notes, debentures, loan stock or any similar instrument;
 
  (d)   the amount of any liability in respect of Finance Leases;
 
  (e)   receivables sold or discounted (other than any receivables to the extent they are sold on a non-recourse basis) and meet any requirement for de-recognition under the Accounting Principles;
 
  (f)   any Treasury Transaction (and, when calculating the value of that Treasury Transaction, only the marked to market value (or, if any actual amount is due as a result of the termination or close-out of that Treasury Transaction, that amount) shall be taken into account);
Hogan Lovells

- 8 -


 

  (g)   any counter-indemnity obligation in respect of a guarantee, bond, standby or documentary letter of credit or any other instrument issued by a bank or financial institution in respect of:
  (i)   an underlying liability of an entity which is not a member of the Group which liability would fall within one of the other paragraphs of this definition; or
 
  (ii)   any liabilities of any member of the Group relating to any post-retirement benefit scheme;
  (h)   any amount raised by the issue of redeemable shares which are redeemable (other than at the option of the issuer) before the Termination Date or are otherwise classified as borrowings under the Accounting Principles;
 
  (i)   any amount of any liability under an advance or deferred purchase agreement if:
  (i)   one of the primary reasons behind entering into the agreement is to raise finance or to finance the acquisition or construction of the asset or service in question; or
 
  (ii)   the agreement is in respect of the supply of assets or services and payment is due more than 90 days after the date of supply;
  (j)   any amount raised under any other transaction (including any forward sale or purchase, sale and sale back or sale and leaseback agreement) having the commercial effect of a borrowing or otherwise classified as borrowings under the Accounting Principles; and
 
  (k)   the amount of any liability in respect of any guarantee for any of the items referred to in paragraphs (a) to (j) above.
    “Financial Quarter” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 22.1 (Financial definitions).
 
    “Financial Year” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 22.1 (Financial definitions).
 
    “FSA” means the Financial Services Authority and any replacement of that authority which is responsible from time to time for the prudential supervision of insurers authorised in the United Kingdom.
 
    “FSA Returns” means the documents required (taken together) to be filed by an insurer with the FSA under Rule 9.6(1) of IPRU(INS) or as may be defined in any rules amending or replacing it.
 
    “FSA Rules” means the FSA’s Handbook of Rules and Guidance as amended, varied, substituted or replaced from time to time including, without limitation, GENPRU, IPRU(INS), INSPRU and SUP and including the rules of any other regulator which is responsible from time to time for the prudential supervision of insurers authorised in the United Kingdom.
 
    “Funds Flow Statement” means a funds flow statement in the agreed form.
 
    “GENPRU” means the General Prudential Sourcebook forming part of the FSA Rules.
 
    “Gordian Memorandum” means the Enstar Australia Limited memorandum dated 26 October 2010, reference: Financial Report for the three months ended 30 September 2010.
Hogan Lovells

- 9 -


 

    “Gordian Valuation” means the report by Ernst & Young dated 8 February 2010, addressed to Enstar Australia Limited and entitled ‘Gordian Run-Off Limited Valuation of Insurance Liabilities as at 31 December 2009’.
 
    “Group” means the Parent and each of its Subsidiaries for the time being.
 
    Group Actuarial Report” means the report by Ernst & Young for the period ending 31 December 2009 and the draft report by Ernst & Young for the period ending 30 September 2010, in each case, relating to the Group.
 
    “Group Capital Resources” means the group capital resources of the Parent, as calculated in accordance with INSPRU 6.1.36R or under any rules amending or replacing it.
 
    “Group Capital Resources Report” means any group capital resources report submitted to the FSA in accordance with IPRU(INS), rule 9.40 or as may be defined in any rules amending or replacing it.
 
    “Group Capital Requirement” means the group capital resources requirement of the Parent as calculated in accordance with INSPRU 6.1.33R or under any rules amending or replacing it.
 
    “Group Structure Chart” means the group structure chart in Schedule 11 (Group Structure Chart).
 
    “Guarantor” means an Original Guarantor or an Additional Guarantor unless it has ceased to be a Guarantor in accordance with Clause 27 (Changes to the Obligors).
 
    “Holding Company” means, in relation to a company or corporation, any other company or corporation in respect of which it is a Subsidiary.
 
    “ICA Capital Requirement” means, in respect of an insurer, the amount of capital resources which the board of that insurer considers are required by that insurer in order to have a 99.5% confidence level over a one year timeframe that the value of assets of that insurer will exceed the value of its liabilities, determined in accordance with INSPRU 7, and, following the implementation of Solvency II, shall mean the SCR (as defined in Solvency II) of that insurer as supplemented by any additional capital resources identified as required by that insurer’s Own Risk and Solvency Assessment (as defined in Solvency II).
 
    “ICG Capital Requirement” means, in respect of an insurer, the aggregate of: (a) the ICA Capital Requirement of that insurer; and (b) the amount of capital resources which the FSA indicates in any formal guidance given by it to that insurer or to any member of the Group that it considers that insurer should hold in addition to its ICA Capital Requirement, or which should be held by the Group as a whole in respect of that insurer in addition to that insurer’s ICA Capital Requirement, and, following the implementation of Solvency II, shall mean the aggregate of any capital add-ons (as defined in Solvency II) prescribed by the FSA or any other regulator in respect of that insurer.
 
    “IFRS” means international accounting standards within the meaning of IAS Regulation 1606/2002 to the extent applicable to the relevant financial statements.
 
    “Information Package” means the Reports, the Board Memorandum, the Gordian Memorandum and the Barclays Presentation.
 
    “Intellectual Property” means:
  (a)   any patents, trade marks, service marks, designs, business names, copyrights, database rights, design rights, domain names, moral rights, inventions,
Hogan Lovells

- 10 -


 

      confidential information, knowhow and other intellectual property rights and interests (which may now or in the future subsist), whether registered or unregistered; and
 
  (b)   the benefit of all applications and rights to use such assets of each Group (which may now or in the future subsist).
    “INSPRU” means the Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers forming part of the FSA Rules.
 
    “INSPRU(INS)” means the Interim Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers, forming part of the FSA Rules.
 
    “Intercompany Loans” means those loans listed in Schedule 13 (Intercompany Loans) which are to be repaid with the proceeds of Facility A.
 
    “Interest Period” means, in relation to a Loan, each period determined in accordance with Clause 11 (Interest Periods) and, in relation to an Unpaid Sum, each period determined in accordance with Clause 10.3 (Default interest).
 
    “Investment Policy” means the Group’s investment policy as detailed in the document entitled ‘Investment Policy and Procedures, Version 8.0 — February 3, 2010”.
 
    “ITA” means the Income Tax Act 2007.
 
    “Joint Venture” means any joint venture entity, whether a company, unincorporated firm, undertaking, association, joint venture or partnership or any other entity.
 
    “Knapton” means Knapton Holdings Limited a company registered in England and Wales with registered number 7014132.
 
    “Legal Opinion” means any legal opinion delivered to the Agent under Clause 4.1 (Initial conditions precedent) or Clause 27 (Changes to the Obligors).
 
    “Legal Reservations” means:
  (a)   the principle that equitable remedies may be granted or refused at the discretion of a court and the limitation of enforcement by laws relating to insolvency, reorganisation and other laws generally affecting the rights of creditors;
 
  (b)   the time barring of claims under the Limitation Acts, the possibility that an undertaking to assume liability for or indemnify a person against non-payment of UK stamp duty may be void and defences of set-off or counterclaim;
 
  (c)   similar principles, rights and defences under the laws of any Relevant Jurisdiction; and
 
  (d)   any other matters which are set out as qualifications or reservations as to matters of law of general application in the Legal Opinions.
    “Lender” means:
  (a)   the Original Lender; and
 
  (b)   any bank, financial institution, trust, fund or other entity which has become a Party as a Lender in accordance with Clause 25 (Changes to the Lenders),
    which in each case has not ceased to be a Party in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.
 
    “LIBOR” means, in relation to any Loan:
Hogan Lovells

- 11 -


 

  (a)   the applicable Screen Rate; or
 
  (b)   (if no Screen Rate is available for the currency or Interest Period of that Loan) the Base Reference Bank Rate,
    as of the Specified Time on the Quotation Day for the currency of that Loan and a period comparable to the Interest Period of that Loan.
 
    “Limitation Acts” means the Limitation Act 1980 and the Foreign Limitation Periods Act 1984.
 
    “LMA” means the Loan Market Association.
 
    “Loan” means a Facility A Loan or a Facility B Loan.
 
    “Majority Lenders” means a Lender or Lenders whose Commitments aggregate more than 66⅔ per cent. of the Total Commitments (or, if the Total Commitments have been reduced to zero, aggregated more than 66⅔ per cent. of the Total Commitments immediately prior to that reduction).
 
    “Mandatory Cost” means the percentage rate per annum calculated by the Agent in accordance with Schedule 4 (Mandatory Cost Formula).
 
    “Margin” means 3.00 per cent per annum;
 
    “Material Adverse Effect” means in the reasonable opinion of the Majority Lenders a material adverse effect on:
  (a)   the business, operations, property, condition (financial or otherwise) or prospects of the Group taken as a whole; or
 
  (b)   the ability of an Obligor to perform its obligations under the Finance Documents; or
 
  (c)   the validity or enforceability of, or the effectiveness or ranking of any Security granted or purporting to be granted pursuant to any of, the Finance Documents or the rights or remedies of any Finance Party under any of the Finance Documents.
    “Month” means a period starting on one day in a calendar month and ending on the numerically corresponding day in the next calendar month, except that:
  (a)   (subject to paragraph (c) below) if the numerically corresponding day is not a Business Day, that period shall end on the next Business Day in that calendar month in which that period is to end if there is one, or if there is not, on the immediately preceding Business Day;
 
  (b)   if there is no numerically corresponding day in the calendar month in which that period is to end, that period shall end on the last Business Day in that calendar month; and
 
  (c)   if an Interest Period begins on the last Business Day of a calendar month, that Interest Period shall end on the last Business Day in the calendar month in which that Interest Period is to end.
    The above rules will only apply to the last Month of any period.
 
    “NAB Security” means the debenture dated 19 April 2010 and granted by Knapton Holdings Limited (registered in England and Wales with company number 7014132) in favour of National Australia Bank Limited.
Hogan Lovells

- 12 -


 

    “New Lender” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 25 (Changes to the Lenders).
 
    “Obligor” means the Parent, the Borrower, a Guarantor or a Chargor.
 
    “Obligors’ Agent” means the Parent, appointed to act on behalf of each Obligor in relation to the Finance Documents pursuant to Clause 2.3 (Obligors’ Agent).
 
    “Original Chargor” means the Parent and each Subsidiary of the Parent listed as an Original Chargor in Schedule 1 (The Original Obligors).
 
    “Original Financial Statements” means:
  (a)   in relation to the Parent, its consolidated audited financial statements for its Financial Year ended 31 December 2009;
 
  (b)   in relation to each member of the Secured Group and each Original Obligor other than the Parent, its audited financial statements for its Financial Year ended 31 December 2009; and
 
  (c)   in relation to any other Obligor, its audited financial statements delivered to the Agent as required by Clause 27 (Changes to the Obligors).
    “Original Group” means each member of the Group as at the date of this Agreement.
 
    “Original Group Financial Indebtedness” means any Financial Indebtedness incurred by a member of the Original Group prior to the date of this Agreement or any extension or refinancing of such indebtedness for the same or a lower amount.
 
    “Original Group Security” means any security granted by a member of the Original Group prior to the date of this Agreement.
 
    “Original Obligor” means the Borrower, an Original Guarantor or an Original Chargor.
 
    “Parent CIGNA Guarantee” means a guarantee of up to US$68,000,000 given by the Parent in favour of the CIGNA Entities in respect of the reinsurance obligations of Fitzwilliam Insurance Limited under the CIGNA Reinsurance Arrangements.
 
    “Participating Member State” means any member state of the European Union that adopts or has adopted the euro as its lawful currency in accordance with legislation of the European Union relating to Economic and Monetary Union.
 
    “Party” means a party to this Agreement.
 
    “Permitted Disposal” means any sale, lease, licence, surrender, transfer or other disposal which, except in the case of paragraph (b) below, is on arm’s length terms:
  (a)   of cash made by any member of the Group in the ordinary course of trading of the disposing entity;
 
  (b)   of Cash Equivalent Investments for cash or in exchange for other Cash Equivalent Investments; and
 
  (c)   to which the Majority Lenders have given their prior written consent (and this may include consent to a transaction including shares in any member of the Group).
    “Permitted Distribution” means:
  (a)   the payment of a dividend to the Parent or any of its wholly owned Subsidiaries; and
Hogan Lovells

- 13 -


 

  (b)   the payment of a dividend by the Parent provided that at the time such dividend is declared or paid, no Event of Default is continuing.
    “Permitted Loan” means a loan made by a member of the Group to facilitate the transfer of any Capital Release Amount as required pursuant to Clause 23.28 (Transfer of Capital Release Amount), provided that such loan is subordinated to the Facilities on terms acceptable to the Agent.
 
    “Permitted Security” means:
  (a)   any lien arising by operation of law and in the ordinary course of trading and not as a result of any default or omission by any member of the Group;
 
  (b)   any cash collateral security granted by a member of the Secured Group in relation to letters of credit issued in respect of the obligations of that member of the Secured Group in relation to its contingent obligations in respect of potential claims under insurance contracts;
 
  (c)   Original Group Security;
 
  (d)   any Existing Security (in the case of Existing Security falling with Part 1 or Part 3 of Schedule 14 (Existing Security), until such time as the relevant Security is required to be discharged and released in accordance with Clause 23.29 (Conditions subsequent)) or Transaction Security;
 
  (e)   any Security or Quasi-Security arising under any retention of title, hire purchase or conditional sale arrangement or arrangements having similar effect in respect of goods supplied to the Parent in the ordinary course of trading and on the supplier’s standard or usual terms and not arising as a result of any default or omission by the Parent; and
 
  (f)   any security granted over the shares or any other ownership interest in a member of the Group that is not member of the Original Group or in any joint venture established after the date of this Agreement.
    “Permitted Share Issue” means an issue of shares by a member of the Group which is a Subsidiary to its immediate Holding Company for non-cash consideration where (if the existing shares of the Subsidiary are the subject of the Transaction Security) the newly-issued shares also become subject to the Transaction Security on the same terms.
 
    “Permitted Transaction” means:
  (a)   any disposal required, Financial Indebtedness incurred, guarantee, indemnity or Security or Quasi-Security given, or other transaction arising, under the Finance Documents;
 
  (b)   the solvent liquidation or reorganisation of any member of the Group which is not an Obligor or whose shares have not been charged or pledged by an Obligor so long as any payments or assets distributed as a result of such liquidation or reorganisation are distributed to other members of the Group; or
 
  (c)   transactions (other than (i) any sale, lease, licence, transfer or other disposal; and (ii) the granting or creation of Security, the incurring or permitting to subsist of Financial Indebtedness or the disposal of the shares, in each case, of any member of the Group), conducted in the ordinary course of trading on arm’s length terms.
    “Pillar 1 Capital Requirement” means, in respect of an insurer, the capital resources requirement of that insurer as calculated under GENPRU 2.1, and, following the
Hogan Lovells

- 14 -


 

    implementation of Solvency II, shall mean the SCR (as defined in Solvency II) of that insurer.
 
    “Qualifying Lender” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 14 (Tax gross-up and indemnities).
 
    “Quarter Date” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 22.1 (Financial definitions).
 
    “Quarterly Financial Statement” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 21 (Information undertakings).
 
    “Quasi-Security” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 23.10 (Negative pledge).
 
    “Quotation Day” means, in relation to any period for which an interest rate is to be determined:
  (a)   (if the currency is sterling) the first day of that period;
 
  (b)   (if the currency is euro) two TARGET Days before the first day of that period; or
 
  (c)   (for any other currency) two Business Days before the first day of that period,
    unless market practice differs in the Relevant Interbank Market for a currency, in which case the Quotation Day for that currency will be determined by the Agent in accordance with market practice in the Relevant Interbank Market (and if quotations would normally be given by leading banks in the Relevant Interbank Market on more than one day, the Quotation Day will be the last of those days).
 
    “Receiver” means a receiver or receiver and manager or administrative receiver of the whole or any part of the Charged Property.
 
    “Related Fund” in relation to a fund (the “first fund”), means a fund which is managed or advised by the same investment manager or investment adviser as the first fund or, if it is managed by a different investment manager or investment adviser, a fund whose investment manager or investment adviser is an Affiliate of the investment manager or investment adviser of the first fund.
 
    “Relevant Interbank Market” means in relation to euro, the European interbank market and, in relation to any other currency, the London interbank market.
 
    “Relevant Jurisdiction” means, in relation to an Obligor:
  (a)   its jurisdiction of incorporation;
 
  (b)   any jurisdiction where any asset subject to or intended to be subject to the Transaction Security to be created by it is situated;
 
  (c)   any jurisdiction where it conducts its business; and
 
  (d)   the jurisdiction whose laws govern the perfection of any of the Transaction Security Documents entered into by it.
    “Relevant Period” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 22.1 (Financial definitions).
 
    “Reliance Parties” means the Agent, the Arranger, the Security Agent, the Original Lender and each person which becomes a Lender as a part of the primary syndication of the Facilities.
 
    “Repayment Date” means a Facility A Repayment Date or a Facility B Repayment Date.
Hogan Lovells

- 15 -


 

“Repayment Instalment” means any one or more of the repayment instalments in relation to any Loan provided for in Clause 6.1 (Repayment of Loans).
“Repeating Representations” means each of the representations set out in Clause 20.2 (Status) to Clause 20.7 (Governing law and enforcement), Clause 20.11 (No default), paragraph (g) of Clause 20.12 (No misleading information), Clause 20.13 (Original Financial Statements), Clause 20.18 (Ranking) to Clause 20.20 (Legal and beneficial ownership) and Clause 20.26 (Centre of main interests and establishments).
“Reports” means the CIGNA Actuarial Report and the Group Actuarial Report.
“Representative” means any delegate, agent, manager, administrator, nominee, attorney, trustee or custodian.
“Royston” means Royston Run-off Limited, a company incorporated under the laws of England and Wales whose registered office is at Avaya House, 2 Cathedral Hill, Guildford, Surrey, GU2 7YL with company number 06708757.
“Royston Facility Agreement” means the US$184,616,000 term facility agreement dated 3 October 2008 (as amended and restated on 4 August 2009 and made between, amongst others, Royston as borrower, National Australia Bank Limited Barclays Bank PLC as arrangers and National Australia Bank Limited as agent and security agent.
“Screen Rate” means the British Bankers’ Association Interest Settlement Rate for the relevant currency and period displayed on the appropriate page of the Reuters screen. If the agreed page is replaced or service ceases to be available, the Agent may specify another page or service displaying the appropriate rate after consultation with the Parent and the Lenders.
“Secured Group” means each of:
  (a)   those members of the Group listed in Part 1 (Members of the Secured Group whose shares are subject to Transaction Security) of Schedule 12 (The Secured Group);
 
  (b)   those members of the Group listed in Part 2 (Members of the Secured Group whose shares are not subject to Transaction Security) of Schedule 12 (The Secured Group); and
 
  (c)   those members of the Group whose shares are or are required to be subject to Transaction Security in favour of the Security Agent.
“Secured Parties” means each Finance Party, any Receiver or Delegate.
“Security” means a mortgage, charge, pledge, lien or other security interest securing any obligation of any person or any other agreement or arrangement having a similar effect.
“Solvency II” means the directive of The European Parliament and of the Council of the European Union made in 2009 on the taking-up and pursuit of the business of Insurance and Reinsurance (Solvency II), or any implementing measures or guidance made or published thereunder.
“Specified Time” means a time determined in accordance with Schedule 9 (Timetables).
“Sterling” and “£” means the lawful currency of the UK.
“Subsidiary” means an entity of which a person:
  (a)   has direct or indirect Control; or
Hogan Lovells

- 16 -


 

  (b)   owns directly or indirectly more than fifty per cent. (50%) of the share capital or similar right of ownership; or
 
  (c)   is entitled to receive more than fifty per cent. (50%) of the dividends or distributions,
and any entity (whether or not so controlled) treated as a subsidiary in the latest financial statements of that person from time to time and disregarding, for the purpose of this definition, the fact that any shares in that entity may be held by way of security, that the beneficiary of the security (or its nominee) may be registered as a member of the relevant undertaking and/or that such beneficiary of the security (or its nominee) may be entitled to exercise voting powers and rights with respect to those charged shares.
“SUP” means the Supervision Manual forming part of the FSA Rules.
“TARGET 2” means the Trans-European Automated Real-time Gross Settlement Express Transfer payment system which utilises a single shared platform and which was launched on 19 November 2007.
“TARGET Day” means any day on which TARGET 2 is open for the settlement of payments in euro.
“Tax” means any tax, levy, impost, duty or other charge or withholding of a similar nature (including any penalty or interest payable in connection with any failure to pay or any delay in paying any of the same).
“Termination Date” means the date falling 36 months from the date of this Agreement.
“Total Commitments” means the aggregate of the Total Facility A Commitments and the Total Facility B Commitments, being US$115,000,000 at the date of this Agreement.
“Total Facility A Commitments” means the aggregate of the Facility A Commitments, being US$52,100,000 at the date of this Agreement.
“Total Facility B Commitments” means the aggregate of the Facility B Commitments, being US$62,900,000 at the date of this Agreement.
“Transaction Security” means the Security created or expressed to be created in favour of the Security Agent pursuant to the Transaction Security Documents.
“Transaction Security Documents” means each of the documents listed as being a Transaction Security Document in paragraph 2(c) of Part 1A of Schedule 2 (Conditions precedent), any document required to be delivered to the Agent under paragraph 13 of Part 2 of Schedule 2 (Conditions precedent) together with any other document entered into by any Obligor creating or expressed to create any Security over all or any part of its assets in respect of the obligations of any of the Obligors under any of the Finance Documents.
“Transfer Certificate” means a certificate substantially in the form set out in Schedule 5 (Form of Transfer Certificate) or any other form agreed between the Agent and the Parent.
“Transfer Date” means, in relation to an assignment or transfer, the later of:
  (a)   the proposed Transfer Date specified in the relevant Assignment Agreement or Transfer Certificate; and
 
  (b)   the date on which the Agent executes the relevant Assignment Agreement or Transfer Certificate.
Hogan Lovells

- 17 -


 

“Treasury Transactions” means any derivative transaction entered into in connection with protection against or benefit from fluctuation in any rate or price.
“UK” means the United Kingdom of Great Britain and Northern Ireland.
“Unpaid Sum” means any sum due and payable but unpaid by an Obligor under the Finance Documents.
“USD” “US$” and “US Dollar” means the lawful currency of the United States of America.
“Utilisation” means a Loan.
“Utilisation Date” means the date of a Utilisation being the date on which the relevant Loan is to be made.
“Utilisation Request” means a notice substantially in the relevant form set out in Schedule 3 (Requests).
“VAT” means value added tax as provided for in the Value Added Tax Act 1994 and any other tax of a similar nature.
1.2   Construction
  (a)   Unless a contrary indication appears, a reference in this Agreement to:
  (i)   the “Agent”, the “Arranger”, any “Finance Party”, any “Lender”, any “Obligor”, any “Party”, any “Secured Party”, the “Security Agent” or any other person shall be construed so as to include its successors in title, permitted assigns and permitted transferees and, in the case of the Security Agent, any person for the time being appointed as Security Agent or Security Agents in accordance with the Finance Documents;
 
  (ii)   a document in “agreed form” is a document which is previously agreed in writing by or on behalf of the Parent and the Agent or, if not so agreed, is in the form specified by the Agent;
 
  (iii)   “assets” includes present and future properties, revenues and rights of every description;
 
  (iv)   “Barclays Corporate” means Barclays Corporate, the corporate banking division of Barclays Bank PLC;
 
  (v)   a “Finance Document” or any other agreement or instrument is a reference to that Finance Document or other agreement or instrument as amended, novated, supplemented or extended (in any case, however fundamentally);
 
  (vi)   “guarantee” means (other than in Clause 19 (Guarantee and indemnity)) any guarantee, letter of credit, bond, indemnity or similar assurance against loss, or any obligation, direct or indirect, actual or contingent, to purchase or assume any indebtedness of any person or to make an investment in or loan to any person or to purchase assets of any person where, in each case, such obligation is assumed in order to maintain or assist the ability of such person to meet its indebtedness;
 
  (vii)   “Guarantor”, “Original Guarantor”, “Additional Guarantor” and “this guarantee” shall not be construed restrictively and shall include the
Hogan Lovells

- 18 -


 

payment undertakings and indemnities contained in Clause 19 (Guarantee and indemnity);
  (viii)   “wholly owned subsidiary” means a company or corporation that has no members except for:
  (1)   another company or corporation and that other company’s or corporation’s wholly-owned subsidiaries; or
 
  (2)   persons acting on behalf of that other company or corporation and that other company’s or corporation’s wholly-owned subsidiaries.
  (ix)   “including” and “in particular” shall not be construed restrictively but shall mean “including without prejudice to the generality of the foregoing” and “in particular, but without limitation”;
 
  (x)   “indebtedness” includes any obligation (whether incurred as principal or as surety) for the payment or repayment of money, whether present or future, actual or contingent;
 
  (xi)   a “person” includes any individual, firm, company, corporation, government, state or agency of a state or any association, joint venture, trust, consortium or partnership (whether or not having separate legal personality);
 
  (xii)   a “regulation” includes any regulation, rule, official directive, request, or guideline (whether or not having the force of law) of any governmental, intergovernmental or supranational body, agency or department of any regulatory, self-regulatory or other authority or organisation;
 
  (xiii)   a statute, statutory instrument, rule, regulation or provision shall be construed as a reference to such statute, statutory instrument, rule, regulation or provision as the same may have been, or may from time to time be, amended or supplemented or replaced or extended (including by subordinate legislation) or, in the case of a statute, re-enacted; and
 
  (xiv)   a time of day is a reference to London time.
  (b)   Section, Clause and Schedule headings are for ease of reference only.
 
  (c)   Unless a contrary indication appears, a term used in any other Finance Document or in any notice given under or in connection with any Finance Document has the same meaning in that Finance Document or notice as in this Agreement.
 
  (d)   A Default (other than an Event of Default) is “continuing” if it has not been remedied or waived and an Event of Default is “continuing” if it has not been waived.
 
  (e)   Any consent, waiver or approval required from a Finance Party under a Finance Document must be in writing and will be of no effect if not in writing.
 
  (f)   Reference to a monetary sum specified in the Base Currency in Clause 20 (Representations), Clause 21 (Information undertakings), Clause 22 (Financial covenants), Clause 23 (General undertakings) and/or Clause 24 (Events of Default) shall be deemed to include reference to the Base Currency Equivalent of such sum.
Hogan Lovells

- 19 -


 

1.3   Third party rights
  (a)   Unless expressly provided to the contrary in a Finance Document a person who is not a Party has no right under the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 (the “Third Parties Act”) to enforce or enjoy the benefit of any term of this Agreement.
 
  (b)   Notwithstanding any term of any Finance Document, the consent of any person who is not a Party is not required to rescind or vary this Agreement at any time.
Hogan Lovells

- 20 -


 

Section 2
The Facilities
2. The Facilities
2.1   The Facilities
  (a)   Subject to the terms of this Agreement, the Lenders make available:
  (i)   a Base Currency term loan facility in an aggregate amount equal to the Total Facility A Commitments; and
 
  (ii)   a Base Currency term loan facility in an aggregate amount equal to the Total Facility B Commitments.
  (b)   The Facilities will be available to the Borrowers.
2.2   Finance Parties’ rights and obligations
  (a)   The obligations of each Finance Party under the Finance Documents are several. Failure by a Finance Party to perform its obligations under the Finance Documents does not affect the obligations of any other Party under the Finance Documents. No Finance Party is responsible for the obligations of any other Finance Party under the Finance Documents.
 
  (b)   The rights of each Finance Party under or in connection with the Finance Documents are separate and independent rights and any debt arising under the Finance Documents to a Finance Party from an Obligor shall be a separate and independent debt.
 
  (c)   A Finance Party may, except as otherwise stated in the Finance Documents, separately enforce its rights under the Finance Documents.
2.3   Obligors’ Agent
  (a)   Each Obligor (other than the Parent) by its execution of this Agreement or an Accession Deed irrevocably appoints the Parent to act on its behalf as its agent in relation to the Finance Documents and irrevocably authorises:
  (i)   the Parent on its behalf to supply all information concerning itself contemplated by the Finance Documents to the Finance Parties and to give all notices and instructions (including, in the case of the Borrower, Utilisation Requests), to execute on its behalf any Accession Deed, to make any agreements and to effect any amendments, supplements and variations capable of being given, made or effected by any Obligor notwithstanding that they may affect the Obligor, without further reference to or the consent of that Obligor; and
 
  (ii)   each Finance Party to give any notice, demand or other communication to that Obligor pursuant to the Finance Documents to the Parent,
and in each case the Obligor shall be bound as though the Obligor itself had given the notices and instructions (including, without limitation, any Utilisation Requests) or executed or made the agreements or effected the amendments, supplements or variations, or received the relevant notice, demand or other communication.
  (b)   Every act, omission, agreement, undertaking, settlement, waiver, amendment, supplement, variation, notice or other communication given or made by the
Hogan Lovells

- 21 -


 

Obligors’ Agent or given to the Obligors’ Agent under any Finance Document on behalf of another Obligor or in connection with any Finance Document (whether or not known to any other Obligor and whether occurring before or after such other Obligor became an Obligor under any Finance Document) shall be binding for all purposes on that Obligor as if that Obligor had expressly made, given or concurred with it. In the event of any conflict between any notices or other communications of the Obligors’ Agent and any other Obligor, those of the Obligors’ Agent shall prevail.
3. Purpose
3.1   Purpose
  (a)   The Parent shall apply all amounts borrowed by it under Facility A towards repayment of the Intercompany Loans;
 
  (b)   The Parent shall apply all amounts borrowed by it under Facility B:
  (i)   in an amount of up to US$62,900,000 towards payment of the collateral trust deposit pursuant to the CIGNA Reinsurance Arrangements; or
 
  (ii)   to the extent not required to be utilised pursuant to sub-paragraph (i) above (and in any event subject to a limit of US$2,900,000), towards general corporate and working capital purposes of the Group (but not towards acquisitions of companies, businesses or undertakings or prepayment of any Loan of the Intercompany Loans).
3.2   Monitoring
No Finance Party is bound to monitor or verify the application of any amount borrowed pursuant to this Agreement.
4. Conditions of utilisation
4.1   Initial conditions precedent
The Lenders will only be obliged to comply with Clause 5.4 (Lenders’ participation) in relation to any Utilisation if on or before the Utilisation Date for that Utilisation, the Agent has received all of the documents and other evidence listed in Part 1A and Part 1B of Schedule 2 (Conditions precedent) in form and substance satisfactory to the Agent. The Agent shall notify the Obligors’ Agent and the Lenders promptly upon being so satisfied.
4.2   Further conditions precedent
Subject to Clause 4.1 (Initial conditions precedent), the Lenders will only be obliged to comply with Clause 5.4 (Lenders’ participation) if on the date of the Utilisation Request and on the proposed Utilisation Date:
  (a)   in the case of the first Utilisation, all the representations and warranties in Clause 20 (Representations) or, in relation to any other Utilisation, the Repeating Representations, to be made by each Obligor are true;
 
  (b)   none of the events described in Clause 12.2 (Market disruption) has occurred which has resulted in any Lender being unable to fund its participation in the proposed Utilisation; and
 
  (c)   in relation to a Utilisation of Facility B for the purpose set out at Clause 3.1(b)(i) (Purpose) above, on or before the Utilisation Date for that Utilisation, the Agent
Hogan Lovells

- 22 -


 

has received all of the documents and evidence listed in Part 1B of Schedule 2 (Conditions precedent).
4.3   Maximum number of Utilisations
The Borrower (or the Obligors’ Agent) may not deliver a Utilisation Request if as a result of the proposed Utilisation:
  (a)   two or more Facility A Loans would be outstanding; or
 
  (b)   three or more Facility B Loans would be outstanding.
Hogan Lovells

- 23 -


 

Section 3
Utilisation
5. Utilisation — Loans
5.1   Delivery of a Utilisation Request
The Borrower (or the Obligors’ Agent on its behalf) may utilise a Facility by delivery to the Agent of a duly completed Utilisation Request not later than the Specified Time.
5.2   Completion of a Utilisation Request for Loans
  (a)   Each Utilisation Request for a Loan is irrevocable and will not be regarded as having been duly completed unless:
  (i)   it identifies the Facility to be utilised and specified the purpose against which the Loan will be applied;
 
  (ii)   the proposed Utilisation Date is a Business Day within the Availability Period applicable to that Facility;
 
  (iii)   the currency and amount of the Utilisation comply with Clause 5.3 (Currency and amount); and
 
  (iv)   the proposed Interest Period complies with Clause 11 (Interest Periods).
  (b)   Only one Utilisation may be requested in each Utilisation Request.
5.3   Currency and amount
  (a)   The currency specified in a Utilisation Request must be the Base Currency.
 
  (b)   Facility A shall be drawn in full in one Utilisation.
 
  (c)   The amount of a proposed Utilisation in respect of Facility B shall be must be the amount specified in either sub-paragraph (b)(i) or (b)(ii) of Clause 3.1 (Purpose).
5.4   Lenders’ participation
  (a)   If the conditions set out in this Agreement have been met, each Lender shall make its participation in each Loan available by the Utilisation Date through its Facility Office.
 
  (b)   The amount of each Lender’s participation in each Loan will be equal to the proportion borne by its Available Commitment to the Available Facility immediately prior to making the Loan.
5.5   Cancellation of Commitment
The Commitments which, at that time, are unutilised shall be immediately cancelled at the end of the Availability Period for the Facility.
Hogan Lovells

- 24 -


 

Section 4
Repayment, prepayment and cancellation
6. Repayment
6.1   Repayment of Loans
  (a)   The Borrowers under Facility A shall repay the aggregate Loans in instalments by repaying on each Facility A Repayment Date an amount which reduces the Base Currency Amount of the outstanding aggregate Facility A Loans by the amount set out opposite that Facility A Repayment Date below:
         
Facility A Repayment Date   Repayment Instalment  
The date falling 12 months from the date of this Agreement.
  US$ 17,366,666.66  
 
       
The date falling 24 months from the date of this Agreement.
  US$ 17,366,666.67  
 
       
The date falling 36 months from the date of this Agreement.
  US$ 17,366,666.67  
  (b)   The Borrowers under Facility B shall repay the aggregate Loans in instalments by repaying on each Facility B Repayment Date an amount which reduces the Base Currency Amount of the outstanding aggregate Facility B Loans by the amount set out opposite that Facility B Repayment Date below:
         
Facility B Repayment Date   Repayment Instalment  
The date falling 12 months from the date of this Agreement.
  US$ 20,966,666.66  
 
       
The date falling 24 months from the date of this Agreement.
  US$ 20,966,666.67  
 
       
The date falling 36 months from the date of this Agreement.
  US$ 20,966,666.67  
  (c)   The Borrowers may not reborrow any part of a Facility which is repaid.
6.2   Effect of cancellation and prepayment on scheduled repayments and reductions
  (a)   If the Obligors’ Agent cancels the whole or any part of the Facility A Commitments or Facility B Commitments in accordance with Clause 7.4 (Right of cancellation and repayment in relation to a single Lender) or if the Facility A Commitment or Facility B Commitment of any Lender is reduced under Clause 7.1 (Illegality) then the amount of the Repayment Instalment in relation to the relevant Facility for each Repayment Date falling after that cancellation will reduce pro rata by the amount cancelled.
 
  (b)   If the Obligors’ Agent cancels the whole or any part of the Facility A Commitments or Facility B Commitments, in accordance with Clause 7.2 (Voluntary cancellation) then the amount of the Repayment Instalment in relation to the relevant Facility for
Hogan Lovells

- 25 -


 

each Repayment Date falling after that cancellation will reduce pro rata by the amount cancelled.
  (c)   If any of the Facility A Loans or Facility B Loans are prepaid in accordance with Clause 7.4 (Right of cancellation and repayment in relation to a single Lender) or Clause 7.1 (Illegality) then the amount of the Repayment Instalment for the relevant Facility for each Repayment Date falling after that prepayment will reduce pro rata by the amount of the relevant Loan prepaid.
 
  (d)   If any of the Facility A Loans or Facility B Loans are prepaid in accordance with Clause 7.3 (Voluntary prepayment of Loans) then the amount of the Repayment Instalment for each Repayment Date falling after that prepayment will reduce pro rata by the amount prepaid.
7. Illegality, voluntary prepayment and cancellation
7.1   Illegality
If it becomes unlawful in any applicable jurisdiction for a Lender to perform any of its obligations as contemplated by this Agreement or to fund, issue or maintain its participation in any Utilisation:
  (a)   that Lender, shall promptly notify the Agent upon becoming aware of that event;
 
  (b)   upon the Agent notifying the Obligors’ Agent, the Commitment of that Lender will be immediately cancelled; and
 
  (c)   the Borrower shall repay that Lender’s participation in the Utilisations on the last day of the Interest Period for each Utilisation occurring after the Agent has notified the Obligors’ Agent or, if earlier, the date specified by the Lender in the notice delivered to the Agent (being no earlier than the last day of any applicable grace period permitted by law).
7.2   Voluntary cancellation
The Obligors’ Agent may, if it gives the Agent not less than 5 Business Days’ (or such shorter period as the Majority Lenders may agree) prior notice, cancel the whole or any part (being a minimum amount of US$1,000,000) of an Available Facility. Any cancellation under this Clause 7.2 shall reduce the Commitments of the Lenders rateably under that Facility.
7.3   Voluntary prepayment of Loans
  (a)   The Borrower to which a Loan has been made may, if it or the Obligors’ Agent gives the Agent not less than 5 Business Days’ (or such shorter period as the Majority Lenders may agree) prior notice, prepay the whole or any part of that Loan (but, if in part, being an amount that reduces the Base Currency Amount of that Loan by a minimum amount of US$1,000,000).
  (b)   A Loan may only be prepaid after the last day of the Availability Period relating to the Facility (or, if earlier, the day on which the applicable Available Facility is zero).
7.4   Right of cancellation and repayment in relation to a single Lender
  (a)   If:
  (i)   any sum payable to any Lender by an Obligor is required to be increased under paragraph (c) of Clause 14.2 (Tax gross-up); or
Hogan Lovells

- 26 -


 

  (ii)   any Lender claims indemnification from the Obligors’ Agent or an Obligor under Clause 14.3 (Tax indemnity) or Clause 15 (Increased Costs),
the Obligors’ Agent may, whilst the circumstance giving rise to the requirement for that increase or indemnification continues give the Agent notice of cancellation of the Commitment of that Lender and its intention to procure the repayment of that Lender’s participation in the Utilisations.
  (b)   On receipt of a notice referred to in paragraph (a) above in relation to a Lender, the Commitment of that Lender shall immediately be reduced to zero.
  (c)   On the last day of each Interest Period which ends after the Obligors’ Agent has given notice under paragraph (a) above in relation to a Lender (or, if earlier, the date specified by the Obligors’ Agent in that notice), the Borrower shall repay that Lender’s participation in that Utilisation together with all interest and other amounts accrued under the Finance Documents.
8. Mandatory prepayment
8.1   Exit
  (a)   Upon the occurrence of:
  (i)   a Change of Control; or
 
  (ii)   the sale of all or substantially all of the assets of the Group whether in a single transaction or a series of related transactions,
the Parent and the Agent shall enter into good faith negotiations to determine how the Facilities can continue to remain outstanding and be made available by the Lenders. If no agreement is reached within 30 days of the Change of Control, the Facilities will be immediately cancelled and all outstanding Utilisations, together with accrued interest, and all other amounts accrued under the Finance Documents, shall become due and payable 5 days after such cancellation.
9. Restrictions
9.1   Notices of cancellation or prepayment
Any notice of cancellation, prepayment, authorisation or other election given by any Party under Clause 7 (Illegality, voluntary prepayment and cancellation) (subject to the terms of those Clauses) shall be irrevocable and, unless a contrary indication appears in this Agreement, shall specify the date or dates upon which the relevant cancellation or prepayment is to be made and the amount of that cancellation or prepayment.
9.2   Interest and other amounts
Any prepayment under this Agreement shall be made together with accrued interest on the amount prepaid and, subject to any Break Costs, without premium or penalty.
9.3   No reborrowing of Facilities
No Borrower may reborrow any part of a Facility which is prepaid.
9.4   Prepayment in accordance with Agreement
No Borrower shall repay or prepay all or any part of the Utilisations or cancel all or any part of the Commitments except at the times and in the manner expressly provided for in this Agreement.
Hogan Lovells

- 27 -


 

9.5   No reinstatement of Commitments
No amount of the Total Commitments cancelled under this Agreement may be subsequently reinstated.
9.6   Agent’s receipt of Notices
If the Agent receives a notice under Clause 7 (Illegality, voluntary prepayment and cancellation) it shall promptly forward a copy of that notice or election to either the Obligors’ Agent or the affected Lender, as appropriate.
9.7   Effect of Repayment and Prepayment on Commitments
If all or part of a Utilisation under a Facility is repaid or prepaid and is not available for redrawing (other than by operation of Clause 4.2 (Further conditions precedent)), an amount of the Commitments (equal to the Base Currency Amount of the amount of the Utilisation which is repaid or prepaid) in respect of that Facility will be deemed to be cancelled on the date of repayment or prepayment. Any cancellation under this Clause 9.7 shall reduce the Commitments of the Lenders rateably under that Facility.
Hogan Lovells

- 28 -


 

Section 5
Costs of Utilisation
10. Interest
10.1   Calculation of interest
  (a)   The rate of interest on each Loan for each Interest Period is the percentage rate per annum which is the aggregate of the applicable:
  (i)   Margin;
  (ii)   LIBOR; and
 
  (iii)   Mandatory Cost, if any.
10.2   Payment of interest
The Borrower to which a Loan has been made shall pay accrued interest on that Loan on the last day of each Interest Period.
10.3   Default interest
  (a)   If an Obligor fails to pay any amount payable by it under a Finance Document on its due date, interest shall accrue on the overdue amount from the due date up to the date of actual payment (both before and after judgment) at a rate which, subject to paragraph (b) below, is one per cent higher than the rate which would have been payable if the overdue amount had, during the period of non-payment, constituted a Loan in the currency of the overdue amount for successive Interest Periods, each of a duration selected by the Agent (acting reasonably). Any interest accruing under this Clause 10.3 shall be immediately payable by the Obligor on demand by the Agent.
  (b)   If any overdue amount consists of all or part of a Loan which became due on a day which was not the last day of an Interest Period relating to that Loan:
  (i)   the first Interest Period for that overdue amount shall have a duration equal to the unexpired portion of the current Interest Period relating to that Loan; and
 
  (ii)   the rate of interest applying to the overdue amount during that first Interest Period shall be one per cent higher than the rate which would have applied if the overdue amount had not become due.
  (c)   Default interest (if unpaid) arising on an overdue amount will be compounded with the overdue amount at the end of each Interest Period applicable to that overdue amount but will remain immediately due and payable.
10.4   Notification of rates of interest
The Agent shall promptly notify the Lenders and the relevant Borrower (or the Obligors’ Agent) of the determination of a rate of interest under this Agreement.
11. Interest Periods
11.1   Selection of Interest Periods and Terms
  (a)   The Interest Period for a Loan shall be three Months.
Hogan Lovells

- 29 -


 

  (b)   An Interest Period for a Loan shall not extend beyond the Termination Date.
  (c)   Each Interest Period for a Loan shall start on the Utilisation Date or (if already made) on the last day of its preceding Interest Period.
11.2   Non-Business Days
If an Interest Period would otherwise end on a day which is not a Business Day, that Interest Period will instead end on the next Business Day in that calendar month (if there is one) or the preceding Business Day (if there is not).
11.3   Consolidation Loans
If two or more Interest Periods:
  (a)   relate to Loans made to the same Borrower; and
  (b)   end on the same date,
those Loans will, be consolidated into, and treated as, a single Loan on the last day of the Interest Period.
12. Changes to the calculation of interest
12.1   Absence of quotations
Subject to Clause 12.2 (Market disruption) if LIBOR is to be determined by reference to the Base Reference Banks but a Base Reference Bank does not supply a quotation by the Specified Time on the Quotation Day, the applicable LIBOR shall be determined on the basis of the quotations of the remaining Base Reference Banks.
12.2   Market disruption
  (a)   If a Market Disruption Event occurs in relation to a Loan for any Interest Period, then the rate of interest on each Lender’s share of that Loan for the Interest Period shall be the percentage rate per annum which is the sum of:
  (i)   the Margin;
 
  (ii)   the rate notified to the Agent by that Lender as soon as practicable and in any event by close of business on the date falling 2 Business Days after the Quotation Day (or, if earlier, on the date falling 2 Business Days prior to the date on which interest is due to be paid in respect of that Interest Period), to be that which expresses as a percentage rate per annum the cost to that Lender of funding its participation in that Loan from whatever source it may reasonably select; and
 
  (iii)   the Mandatory Cost, if any, applicable to that Lender’s participation in the Loan.
  (b)   If:
  (i)   the percentage rate per annum notified by a Lender pursuant to paragraph (a)(ii) above is less than LIBOR; or
 
  (ii)   a Lender has not notified the Agent of a percentage rate per annum pursuant to paragraph (a)(ii) above,
the cost to that Lender of funding its participation in that Loan for that Interest Period shall be deemed, for the purposes of paragraph (a) above, to be LIBOR.
Hogan Lovells

- 30 -


 

  (c)   In this Agreement:
“Market Disruption Event” means:
  (i)   at or about noon on the Quotation Day for the relevant Interest Period the Screen Rate is not available and none or only one of the Base Reference Banks supplies a rate to the Agent to determine LIBOR for the relevant currency and Interest Period; or
 
  (ii)   before close of business in London on the Quotation Day for the relevant Interest Period, the Agent receives notifications from a Lender or Lenders (whose participations in a Loan exceed 30 per cent of that Loan) that the cost to it of funding its participation in that Loan from whatever source it may reasonably select would be in excess of LIBOR.
12.3   Alternative basis of interest or funding
  (a)   If a Market Disruption Event occurs and the Agent or the Parent so requires, the Agent and the Obligors’ Agent shall enter into negotiations (for a period of not more than 30 days) with a view to agreeing a substitute basis for determining the rate of interest.
  (b)   Any alternative basis agreed pursuant to paragraph (a) above shall, with the prior consent of all the Lenders and the Obligors’ Agent, be binding on all Parties.
12.4   Break Costs
  (a)   The Borrower shall, within three Business Days of demand by a Finance Party, pay to that Finance Party its Break Costs attributable to all or any part of a Loan or Unpaid Sum being paid by the Borrower on a day other than the last day of an Interest Period for that Loan or Unpaid Sum.
  (b)   Each Lender shall, as soon as reasonably practicable after a demand by the Agent, provide a certificate confirming the amount of its Break Costs for any Interest Period in which they accrue.
13. Fees
13.1   Arrangement fee
The Parent shall pay to the Arranger an arrangement fee in the amount, manner and at the times agreed in a Fee Letter.
13.2   Prepayment fee
If a prepayment is made in full under Clause 7.3 (Voluntary prepayment of Loans) as a result of a refinancing or proposed refinancing of the Facilities with a third party, the Parent shall pay with the proposed prepayment a fee in an amount equal to 1% per cent of the amount to be prepaid to the Agent for distribution to the Lenders.
Hogan Lovells

- 31 -


 

Section 6
Additional payment obligations
14.   Tax gross-up and indemnities
 
14.1   Definitions
  (a)   In this Agreement:
 
      “Protected Party” means a Finance Party which is or will be subject to any liability or required to make any payment for or on account of Tax in relation to a sum received or receivable (or any sum deemed for the purposes of Tax to be received or receivable) under a Finance Document.
 
      “Qualifying Lender” means:
  (i)   a Lender (other than a Lender within paragraph (ii) below) which is beneficially entitled to interest payable to that Lender in respect of an advance under a Finance Document and is:
  (1)   a Lender:
  (A)   which is a bank (as defined for the purpose of Section 879 of the ITA) making an advance under a Finance Document; or
 
  (B)   in respect of an advance made under a Finance Document by a person that was a bank (as defined for the purpose of Section 879 of the ITA) at the time that that advance was made,
      and which is within the charge to United Kingdom corporation tax as respects any payments of interest made in respect of that advance;
 
  (2)   a Lender which is:
  (A)   a company resident in the United Kingdom for United Kingdom tax purposes;
 
  (B)   a partnership each member of which is:
  (aa)   a company so resident in the United Kingdom; or
 
  (bb)   a company not so resident in the United Kingdom which carries on a trade in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment and which brings into account in computing its chargeable profits (within the meaning of section 19 of the CTA) the whole of any share of interest payable in respect of that advance that falls to it by reason of Part 17 of the CTA;
 
  (cc)   a company not so resident in the United Kingdom which carries on a trade in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment and which brings into account interest payable in respect of that advance in computing the chargeable profits
Hogan Lovells

- 32 -


 

      (within the meaning of section 19 of the CTA) of that company; or
  (3)   a Treaty Lender; or
  (ii)   a building society (as defined for the purposes of Section 880 of the ITA) making an advance under a Finance Document.
      “Tax Confirmation” means a confirmation by a Lender that the person beneficially entitled to interest payable to that Lender in respect of an advance under a Finance Document is either:
  (i)   a company resident in the United Kingdom for United Kingdom tax purposes;
 
  (ii)   a partnership each member of which is:
  (1)   a company so resident in the United Kingdom; or
 
  (2)   a company not so resident in the United Kingdom which carries on a trade in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment and which brings into account in computing its chargeable profits (within the meaning of section 19 of the CTA) the whole of any share of interest payable in respect of that advance that falls to it by reason of Part 17 of the CTA; or
  (iii)   a company not so resident in the United Kingdom which carries on a trade in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment and which brings into account interest payable in respect of that advance in computing the chargeable profits (within the meaning of section 19 of the CTA) of that company.
      “Tax Credit” means a credit against, relief or remission for, or repayment of, any Tax.
 
      “Tax Deduction” means a deduction or withholding for or on account of Tax from a payment under a Finance Document.
 
      “Tax Payment” means either the increase in a payment made by an Obligor to a Finance Party under Clause 14.2 (Tax gross-up) or a payment under Clause 14.3 (Tax indemnity).
 
      “Treaty Lender” means a Lender which:
  (i)   is treated as a resident of a Treaty State for the purposes of the Treaty; and
 
  (ii)   does not carry on a business in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment with which that Lender’s participation in the Loan is effectively connected;
      “Treaty State” means a jurisdiction having a double taxation agreement (a “Treaty”) with the United Kingdom which makes provision for full exemption from tax imposed by the United Kingdom on interest; and
Hogan Lovells

- 33 -


 

      “UK Non-Bank Lender” means, where a Lender becomes a Party after the day on which this Agreement is entered into, a Lender which gives a Tax Confirmation in the Assignment Agreement or Transfer Certificate which it executes on becoming a Party.
    Unless a contrary indication appears, in this Clause 14 a reference to “determines” or “determined” means a determination made in the absolute discretion of the person making the determination.
 
14.2   Tax gross-up
  (a)   Each Obligor shall make all payments to be made by it without any Tax Deduction, unless a Tax Deduction is required by law.
 
  (b)   The Parent shall promptly upon becoming aware that an Obligor must make a Tax Deduction (or that there is any change in the rate or the basis of a Tax Deduction) notify the Agent accordingly. Similarly, a Lender shall notify the Agent on becoming so aware in respect of a payment payable to that Lender. If the Agent receives such notification from a Lender it shall notify the Parent and that Obligor.
 
  (c)   If a Tax Deduction is required by law to be made by an Obligor, the amount of the payment due from that Obligor shall be increased to an amount which (after making any Tax Deduction) leaves an amount equal to the payment which would have been due if no Tax Deduction had been required.
 
  (d)   A payment shall not be increased under paragraph (c) above by reason of a Tax Deduction on account of tax imposed by the United Kingdom, if on the date on which the payment falls due:
  (i)   the payment could have been made to the relevant Lender without a Tax Deduction if the Lender had been a Qualifying Lender, but on that date that Lender is not or has ceased to be a Qualifying Lender other than as a result of any change after the date it became a Lender under this Agreement in (or in the interpretation, administration, or application of) any law or Treaty, or any published practice or published concession of any relevant taxing authority; or
 
  (ii)   the relevant Lender is a Qualifying Lender solely by virtue of paragraph (i)(2) of the definition of Qualifying Lender; and
  (1)   an officer of H.M. Revenue & Customs has given (and not revoked) a direction (a “Direction”) under section 931 of the ITA which relates to the payment and that Lender has received from the Obligor making the payment or from the Parent a certified copy of that Direction; and
 
  (2)   the payment could have been made to the Lender without any Tax Deduction if that Direction had not been made; or
  (iii)   the relevant Lender is a Qualifying Lender solely by virtue of paragraph (i)(2) of the definition of Qualifying Lender and:
  (1)   the relevant Lender has not given a Tax Confirmation to the Parent; and
 
  (2)   the payment could have been made to the Lender without any Tax Deduction if the Lender had given a Tax Confirmation to the Parent, on the basis that the Tax Confirmation would have enabled
Hogan Lovells

- 34 -


 

      the Parent to have formed a reasonable belief that the payment was an “exceptional payment” for the purpose of section 930 of the ITA; or
  (iv)   the relevant Lender is a Treaty Lender and the Obligor making the payment is able to demonstrate that the payment could have been made to the Lender without the Tax Deduction had that Lender complied with its obligations under paragraph (g) below.
  (e)   If an Obligor is required to make a Tax Deduction, that Obligor shall make that Tax Deduction and any payment required in connection with that Tax Deduction within the time allowed and in the minimum amount required by law.
 
  (f)   Within 30 days of making either a Tax Deduction or any payment required in connection with that Tax Deduction, the Obligor making that Tax Deduction shall deliver to the Agent for the Finance Party entitled to the payment a statement under section 975 of the ITA or other evidence reasonably satisfactory to that Finance Party that the Tax Deduction has been made or (as applicable) any appropriate payment paid to the relevant taxing authority.
 
  (g)    
  (i)   Subject to paragraph (ii) below, a Treaty Lender and each Obligor which makes a payment to which that Treaty Lender is entitled shall co-operate in completing any procedural formalities necessary for that Obligor to obtain authorisation to make that payment without a Tax Deduction;
 
  (ii)   Nothing in paragraph (i) above shall require a Treaty Lender to:
  (1)   register under the HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme;
 
  (2)   apply the HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme to any Utilisation if it has so registered; or
 
  (3)   file Treaty forms if it has included an indication to the effect that it wishes the HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme to apply to this Agreement in accordance with paragraph (j) below or paragraph (a) of Clause 14.6 (HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme confirmation) and the Obligor making that payment has not complied with its obligations under paragraph (k) below or paragraph (b) of Clause 14.6 (HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme confirmation).
  (h)   A UK Non-Bank Lender which becomes a Party on the day on which this Agreement is entered into gives a Tax Confirmation to the Parent by entering into this Agreement.
 
  (i)   A UK Non-Bank Lender shall promptly notify the Parent and the Agent if there is any change in the position from that set out in the Tax Confirmation.
 
  (j)   A Treaty Lender which becomes a Party on the day on which this Agreement is entered into that holds a passport under the HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme, and which wishes that scheme to apply to this Agreement, shall include an indication to that effect (for the benefit of the Agent and without liability to any Obligor) by notifying the Agent of its scheme reference number and its jurisdiction of tax residence.
Hogan Lovells

- 35 -


 

  (k)   Where a Lender includes the indication described in paragraph (j) above in Part 2 of Schedule 1 (The Original Obligors), the Borrower shall, to the extent that that Lender is a Lender under a Facility made available to the Borrower pursuant to Clause 2.1 (The Facilities), file a duly completed form DTTP2 in respect of such Lender with HM Revenue & Customs within 30 days of the date of this Agreement and shall promptly provide the Lender with a copy of that filing; and
 
  (l)   If a Lender has not included an indication to the effect that it wishes the HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme to apply to this Agreement in accordance with paragraph (j) above or paragraph (a) of Clause 14.6 (HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme confirmation), no Obligor shall file any form relating to the HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme in respect of that Lender’s Commitment(s) or its participation in any Utilisation.
14.3   Tax indemnity
  (a)   The Parent shall (within three Business Days of demand by the Agent) pay to a Protected Party an amount equal to the loss, liability or cost which that Protected Party determines will be or has been (directly or indirectly) suffered for or on account of Tax by that Protected Party in respect of a Finance Document.
 
  (b)   Paragraph (a) above shall not apply:
  (i)   with respect to any Tax assessed on a Finance Party:
  (1)   under the law of the jurisdiction in which that Finance Party is incorporated or, if different, the jurisdiction (or jurisdictions) in which that Finance Party is treated as resident for tax purposes; or
 
  (2)   under the law of the jurisdiction in which that Finance Party’s Facility Office is located in respect of amounts received or receivable in that jurisdiction,
      if that Tax is imposed on or calculated by reference to the net income received or receivable (but not any sum deemed to be received or receivable) by that Finance Party; or
 
  (ii)   to the extent a loss, liability or cost:
  (1)   is compensated for by an increased payment under Clause 14.2 (Tax gross-up); or
 
  (2)   would have been compensated for by an increased payment under Clause 14.2 (Tax gross-up) but was not so compensated solely because one of the exclusions in paragraph (d) of Clause 14.2 (Tax gross-up) applied.
  (c)   A Protected Party making, or intending to make a claim under paragraph (a) above shall promptly notify the Agent of the event which will give, or has given, rise to the claim, following which the Agent shall notify the Parent.
 
  (d)   A Protected Party shall, on receiving a payment from an Obligor under this Clause 14.3, notify the Agent.
14.4   Tax Credit
 
    If an Obligor makes a Tax Payment and the relevant Finance Party determines that:
Hogan Lovells

- 36 -


 

  (a)   a Tax Credit is attributable either to an increased payment of which that Tax Payment forms part or to that Tax Payment; and
 
  (b)   that Finance Party has obtained, utilised and retained that Tax Credit,
    the Finance Party shall pay an amount to the Obligor which that Finance Party determines will leave it (after that payment) in the same after-Tax position as it would have been in had the Tax Payment not been required to be made by the Obligor.
 
14.5   Lender Status Confirmation
 
    Each Lender which becomes a Party to this Agreement after the date of this Agreement shall indicate, in the Transfer Certificate or Assignment Agreement which it executes on becoming a Party, and for the benefit of the Agent and without liability to any Obligor, which of the following categories it falls in:
  (a)   not a Qualifying Lender;
 
  (b)   a Qualifying Lender (other than a Treaty Lender); or
 
  (c)   a Treaty Lender.
    If a New Lender fails to indicate its status in accordance with this Clause 14.5 then such New Lender shall be treated for the purposes of this Agreement (including by each Obligor) as if it is not a Qualifying Lender until such time as it notifies the Agent which category applies (and the Agent upon receipt of such notification, shall inform the Parent). For the avoidance of doubt, a Transfer Certificate or Assignment Agreement shall not be invalidated by any failure of a Lender to comply with this Clause 14.5.
 
14.6   HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme confirmation
  (a)   A New Lender that is a Treaty Lender that holds a passport under the HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme, and which wishes that scheme to apply to this Agreement, shall include an indication to that effect (for the benefit of the Agent and without liability to any Obligor) in the Transfer Certificate or Assignment Agreement which it executes by including its scheme reference number and its jurisdiction of tax residence in that Transfer Certificate or Assignment Agreement.
 
  (b)   Where a New Lender includes the indication described in paragraph (a) above in the relevant Transfer Certificate or Assignment Agreement the Borrower shall, to the extent that that New Lender becomes a Lender under a Facility which is made available to the Borrower pursuant to Clause 2.1 (The Facilities), file a duly completed form DTTP2 in respect of such Lender with HM Revenue & Customs within 30 days of that Transfer Date or that date on which the increase in Total Commitments takes effect and shall promptly provide the Lender with a copy of that filing.
14.7   Stamp taxes
 
    The Parent shall pay and, within three Business Days of demand, indemnify each Secured Party and Arranger against any cost, loss or liability that Secured Party or Arranger incurs in relation to all stamp duty, registration and other similar Taxes payable in respect of any Finance Document.
 
14.8   Value added tax
  (a)   All amounts set out or expressed in a Finance Document to be payable by any Party to a Finance Party which (in whole or in part) constitute the consideration for a supply or supplies for VAT purposes shall be deemed to be exclusive of any
Hogan Lovells

- 37 -


 

      VAT which is chargeable on such supply or supplies, and accordingly, subject to paragraph (b) below, if VAT is or becomes chargeable on any supply made by any Finance Party to any Party under a Finance Document, that Party shall pay to the Finance Party (in addition to and at the same time as paying any other consideration for such supply) an amount equal to the amount of such VAT (and such Finance Party shall promptly provide an appropriate VAT invoice to such Party).
 
  (b)   If VAT is or becomes chargeable on any supply made by any Finance Party (the “Supplier”) to any other Finance Party (the “Recipient”) under a Finance Document, and any Party other than the Recipient (the “Subject Party”) is required by the terms of any Finance Document to pay an amount equal to the consideration for such supply to the Supplier (rather than being required to reimburse the Recipient in respect of that consideration), such Party shall also pay to the Supplier (in addition to and at the same time as paying such amount) an amount equal to the amount of such VAT. The Recipient will promptly pay to the Subject Party an amount equal to any credit or repayment obtained by the Recipient from the relevant tax authority which the Recipient reasonably determines is in respect of such VAT.
 
  (c)   Where a Finance Document requires any Party to reimburse or indemnify a Finance Party for any cost or expense, that Party shall reimburse or indemnify (as the case may be) such Finance Party for the full amount of such cost or expense, including such part thereof as represents VAT, save to the extent that such Finance Party reasonably determines that it is entitled to credit or repayment in respect of such VAT from the relevant tax authority.
 
  (d)   Any reference in this Clause 14.8 to any Party shall, at any time when such Party is treated as a member of a group for VAT purposes, include (where appropriate and unless the context otherwise requires) a reference to the representative member of such group at such time (the term “representative member” to have the same meaning as in the Value Added Tax Act 1994).
15.   Increased Costs
 
15.1   Increased Costs
  (a)   Subject to Clause 15.3 (Exceptions) the Parent shall, within three Business Days of a demand by the Agent, pay for the account of a Finance Party the amount of any Increased Costs incurred by that Finance Party or any of its Affiliates as a result of (i) the introduction of or any change in (or in the interpretation, administration or application of) any law or regulation or (ii) compliance with any law or regulation made after the date of this Agreement.
 
  (b)   In this Agreement “Increased Costs” means:
  (i)   a reduction in the rate of return from a Facility or on a Finance Party’s (or its Affiliate’s) overall capital;
 
  (ii)   an additional or increased cost; or
 
  (iii)   a reduction of any amount due and payable under any Finance Document,
      which is incurred or suffered by a Finance Party or any of its Affiliates to the extent that it is attributable to that Finance Party having entered into its Commitment or funding or performing its obligations under any Finance Document.
Hogan Lovells

- 38 -


 

15.2   Increased cost claims
  (a)   A Finance Party intending to make a claim pursuant to Clause 15.1 (Increased Costs) shall notify the Agent of the event giving rise to the claim, following which the Agent shall promptly notify the Parent.
 
  (b)   Each Finance Party shall, as soon as practicable after a demand by the Agent, provide a certificate confirming the amount of its Increased Costs.
15.3   Exceptions
  (a)   Clause 15.1 (Increased Costs) does not apply to the extent any Increased Cost is:
  (i)   attributable to a Tax Deduction required by law to be made by an Obligor;
 
  (ii)   compensated for by Clause 14.3 (Tax indemnity) (or would have been compensated for under Clause 14.3 (Tax indemnity) but was not so compensated solely because any of the exclusions in paragraph (b) of Clause 14.3 (Tax indemnity) applied);
 
  (iii)   compensated for by the payment of the Mandatory Cost; or
 
  (iv)   attributable to the wilful breach by the relevant Finance Party or its Affiliates of any law or regulation.
  (b)   In this Clause 15.3 reference to a “Tax Deduction” has the same meaning given to the term in Clause 14.1 (Definitions).
16.   Other indemnities
 
16.1   Currency indemnity
  (a)   If any sum due from an Obligor under the Finance Documents (a “Sum”), or any order, judgment or award given or made in relation to a Sum, has to be converted from the currency (the “First Currency”) in which that Sum is payable into another currency (the “Second Currency”) for the purpose of:
  (i)   making or filing a claim or proof against that Obligor; or
 
  (ii)   obtaining or enforcing an order, judgment or award in relation to any litigation or arbitration proceedings,
      that Obligor shall as an independent obligation, within three Business Days of demand, indemnify the Arranger and each other Secured Party to whom that Sum is due against any cost, loss or liability arising out of or as a result of the conversion including any discrepancy between (1) the rate of exchange used to convert that Sum from the First Currency into the Second Currency and (2) the rate or rates of exchange available to that person at the time of its receipt of that Sum.
 
  (b)   Each Obligor waives any right it may have in any jurisdiction to pay any amount under the Finance Documents in a currency or currency unit other than that in which it is expressed to be payable.
16.2   Other indemnities
 
    The Parent shall (or shall procure that an Obligor will), within three Business Days of demand, indemnify the Arranger and each other Secured Party against any cost, loss or liability incurred by it as a result of:
Hogan Lovells

- 39 -


 

  (a)   the occurrence or continuance of any Event of Default;
 
  (b)   a failure by an Obligor to pay any amount due under a Finance Document on its due date, including without limitation, any cost, loss or liability arising as a result of Clause 30 (Sharing among the Finance Parties);
 
  (c)   funding, or making arrangements to fund, its participation in a Utilisation requested by the Borrower (or the Obligors’ Agent on its behalf) in a Utilisation Request but not made by reason of the operation of any one or more of the provisions of this Agreement (other than by reason of default or negligence by that Finance Party alone);
 
  (d)   a Utilisation (or part of a Utilisation) not being prepaid in accordance with a notice of prepayment given by the Borrower or the Obligors’ Agent.
16.3   Indemnity to the Agent
 
    The Parent shall promptly indemnify the Agent against any cost, loss or liability incurred by the Agent (acting reasonably) as a result of:
  (a)   investigating any event which it reasonably believes is a Default; or
 
  (b)   acting or relying on any notice, request or instruction which it reasonably believes to be genuine, correct and appropriately authorised.
16.4   Indemnity to the Security Agent
  (a)   Each Obligor shall promptly indemnify the Security Agent and every Receiver and Delegate against any cost, loss or liability incurred by any of them as a result of:
  (i)   the taking, holding, protection or enforcement of the Transaction Security;
 
  (ii)   the exercise of any of the rights, powers, discretions and remedies vested in the Security Agent and each Receiver and Delegate by the Finance Documents or by law; and
 
  (iii)   any default by any Obligor in the performance of any of the obligations expressed to be assumed by it in the Finance Documents.
  (b)   The Security Agent may, in priority to any payment to the Secured Parties, indemnify itself out of the Charged Property in respect of, and pay and retain, all sums necessary to give effect to the indemnity in this Clause 16.4 and shall have a lien on the Transaction Security and the proceeds of the enforcement of the Transaction Security for all moneys payable to it.
17.   Mitigation by the Lenders
 
17.1   Mitigation
  (a)   Each Finance Party shall, in consultation with the Parent, take all reasonable steps to mitigate any circumstances which arise and which would result in any amount becoming payable under or pursuant to, or cancelled pursuant to, any of Clause 7.1 (Illegality), Clause 14 (Tax gross-up and indemnities) or Clause 15 (Increased Costs) or paragraph 3 of Schedule 4 (Mandatory Cost Formula) including (but not limited to) transferring its rights and obligations under the Finance Documents to another Affiliate or Facility Office.
 
  (b)   Paragraph (a) above does not in any way limit the obligations of any Obligor under the Finance Documents.
Hogan Lovells

- 40 -


 

17.2   Limitation of liability
  (a)   The Parent shall promptly indemnify each Finance Party for all costs and expenses reasonably incurred by that Finance Party as a result of steps taken by it under Clause 17.1 (Mitigation).
 
  (b)   A Finance Party is not obliged to take any steps under Clause 17.1 (Mitigation) if, in the opinion of that Finance Party (acting reasonably), to do so might be prejudicial to it.
18.   Costs and expenses
 
18.1   Transaction expenses
 
    The Parent shall promptly on demand pay the Agent, the Arranger and the Security Agent the amount of all costs and expenses (including legal fees) reasonably incurred by any of them (and, in the case of the Security Agent, by any Receiver or Delegate) in connection with the negotiation, preparation, printing, execution, completion, syndication and perfection of:
  (a)   this Agreement and any other documents referred to in this Agreement and the Transaction Security;
 
  (b)   any other Finance Documents executed after the date of this Agreement; and
 
  (c)   any advice received from Danish or Australian legal counsel in relation to the ability of the Finance Parties to appoint members and otherwise control any member of Secured Group.
18.2   Amendment costs
 
    If:
  (a)   an Obligor requests an amendment, waiver or consent; or
 
  (b)   an amendment is required pursuant to Clause 31.9 (Change of currency),
    the Parent shall in each case, within three Business Days of demand, reimburse each of the Agent and the Security Agent for the amount of all costs and expenses (including legal fees) reasonably incurred by the Agent and the Security Agent (and, in the case of the Security Agent, by any Receiver or Delegate) in responding to, evaluating, negotiating or complying with that request or requirement.
 
18.3   Security Agent’s ongoing costs
  (a)   In the event of:
  (i)   a Default;
 
  (ii)   the Security Agent considering it necessary or expedient; or
 
  (iii)   the Security Agent being requested by an Obligor or the Majority Lenders to undertake duties which the Security Agent and the Parent agree to be of an exceptional nature and/or outside the scope of the normal duties of the Security Agent under the Finance Documents,
      the Parent shall, in each case, pay to the Security Agent any additional remuneration that may be agreed between them.
Hogan Lovells

- 41 -


 

  (b)   If the Security Agent and the Parent fail to agree upon the nature of the duties or upon any additional remuneration, that dispute shall be determined by an investment bank (acting as an expert and not as an arbitrator) selected by the Security Agent and approved by the Parent or, failing approval, nominated (on the application of the Security Agent) by the President for the time being of the Law Society of England and Wales (the costs of the nomination and of the investment bank being payable by the Parent) and the determination of any investment bank shall be final and binding upon the parties to this Agreement.
18.4   Enforcement and preservation costs
 
    The Parent shall, within three Business Days of demand, pay to the Arranger and each other Secured Party on a full indemnity basis the amount of all costs and expenses (including legal, valuation, accountancy and consulting fees and commission and out of pocket expenses) and any VAT thereon incurred by it in connection with the enforcement of or the preservation of or the release of any rights under any Finance Document or any of the documents referred to in such documents in any jurisdiction and any proceedings instituted by or against the Security Agent as a consequence of taking or holding the Transaction Security or enforcing these rights.
Hogan Lovells

- 42 -


 

Section 7
Guarantee and indemnity
19.   Guarantee and indemnity
 
19.1   Guarantee and indemnity
 
    Each Guarantor irrevocably and unconditionally jointly and severally:
  (a)   guarantees to each Finance Party punctual performance by the Borrower of all the Borrower’s obligations under the Finance Documents;
 
  (b)   undertakes with each Finance Party that whenever the Borrower does not pay any amount when due under or in connection with any Finance Document, that Guarantor shall immediately on demand pay that amount as if it was the principal obligor; and
 
  (c)   agrees with each Finance Party that if any obligation guaranteed by it is or becomes unenforceable, invalid or illegal, it will, as an independent and primary obligation, indemnify that Finance Party immediately on demand against any cost, loss or liability it incurs as a result of an Obligor not paying any amount which would, but for such unenforceability, invalidity or illegality, have been payable by it under any Finance Document on the date when it would have been due. The amount payable by a Guarantor under this indemnity will not exceed the amount it would have had to pay under this Clause 19 if the amount claimed had been recoverable on the basis of a guarantee.
19.2   Continuing guarantee
 
    This guarantee is a continuing guarantee and will extend to the ultimate balance of sums payable by any Obligor under the Finance Documents, regardless of any intermediate payment or discharge in whole or in part.
 
19.3   Reinstatement
 
    If any discharge, release or arrangement (whether in respect of the obligations of any Obligor or any security for those obligations or otherwise) is made by a Finance Party in whole or in part on the basis of any payment, security or other disposition which is avoided or must be restored on insolvency, liquidation, administration or otherwise, without limitation, then the liability of each Guarantor under this Clause 19 will continue or be reinstated as if the discharge, release or arrangement had not occurred.
 
19.4   Waiver of defences
 
    The obligations of each Guarantor under this Clause 19 will not be affected by an act, omission, matter or thing which, but for this Clause 19, would reduce, release or prejudice any of its obligations under this Clause 19 (without limitation and whether or not known to it or any Finance Party) including:
  (a)   any time, waiver or consent granted to, or composition with, any Obligor or other person;
 
  (b)   the release of any other Obligor or any other person under the terms of any composition or arrangement with any creditor of any member of the Group;
 
  (c)   the taking, variation, compromise, exchange, renewal or release of, or refusal or neglect to perfect, take up or enforce, any rights against, or security over assets of, any Obligor or other person or any non-presentation or non-observance of any
Hogan Lovells

- 43 -


 

      formality or other requirement in respect of any instrument or any failure to realise the full value of any Security;
 
  (d)   any legal limitation, incapacity or lack of power, authority or legal personality of or dissolution or change in the members or status of an Obligor or any other person;
 
  (e)   any amendment, novation, supplement, extension or restatement (however fundamental and whether or not more onerous) or replacement of a Finance Document or any other document or Security including any change in the purpose of, any extension of or increase in any facility or the addition of any new facility under any Finance Document or other document or Security;
 
  (f)   any unenforceability, illegality, invalidity or frustration of any obligation of any person under any Finance Document or any other document or Security;
 
  (g)   the failure of any member of the Group to enter into or be bound by any Finance Document;
 
  (h)   any action (or decision not to act) taken by a Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) in accordance with Clause 19.7 (Appropriations); or
 
  (i)   any insolvency, dissolution or similar proceedings or from any law, regulation or order.
19.5   Guarantor intent
 
    Without prejudice to the generality of Clause 19.4 (Waiver of defences), each Guarantor expressly confirms that it intends that this guarantee shall extend from time to time to any (however fundamental) variation, increase, extension or addition of or to any of the Finance Documents and/or any facility or amount made available under any of the Finance Documents for the purposes of or in connection with any of the following: acquisitions of any nature; increasing working capital; enabling investor distributions to be made; carrying out restructurings; refinancing existing facilities; refinancing any other indebtedness; making facilities available to new borrowers; any other variation or extension of the purposes for which any such facility or amount might be made available from time to time; and any fees, costs and/or expenses associated with any of the foregoing.
 
19.6   Immediate recourse
 
    Each Guarantor waives any right it may have of first requiring any Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) to proceed against or enforce any other rights or security or claim payment from any person before claiming from that Guarantor under this Clause 19. This waiver applies irrespective of any law or any provision of a Finance Document to the contrary.
 
19.7   Appropriations
 
    Until all amounts which may be or become payable by the Obligors under or in connection with the Finance Documents have been irrevocably paid in full, each Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) may:
  (a)   refrain from applying or enforcing any other moneys, security or rights held or received by that Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) in respect of those amounts, or apply and enforce the same in such manner and order as it sees fit (whether against those amounts or otherwise) and no Guarantor shall be entitled to the benefit of the same; and
Hogan Lovells

- 44 -


 

  (b)   hold in an interest-bearing suspense account any moneys received from any Guarantor or on account of any Guarantor’s liability under this Clause 19.
19.8   Deferral of Guarantors’ rights
 
    Until all amounts which may be or become payable by the Obligors under or in connection with the Finance Documents have been irrevocably paid in full and unless the Agent otherwise directs, no Guarantor will exercise any rights which it may have by reason of performance by it of its obligations under the Finance Documents or by reason of any amount being payable, or liability arising, under this Clause 19:
  (a)   to be indemnified by an Obligor;
 
  (b)   to claim any contribution from any other guarantor of any Obligor’s obligations under the Finance Documents;
 
  (c)   to take the benefit (in whole or in part and whether by way of subrogation or otherwise) of any rights of the Finance Parties under the Finance Documents or of any other guarantee or security taken pursuant to, or in connection with, the Finance Documents by any Finance Party;
 
  (d)   to bring legal or other proceedings for an order requiring any Obligor to make any payment, or perform any obligation, in respect of which any Guarantor has given a guarantee, undertaking or indemnity under Clause 19.1 (Guarantee and indemnity);
 
  (e)   to exercise any right of set-off against any Obligor; and/or
 
  (f)   to claim or prove as a creditor of any Obligor in competition with any Finance Party;
    If a Guarantor receives any benefit, payment or distribution in relation to such rights it shall hold that benefit, payment or distribution to the extent necessary to enable all amounts which may be or become payable to the Finance Parties by the Obligors under or in connection with the Finance Documents to be repaid in full on trust for the Finance Parties and shall promptly pay or transfer the same to the Agent or as the Agent may direct for application in accordance with Clause 31 (Payment mechanics).
 
19.9   Release of Guarantors’ right of contribution
 
    If any Guarantor (a “Retiring Guarantor”) ceases to be a Guarantor in accordance with the terms of the Finance Documents for the purpose of any sale or other disposal of that Retiring Guarantor then on the date such Retiring Guarantor ceases to be a Guarantor:
  (a)   that Retiring Guarantor is released by each other Guarantor from any liability (whether past, present or future and whether actual or contingent) to make a contribution to any other Guarantor arising by reason of the performance by any other Guarantor of its obligations under the Finance Documents; and
 
  (b)   each other Guarantor waives any rights it may have by reason of the performance of its obligations under the Finance Documents to take the benefit (in whole or in part and whether by way of subrogation or otherwise) of any rights of the Finance Parties under any Finance Document or of any other security taken pursuant to, or in connection with, any Finance Document where such rights or security are granted by or relate to the assets of the Retiring Guarantor.
Hogan Lovells

- 45 -


 

19.10   Additional security
 
    This guarantee is in addition to and is not in any way prejudiced by any other guarantee or security now or subsequently held by any Finance Party.
 
19.11   Guarantee limitations
 
    With respect to any Additional Guarantor, this guarantee is subject to any limitations set out in the Accession Deed applicable to such Additional Guarantor.
Hogan Lovells

- 46 -


 

Section 8
Representations, undertakings and Events of Default
20.   Representations
 
20.1   General
  (a)   Each Obligor makes the representations and warranties set out in this Clause 20 to each Finance Party in accordance with Clause 20.31 (Times when representations made).
 
  (b)   For ease of reference only, the representations and warranties in this Clause 20 marked with an asterisk are the Repeating Representations.
20.2   *Status
  (a)   It and each of its Subsidiaries is a limited liability corporation, duly incorporated and validly existing under the law of its jurisdiction of incorporation.
 
  (b)   It and each of its Subsidiaries has the power to own its assets and carry on its business as it is being conducted.
20.3   *Binding obligations
 
    Subject to the Legal Reservations:
  (a)   the obligations expressed to be assumed by it in each Finance Document to which it is a party are legal, valid, binding and enforceable obligations; and
 
  (b)   (without limiting the generality of paragraph (a) above), each Transaction Security Document to which it is a party creates the security interests which that Transaction Security Document purports to create and those security interests are valid and effective.
20.4   *Non-conflict with other obligations
 
    The entry into and performance by it of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Finance Documents and the granting of the Transaction Security do not and will not conflict with:
  (a)   any law or regulation applicable to it;
 
  (b)   the constitutional documents of any member of the Group; or
 
  (c)   any agreement or instrument binding upon it or any member of the Group or any member of the Group’s assets or constitute a default or termination event (however described) under any such agreement or instrument or would result in any liability on the part of a Finance Party to any third party or require the creation of any security interest over any asset in favour of a third party.
20.5   *Power and authority
  (a)   It has the power to enter into, perform and deliver, and has taken all necessary action to authorise its entry into, performance and delivery of, the Finance Documents to which it is or will be a party and the transactions contemplated by those Finance Documents.
Hogan Lovells

- 47 -


 

  (b)   No limit on its powers will be exceeded as a result of the borrowing, grant of security or giving of guarantees or indemnities contemplated by the Finance Documents to which it is a party.
20.6   *Validity and admissibility in evidence
  (a)   All Authorisations required:
  (i)   to enable it lawfully to enter into, exercise its rights and comply with its obligations in the Finance Documents to which it is a party; and
 
  (ii)   to make the Finance Documents to which it is a party admissible in evidence in its Relevant Jurisdictions,
      have been obtained or effected and are in full force and effect except any Authorisation referred to in Clause 20.9 (No filing or stamp taxes), which Authorisations will be promptly obtained or effected after the date of this Agreement.
  (b)   All Authorisations necessary for the conduct of the business, trade and ordinary activities of members of the Group have been obtained or effected and are in full force and effect and are not likely to be revoked or materially adversely amended and no notice of an intention to terminate any such Authorisation has been received by any member of the Group.
20.7   *Governing law and enforcement
  (a)   The law expressed to be the governing law in each Finance Document will be recognised and enforced in the Relevant Jurisdictions of each Obligor executing that Finance Document.
 
  (b)   Any judgment obtained in relation to a Finance Document in the jurisdiction of the governing law of that Finance Document will be recognised and enforced in its Relevant Jurisdictions.
20.8   Insolvency
    No:
  (a)   corporate action, legal proceeding or other procedure or step described in paragraph (a) of Clause 24.7 (Insolvency proceedings); or
 
  (b)   creditors’ process described in Clause 24.8 (Creditors’ process),
    has been taken or, to the knowledge of the Parent, threatened in relation to a member of the Group and none of the circumstances described in Clause 24.6 (Insolvency) applies to any member of the Group.
20.9   No filing or stamp taxes
 
    Under the laws of its Relevant Jurisdiction it is not necessary that any Finance Document be filed, recorded or enrolled with any court or other authority in that jurisdiction or that any stamp, registration, notarial or similar Taxes or fees be paid on or in relation to the Finance Documents or the transactions contemplated by the Finance Documents except any filing, recording or enrolling or any tax or fee payable in relation to any Transaction Security Document which is referred to in any Legal Opinion and which will be made or paid promptly after the date of the relevant Finance Document.
Hogan Lovells

- 48 -


 

20.10   Deduction of Tax
    It is not required to make any deduction for or on account of Tax from any payment it may make under any Finance Document to a Lender which is:
  (a)   a Qualifying Lender:
  (i)   falling within paragraph (i)(1) of the definition of Qualifying Lender; or
 
  (ii)   except where a Direction has been given under section 931 of the ITA in relation to the payment concerned, falling within paragraph (i)(2) of the definition of Qualifying Lender ; or
 
  (iii)   falling within paragraph (ii) of the definition of Qualifying Lender or;
  (b)   a Treaty Lender and the payment is one specified in a direction given by the Commissioners of Revenue & Customs under Regulation 2 of the Double Taxation Relief (Taxes on Income) (General) Regulations 1970 (SI 1970/488).
20.11   *No default
  (a)   No Event of Default and, on the date of this Agreement, no Default is continuing or is reasonably likely to result from the making of any Utilisation or the entry into, the performance of, or any transaction contemplated by, any Finance Document.
 
  (b)   No other event or circumstance is outstanding which constitutes (or, with the expiry of a grace period, the giving of notice, the making of any determination or any combination of any of the foregoing would constitute) a default or termination event (however described) under any other agreement or instrument which is binding on it or any of its Subsidiaries or to which its (or any of its Subsidiaries’) assets are subject which has or is reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.
20.12   No misleading information
    Save as specifically disclosed in writing to the Agent and the Arranger in a separate disclosure letter prior to the date of this Agreement:
  (a)   Any factual information contained in the Information Package was true and accurate in all material respects as at the date of the relevant report or document containing the information or (as the case may be) as at the date the information is expressed to be given.
 
  (b)   The Barclays Presentation has been prepared in accordance with the Accounting Principles as applied to the Original Financial Statements, and the financial projections contained in the Barclays Presentation have been prepared on the basis of recent historical information, are fair and based on reasonable assumptions and have been approved by the board of directors of the Parent.
 
  (c)   Any financial projection or forecast contained in the Information Package has been prepared on the basis of recent historical information and on the basis of reasonable assumptions and was fair (as at the date of the relevant report or document containing the projection or forecast) and arrived at after careful consideration.
 
  (d)   The expressions of opinion or intention provided by or on behalf of an Obligor for the purposes of the Information Package were made after careful consideration and (as at the date of the relevant report or document containing the expression of opinion or intention) were fair and based on reasonable grounds.
Hogan Lovells

- 49 -


 

  (e)   No event or circumstance has occurred or arisen and no information has been omitted from the Information Package and no information has been given or withheld that results in the information, opinions, intentions, forecasts or projections contained in the Information Package being untrue or misleading in any material respect.
 
  (f)   All material information provided to a Finance Party by or on behalf of the Parent in connection with CIGNA and/or the CIGNA Reinsurance Arrangements on or before the date of this Agreement and not superseded before that date (whether or not contained in the Information Package) is accurate and not misleading in any material respect and all projections provided to any Finance Party on or before the date of this Agreement have been prepared in good faith on the basis of assumptions which were reasonable at the time at which they were prepared and supplied.
 
  (g)   *All other written information provided by any member of the Group (including its advisers) to a Finance Party or the provider of any Report was true, complete and accurate in all material respects as at the date it was provided and is not misleading in any respect.
20.13   *Original Financial Statements
  (a)   Its Original Financial Statements were prepared in accordance with the Accounting Principles consistently applied unless expressly disclosed to the Agent in writing to the contrary.
 
  (b)   Its unaudited Original Financial Statements fairly represent its financial condition and results of operations for the relevant period unless expressly disclosed to the Agent in writing to the contrary prior to the date of this Agreement.
 
  (c)   Its audited Original Financial Statements give a true and fair view of its financial condition and results of operations during the relevant Financial Year unless expressly disclosed to the Agent in writing to the contrary prior to the date of this Agreement.
 
  (d)   There has been no material adverse change in its assets, business or financial condition (or the assets, business or consolidated financial condition of the Group, in the case of the Parent) since the date of the Original Financial Statements.
 
  (e)   The Original Financial Statements of the Parent do not consolidate the results, assets or liabilities of any person or business which does not form part of the Group.
 
  (f)   Its most recent financial statements delivered pursuant to Clause 21.1 (Financial statements):
  (i)   have been prepared in accordance with the Accounting Principles as applied to the Original Financial Statements and the Barclays Presentation; and
 
  (ii)   give a true and fair view of (if audited) or fairly present (if unaudited) its consolidated financial condition as at the end of, and consolidated results of operations for, the period to which they relate.
  (g)   The budgets and forecasts supplied under this Agreement were arrived at after careful consideration and have been prepared in good faith on the basis of recent historical information and on the basis of assumptions which were reasonable as at the date they were prepared.
Hogan Lovells

- 50 -


 

  (h)   Since the date of the most recent financial statements delivered pursuant to Clause 21.1 (Financial statements) there has been no material adverse change in the business, assets or financial condition of the Group.
20.14   No proceedings pending or threatened
    No litigation, arbitration or administrative proceedings or investigations of, or before, any court, arbitral body or agency which, if adversely determined, are reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect, have (to the best of its knowledge and belief (having made due and careful enquiry)) been started or threatened against it or any of its Subsidiaries.
 
20.15   No breach of laws
  (a)   It has not (and none of its Subsidiaries has) breached any law or regulation which breach has or is reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.
 
  (b)   No labour disputes are current or, to the best of its knowledge and belief (having made due and careful enquiry), threatened against any member of the Group which have or are reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.
20.16   Taxation
  (a)   It is not (and none of its Subsidiaries is) materially overdue in the filing of any Tax returns and it is not (and none of its Subsidiaries is) overdue in the payment of any amount in respect of Tax of US$500,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency) or more.
 
  (b)   No claims or investigations are being or are reasonably likely to be made or conducted against it (or any of its Subsidiaries) with respect to Taxes such that a liability of, or claim against, any member of the Group of US$500,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency) or more is reasonably likely to arise.
 
  (c)   It is resident for Tax purposes only in the jurisdiction of its incorporation.
20.17   Security and Financial Indebtedness
  (a)   No Security or Quasi-Security exists over all or any of the present or future assets of any member of the Secured Group other than as permitted by this Agreement.
 
  (b)   No Security or Quasi-Security exists over all or any of the Charged Property of any Obligor other than pursuant to this Agreement.
 
  (c)   No member of the Secured Group has any Financial Indebtedness outstanding other than as permitted by this Agreement.
 
  (d)   All of the Existing Security listed in Part 2 of Schedule 14 (Secured Group - Letter of credit / ordinary course security) relates to security granted in relation to letters of credit and was granted in the ordinary course of business.
20.18   *Ranking
 
    The Transaction Security has or will have first ranking priority and it is not subject to any prior ranking or pari passu ranking Security.
Hogan Lovells

- 51 -


 

20.19   *Good title to assets
 
    It and each of its Subsidiaries has a good, valid and marketable title to, or valid leases or licences of, and all appropriate Authorisations to use, the assets necessary to carry on its business as presently conducted.
 
20.20   *Legal and beneficial ownership
 
    It and each of its Subsidiaries is the sole legal and beneficial owner of the respective assets over which it purports to grant Security to the Security Agent.
 
20.21   Shares
 
    The shares of any member of the Group which are subject to the Transaction Security are fully paid and not subject to any option to purchase or similar rights. The constitutional documents of companies whose shares are subject to the Transaction Security do not and could not restrict or inhibit any transfer of those shares on creation or enforcement of the Transaction Security. There are no agreements in force which provide for the issue or allotment of, or grant any person the right to call for the issue or allotment of, any share or loan capital of any member of the Group (including any option or right of pre-emption or conversion).
 
20.22   Intellectual Property
 
    It and each of its Subsidiaries:
  (a)   is the sole legal and beneficial owner of or has licensed to it on normal commercial terms all the Intellectual Property which is material in the context of its business and which is required by it in order to carry on its business as it is being conducted and as contemplated in the Barclays Presentation;
 
  (b)   does not (nor does any of its Subsidiaries), in carrying on its businesses, infringe any Intellectual Property of any third party in any respect which has or is reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect; and
 
  (c)   has taken all formal or procedural actions (including payment of fees) required to maintain any material Intellectual Property owned by it.
20.23   Group Structure Chart
 
    The Group Structure Chart is true, complete and accurate in all material respects and shows the following information:
  (i)   each member of the Group, including current name, its jurisdiction of incorporation and/or establishment, its shareholders and indicates whether a company is a Dormant Subsidiary or is not a company with limited liability; and
 
  (ii)   all minority interests in any member of the Group and any person in which any member of the Group holds shares in its issued share capital or equivalent ownership interest of such person.
20.24   Financial Year end
 
    The end of the Financial Year for each member of the Group is 31 December.
Hogan Lovells

- 52 -


 

20.25   Disclosures and other documents
 
    As at the date of delivery, the documents delivered to the Agent under any Finance Document by or on behalf of any Obligor (including pursuant to Clause 4.1 (Initial conditions precedent)) are genuine (or, in the case of copy documents, are true, complete and accurate copies of originals which are genuine), are up to date and in full force and effect (or if a copy, the original is up to date and in full force and effect) and have not been amended.
 
20.26   *Centre of main interests and establishments
 
    In relation to each Obligor incorporated in a member state of the European Union, for the purposes of The Council of the European Union Regulation No. 1346/2000 on Insolvency Proceedings (the “Regulation”), its centre of main interest (as that term is used in Article 3(1) of the Regulation) is situated in its jurisdiction of incorporation and it has no “establishment” (as that term is used in Article 2(h) of the Regulations) in any other jurisdiction.
 
20.27   Insurance
 
    There has been no non-disclosure, misrepresentation or breach of any term of any material insurance policy which would entitle any insurer to repudiate, rescind or cancel it or to treat it as avoided in whole or in part or otherwise decline any valid claim under it by or on behalf of any member of the Group.
 
20.28   Immunity
  (a)   The execution by it of each Finance Document constitutes, and the exercise by it of its rights and performance of its obligations under each Finance Document will constitute private and commercial acts performed for private and commercial purposes.
 
  (b)   It will not be entitled to claim immunity from suit, execution, attachment or other legal process in any proceedings taken in its Relevant Jurisdictions in relation to any Finance Document.
20.29   No adverse consequences
  (a)   It is not necessary under the laws of its Relevant Jurisdictions:
  (i)   in order to enable any Finance Party to enforce its rights under any Finance Document; or
 
  (ii)   by reason of the execution of any Finance Document or the performance by it of its obligations under any Finance Document,
      that any Finance Party should be licensed, qualified or otherwise entitled to carry on business in any of its Relevant Jurisdictions.
  (b)   No Finance Party is or will be deemed to be resident, domiciled or carrying on business in its Relevant Jurisdictions by reason only of the execution, performance and/or enforcement of any Finance Document.
20.30   Pensions
    Each member of the Group is in compliance in all material respects with all applicable laws, regulations and contracts relating to the provision of pension schemes and any pension scheme(s) it operates or participates in. Each such pension scheme is fully
Hogan Lovells

- 53 -


 

    funded based on the minimum funding requirement required by applicable law or regulation.
 
20.31   Times when representations made
  (a)   All the representations and warranties in this Clause 20 are made by each Original Obligor on the date of this Agreement and with respect to the Information Package, on the date of this Agreement and on any later date on which the Information Package (or part of it) is released to the Arranger.
 
  (b)   The Repeating Representations are deemed to be made by each Obligor on the date of each Utilisation Request, on each Utilisation Date and on the first day of each Interest Period (except that those contained in paragraphs (a) to (e) of Clause 20.13 (Original Financial Statements) will cease to be so made once subsequent financial statements have been delivered under this Agreement).
 
  (c)   All the representations and warranties in this Clause 20 except Clause 20.12 (No misleading information), Clause 20.23 (Group Structure Chart), Clause 20.25 (Disclosures and other documents) are deemed to be made by each Additional Obligor on the day on which it becomes (or it is proposed that it becomes) an Additional Obligor.
 
  (d)   Each representation or warranty deemed to be made after the date of this Agreement shall be deemed to be made by reference to the facts and circumstances existing at the date the representation or warranty is deemed to be made.
21.   Information undertakings
    The undertakings in this Clause 21 remain in force from the date of this Agreement for so long as any amount is outstanding under the Finance Documents or any Commitment is in force.
    In this Clause 21:
    “Annual Financial Statements” means the financial statements for a Financial Year delivered pursuant to paragraph (a) of Clause 21.1 (Financial statements).
    “Quarterly Financial Statements” means the financial statements delivered pursuant to paragraph (b) of Clause 21.1 (Financial statements).
    “Quarterly Management Accounts” means the management accounts of the Secured Group delivered pursuant to paragraph (c) of Clause 21.1 (Financial statements).
21.1   Financial statements
    The Parent shall supply to the Agent in sufficient copies for all the Lenders:
  (a)   as soon as they are available, but in any event within 120 days after the end of each of its Financial Years:
  (i)   its audited consolidated and unconsolidated financial statements for that Financial Year;
 
  (ii)   the audited financial statements (consolidated if appropriate) of each member of the Secured Group for that Financial Year; and
 
  (iii)   the audited financial statements of each Obligor for that Financial Year if requested by the Agent;
Hogan Lovells

- 54 -


 

  (b)   as soon as they are available, but in any event within 45 days after the end of each Financial Quarter of each of its Financial Years its consolidated and unconsolidated financial statements for that Financial Quarter which shall include the Capital Release Schedule; and
 
  (c)   as soon as they are available, but in any event within 45 days after the end of each Financial Quarter of each of its Financial Years the management accounts of each member of the Secured Group (to include cumulative management accounts for the Financial Year to date).
21.2   Provision and contents of Compliance Certificate
  (a)   The Parent shall supply a Compliance Certificate to the Agent with each set of its audited consolidated Annual Financial Statements and each set of its consolidated Quarterly Financial Statements.
 
  (b)   The Compliance Certificate shall, amongst other things, set out (in reasonable detail) computations as to compliance with Clause 22 (Financial covenants).
 
  (c)   Each Compliance Certificate shall be signed by two directors one of whom must be the Chief Financial Officer of the Group and, if required to be delivered with the consolidated Annual Financial Statements of the Parent, shall be reported on by the Parent’s Auditors in the form agreed by the Parent and the Majority Lenders.
21.3   Requirements as to financial statements
  (a)   The Parent shall procure that each set of Annual Financial Statements and Quarterly Financial Statements includes a balance sheet, profit and loss account and cashflow statement. In addition the Parent shall procure that:
  (i)   each set of Annual Financial Statements shall be audited by the Auditors;
 
  (ii)   each set of Quarterly Financial Statements includes a cashflow forecast (comprising the Capital Release Schedule) in respect of the Group relating to the 12 month period commencing at the end of the relevant Financial Quarter; and
 
  (iii)   each set of Quarterly Management Accounts is accompanied by:
  (1)   a statement by the directors of the Parent commenting on the performance of the Group for the quarter to which the financial statement relate and the Financial Year to date and any material developments or material proposals affecting the Group or its business; and
 
  (2)   a report setting out, in respect of each insurance company in the Group: (i) its capital resources; (ii) its Pillar 1 Capital Requirement; (iii) its ICA Capital Requirement; (iv) its ICG Capital Requirement; and (v) any deductions made from its capital resources when determining its compliance with its ICA Capital Requirement or its ICG Capital Requirement.
  (b)   Each set of financial statements delivered pursuant to Clause 21.1 (Financial statements):
  (i)   shall be certified by the Chief Financial Officer as giving a true and fair view of (in the case of Annual Financial Statements for any Financial Year), or fairly representing (in other cases), its financial condition and operations as at the date as at which those financial statements were
Hogan Lovells

- 55 -


 

      drawn up and, in the case of the Annual Financial Statements, shall be accompanied by any letter addressed to the management of the relevant company by the Auditors and accompanying those Annual Financial Statements;
 
  (ii)   in the case of consolidated financial statements of the Group, shall be accompanied by a statement by the Chief Financial Officer comparing actual performance for the period to which the financial statements relate to:
  (1)   the projected performance for that period set out in the Budget; and
 
  (2)   the actual performance for the corresponding period in the preceding Financial Year of the Group; and
  (iii)   shall be prepared using the Accounting Principles, accounting practices and financial reference periods consistent with those applied in the preparation of the Barclays Presentation, unless, in relation to any set of financial statements, the Parent notifies the Agent that there has been a change in the Accounting Principles or the accounting practices and its Auditors (or, if appropriate, the Auditors of the Obligor) deliver to the Agent:
  (1)   a description of any change necessary for those financial statements to reflect the Accounting Principles or accounting practices upon which the Barclays Presentation was prepared; and
 
  (2)   sufficient information, in form and substance as may be reasonably required by the Agent, to enable the Lenders to determine whether Clause 22 (Financial covenants) has been complied with and to make an accurate comparison between the financial position indicated in those financial statements and the Barclays Presentation (in the case of the Parent) or that Obligor’s Original Financial Statements (in the case of an Obligor).
      Any reference in this Agreement to any financial statements shall be construed as a reference to those financial statements as adjusted to reflect the basis upon which the Barclays Presentation or, as the case may be, the Original Financial Statements were prepared.
  (c)   If the Agent receives a report from the Parent’s Auditors pursuant to sub-paragraph (b)(iii) above, the Majority Lenders (in consultation with the Parent and the Auditors) may require such changes to the covenants set out in Clause 22 (Financial covenants) as are necessary solely to reflect the changes notified to them.
 
  (d)   If the Agent wishes to discuss the financial position of any member of the Group with the Auditors, the Agent may notify the Parent, stating the questions or issues which the Agent wishes to discuss with the Auditors. In this event, the Parent must ensure that the Auditors are authorised (at the expense of the Parent):
  (i)   to discuss the financial position of each member of the Group with the Agent on request from the Agent;
 
  (ii)   to verify any financial information required by the Finance Documents to be provided to the Agent;
Hogan Lovells

- 56 -


 

  (iii)   to disclose to the Agent for the Finance Parties any information which the Agent may reasonably request; and
 
  (iv)   to verify any figures required to calculate the financial covenants in Clause 22 (Financial covenants).
  (e)   If following discussions with the Parent’s Auditors pursuant to paragraph (d) above, the Majority Lenders (acting reasonably) remain concerned about the accuracy of the financial information supplied to them, they may require (at the Parent’s expense) an independent firm of accountants acceptable to the Majority Lenders to carry out an appropriate investigation and give a certificate satisfactory to the Majority Lenders concerning any matter referred to in sub-paragraph (d)(i) above or the calculation of any term defined in Clause 22.1 (Financial definitions).
21.4   Budget
  (a)   The Parent shall supply to the Agent in sufficient copies for all the Lenders, as soon as the same become available but in any event not less than 60 days after the start of each of its Financial Years, an annual Budget for that Financial Year.
 
  (b)   The Parent shall ensure that each Budget:
  (i)   is in a format reasonably acceptable to the Agent and includes a projected consolidated profit and loss, balance sheet and cashflow statement for the Group, projected financial covenant calculations, Capital Expenditure to be incurred and its anticipated timing and a Capital Release Schedule;
 
  (ii)   is prepared in accordance with the Accounting Principles and the accounting practices and financial reference periods applied to financial statements under Clause 21.1 (Financial statements); and
 
  (iii)   has been approved by the board of directors of the Parent.
  (c)   If the Parent updates or changes the Budget, it shall promptly deliver to the Agent, in sufficient copies for each of the Lenders, such updated or changed Budget together with a written explanation of the main changes in that Budget.
21.5   Annual Actuarial Report
 
    The Parent shall supply to the Agent in sufficient copies for all of the Lenders, as soon as the same shall become available, but in any event not more than 60 days after the end of each of its Financial Years, an actuarial report provided by Ernst & Young in respect of each member of the Group.
21.6   Presentations
 
    Once in every Financial Year, or more frequently if requested to do so by the Agent if the Agent reasonably suspects a Default is continuing or may have occurred or may occur, at least two directors of the Parent (one of whom shall be the Chief Financial Officer) must give a presentation to the Finance Parties in London about the on-going business and financial performance of the Group.
 
21.7   Year-end
  (a)   The Parent shall procure that the end of each Financial Year of each member of the Group falls on 31 December.
 
  (b)   The Parent shall procure that each quarterly accounting period and each Financial Quarter of each member of the Group ends on a Quarter Date.
Hogan Lovells

- 57 -


 

21.8   Information: miscellaneous
 
    The Parent shall supply to the Agent (in sufficient copies for all the Lenders, if the Agent so requests):
  (a)   at the same time as they are dispatched, copies of all documents dispatched by the Parent to its shareholders generally (or any class of them) or dispatched by the Parent or any Obligors to its creditors generally (or any class of them);
 
  (b)   promptly upon becoming aware of them, the details of any litigation, arbitration or administrative proceedings which are current, threatened or pending against any member of the Group other than in the ordinary course of business, and which, if adversely determined would involve a liability, or a potential or alleged liability, exceeding US$2,000,000 (or its equivalent in other currencies);
 
  (c)   written notice of any business or transaction undertaken by the Borrower or any member of the Group involving (directly or indirectly) any of Sudan, Iran, Myanmar (Burma), Cuba, North Korea or Syria, to the extent possible in advance of, and in any event promptly upon, the Borrower or such member of the Group commencing such business or transaction, together with sufficient details of such business or transaction as the Lender may require to satisfy any sanctions-related laws, regulations or requirements to which it is subject;
 
  (d)   promptly, copies of any correspondence, documentation or other communication dispatched by or to the FSA or other relevant regulatory body in respect of any member of the Group’s regulatory capital requirements;
 
  (e)   within 10 business days of submission to the FSA by any insurance company in the Group, copies of: (i) FSA Returns; (ii) the Group Capital Resources Report; and (iii) Close Links Report;
 
  (f)   promptly, copies of any agreement for the acquisition or disposal of a Subsidiary or for an insurance business transfer to or from any member of the Group, together with copies of all documents sent to policyholders in connection with any such insurance business transfer;
 
  (g)   promptly, such information as the Security Agent may reasonably require about the Charged Property and compliance of the Obligors with the terms of any Transaction Security Documents; and
 
  (h)   promptly on request, such further information regarding the financial condition, assets and operations of the Group and/or any member of the Group (including any requested amplification or explanation of any item in the financial statements, budgets or other material provided by any Obligor under this Agreement, any changes to senior management and an up to date copy of its Shareholders’ register (or equivalent in its jurisdiction of incorporation)) as any Finance Party through the Agent may reasonably request.
21.9   Notification of default
  (a)   Each Obligor shall notify the Agent of any Default (and the steps, if any, being taken to remedy it) promptly upon becoming aware of its occurrence (unless that Obligor is aware that a notification has already been provided by another Obligor).
 
  (b)   Promptly upon a request by the Agent, the Parent shall supply to the Agent a certificate signed by two of its directors or senior officers on its behalf certifying that no Default is continuing (or if a Default is continuing, specifying the Default and the steps, if any, being taken to remedy it).
Hogan Lovells

- 58 -


 

21.10   “Know your customer” checks
  (a)   If:
  (i)   the introduction of or any change in (or in the interpretation, administration or application of) any law or regulation made after the date of this Agreement;
 
  (ii)   any change in the nature of an Obligor’s business or in the status of an Obligor or the composition of the shareholders of an Obligor after the date of this Agreement; or
 
  (iii)   a proposed assignment or transfer by a Lender of any of its rights and/or obligations under this Agreement to a party that is not a Lender prior to such assignment or transfer,
    obliges the Agent or any Lender (or, in the case of paragraph (iii) above, any prospective new Lender) to comply with “know your customer” or similar identification procedures in circumstances where the necessary information is not already available to it, each Obligor shall promptly upon the request of the Agent or any Lender supply, or procure the supply of, such documentation and other evidence as is reasonably requested by the Agent (for itself or on behalf of any Lender) or any Lender (for itself or, in the case of the event described in paragraph (iii) above, on behalf of any prospective new Lender) in order for the Agent, such Lender or, in the case of the event described in paragraph (iii) above, any prospective new Lender to carry out and be satisfied it has complied with all necessary “know your customer” or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations pursuant to the transactions contemplated in the Finance Documents.
  (b)   Each Lender shall promptly upon the request of the Agent supply, or procure the supply of, such documentation and other evidence as is reasonably requested by the Agent (for itself) in order for the Agent to carry out and be satisfied it has complied with all necessary “know your customer” or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations pursuant to the transactions contemplated in the Finance Documents.
 
  (c)   The Parent shall, by not less than 10 Business Days’ prior written notice to the Agent, notify the Agent (which shall promptly notify the Lenders) of its intention to request that one of its Subsidiaries becomes an Additional Obligor pursuant to Clause 27 (Changes to the Obligors).
 
  (d)   Following the giving of any notice pursuant to paragraph (c) above, if the accession of such Additional Obligor obliges the Agent or any Lender to comply with “know your customer” or similar identification procedures in circumstances where the necessary information is not already available to it, the Parent shall promptly upon the request of the Agent or any Lender supply, or procure the supply of, such documentation and other evidence as is reasonably requested by the Agent (for itself or on behalf of any Lender) or any Lender (for itself or on behalf of any prospective new Lender) in order for the Agent, or such Lender or any prospective new Lender to carry out and be satisfied it has complied with all necessary “know your customer” or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations pursuant to the accession of such Subsidiary to this Agreement as an Additional Obligor.
Hogan Lovells

- 59 -


 

22.   Financial covenants
22.1   Financial definitions
    “Borrowings” means, at any time, the aggregate outstanding principal, capital or nominal amount (and any fixed or minimum premium payable on prepayment or redemption) of any indebtedness of members of the Group for or in respect of:
  (a)   moneys borrowed and debit balances at banks or other financial institutions;
 
  (b)   any acceptances under any acceptance credit or bill discounting facility (or dematerialised equivalent);
 
  (c)   any note purchase facility or the issue of bonds (but not Trade Instruments), notes, debentures, loan stock or any similar instrument;
 
  (d)   any Finance Lease;
 
  (e)   receivables sold or discounted (other than any receivables to the extent they are sold on a non-recourse basis and meet any requirements for de-recognition under the Accounting Principles);
 
  (f)   any counter-indemnity obligation in respect of a guarantee, bond, standby or documentary letter of credit or any other instrument issued by a bank or financial institution in respect of (i) an underlying liability of an entity which is not a member of the Group which liability would fall within one of the other paragraphs of this definition or (ii) any liabilities of any member of the Group relating to any post-retirement benefit scheme;
 
  (g)   any amount raised by the issue of shares which are redeemable (other than at the option of the issuer) before the Termination Date or are otherwise classified as borrowings under the Accounting Principles;
 
  (h)   any amount of any liability under an advance or deferred purchase agreement if (i) one of the primary reasons behind the entry into the agreement is to raise finance or to finance the acquisition or construction of the asset or service in question or (ii) the agreement is in respect of the supply of assets or services and payment is due more than 90 days after the date of supply;
 
  (i)   any amount raised under any other transaction (including any forward sale or purchase agreement, sale and sale back or sale and leaseback agreement) having the commercial effect of a borrowing or otherwise classified as borrowings under the Accounting Principles; and
 
  (j)   (without double counting) the amount of any liability in respect of any guarantee or indemnity for any of the items referred to in paragraphs (a) to (i) above.
    “Capital Expenditure” means any expenditure or obligation in respect of expenditure which, in accordance with the Accounting Principles, is treated as capital expenditure (and including the capital element of any expenditure or obligation incurred in connection with a Finance Lease).
    “Consolidated Tangible Net Worth” means at any time, Total Shareholders Equity less Noncontrolling interest, each as set out in the most recently delivered financial statements of the Parent pursuant to paragraphs (a) and (b) of Clause 21.1 (Financial Statements).
    “Finance Lease” means any lease or hire purchase contract which would, in accordance with the Accounting Principles, be treated as a finance or capital lease.
Hogan Lovells

- 60 -


 

    “Financial Quarter” means the period commencing on the day after one Quarter Date and ending on the next Quarter Date.
    “Financial Year” means the annual accounting period of the Group ending on or about 31 December in each year.
    “Gearing Ratio” means, in respect of any Relevant Period, the ratio of Total Debt on the last day of that Relevant Period to Consolidated Tangible Net Worth in respect of that Relevant Period.
    “Intra-Group Indebtedness” means, in relation to a member of the Secured Group, the amount owed by it to any member of the Group (other than another member of the Secured Group) pursuant to any loan made by such other member of the Group.
    “Quarter Date” means each of 31 March, 30 June, 30 September and 31 December.
    “Relevant Period” means each period of 12 months ending on or about the last day of the Financial Year and each period of 12 months ending on or about the last day of each Financial Quarter.
    “Total Debt” means, at any time, the aggregate amount of all obligations of members of the Group for or in respect of Borrowings at that time but:
  (a)   excluding any such obligations to any other member of the Group; and
 
  (b)   including, in the case of Finance Leases only, their capitalised value,
    and so that no amount shall be included or excluded more than once.
 
    “Working Capital” means, on any date, Current Assets less Current Liabilities.
22.2   Financial condition
    The Parent shall ensure that:
  (a)   Gearing
 
      The Gearing Ratio shall not at anytime be more than 0.4:1.
 
  (b)   Minimum Net Worth
 
      Consolidated Tangible Net Worth shall not at any time be less than US$706,576,800.00.
 
  (c)   Regulatory Cover
  (i)   Each member of the Group will at all times hold capital resources which are not less than the amount that it is required to hold in accordance with applicable law and applicable rules and guidance given by any regulator, including, without limitation, its Pillar 1 Capital Requirement, its ICA Capital Requirement and its ICG Capital Requirement; and
 
  (ii)   The Group Capital Resources of the Group are not less than the Group Capital Requirement.
  (d)   Secured Group Cover
 
      the ratio of :
Hogan Lovells

- 61 -


 

  (1)   the aggregate of the total assets less total liabilities and (without double counting) Intra-Group Indebtedness of each member of the Secured Group (each as set out in the relevant financial statements of such member of the Secured Group),
 
      to
 
  (2)   the amount of outstanding Loans,
      shall not at any time be less than 2:1.
22.3   Financial testing
  (a)   Subject to paragraph (b) below, the financial covenants set out in Clause 22.2 (Financial condition) shall be calculated in accordance with the Accounting Principles and tested by reference to each of the financial statements delivered pursuant to paragraphs (a), (b) and (c) of Clause 21.1 (Financial statements) and/or each Compliance Certificate delivered pursuant to Clause 21.2 (Provision and contents of Compliance Certificate).
 
  (b)   When calculating the financial covenants in this Clause the effect of all transactions between members of the Group shall be eliminated to the extent not already netted out on consolidation.
 
  (c)   No item shall be deducted or credited more than once in any calculation.
 
  (d)   Where an amount in any financial statement or Compliance Certificate is not denominated in the Base Currency, it shall be converted into the Base Currency at the rate specified in the financial statements so long as such rate has been set in accordance with the Accounting Principles.
 
  (e)   The financial covenants in Clause 22.2 (Financial condition) shall be tested as of the end of each Relevant Period.
23.   General undertakings
    The undertakings in this Clause 23 remain in force from the date of this Agreement for so long as any amount is outstanding under the Finance Documents or any Commitment is in force.
Authorisations and compliance with laws
23.1   Authorisations
    Each Obligor shall promptly:
  (i)   obtain, comply with and do all that is necessary to maintain in full force and effect; and
 
  (ii)   supply certified copies to the Agent of,
    any Authorisation required under any law or regulation of a Relevant Jurisdiction to:
  (iii)   enable it to perform its obligations under the Finance Documents;
 
  (iv)   ensure the legality, validity, enforceability or admissibility in evidence of any Finance Document; and
 
  (v)   carry on its business where failure to do so has or is reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.
Hogan Lovells

- 62 -


 

23.2   Compliance with laws
 
    Each Obligor shall (and the Parent shall ensure that each member of the Group will) comply in all respects with all laws to which it may be subject, if failure so to comply has or is reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.
 
23.3   Taxation
  (a)   Each Obligor shall (and the Parent shall ensure that each member of the Group will) pay and discharge all Taxes imposed upon it or its assets within the time period allowed without incurring penalties unless and only to the extent that:
  (i)   such payment is being contested in good faith;
 
  (ii)   adequate reserves are being maintained for those Taxes and the costs required to contest them have been disclosed in its latest financial statements delivered to the Agent under Clause 21.1 (Financial statements); and
 
  (iii)   such payment can be lawfully withheld and failure to pay those Taxes does not have or is not reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.
  (b)   No member of the Group may change its residence for Tax purposes.
Restrictions on business focus
23.4   Merger
 
    No Obligor shall (and the Parent shall ensure that no other member of the Original Group will) enter into (or agree to enter into) any amalgamation, demerger, merger, consolidation or corporate reconstruction other than (i) any solvent liquidation or reorganisation permitted by paragraph (b) of the definition of Permitted Transaction; and (ii) where the Parent or other member of the Original Group is the surviving entity.
 
23.5   Change of business or Investment Policy
  (a)   The Parent shall procure that no substantial change is made to the general nature of the business of the Parent, or the Group taken as a whole from that carried on at the date of this Agreement.
 
  (b)   The Parent shall procure that:
  (i)   no change is made to the Investment Policy in effect as at the date of this Agreement without the consent of the Agent; and
 
  (ii)   that all investments made by the Group comply with the Investment Policy (upon making the investment and thereafter).
23.6   Acquisitions
  (a)   Except as permitted under paragraph (b) below, the Parent shall not and shall ensure that no member of the Group will:
  (i)   acquire a company or any shares or securities or a business or undertaking (or, in each case, any interest in any of them); or
 
  (ii)   incorporate a company.
Hogan Lovells

- 63 -


 

  (b)   Paragraph (a) above does not apply to an acquisition of a company, of shares, securities or a business or undertaking (or, in each case, any interest in any of them) or the incorporation of a company by the Parent or a Subsidiary that is not a member of the Secured Group, provided that, the Group’s aggregate net portfolio shall not at any time consist of a concentration of more than 40% of net loss reserves in relation to any business line.
23.7   Joint Ventures
  (a)   Except as permitted under paragraph (b) below, the Parent shall not and shall ensure that no member of the Group will:
  (i)   enter into, invest in or acquire (or agree to acquire) any shares, stocks, securities or other interest in any Joint Venture; or
 
  (ii)   transfer any assets or lend to or guarantee or give an indemnity for or give Security for the obligations of a Joint Venture or maintain the solvency of or provide working capital to any Joint Venture (or agree to do any of the foregoing).
  (b)   Paragraph (a) above does not apply to any acquisition of (or agreement to acquire) any interest in a Joint Venture or transfer of assets (or agreement to transfer assets) to a Joint Venture or loan made to or guarantee given in respect of the obligations of a Joint Venture if such transaction is entered into by the Parent or a Subsidiary that is not a member of the Secured Group, provided that, the Group’s aggregate net portfolio shall not at any time consist of a concentration of more than 40% of net loss reserves in relation to any business line.
Restrictions on dealing with assets and Security
23.8   Preservation of assets
 
    Each Obligor shall (and the Parent shall ensure that each member of the Secured Group will) maintain in good working order and condition (ordinary wear and tear excepted) all of its assets necessary or desirable in the conduct of its business.
 
23.9   Pari passu ranking
 
    Each Obligor shall ensure that at all times any unsecured and unsubordinated claims of a Finance Party against it under the Finance Documents rank at least pari passu with the claims of all its other unsecured and unsubordinated creditors except those creditors whose claims are mandatorily preferred by laws of general application to companies.
 
23.10   Negative pledge
    Except as permitted under paragraph (d) below:
  (a)   No Obligor will create or permit to subsist any Security over any of the Charged Property.
 
  (b)   The Parent shall ensure that no member of the Secured Group or the Original Group will create or permit to subsist any Security over any of its assets.
 
  (c)   The Parent shall ensure that no member of the Secured Group will sell, transfer or otherwise dispose of any of its receivables.
 
  (d)   The Parent shall ensure that no member of the Secured Group will:
Hogan Lovells

- 64 -


 

  (i)   sell, transfer or otherwise dispose of any of its assets on terms whereby they are or may be leased to or re-acquired by any other member of the Group;
 
  (ii)   enter into any arrangement under which money or the benefit of a bank or other account may be applied, set-off or made subject to a combination of accounts; or
 
  (iii)   enter into any other preferential arrangement having a similar effect,
      in circumstances where the arrangement or transaction is entered into primarily as a method of raising Financial Indebtedness or of financing the acquisition of an asset. An arrangement or transaction referred to in paragraph (c) or in this paragraph (d) is termed “Quasi — Security".
 
  (e)   Paragraphs (a) — (d) above do not apply to any Security or (as the case may be) Quasi-Security, which is given under the Finance Documents or to any Permitted Security.
23.11   Disposals
  (a)   Except as permitted under paragraph (c) below, the Parent shall ensure that no member of the Secured Group will enter into a single transaction or a series of transactions (whether related or not) and whether voluntary or involuntary to sell, lease, transfer, licence, surrender, set-off or otherwise dispose of any asset, including tax assets.
 
  (b)   No Obligor will enter into a single transaction or a series of transactions (whether related or not) and whether voluntary or involuntary to sell, lease, transfer, licence, surrender, set-off or otherwise dispose of any Charged Property.
 
  (c)   Paragraph (a) above does not apply to any sale, lease, transfer or other disposal which is:
  (i)   a Permitted Disposal;
 
  (ii)   a Permitted Transaction.
23.12   Arm’s length basis
  (a)   Except as permitted by paragraph (b) below, the Parent shall ensure no member of the Secured Group will enter into any transaction with any person except on arm’s length terms and for full market value.
 
  (b)   The following transactions shall not be a breach of this Clause 23.12:
  (i)   intra-Group transactions permitted under Clause 23.13 (Loans or credit);
 
  (ii)   fees, costs and expenses payable under the Finance Documents in the amounts set out in the Finance Documents delivered to the Agent under Clause 4.1 (Initial conditions precedent) or agreed by the Agent; and
 
  (iii)   any Permitted Transaction.
Hogan Lovells

- 65 -


 

Restrictions on movement of cash — cash out
23.13   Loans or credit
  (a)   Except as permitted under paragraph (b) below, the Parent shall ensure that no member of the Secured Group will be a creditor in respect of any Financial Indebtedness.
 
  (b)   Paragraph (a) above does not apply to:
  (i)   a Permitted Loan; or
 
  (ii)   a Permitted Transaction which is referred to in paragraph (a) of the definition of that term.
23.14   No guarantees or indemnities
  (a)   Except as permitted under paragraph (b) below, the Parent shall ensure that no member of the Secured Group will incur or allow to remain outstanding any guarantee, bond or indemnity in respect of any obligation of any person.
 
  (b)   Paragraph (a) above does not apply to a guarantee which is a Permitted Transaction which is referred to in paragraph (a) of the definition of that term.
23.15   Dividends and share redemption
  (a)   Except as permitted under paragraph (b) below, the Parent shall not (and will ensure that no other member of the Group will):
  (i)   declare, make or pay any dividend, charge, fee or other distribution (or interest on any unpaid dividend, charge, fee or other distribution) (whether in cash or in kind) on or in respect of its share capital (or any class of its share capital);
 
  (ii)   repay or distribute any dividend or share premium reserve;
 
  (iii)   pay or allow any member of the Group to pay any management, advisory or other fee to or to the order of any of the direct or indirect shareholders of the Parent; or
 
  (iv)   redeem, repurchase, defease, retire or repay any of its share capital or resolve to do so.
  (b)   Paragraph (a) above does not apply to:
  (i)   a Permitted Distribution; or
 
  (ii)   a Permitted Transaction (other than one referred to in paragraph (b) of the definition of that term).
  (c)   Notwithstanding paragraph (b)(i) above, the Parent will only declare a dividend or other distribution in accordance with its distribution policy as notified to its shareholders in its Original Financial Statements.
Hogan Lovells

- 66 -


 

Restrictions on movement of cash — cash in
23.16   Financial Indebtedness
  (a)   Except as permitted under paragraph (a) below, the Parent shall ensure that no member of the Original Group will incur or allow to remain outstanding any Financial Indebtedness.
 
  (b)   Paragraph (a) above does not apply to:
  (i)   Financial Indebtedness arising under the Finance Documents;
 
  (ii)   The Parent CIGNA Guarantee and/or any other guarantee issued by the Parent in support of a reinsurance agreement entered into by a member of the Group that is not a member of the Original Group in the ordinary course of its business;
 
  (iii)   Original Group Financial Indebtedness; or
 
  (iv)   Financial Indebtedness incurred by a member of the Group to facilitate the transfer of any Capital Release Amount as required pursuant to Clause 23.28 (Transfer of Capital Release Amount), provided that the relevant loan is subordinated to the Facilities on terms acceptable to the Agent.
23.17   Share capital
 
    No Obligor (other than the Parent) shall (and the Parent shall ensure no member of the Group will) issue any shares except pursuant to a Permitted Share Issue.
Miscellaneous
23.18   Insurance
  (a)   Each Obligor shall (and the Parent shall ensure that each member of the Group will) maintain insurances on and in relation to its business and assets against those risks and to the extent as is usual for companies carrying on the same or substantially similar business.
 
  (b)   All insurances must be with reputable independent insurance companies or underwriters.
23.19   Pensions
 
    The Parent shall ensure that all pension schemes operated by or maintained for the benefit of members of the Group and/or any of their employees are fully funded as required by applicable law or regulation and that no action or omission is taken by any member of the Group in relation to such a pension scheme which has or is reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect (including, the termination or commencement of winding-up proceedings of any such pension scheme or any member of the Group ceasing to employ any member of such a pension scheme).
 
23.20   Access
 
    Each Obligor shall, and the Parent shall ensure that each member of the Group will (not more than once in every Financial Year unless the Agent reasonably suspects a Default is continuing or may occur), permit the Agent and/or the Security Agent and/or accountants or other professional advisers and contractors of the Agent or Security Agent free access at all reasonable times and on reasonable notice at the risk and cost of the Obligor to (a)
Hogan Lovells

- 67 -


 

    the premises, assets, books, accounts and records of each member of the Group and (b) meet and discuss matters with senior management.
 
23.21   Intellectual Property
  (a)   Each Obligor shall and the Parent shall procure that each member of the Original Group will:
  (i)   preserve and maintain the subsistence and validity of the Intellectual Property necessary for its business;
 
  (ii)   use reasonable endeavours (including the institution of legal proceedings) to prevent any infringement in any material respect of the Intellectual Property;
 
  (iii)   immediately notify the Agent if it becomes aware of any infringement or challenge to the validity, enforceability or ownership of any Intellectual Property and supply the Security Agent with all information relating to it which is reasonably requested by the Agent;
 
  (iv)   make registrations and pay all registration fees and taxes necessary to maintain the Intellectual Property in full force and effect and record its interest in that Intellectual Property;
 
  (v)   not use or permit the Intellectual Property to be used in a way or take any step or omit to take any step in respect of that Intellectual Property which may materially and adversely affect the existence or value of that Intellectual Property or imperil the right of any member of the Group to use such property; and
 
  (vi)   not discontinue the use of the Intellectual Property,
      where failure to do so in the case of sub-paragraphs (i) and (ii) above, or, in the case of sub-paragraphs (iv) and (v) above, such use, permission to use, omission or discontinuation is reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.
 
  (b)   Failure to comply with any part of paragraph (a) above shall not be a breach of this Clause 23.21 to the extent that any dealing with Intellectual Property which would otherwise be a breach of paragraph (a) above is contemplated by paragraph (a) of the definition of Permitted Transaction.
23.22   Financial assistance
 
    Each Obligor shall (and the Parent shall procure each member of the Group will) comply in all respects with all relevant financial assistance legislation in relevant jurisdictions including in relation to the execution of the Transaction Security Documents and payment of amounts due under this Agreement.
 
23.23   Group bank accounts
 
    The Parent shall ensure that all bank accounts of the Secured Group shall be opened and maintained with a Finance Party or an Affiliate of a Finance Party.
 
23.24   Treasury Transactions
 
    The Parent will procure that no members of the Secured Group will enter into any Treasury Transaction, other than spot and forward delivery foreign exchange contracts entered into in the ordinary course of business and not for speculative purposes.
Hogan Lovells

- 68 -


 

23.25   Further assurance
  (a)   Each Obligor shall (and the Parent shall procure that each member of the Secured Group will) promptly do all such acts or execute all such documents (including assignments, transfers, mortgages, charges, notices and instructions) as the Security Agent may reasonably specify and in such form as the Security Agent may reasonably require (in favour of the Security Agent or its nominee(s)) in order to:
  (i)   perfect or protect the Security created or intended to be created under or evidenced by the Transaction Security Documents (which may include the execution of a mortgage, charge, assignment or other Security over all or any of the assets which are, or are intended to be, the subject of the Transaction Security) or for the exercise of any rights, powers and remedies of the Security Agent or the Finance Parties provided by or pursuant to the Finance Documents or by law;
 
  (ii)   confer on the Security Agent or confer on the Finance Parties, Security over any property and assets of that Obligor located in any jurisdiction which is (to the extent permitted by local law) equivalent or similar to the Security intended to be conferred by or pursuant to the Transaction Security Documents; and/or
 
  (iii)   facilitate the realisation of the assets which are, or are intended to be, the subject of the Transaction Security.
  (b)   Each Obligor shall (and the Parent shall procure that each member of the Secured Group shall) take all such action as is available to it (including making all filings and registrations) as may be necessary for the purpose of the creation, perfection, protection or maintenance of any Security conferred or intended to be conferred on the Security Agent or the Finance Parties by or pursuant to the Finance Documents.
23.26   Announcements
 
    The Parent agrees that it will not make, or permit any of its officers or employees to make any press release or other media communication in connection with the Facilities which refers to any Finance Party without previously agreeing its contents with the Agent.
 
23.27   Regulatory Compliance
 
    Each member of the Secured Group shall observe and comply with all applicable acts, byelaws, guidance and regulations (including, without limitation, under the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (and related subordinate legislation) and the FSA Handbook (as amended from time to time) and any conditions or requirements prescribed under any applicable acts, byelaws and regulations), the failure to observe or comply with which would reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.
 
23.28   Transfer of Capital Release Amount
 
    On each date on which the Capital Release Amount in relation to any member of the Secured Group is greater than zero, each Obligor shall (and shall procure that each member of the Group shall) procure that an amount equal to the relevant Capital Release Amount on that date is promptly transferred to the CRA Account of the Parent by way of dividend, loan or otherwise (subject to the other provisions of this Agreement).
Hogan Lovells

- 69 -


 

23.29   Conditions subsequent
  (a)   The Parent shall deliver to the Agent a schedule detailing all Original Group Financial Indebtedness and all Original Group Security, by no later than 10 Business Days after the date of this Agreement.
 
  (b)   The Parent shall deliver to the Agent evidence satisfactory to the Agent that all Existing Security listed in Part 3 of Schedule 14 Secured Group (Security to be released as a Condition Subsequent) has been fully discharged, by no later than 10 Business Days after the date of this Agreement.
 
  (c)   The Parent shall (i) open CRA Accounts; and (ii) grant security in favour of and to the satisfaction of the Security Agent in respect of its CRA Accounts, by no later than 30 days after the date of this Agreement.
 
  (d)   The Parent shall procure that Knapton accedes as an Additional Obligor, that the NAB Security is fully discharged and that Knapton grants security over its shares in Knapton Insurance Limited (registered in England and Wales with registered number 00014644) by no later than 60 days from the date of this Agreement.
 
  (e)   The Parent shall procure that originals of all share certificates, transfers and stock transfer forms (all stock transfer forms to be executed by two directors or a director and the secretary of the company that owns the relevant shares but with the sections relating to the consideration and the transferee left blank) or equivalent, are duly executed by the relevant Obligor in relation to the assets subject to or expressed to be subject to the Transaction Security and provided to the Security Agent by no later than 7 Business Days after the date of this Agreement.
24.    Events of Default
 
    Each of the events or circumstances set out in this Clause 24 is an Event of Default (save for Clause 24.18 (Acceleration).
 
24.1   Non-payment
 
    An Obligor does not pay on the due date any amount payable pursuant to a Finance Document in the manner in which it is expressed to be payable unless:
  (a)   its failure to pay is caused by:
  (i)   administrative or technical error by a bank in the transmission of funds; or
 
  (ii)   a Disruption Event; and
  (b)   payment is made within three Business Days of its due date.
24.2   Financial covenants and other obligations
 
    Any requirement of Clause 22 (Financial covenants) is not satisfied or an Obligor does not comply with the provisions of Clause 23.10 (Negative pledge), Clause 23.11 (Disposals), Clause 23.6 (Acquisitions), Clause 23.7 (Joint Ventures), Clause 23.13 (Loans or credit), Clause 23.14 (No guarantees or indemnities) and/or Clause 23.16 (Financial Indebtedness)
Hogan Lovells

- 70 -


 

24.3   Other obligations
  (a)   An Obligor does not comply with any provision of the Finance Documents (other than those referred to in Clause 24.1 (Non-payment) and Clause 24.2 (Financial covenants and other obligations)).
 
  (b)   No Event of Default under paragraph (a) above will occur if the failure to comply is capable of remedy and is remedied within ten Business Days after the earlier of (i) the Agent giving notice to the Parent or relevant Obligor and (ii) the Parent or an Obligor becoming aware of the failure to comply.
24.4   Misrepresentation
  (a)   Any representation, warranty or statement made or deemed to be made by an Obligor in the Finance Documents or any other document delivered by or on behalf of any Obligor under or in connection with any Finance Document is or proves to have been incorrect or misleading when made or deemed to be made.
 
  (b)   No Event of Default under Clause (a) above will occur if the circumstances giving rise to the relevant misrepresentation are capable of remedy and are remedied within ten Business Days after the earlier of (i) the Agent giving notice to the Parent or relevant Obligor and (ii) the Parent or an Obligor becoming aware of the failure to comply.
24.5   Cross default
  (a)   Any Financial Indebtedness of any member of the Group is not paid when due nor within any originally applicable grace period.
 
  (b)   Any Financial Indebtedness of any member of the Group is declared to be or otherwise becomes due and payable prior to its specified maturity as a result of an event of default (however described).
 
  (c)   Any commitment for any Financial Indebtedness of any member of the Group is cancelled or suspended by a creditor of any member of the Group as a result of an event of default (however described).
 
  (d)   Any creditor of any member of the Group becomes entitled to declare any Financial Indebtedness of any member of the Group due and payable prior to its specified maturity as a result of an event of default (however described).
 
  (e)   No Event of Default will occur under this Clause 24.5 if the aggregate amount of Financial Indebtedness or commitment for Financial Indebtedness falling within paragraphs (a) to (d) above is less than:
  (i)   US$10,000,000, in respect of the Parent;
 
  (ii)   zero, in respect of the any member of the Secured Group or any Obligor; or
 
  (iii)   US$5,000,000, in respect of any other member of the Group,
      (or its Base Currency Equivalent in each case).
24.6   Insolvency
  (a)   A member of the Group is unable or admits inability to pay its debts as they fall due or is deemed to or declared to be unable to pay its debts under applicable law, suspends or threatens to suspend making payments on any of its debts or, by
Hogan Lovells

- 71 -


 

      reason of actual or anticipated financial difficulties, commences negotiations with one or more of its creditors with a view to rescheduling any of its indebtedness.
 
  (b)   The value of the assets of any member of the Group is less than its liabilities (taking into account contingent and prospective liabilities).
 
  (c)   A moratorium is declared in respect of any indebtedness of any member of the Group. If a moratorium occurs, the ending of the moratorium will not remedy any Event of Default caused by that moratorium.
24.7   Insolvency proceedings
  (a)   Any corporate action, legal proceedings or other procedure or step is taken in relation to:
  (i)   the suspension of payments, a moratorium of any indebtedness, winding-up, dissolution, administration or reorganisation (by way of voluntary arrangement, scheme of arrangement or otherwise) of any member of the Group;
 
  (ii)   a composition, compromise, assignment or arrangement with any creditor of any member of the Group;
 
  (iii)   the appointment of a liquidator, receiver, administrative receiver, administrator, compulsory manager or other similar officer in respect of any member of the Group or any of its assets; or
 
  (iv)   enforcement of any Security over any assets of any member of the Group,
    or any analogous procedure or step is taken in any jurisdiction.
 
  (b)   Paragraph (a) above shall not apply to:
  (i)   any winding-up petition which is frivolous or vexatious and is discharged, stayed or dismissed before it is advertised and in any event within 14 days of commencement; or
 
  (ii)   any step or procedure contemplated by paragraph (b) of the definition of Permitted Transaction.
24.8   Creditors’ process
 
    Any expropriation, attachment, sequestration, distress or execution or any analogous process in any jurisdiction affects any asset or assets of a member of the Group having an aggregate value of:
  (i)   US$5,000,000, in respect of the Parent; or
 
  (ii)   zero, in respect of the any member of the Secured Group or any Obligor,
    and is not discharged within seven days.
 
24.9   Unlawfulness and invalidity
  (a)   It is or becomes unlawful for an Obligor to perform any of its obligations under the Finance Documents or any Transaction Security created or expressed to be created or evidenced by the Transaction Security Documents ceases to be effective.
Hogan Lovells

- 72 -


 

  (b)   Any obligation or obligations of any Obligor under any Finance Document are not (subject to the Legal Reservations) or cease to be legal, valid, binding or enforceable and the cessation individually or cumulatively materially and adversely effects the interests of the Lenders under the Finance Documents.
 
  (c)   Any Finance Document ceases to be in full force and effect or any Transaction Security ceases to be legal, valid, binding, enforceable or effective or is alleged by a party to it (other than a Finance Party) to be ineffective.
24.10   Cessation of business
 
    Any member of the Group suspends or ceases to carry on (or threatens to suspend or cease to carry on) all or a material part of its business except as a result of a disposal which is a Permitted Disposal or a Permitted Transaction which is contemplated in paragraphs (a) or (b) of the definition of that term.
24.11   Change of ownership
 
    An Obligor (other than the Parent) ceases to be a wholly-owned Subsidiary of the Parent except as a result of a disposal which is a Permitted Disposal.
 
24.12   Audit qualification
 
    The Auditors of the Group qualify the audited annual consolidated financial statements of the Parent.
 
24.13   Expropriation
 
    The authority or ability of any member of the Group to conduct its business is limited or wholly or substantially curtailed by any seizure, expropriation, nationalisation, intervention, restriction or other action by or on behalf of any governmental, regulatory or other authority or other person in relation to any member of the Group or any of its assets.
 
24.14   Cessation of licences
  (a)   The cessation, variation or imposition of limitations (for any reason) of any consent, authorisation, licence and/or exemption which is required to enable the Borrower or any Subsidiary to carry on its business, or the taking by any governmental, regulatory or other authority of any action in relation to the Borrower or any Subsidiary which could, in the Lender’s opinion, acting reasonably, have a material adverse effect on all or part of such business.
 
  (b)   No Event of Default under paragraph (a) above will occur if the failure to comply is capable of remedy and is remedied within twenty Business Days of the earlier of (1) the Lender giving notice to the Borrower and (2) the Borrower becoming aware of the failure to comply.
24.15   Repudiation and rescission of agreements
 
    An Obligor (or any other relevant party) rescinds or purports to rescind or repudiates or purports to repudiate a Finance Document or any of the Transaction Security or evidences an intention to rescind or repudiate a Finance Document or any Transaction Security.
 
24.16   Litigation
 
    Any litigation, arbitration, administrative, governmental, regulatory or other investigations, proceedings or disputes are commenced or threatened in relation to the Finance Documents or the transactions contemplated in the Finance Documents or against any
Hogan Lovells

- 73 -


 

    member of the Group or its assets and which if successful would be reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.
 
24.17   Material adverse change
 
    Any event or circumstance occurs which the Majority Lenders reasonably believe has or is reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.
 
24.18   Financial Services and Markets Act Sanctions
 
    Any fine, levy or sanctions are imposed upon any member of the Secured Group by the FSA or under the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 which the Majority Lenders reasonably believe has or is reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.
 
24.19   Acceleration
 
    On and at any time after the occurrence of an Event of Default which is continuing the Agent may, and shall if so directed by the Majority Lenders, by notice to the Parent:
  (a)   cancel the Total Commitments at which time they shall immediately be cancelled;
 
  (b)   declare that all or part of the Utilisations, together with accrued interest, and all other amounts accrued or outstanding under the Finance Documents be immediately due and payable, at which time they shall become immediately due and payable;
 
  (c)   declare that all or part of the Utilisations be payable on demand, at which time they shall immediately become payable on demand by the Agent on the instructions of the Majority Lenders; or
 
  (d)   exercise or direct the Security Agent to exercise any or all of its rights, remedies, powers or discretions under the Finance Documents.
Hogan Lovells

- 74 -


 

Section 9
Changes to Parties
25.   Changes to the Lenders
 
25.1   Assignments and transfers by the Lenders
  (a)   Subject to this Clause 25 and to Clause 26 (Prohibition on Debt Purchase Transactions), a Lender (the “Existing Lender") may:
  (i)   assign any of its rights; or
 
  (ii)   transfer by novation any of its rights and obligations,
      under any Finance Document to another bank or financial institution or to a trust, fund or other entity which is regularly engaged in or established for the purpose of making, purchasing or investing in loans, securities or other financial assets (the “New Lender").
25.2   Conditions of assignment or transfer
  (a)   An Existing Lender may not make an assignment or transfer in accordance with Clause 25.1 (Assignments and transfers by the Lenders) without the prior consent of the Parent (not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed) unless the assignment or transfer is:
  (i)   to another Lender or an Affiliate of a Lender;
 
  (ii)   if the Existing Lender is a fund, to a fund which is a Related Fund of the Existing Lender; or
 
  (iii)   made at a time when an Event of Default is continuing.
  (b)   The consent of the Parent required pursuant to paragraph (a) above shall be deemed to have been given if no notice to the contrary is received by the Agent within 5 Business Days of the request.
 
  (c)   An assignment will only be effective on:
  (i)   receipt by the Agent (whether in the Assignment Agreement or otherwise) of written confirmation from the New Lender (in form and substance satisfactory to the Agent) that the New Lender will assume the same obligations to the other Finance Parties and the other Secured Parties as it would have been under if it was an Original Lender; and
 
  (ii)   the performance by the Agent of all necessary “know your customer” or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations in relation to such assignment to a New Lender, the completion of which the Agent shall promptly notify to the Existing Lender and the New Lender.
  (d)   A transfer will only be effective if the procedure set out in Clause 25.5 (Procedure for transfer) is complied with.
 
  (e)   If:
  (i)   a Lender assigns or transfers any of its rights or obligations under the Finance Documents or changes its Facility Office; and
Hogan Lovells

- 75 -


 

  (ii)   as a result of circumstances existing at the date the assignment, transfer or change occurs, an Obligor would be obliged to make a payment to the New Lender or Lender acting through its new Facility Office under Clause 15 (Increased Costs),
      then (unless the assignment, transfer or charge has been made in mitigation in accordance with Clause 17 (Mitigation by the Lenders)) the New Lender or Lender acting through its new Facility Office is only entitled to receive payment under that Clause to the same extent as the Existing Lender or Lender acting through its previous Facility Office would have been if the assignment, transfer or change had not occurred. This paragraph (e) shall not apply in respect of an assignment or transfer made in the ordinary course of the primary syndication of the Facilities.
 
  (f)   Each New Lender, by executing the relevant Transfer Certificate or Assignment Agreement, confirms, for the avoidance of doubt, that the Agent has authority to execute on its behalf any amendment or waiver that has been approved by or on behalf of the requisite Lender or Lenders in accordance with this Agreement on or prior to the date on which the transfer or assignment becomes effective in accordance with this Agreement and that it is bound by that decision to the same extent as the Existing Lender would have been had it remained a Lender.
25.3   Assignment or transfer fee
 
    Unless the Agent otherwise agrees and excluding an assignment or transfer:
  (a)   to an Affiliate of a Lender;
 
  (b)   to a Related Fund; or
 
  (c)   made in connection with primary syndication of the Facilities,
    the New Lender shall, on the date upon which an assignment or transfer takes effect, pay to the Agent (for its own account) a fee of US$2,000.
 
25.4   Limitation of responsibility of Existing Lenders
  (a)   Unless expressly agreed to the contrary, an Existing Lender makes no representation or warranty and assumes no responsibility to a New Lender for:
  (i)   the legality, validity, effectiveness, adequacy or enforceability of the Finance Documents, the Finance Security or any other documents;
 
  (ii)   the financial condition of any Obligor;
 
  (iii)   the performance and observance by any Obligor or any other member of the Group of its obligations under the Finance Documents or any other documents; or
 
  (iv)   the accuracy of any statements (whether written or oral) made in or in connection with any Finance Document or any other document,
      and any representations or warranties implied by law are excluded.
 
  (b)   Each New Lender confirms to the Existing Lender, the other Finance Parties and the Secured Parties that it:
  (i)   has made (and shall continue to make) its own independent investigation and assessment of the financial condition and affairs of each Obligor and its related entities in connection with its participation in this Agreement and
Hogan Lovells

- 76 -


 

      has not relied exclusively on any information provided to it by the Existing Lender or any other Finance Party in connection with any Finance Document or the Transaction Security; and
 
  (ii)   will continue to make its own independent appraisal of the creditworthiness of each Obligor and its related entities whilst any amount is or may be outstanding under the Finance Documents or any Commitment is in force.
  (c)   Nothing in any Finance Document obliges an Existing Lender to:
  (i)   accept a re-transfer or reassignment from a New Lender of any of the rights and obligations assigned or transferred under this Clause 25; or
 
  (ii)   support any losses directly or indirectly incurred by the New Lender by reason of the non-performance by any Obligor of its obligations under the Finance Documents or otherwise.
25.5   Procedure for transfer
  (a)   Subject to the conditions set out in Clause 25.2 (Conditions of assignment or transfer) a transfer is effected in accordance with paragraph (b) below when the Agent executes an otherwise duly completed Transfer Certificate delivered to it by the Existing Lender and the New Lender. The Agent shall, subject to paragraph (b) below, as soon as reasonably practicable after receipt by it of a duly completed Transfer Certificate appearing on its face to comply with the terms of this Agreement and delivered in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, execute that Transfer Certificate.
 
  (b)   The Agent shall only be obliged to execute a Transfer Certificate delivered to it by the Existing Lender and the New Lender once it is satisfied it has complied with all necessary “know your customer” or similar other checks under all applicable laws and regulations in relation to the transfer to such New Lender.
 
  (c)   Subject to Clause 25.9 (Pro Rata Interest Settlement) on the Transfer Date:
  (i)   to the extent that in the Transfer Certificate the Existing Lender seeks to transfer by novation its rights, benefits and obligations under the Finance Documents and in respect of the Transaction Security each of the Obligors and the Existing Lender shall be released from further obligations towards one another under the Finance Documents and in respect of the Transaction Security and their respective rights against one another under the Finance Documents and in respect of the Transaction Security shall be cancelled (being the “Discharged Rights and Obligations”);
 
  (ii)   each of the Obligors and the New Lender shall assume obligations towards one another and/or acquire rights and benefits against one another which differ from the Discharged Rights and Obligations only insofar as that Obligor or other member of the Group and the New Lender have assumed and/or acquired the same in place of that Obligor and the Existing Lender;
 
  (iii)   the Agent, the Arranger, the Security Agent, the New Lender and the other Lenders shall acquire the same rights and assume the same obligations between themselves and in respect of the Transaction Security as they would have acquired and assumed had the New Lender been an Original Lender with the rights, and/or obligations acquired or assumed by it as a result of the transfer and to that extent the Agent, the Arranger, the
Hogan Lovells

- 77 -


 

      Security Agent and the Existing Lender shall each be released from further obligations to each other under the Finance Documents; and
 
  (iv)   the New Lender shall become a Party as a “Lender”.
25.6   Procedure for assignment
  (a)   Subject to the conditions set out in Clause 25.2 (Conditions of assignment or transfer) an assignment may be effected in accordance with paragraph (c) below when the Agent executes an otherwise duly completed Assignment Agreement delivered to it by the Existing Lender and the New Lender. The Agent shall, subject to paragraph (b) below, as soon as reasonably practicable after receipt by it of a duly completed Assignment Agreement appearing on its face to comply with the terms of this Agreement and delivered in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, execute that Assignment Agreement.
 
  (b)   The Agent shall only be obliged to execute an Assignment Agreement delivered to it by the Existing Lender and the New Lender once it is satisfied it has complied with all necessary “know your customer” or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations in relation to the assignment to such New Lender.
 
  (c)   Subject to Clause 25.9 (Pro Rata Interest Settlement) on the Transfer Date:
  (i)   the Existing Lender will assign absolutely to the New Lender its rights under the Finance Documents and in respect of the Transaction Security expressed to be the subject of the assignment in the Assignment Agreement;
 
  (ii)   the Existing Lender will be released from the obligations (the “Relevant Obligations”) expressed to be the subject of the release in the Assignment Agreement (and any corresponding obligations by which it is bound in respect of the Transaction Security); and
 
  (iii)   the New Lender shall become a Party as a “Lender” and will be bound by obligations equivalent to the Relevant Obligations.
  (d)   Lenders may utilise procedures other than those set out in this Clause 25.6 to assign their rights under the Finance Documents (but not, without the consent of the relevant Obligor or unless in accordance with Clause 25.5 (Procedure for transfer), to obtain a release by that Obligor from the obligations owed to that Obligor by the Lenders nor the assumption of equivalent obligations by a New Lender) provided that they comply with the conditions set out in Clause 25.2 (Conditions of assignment or transfer).
25.7   Copy of Transfer Certificate or Assignment Agreement to Parent
 
    The Agent shall, as soon as reasonably practicable after it has executed a Transfer Certificate or an Assignment Agreement, send to the Parent a copy of that Transfer Certificate or Assignment Agreement.
 
25.8   Security Interests over Lenders’ rights
 
    In addition to the other rights provided to Lenders under this Clause 25, each Lender may without consulting with or obtaining consent from any Obligor, at any time charge, assign or otherwise create Security in or over (whether by way of collateral or otherwise) all or any of its rights under any Finance Document to secure obligations of that Lender including, without limitation:
Hogan Lovells

- 78 -


 

  (a)   any charge, assignment or other Security to secure obligations to a federal reserve or central bank; and
 
  (b)   in the case of any Lender which is a fund, any charge, assignment or other Security granted to any holders (or trustee or representatives of holders) of obligations owed, or securities issued, by that Lender as security for those obligations or securities,
    except that no such charge, assignment or Security shall:
  (i)   release a Lender from any of its obligations under the Finance Documents or substitute the beneficiary of the relevant charge, assignment or other Security for the Lender as a party to any of the Finance Documents; or
 
  (ii)   require any payments to be made by an Obligor or grant to any person any more extensive rights than those required to be made or granted to the relevant Lender under the Finance Documents.
25.9   Pro Rata Interest Settlement
 
    If the Agent has notified the Lenders that it is able to distribute interest payments on a “pro rata basis” to Existing Lenders and New Lenders then (in respect of any transfer pursuant to Clause 25.5 (Procedure for transfer) or any assignment pursuant to Clause 25.6 (Procedure for assignment) the Transfer Date of which, in each case, is after the date of such notification and is not on the last day of an Interest Period):
  (a)   any interest or fees in respect of the relevant participation which are expressed to accrue by reference to the lapse of time shall continue to accrue in favour of the Existing Lender up to but including the Transfer Date (“Accrued Amounts”) and shall become due and payable to the Existing Lender (without further interest accruing on them) until the last day of the current Interest Period (or, if the Interest Period is longer than six Months, on the next of the dates which falls at six Monthly intervals after the first day of that Interest Period); and
 
  (b)   the rights assigned or transferred by the Existing Lender will not include the right to the Accrued Amounts so that, for the avoidance of doubt:
  (i)   when the Accrued Amounts become payable, those Accrued Amounts will be payable for the account of the Existing Lender, and
 
  (ii)   the amount payable to the New Lender on that date will be the amount which would, but for the application of this Clause 25.9, have been payable to it on that date, but after deduction of the Accrued Amounts.
26.   Prohibition on Debt Purchase Transactions
 
    The Parent shall not, and shall procure that each other member of the Group shall not, enter into any Debt Purchase Transaction or beneficially own all or any part of the share capital of a company that is a Lender or a party to a Debt Purchase Transaction of the type referred to in paragraphs (b) or (c) of the definition of Debt Purchase Transaction.
 
27.   Changes to the Obligors
 
27.1   Assignment and transfers by Obligors
 
    No Obligor may assign any of its rights or transfer any of its rights or obligations under the Finance Documents.
Hogan Lovells

- 79 -


 

27.2   Additional Guarantors
  (a)   Subject to compliance with the provisions of paragraphs (b) and (c) of Clause 21.10 (“Know your customer” checks), the Parent may request that any of its wholly owned Subsidiaries become a Guarantor.
 
  (b)   A member of the Group shall become an Additional Guarantor and/or Additional Chargor if:
  (i)   the Parent and the proposed Obligor deliver to the Agent a duly completed and executed Accession Deed; and
 
  (ii)   the Agent has received all of the documents and other evidence listed in Part 2 of Schedule 2 (Conditions precedent) in relation to that Additional Obligor, each in form and substance satisfactory to the Agent.
  (c)   The Agent shall notify the Parent and the Lenders promptly upon being satisfied that it has received (in form and substance satisfactory to it) all the documents and other evidence listed in Part 2 of Schedule 2 (Conditions precedent).
 
  (d)   If any legal prohibition would prevent or limit a Subsidiary’s ability to become an Additional Guarantor and/or to enter into Transaction Security, the Obligors shall use their reasonable endeavours lawfully to overcome the prohibition.
27.3   Repetition of representations
 
    Delivery of an Accession Deed constitutes confirmation by the relevant Subsidiary that the representations and warranties referred to in paragraph (c) of Clause 20.31 (Times when representations made) are true and correct in relation to it as at the date of delivery as if made by reference to the facts and circumstances then existing.
Hogan Lovells

- 80 -


 

Section 10
The Finance Parties
28.   Role of the Agent, the Security Agent, the Arranger and others
 
28.1   Appointment of the Agent and Security Agent
  (a)   Until such time (the “Agency Date”) as either a Lender assigns or transfers part, but not all, of its rights and obligations under the Finance Documents to a New Lender in accordance with Clause 25 (Changes to the Lenders), or there is more than one Lender as a result of an amendment and restatement of this Agreement, all references to the Agent in any Finance Document shall be construed as references to that Lender and the appointment of the Agent under Clause 28.1(b) and the provisions of Clause 28.17 (Agent’s and Security Agent’s management time) shall not take effect with respect to the Agent until the Agency Date. If on the Agency Date Barclays Bank PLC is not a Lender, Barclays Bank PLC may resign from its role as Agent in accordance with Clause 28.11(b) (Resignation of the Agent or the Security Agent), provided that such resignation shall be immediately effective and the appointment of the Agent under this Clause 28.11(b) and the provisions of Clause 28.17 (Agent’s and Security Agent’s management time) shall take effect with respect to the Agent upon the appointment of a successor Agent.
 
  (b)   Each of the Lenders appoints the Agent to act as its agent under and in connection with the Finance Documents.
 
  (c)   Each of the Lenders appoints the Security Agent to act as its agent and trustee under and in connection with the Finance Documents and the Charged Property.
 
  (d)   Each of the Lenders authorises the Agent and the Security Agent to:
  (i)   exercise the rights, powers, authorities and discretions specifically given to it under or in connection with the Finance Documents together with any other incidental rights, powers, authorities and discretions; and
 
  (ii)   to execute each of the Finance Documents (to which the Agent or the Security Agent, as applicable, is expressed to be a party) and all other documents that may be approved by (in the case of the Agent) the Majority Lenders or (in the case of the Security Agent) the Agent, for execution by it.
28.2   Duties of the Agent and Security Agent
  (a)   Subject to paragraph (b) below, the Agent shall promptly forward to a Party the original or a copy of any document which is delivered to the Agent for that Party by any other Party excluding, for the avoidance of doubt, any Fee Letter.
 
  (b)   Without prejudice to Clause 25.7 (Copy of Transfer Certificate or Assignment Agreement to Parent), paragraph (a) above shall not apply to any Transfer Certificate or any Assignment Agreement.
 
  (c)   Except where a Finance Document specifically provides otherwise, the Agent is not obliged to review or check the adequacy, accuracy or completeness of any document it forwards to another Party.
 
  (d)   If the Agent receives notice from a Party referring to this Agreement, describing a Default and stating that the circumstance described is a Default, it shall promptly
Hogan Lovells

- 81 -


 

      notify the other Finance Parties. Neither the Agent nor the Security Agent is obliged to monitor or enquire whether a Default has occurred.
 
  (e)   If the Agent is aware of the non-payment of any principal, interest, commitment fee or other fee payable to a Finance Party (other than the Agent, the Arranger or the Security Agent) under this Agreement it shall promptly notify the other Finance Parties.
 
  (f)   The Agent shall promptly send the Security Agent such certification as the Security Agent may require from time to time pursuant to Schedule 10 (Security provisions).
 
  (g)   The Agent shall provide to the Parent within 5 Business Days of a request by the Parent (but no more frequently than once per calendar month), a list (which may be in electronic form) setting out the names of the Lenders as at the date of that request, their respective Commitments, the address and fax number (and the department or officer, if any, for whose attention any communication is to be made) of each Lender for any communication to be made or document to be delivered under or in connection with the Finance Documents, the electronic mail address and/or any other information required to enable the sending and receipt of information by electronic mail or other electronic means to and by each Lender to whom any communication under or in connection with the Finance Documents may be made by that means and the account details of each Lender for any payment to be distributed by the Agent to that Lender under the Finance Documents.
 
  (h)   The Agent’s and the Security Agent’s duties under the Finance Documents are solely mechanical and administrative in nature.
28.3   Role of the Arranger
 
    Except as specifically provided in the Finance Documents, the Arranger has no obligations of any kind to any other Party under or in connection with any Finance Document.
 
28.4   No fiduciary duties
  (a)   Nothing in this Agreement constitutes the Agent, the Arranger, the Security Agent (save in relation to the Charged Property and as expressly provided in Schedule 10 (Security provisions) and the Transaction Security Documents).
 
  (b)   None of the Agent, the Security Agent or the Arranger shall be bound to account to any Lender for any sum or the profit element of any sum received by it for its own account.
28.5   Business with the Group
 
    The Agent, the Security Agent and the Arranger may accept deposits from, lend money to and generally engage in any kind of banking or other business with any member of the Group.
 
28.6   Rights and discretions
  (a)   The Agent and the Security Agent may rely on:
  (i)   any representation, notice or document believed by it to be genuine, correct and appropriately authorised; and
Hogan Lovells

- 82 -


 

  (ii)   any statement made by a director, authorised signatory or employee of any person regarding any matters which may reasonably be assumed to be within his knowledge or within his power to verify.
  (b)   Each of the Agent and the Security Agent may assume (unless it has received notice to the contrary in its capacity as agent for the Lenders) that:
  (i)   no Default has occurred (unless it has actual knowledge of a Default arising under Clause 24.1 (Non-payment));
  (ii)   any right, power, authority or discretion vested in any Party or the Majority Lenders has not been exercised; and
  (iii)   any notice or request made by the Parent (other than a Utilisation Request) is made on behalf of and with the consent and knowledge of all the Obligors.
  (c)   Each of the Agent and the Security Agent may engage, pay for and rely on the advice or services of any lawyers, accountants, surveyors or other experts.
  (d)   Each of the Agent and the Security Agent may act in relation to the Finance Documents through its personnel and agents.
  (e)   Each of the Agent and the Security Agent may disclose to any other Party any information it reasonably believes it has received as agent under the Finance Documents.
  (f)   The Agent may execute on behalf of the Finance Parties any document expressed by any Finance Document to be executed by the Agent on their behalf.
  (g)   Notwithstanding any other provision of any Finance Document to the contrary, none of the Agent, the Security Agent or the Arranger is obliged to do or omit to do anything if it would or might in its reasonable opinion constitute a breach of any law or regulation or a breach of a fiduciary duty or duty of confidentiality.
  (h)   The Agent may not disclose to any Finance Party any details of the rate notified to the Agent by any Lender or the identity of any such Lender for the purpose of paragraph (a)(ii) of Clause 12.2 (Market disruption).
28.7   Majority Lenders’ instructions
  (a)   Unless a contrary indication appears in a Finance Document:
  (i)   the Agent shall:
  (1)   exercise any right, power, authority or discretion vested in it as Agent in accordance with any instructions given to it by the Majority Lenders (or, if so instructed by the Majority Lenders, refrain from exercising any right, power, authority or discretion vested in it as Agent); and
  (2)   not be liable for any act (or omission) if it acts (or refrains from taking any action) in accordance with an instruction of the Majority Lenders; and
  (ii)   the Security Agent shall:
  (1)   exercise any right, power, authority or discretion vested in it as Security Agent in accordance with any instructions given to it by
Hogan Lovells

- 83 -


 

      the Agent (or, if so instructed by the Agent, refrain from exercising any right, power, authority, or discretion vested in it as Security Agent); and
  (2)   not be liable for any act (or omission) if it acts (or refrains from taking any action) in accordance with an instruction of the Agent;
  (b)   Unless a contrary indication appears in a Finance Document, any instructions given by the Majority Lenders (in the case of the Agent) or the Agent (in the case of the Security Agent) will be binding on all the Finance Parties.
  (c)   Any Lender may by notice to the Agent divide its Utilisations or Commitments into separate amounts to reflect sub-participation or similar transactions and may require the Agent to count such separate amounts individually in calculating the composition of the Majority Lenders.
  (d)   Each of the Agent and the Security Agent may refrain from acting in accordance with the instructions of the Majority Lenders (or, if appropriate, the Lenders) (in the case of the Agent) or the Agent (in the case of the Security Agent) or under sub-clause (e) below until it has received such security as it may require for any cost, loss or liability (together with any associated VAT) which it may incur in complying with the instructions.
  (e)   In the absence of instructions from the Majority Lenders, (or, if appropriate, the Lenders) (in the case of the Agent) or the Agent (in the case of the Security Agent), each of the Agent and the Security Agent may act (or refrain from taking action) as it considers to be in the best interest of the Lenders.
  (f)   Neither the Agent nor the Security Agent is authorised to act on behalf of a Lender (without first obtaining that Lender’s consent) in any legal or arbitration proceedings relating to any Finance Document. This paragraph (f) shall not apply to any legal or arbitration proceeding relating to the perfection, preservation or protection of rights under the Transaction Security Documents or enforcement of the Transaction Security or Transaction Security Documents.
28.8   Responsibility for documentation
    None of the Agent, the Arranger or the Security Agent:
  (a)   is responsible for the adequacy, accuracy and/or completeness of any information (whether oral or written) supplied by the Agent, the Arranger, an Obligor or any other person given in or in connection with any Finance Document or the Information Package or the transactions contemplated in the Finance Documents;
  (b)   is responsible for the legality, validity, effectiveness, adequacy or enforceability of any Finance Document or the Transaction Security or any other agreement, arrangement or document entered into, made or executed in anticipation of or in connection with any Finance Document or the Transaction Security; or
  (c)   is responsible for any determination as to whether any information provided or to be provided to any Finance Party is non-public information the use of which may be regulated or prohibited by applicable law or regulation relating to insider dealing or otherwise.
28.9   Exclusion of liability
  (a)   Without limiting paragraph (b) below (and without prejudice to the provisions of paragraph (e) of Clause 31.10 (Disruption to payment systems etc.)), neither the
Hogan Lovells

- 84 -


 

      Agent nor the Security Agent will be liable for any action taken by it under or in connection with any Finance Document or the Transaction Security, unless directly caused by its gross negligence or wilful misconduct.
  (b)   No Party (other than the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable)) may take any proceedings against any officer, employee or agent of the Agent or the Security Agent, in respect of any claim it might have against the Agent or the Security Agent or in respect of any act or omission of any kind by that officer, employee or agent in relation to any Finance Document and any officer, employee or agent of the Agent or the Security Agent may rely on this Clause subject to Clause 1.3 (Third party rights) and the provisions of the Third Parties Act.
  (c)   Neither the Agent nor the Security Agent will be liable for any delay (or any related consequences) in crediting an account with an amount required under the Finance Documents to be paid by it if it has taken all necessary steps as soon as reasonably practicable to comply with the regulations or operating procedures of any recognised clearing or settlement system used by it for that purpose.
  (d)   Nothing in this Agreement shall oblige the Agent, the Security Agent or the Arranger to carry out any “know your customer” or other checks in relation to any person on behalf of any Lender and each Lender confirms to the Agent, the Security Agent and the Arranger that it is solely responsible for any such checks it is required to carry out and that it may not rely on any statement in relation to such checks made by the Agent or the Security Agent or the Arranger.
28.10   Lenders’ indemnity to the Agent and the Security Agent
    Each Lender shall (in proportion to its share of the Total Commitments or, if the Total Commitments are then zero, to its share of the Total Commitments immediately prior to their reduction to zero) indemnify the Agent and the Security Agent, within three Business Days of demand, against any cost, loss or liability (including for negligence or any other category of liability whatsoever) incurred by the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) (otherwise than by reason of the Agent’s or the Security Agent’s (as applicable) gross negligence or wilful misconduct) (or in the case of any costs, loss or liability pursuant to Clause 31.10 (Disruption to payment systems etc.) notwithstanding the Agent’s or the Security Agent’s (as applicable) negligence, gross negligence or any other category of liability whatsoever but not including any claim based on the fraud of the Agent) in acting as Agent under the Finance Documents (unless the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) has been reimbursed by an Obligor pursuant to a Finance Document).
28.11   Resignation of the Agent or the Security Agent
  (a)   The Agent or the Security Agent may resign and appoint one of its Affiliates acting through an office in the United Kingdom as successor by giving notice to the Lenders and the Parent.
  (b)   Alternatively the Agent or the Security Agent may resign by giving 30 days notice to the Lenders and the Parent, in which case the Majority Lenders (after consultation with the Parent) may appoint a successor Agent or Security Agent (as applicable).
  (c)   If the Majority Lenders have not appointed a successor Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) in accordance with paragraph (b) above within 20 days after notice of resignation was given, the retiring Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) (after consultation with the Parent) may appoint a successor Agent or
Hogan Lovells

- 85 -


 

      Security Agent (as the case may be) (acting through an office in the United Kingdom).
  (d)   If the Agent or the Security Agent wishes to resign because (acting reasonably) it has concluded that it is no longer appropriate for it to remain as agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) and the Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) is entitled to appoint a successor Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) under paragraph (c) above, the Agent may (if it concludes (acting reasonably) that it is necessary to do so in order to persuade the proposed successor Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) to become a party to this Agreement as Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) agree with the proposed successor Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) amendments to this Clause 28 and any other term of this Agreement dealing with the rights or obligations of the Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) consistent with then current market practice for the appointment and protection of corporate trustees together with any reasonable amendments to the agency fee or security agency fee (as applicable) payable under this Agreement which are consistent with the successor Agent’s or Security Agent’s (as the case may be) normal fee rates and those amendments will bind the Parties.
  (e)   The retiring Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) shall, at its own cost, make available to the successor Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) such documents and records and provide such assistance as the successor Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) may reasonably request for the purposes of performing its functions as Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) under the Finance Documents.
  (f)   The Agent’s or Security Agent’s (as applicable) resignation notice shall only take effect upon the appointment of a successor.
  (g)   Upon the appointment of a successor, the retiring Agent or Security Agent (as applicable) shall be discharged from any further obligation in respect of the Finance Documents but shall remain entitled to the benefit of this Clause 28. Any successor and each of the other Parties shall have the same rights and obligations amongst themselves as they would have had if such successor had been an original Party.
28.12   Replacement of the Agent or the Security Agent
  (a)   After consultation with the Parent, the Majority Lenders may, by giving 30 days’ notice to the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) replace the Agent or Security Agent (as applicable) by appointing a successor Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) (acting through an office in the United Kingdom).
  (b)   The retiring Agent or the Security Agent (as the case may be) shall (at the expense of the Lenders) make available to the successor Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) such documents and records and provide such assistance as the successor Agent or Security Agent (as applicable) may reasonably request for the purposes of performing its functions as Agent under the Finance Documents.
  (c)   The appointment of the successor Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) shall take effect on the date specified in the notice from the Majority Lenders to the retiring Agent or Security Agent (as applicable). As from this date, the retiring Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) shall be discharged from any further obligation in respect of the Finance Documents but shall remain entitled to the benefit of this Clause 28 (and any agency fees or security agency fees
Hogan Lovells

- 86 -


 

    (as applicable) for the account of the retiring Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) shall cease to accrue from (and shall be payable on) that date).
  (d)   Any successor Agent or Security Agent and each of the other Parties shall have the same rights and obligations amongst themselves as they would have had if such successor had been an original Party.
  (e)   At any time after the appointment of a successor Security Agent, the retiring Security Agent shall do and execute all acts, deeds and documents reasonably required by its successor to transfer to it (or to its nominee, as it may direct) any Charged Property vested in the retiring Security Agent pursuant to the Transaction Security Documents and which shall not have vested in its successor by operation of law. All such acts, deeds and documents shall be done or, as the case may be, executed, at the cost of the retiring Security Agent.
28.13   Confidentiality
  (a)   In acting as agent for the Finance Parties, each of the Agent and the Security Agent shall be regarded as acting through its agency division which shall be treated as a separate entity from any other of its divisions or departments.
  (b)   If information is received by another division or department of the Agent or Security Agent, it may be treated as confidential to that division or department and the Agent or Security Agent (as the case may be) shall not be deemed to have notice of it.
  (c)   Notwithstanding any other provision of any Finance Document to the contrary, neither the Agent, nor the Security Agent nor the Arranger are obliged to disclose to any other person (i) any confidential information, or (ii) any other information if the disclosure would or might in its reasonable opinion constitute a breach of any law or a breach of a fiduciary duty.
  (d)   Notwithstanding that the Agent and the Security Agent may from time to time be the same person, the Agent and the Security Agent have entered into the Finance Documents in their separate capacities as Agent and Security Agent, provided that, where any Finance Documents provides for the Agent or the Security Agent to communicate with or provide instructions to the other, while the two agents are the same person, it will not be necessary for there to be any such formal communication or instructions notwithstanding that the Finance Documents provide in certain cases for the same to be in writing.
28.14   Relationship with the Lenders
  (a)   Subject to Clause 25.9 (Pro Rata Interest Settlement), the Agent may treat the person shown in its records as Lender at the opening of business (in the place of the Agent’s principal office as notified to the Finance Parties from time to time) as the Lender acting through its Facility Office:
  (i)   entitled to or liable for any payment due under any Finance Document on that day; and
  (ii)   entitled to receive and act upon any notice, request, document or communication or make any decision or determination under any Finance Document made or delivered on that day,
      unless it has received not less than five Business Days’ prior notice from that Lender to the contrary in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.
Hogan Lovells

- 87 -


 

  (b)   Each Lender shall supply the Agent with any information required by the Agent in order to calculate the Mandatory Cost in accordance with Schedule 4 (Mandatory Cost Formula).
  (c)   Each Lender shall supply the Agent with any information that the Security Agent may reasonably specify (through the Agent) as being necessary or desirable to enable the Security Agent to perform its functions as Security Agent. Each Lender shall deal with the Security Agent exclusively through the Agent and shall not deal directly with the Security Agent.
  (d)   Any Lender may by notice to the Agent appoint a person to receive on its behalf all notices, communications, information and documents to be made or dispatched to that Lender under the Finance Documents. Such notice shall contain the address, fax number and (where communication by electronic mail or other electronic means is permitted under Clause 33.5 (Electronic communication)) electronic mail address and/or any other information required to enable the sending and receipt of information by that means (and, in each case, the department or officer, if any, for whose attention communication is to be made) and be treated as a notification of a substitute address, fax number, electronic mail address, department and officer by that Lender for the purposes of Clause 33.2 (Addresses) and paragraph (a) (iii) of Clause 33.5 (Electronic communication) and the Agent shall be entitled to treat such person as the person entitled to receive all such notices, communications, information and documents as though that person were that Lender.
28.15   Credit appraisal by the Lenders
    Without affecting the responsibility of any Obligor for information supplied by it or on its behalf in connection with any Finance Document, each Lender confirms to the Agent, the Security Agent and the Arranger that it has been, and will continue to be, solely responsible for making its own independent appraisal and investigation of all risks arising under or in connection with any Finance Document including but not limited to:
  (a)   the financial condition, status and nature of each member of the Group;
  (b)   the legality, validity, effectiveness, adequacy or enforceability of any Finance Document and the Transaction Security and any other agreement, arrangement or document entered into, made or executed in anticipation of, under or in connection with any Finance Document or the Transaction Security;
  (c)   whether that Secured Party has recourse, and the nature and extent of that recourse, against any Party or any of its respective assets under or in connection with any Finance Document, the Transaction Security, the transactions contemplated by the Finance Documents or any other agreement, arrangement or document entered into, made or executed in anticipation of, under or in connection with any Finance Document;
  (d)   the adequacy, accuracy and/or completeness of the Information Package and any other information provided by the Agent, any Party or by any other person under or in connection with any Finance Document, the transactions contemplated by the Finance Documents or any other agreement, arrangement or document entered into, made or executed in anticipation of, under or in connection with any Finance Document; and
  (e)   the right or title of any person in or to, or the value or sufficiency of any part of the Charged Property, the priority of any of the Transaction Security or the existence of any Security affecting the Charged Property.
Hogan Lovells

- 88 -


 

28.16   Base Reference Banks
    If a Base Reference Bank (or, if a Base Reference Bank is not a Lender, the Lender of which it is an Affiliate) ceases to be a Lender, the Agent shall (in consultation with the Parent) appoint another Lender or an Affiliate of a Lender to replace that Base Reference Bank.
28.17   Agent’s and Security Agent’s management time
    Any amount payable to the Agent or the Security Agent under Clause 16.3 (Indemnity to the Agent), Clause 16.4 (Indemnity to the Security Agent), Clause 18 (Costs and expenses) and Clause 28.10 (Lenders’ indemnity to the Agent and the Security Agent) shall include the cost of utilising the Agent’s or the Security Agent’s (as applicable) management time or other resources and will be calculated on the basis of such reasonable daily or hourly rates as the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) may notify to the Parent and the Lenders, and is in addition to any fee paid or payable to the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) under Clause 13 (Fees).
28.18   Deduction from amounts payable by the Agent or the Security Agent
    If any Party owes an amount to the Agent or the Security Agent under the Finance Documents the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) may, after giving notice to that Party, deduct an amount not exceeding that amount from any payment to that Party which the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) would otherwise be obliged to make under the Finance Documents and apply the amount deducted in or towards satisfaction of the amount owed. For the purposes of the Finance Documents that Party shall be regarded as having received any amount so deducted.
28.19   Reliance and engagement letters
    Each Finance Party and Secured Party confirms that each of the Arranger and the Agent has authority to accept on its behalf (and ratifies the acceptance on its behalf of any letters or reports already accepted by the Arranger or Agent) the terms of any reliance letter or engagement letters relating to the Reports or any reports or letters provided by accountants in connection with the Finance Documents or the transactions contemplated in the Finance Documents and to bind it in respect of those Reports, reports or letters and to sign such letters on its behalf and further confirms that it accepts the terms and qualifications set out in such letters.
28.20   Security provisions
    The provisions of Schedule 10 (Security provisions) shall bind each Party.
29.   Conduct of business by the Finance Parties
    No provision of any Finance Document will:
  (a)   interfere with the right of any Finance Party to arrange its affairs (tax or otherwise) in whatever manner it thinks fit;
  (b)   oblige any Finance Party to investigate or claim any credit, relief, remission or repayment available to it or the extent, order and manner of any claim; or
  (c)   oblige any Finance Party to disclose any information relating to its affairs (tax or otherwise) or any computations in respect of Tax.
Hogan Lovells

- 89 -


 

30.   Sharing among the Finance Parties
30.1   Payments to Finance Parties
    If a Finance Party (a “Recovering Finance Party”) receives or recovers any amount from an Obligor other than in accordance with Clause 31 (Payment mechanics) (a “Recovered Amount”) and applies that amount to a payment due under the Finance Documents then:
  (i)   the Recovering Finance Party shall, within three Business Days, notify details of the receipt or recovery, to the Agent;
  (ii)   the Agent shall determine whether the receipt or recovery is in excess of the amount the Recovering Finance Party would have been paid had the receipt or recovery been received or made by the Agent and distributed in accordance with Clause 31 (Payment mechanics), without taking account of any Tax which would be imposed on the Agent in relation to the receipt, recovery or distribution; and
  (iii)   the Recovering Finance Party shall, within three Business Days of demand by the Agent, pay to the Agent an amount (the “Sharing Payment”) equal to such receipt or recovery less any amount which the Agent determines may be retained by the Recovering Finance Party as its share of any payment to be made, in accordance with Clause 31.5 (Partial payments).
30.2   Redistribution of payments
    The Agent shall treat the Sharing Payment as if it had been paid by the relevant Obligor and distribute it between the Finance Parties (other than the Recovering Finance Party) (the “Sharing Finance Parties”) in accordance with Clause 31.5 (Partial payments) towards the obligations of that Obligor to the Sharing Finance Parties.
30.3   Recovering Finance Party’s rights
    On a distribution by the Agent under Clause 30.2 (Redistribution of payments), of a payment received by a Recovering Finance Party from an Obligor, as between the relevant Obligor and the Recovering Finance Party, an amount of the Recovered Amount equal to the Sharing Payment will be treated as not having been paid by that Obligor.
30.4   Reversal of redistribution
    If any part of the Sharing Payment received or recovered by a Recovering Finance Party becomes repayable and is repaid by that Recovering Finance Party, then:
  (a)   each Sharing Finance Party shall, upon request of the Agent, pay to the Agent for the account of that Recovering Finance Party an amount equal to the appropriate part of its share of the Sharing Payment (together with an amount as is necessary to reimburse that Recovering Finance Party for its proportion of any interest on the Sharing Payment which that Recovering Finance Party is required to pay) (the “Redistributed Amount”); and
  (b)   as between the relevant Obligor and each relevant Sharing Finance Party, an amount equal to the relevant Redistributed Amount will be treated as not having been paid by that Obligor.
Hogan Lovells

- 90 -


 

30.5   Exceptions
  (a)   This Clause 30 shall not apply to the extent that the Recovering Finance Party would not, after making any payment pursuant to this Clause, have a valid and enforceable claim against the relevant Obligor.
  (b)   A Recovering Finance Party is not obliged to share with any other Finance Party any amount which the Recovering Finance Party has received or recovered as a result of taking legal or arbitration proceedings, if:
  (i)   it notified the other Finance Party of the legal or arbitration proceedings; and
  (ii)   the other Finance Party had an opportunity to participate in those legal or arbitration proceedings but did not do so as soon as reasonably practicable having received notice and did not take separate legal or arbitration proceedings.
Hogan Lovells

- 91 -


 

Section 11
Administration
31.   Payment mechanics
31.1 Payments to the Agent
  (a)   On each date on which an Obligor or a Lender is required to make a payment under a Finance Document, that Obligor or Lender shall make the same available to the Agent (unless a contrary indication appears in a Finance Document) for value on the due date at the time and in such funds specified by the Agent as being customary at the time for settlement of transactions in the relevant currency in the place of payment.
  (b)   Payment shall be made to such account in the principal financial centre of the country of that currency (or, in relation to euro, in a principal financial centre in a Participating Member State or London) with such bank as the Agent specifies.
31.2   Distributions by the Agent or the Security Agent
    Each payment received by the Agent or the Security Agent under the Finance Documents for another Party shall, subject to Clause 31.3 (Distributions to an Obligor) and Clause 31.4 (Clawback) be made available by the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) as soon as practicable after receipt to the Party entitled to receive payment in accordance with this Agreement (in the case of a Lender, for the account of its Facility Office), to such account as that Party may notify to the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) by not less than five Business Days’ notice with a bank in the principal financial centre of the country of that currency (or, in relation to euro, in the principal financial centre of a Participating Member State or London).
31.3   Distributions to an Obligor
    The Agent and the Security Agent may (with the consent of the Obligor or in accordance with Clause 32 (Set-off)) apply any amount received by it for that Obligor in or towards payment (on the date and in the currency and funds of receipt) of any amount due from that Obligor under the Finance Documents or in or towards purchase of any amount of any currency to be so applied.
31.4   Clawback
  (a)   Where a sum is to be paid to the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) under the Finance Documents for another Party, the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) is not obliged to pay that sum to that other Party (or to enter into or perform any related exchange contract) until it has been able to establish to its satisfaction that it has actually received that sum.
  (b)   If the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) pays an amount to another Party and it proves to be the case that the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) had not actually received that amount, then the Party to whom that amount (or the proceeds of any related exchange contract) was paid by the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) shall on demand refund the same to the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable) together with interest on that amount from the date of payment to the date of receipt by the Agent or the Security Agent (as applicable), calculated by the Agent to reflect its cost of funds.
Hogan Lovells

- 92 -


 

31.5   Partial payments
  (a)   If the Agent receives a payment for application against amounts due in respect of any Finance Documents that is insufficient to discharge all the amounts then due and payable by an Obligor under those Finance Documents, the Agent shall apply that payment towards the obligations of that Obligor under those Finance Documents in the following order:
  (i)   first, in or towards payment pro rata of any unpaid fees, costs and expenses of the Agent and the Security Agent under those Finance Documents;
  (ii)   secondly, in or towards payment pro rata of any accrued interest, fee or commission due but unpaid under those Finance Documents;
  (iii)   thirdly, in or towards payment pro rata of any principal due but unpaid under those Finance Documents; and
  (iv)   fourthly, in or towards payment pro rata of any other sum due but unpaid under the Finance Documents.
  (b)   The Agent shall, if so directed by the Majority Lenders, vary the order set out in sub-paragraphs (a)(ii) to (iv) above.
  (c)   Paragraphs (a) and (b) above will override any appropriation made by an Obligor.
31.6   Set-off by Obligors
    All payments to be made by an Obligor under the Finance Documents shall be calculated and be made without (and free and clear of any deduction for) set-off or counterclaim.
31.7   Business Days
  (a)   Any payment which is due to be made on a day that is not a Business Day shall be made on the next Business Day in the same calendar month (if there is one) or the preceding Business Day (if there is not).
  (b)   During any extension of the due date for payment of any principal or Unpaid Sum under this Agreement interest is payable on the principal or Unpaid Sum at the rate payable on the original due date.
31.8   Currency of account
  (a)   Subject to paragraphs (b) to (e) below, the Base Currency is the currency of account and payment for any sum due from an Obligor under any Finance Document.
  (b)   A repayment of an Utilisation or Unpaid Sum or a part of an Utilisation or Unpaid Sum shall be made in the currency in which that Utilisation or Unpaid Sum is denominated on its due date.
  (c)   Each payment of interest shall be made in the currency in which the sum in respect of which the interest is payable was denominated when that interest accrued.
  (d)   Each payment in respect of costs, expenses or Taxes shall be made in the currency in which the costs, expenses or Taxes are incurred.
Hogan Lovells

- 93 -


 

  (e)   Any amount expressed to be payable in a currency other than the Base Currency shall be paid in that other currency.
31.9   Change of currency
  (a)   Unless otherwise prohibited by law, if more than one currency or currency unit are at the same time recognised by the central bank of any country as the lawful currency of that country, then:
  (i)   any reference in the Finance Documents to, and any obligations arising under the Finance Documents in, the currency of that country shall be translated into, or paid in, the currency or currency unit of that country designated by the Agent (after consultation with the Parent); and
  (ii)   any translation from one currency or currency unit to another shall be at the official rate of exchange recognised by the central bank for the conversion of that currency or currency unit into the other, rounded up or down by the Agent (acting reasonably).
  (b)   If a change in any currency of a country occurs, this Agreement will, to the extent the Agent (acting reasonably and after consultation with the Parent) specifies to be necessary, be amended to comply with any generally accepted conventions and market practice in the Relevant Interbank Market and otherwise to reflect the change in currency.
31.10   Disruption to payment systems etc.
    If either the Agent determines (in its discretion) that a Disruption Event has occurred or the Agent is notified by the Parent that a Disruption Event has occurred:
  (a)   the Agent may, and shall if requested to do so by the Parent, consult with the Parent with a view to agreeing with the Parent such changes to the operation or administration of the Facilities as the Agent may deem necessary in the circumstances;
  (b)   the Agent shall not be obliged to consult with the Parent in relation to any changes mentioned in paragraph (a) above if, in its opinion, it is not practicable to do so in the circumstances and, in any event, shall have no obligation to agree to such changes;
  (c)   the Agent may consult with the Finance Parties in relation to any changes mentioned in paragraph (a) above but shall not be obliged to do so if, in its opinion, it is not practicable to do so in the circumstances;
  (d)   any such changes agreed upon by the Agent and the Parent shall (whether or not it is finally determined that a Disruption Event has occurred) be binding upon the Parties as an amendment to (or, as the case may be, waiver of) the terms of the Finance Documents notwithstanding the provisions of Clause 37 (Amendments and waivers);
  (e)   the Agent shall not be liable for any damages, costs or losses whatsoever (including, without limitation for negligence, gross negligence or any other category of liability whatsoever but not including any claim based on the fraud of the Agent) arising as a result of its taking, or failing to take, any actions pursuant to or in connection with this Clause 31.10; and
  (f)   the Agent shall notify the Finance Parties of all changes agreed pursuant to paragraph (d) above.
Hogan Lovells

- 94 -


 

32.   Set-off
  (a)   A Finance Party may set-off any matured obligation due from an Obligor under the Finance Documents (to the extent beneficially owned by that Finance Party) against any matured obligation owed by that Finance Party to that Obligor, regardless of the place of payment, booking branch or currency of either obligation. If the obligations are in different currencies, the Finance Party may convert either obligation at a market rate of exchange in its usual course of business for the purpose of the set-off. No security interest is created by this Clause 32.
33.   Notices
33.1   Communications in writing
    Any communication to be made under or in connection with the Finance Documents shall be made in writing and, unless otherwise stated, may be made by fax or letter.
33.2   Addresses
    The address and fax number (and the department or officer, if any, for whose attention the communication is to be made) of each Party for any communication or document to be made or delivered under or in connection with the Finance Documents is:
  (a)   in the case of the Parent, that identified with its name below;
  (b)   in the case of each Lender or any other Obligor, that notified in writing to the Agent on or prior to the date on which it becomes a Party; and
  (c)   in the case of the Agent or the Security Agent, that identified with its name below,
    or any substitute address, fax number or department or officer as the Party may notify to the Agent (or the Agent may notify to the other Parties, if a change is made by the Agent) by not less than five Business Days’ notice.
33.3   Delivery
  (a)   Any communication or document made or delivered by one person to another under or in connection with the Finance Documents will only be effective:
  (i)   if by way of fax, when received in legible form; or
  (ii)   if by way of letter, when it has been left at the relevant address or five Business Days after being deposited in the post postage prepaid in an envelope addressed to it at that address,
      and, if a particular department or officer is specified as part of its address details provided under Clause 33.2 (Addresses), if addressed to that department or officer.
  (b)   Any communication or document to be made or delivered to the Agent or the Security Agent will be effective only when actually received by the Agent or Security Agent and then only if it is expressly marked for the attention of the department or officer identified with the Agent’s or Security Agent’s signature below (or any substitute department or officer as the Agent or Security Agent shall specify for this purpose).
  (c)   All notices from or to an Obligor shall be sent through the Agent.
Hogan Lovells

- 95 -


 

  (d)   Any communication or document made or delivered to the Parent in accordance with this Clause 33.3 will be deemed to have been made or delivered to each of the Obligors or any other member of the Group party to a Finance Document.
33.4   Notification of address and fax number
    Promptly upon receipt of notification of an address or fax number or change of address or fax number pursuant to Clause 33.2 (Addresses) or changing its own address or fax number, the Agent shall notify the other Parties.
33.5   Electronic communication
  (a)   Any communication to be made between the Agent or the Security Agent and another Finance Party under or in connection with the Finance Documents may be made by electronic mail or other electronic means, if the Agent, the Security Agent and the relevant Finance Party:
  (i)   agree that, unless and until notified to the contrary, this is to be an accepted form of communication;
  (ii)   notify each other in writing of their electronic mail address and/or any other information required to enable the sending and receipt of information by that means; and
  (iii)   notify each other of any change to their address or any other such information supplied by them.
  (b)   Any electronic communication made between the Agent or the Security Agent and a Finance Party will be effective only when actually received in readable form and in the case of any electronic communication made by a Finance Party to the Agent or the Security Agent only if it is addressed in such a manner as the Agent or Security Agent shall specify for this purpose.
33.6   Use of websites
  (a)   The Parent may satisfy its obligation under this Agreement to deliver any information in relation to those Lenders (the “Website Lenders”) who accept this method of communication by posting this information onto an electronic website designated by the Parent and the Agent (the “Designated Website”) if:
  (i)   the Agent expressly agrees (after consultation with each of the Lenders) that it will accept communication of the information by this method;
  (ii)   both the Parent and the Agent are aware of the address of and any relevant password specifications for the Designated Website; and
  (iii)   the information is in a printable format or otherwise capable of being downloaded by the relevant Website Lender and is in a format previously agreed between the Parent and the Agent.
      If any Lender (a “Paper Form Lender”) does not agree to the delivery of information electronically then the Agent shall notify the Parent accordingly and the Parent shall at its own cost supply the information to the Agent (in sufficient copies for each Paper Form Lender) in paper form. In any event the Parent shall at its own cost supply the Agent with at least one copy in paper form of any information required to be provided by it.
Hogan Lovells

- 96 -


 

  (b)   The Agent shall supply each Website Lender with the address of and any relevant password specifications for the Designated Website following designation of that website by the Parent and the Agent.
  (c)   The Parent shall promptly upon becoming aware of its occurrence notify the Agent if:
  (i)   the Designated Website cannot be accessed due to technical failure;
  (ii)   the password specifications for the Designated Website change;
  (iii)   any new information which is required to be provided under this Agreement is posted onto the Designated Website;
  (iv)   any existing information which has been provided under this Agreement and posted onto the Designated Website is amended; or
  (v)   the Parent becomes aware that the Designated Website or any information posted onto the Designated Website is or has been infected by any electronic virus or similar software.
      If the Parent notifies the Agent under sub-paragraph (i) or sub-paragraph (v) above, all information to be provided by the Parent under this Agreement after the date of that notice shall be supplied in paper form unless and until the Agent and each Website Lender is satisfied that the circumstances giving rise to the notification are no longer continuing.
  (d)   Any Website Lender may request, through the Agent, one paper copy of any information required to be provided under this Agreement which is posted onto the Designated Website. The Parent shall at its own cost comply with any such request within 10 Business Days.
33.7   English language
  (a)   Any notice given under or in connection with any Finance Document must be in English.
  (b)   All other documents provided under or in connection with any Finance Document must be:
  (i)   in English; or
  (ii)   if not in English, and if so required by the Agent, accompanied by a certified English translation and, in this case, the English translation will prevail unless the document is a constitutional, statutory or other official document.
34.   Calculations and certificates
34.1   Accounts
    In any litigation or arbitration proceedings arising out of or in connection with a Finance Document, the entries made in the accounts maintained by a Finance Party are prima facie evidence of the matters to which they relate.
Hogan Lovells

- 97 -


 

34.2   Certificates and determinations
    Any certification or determination by a Finance Party of a rate or amount under any Finance Document is, in the absence of manifest error, conclusive evidence of the matters to which it relates.
34.3   Day count convention
    Any interest, commission or fee accruing under a Finance Document will accrue from day to day and is calculated on the basis of the actual number of days elapsed and a year of 360 days or, in any case where the practice in the Relevant Interbank Market differs, in accordance with that market practice.
35.   Partial invalidity
    If, at any time, any provision of the Finance Documents is or becomes illegal, invalid or unenforceable in any respect under any law of any jurisdiction, neither the legality, validity or enforceability of the remaining provisions nor the legality, validity or enforceability of such provision under the law of any other jurisdiction will in any way be affected or impaired.
36.   Remedies and waivers
    No failure to exercise, nor any delay in exercising, on the part of any Finance Party or Secured Party, any right or remedy under the Finance Documents shall operate as a waiver, nor shall any single or partial exercise of any right or remedy prevent any further or other exercise or the exercise of any other right or remedy. The rights and remedies provided in this Agreement are cumulative and not exclusive of any rights or remedies provided by law.
37.   Amendments and waivers
37.1   Required consents
  (a)   Subject to Clause 37.2 (Exceptions) any term of the Finance Documents may be amended or waived only with the consent of the Majority Lenders and the Obligors’ Agent and any such amendment or waiver will be binding on all Parties.
  (b)   The Agent may effect, on behalf of any Finance Party, any amendment or waiver permitted by this Clause 37.
  (c)   Each Obligor agrees to any such amendment or waiver permitted by this Clause 37 which is agreed to by the Obligors’ Agent. This includes any amendment or waiver which would, but for this paragraph (c), require the consent of all of the Guarantors.
37.2   Exceptions
  (a)   An amendment or waiver that has the effect of changing or which relates to:
  (i)   the definitions of “Majority Lenders” in Clause 1.1 (Definitions);
  (ii)   an extension to the date of payment of any amount under the Finance Documents, but not an extension which results from an amendment to or waiver of the provisions of Clause 8 (Mandatory prepayment) provided that the amendment or waiver does not involve a change to the application of proceeds between the Facilities;
Hogan Lovells

- 98 -


 

  (iii)   a reduction in the Margin or a reduction in the amount of any payment of principal, interest, fees or commission payable;
  (iv)   a change in currency of payment of any amount under the Finance Documents;
  (v)   an increase in or an extension of any Commitment or the Total Commitments;
  (vi)   a change to the Borrowers or Guarantors other than in accordance with Clause 27 (Changes to the Obligors);
  (vii)   any provision which expressly requires the consent of all the Lenders;
  (viii)   Clause 2.2 (Finance Parties’ rights and obligations), Clause 8 (Mandatory prepayment), Clause 25 (Changes to the Lenders) or this Clause 37;
  (ix)   (other than as expressly permitted by the provisions of any Finance Document) the nature or scope of:
  (1)   the guarantee and indemnity granted under Clause 19 (Guarantee and indemnity);
  (2)   the Charged Property; or
  (3)   the manner in which the proceeds of enforcement of the Transaction Security are distributed,
      (except in the case of paragraph (2) and paragraph (3) above, insofar as it relates to a sale or disposal of an asset which is the subject of the Transaction Security where such sale or disposal is expressly permitted under this Agreement or any other Finance Document);
  (x)   the release of any Transaction Security unless permitted under this Agreement or any other Finance Document or relating to a sale or disposal of an asset which is the subject of the Transaction Security where such sale or disposal is expressly permitted under this Agreement or any other Finance Document;
  (xi)   any extension of an Availability Period,
      shall not be made without the prior consent of all the Lenders,
  (b)   An amendment or waiver which relates to the rights or obligations of the Agent, the Arranger or the Security Agent may not be effected without the consent of the Agent, the Arranger or the Security Agent.
38.   Confidentiality
 
38.1   Confidential Information
    Each Finance Party agrees to keep all Confidential Information confidential and not to disclose it to anyone, save to the extent permitted by Clause 38.2 (Disclosure of Confidential Information) and Clause 38.3 (Disclosure to numbering service providers), and to ensure that all Confidential Information is protected with security measures and a degree of care that would apply to its own confidential information.
38.2   Disclosure of Confidential Information
    Any Finance Party may disclose:
Hogan Lovells

- 99 -


 

  (a)   to any of its Affiliates and Related Funds and any of its or their officers, directors, employees, professional advisers, auditors, partners and Representatives such Confidential Information as that Finance Party shall consider appropriate if any person to whom the Confidential Information is to be given pursuant to this paragraph (a) is informed in writing of its confidential nature and that some or all of such Confidential Information may be price-sensitive information except that there shall be no such requirement to so inform if the recipient is subject to professional obligations to maintain the confidentiality of the information or is otherwise bound by requirements of confidentiality in relation to the Confidential Information;
  (b)   to any person:
  (i)   to (or through) whom it assigns or transfers (or may potentially assign or transfer) all or any of its rights and/or obligations under one or more Finance Documents and to any of that person’s Affiliates, Related Funds, Representatives and professional advisers;
  (ii)   with (or through) whom it enters into (or may potentially enter into), whether directly or indirectly, any sub-participation in relation to, or any other transaction under which payments are to be made or may be made by reference to, one or more Finance Documents and/or one or more Obligors and to any of that person’s Affiliates, Related Funds, Representatives and professional advisers;
  (iii)   appointed by any Finance Party or by a person to whom paragraph (b)(i) or (ii) above applies to receive communications, notices, information or documents delivered pursuant to the Finance Documents on its behalf (including, without limitation, any person appointed under paragraph (d) of Clause 28.14 (Relationship with the Lenders));
  (iv)   who invests in or otherwise finances (or may potentially invest in or otherwise finance), directly or indirectly, any transaction referred to in paragraph b(i) or (b)(ii) above;
  (v)   to whom information is required or requested to be disclosed by any court of competent jurisdiction, any governmental, banking, taxation or other regulatory authority or similar body, the rules of any relevant stock exchange or pursuant to any applicable law or regulation;
  (vi)   to whom or for whose benefit that Finance Party charges, assigns or otherwise creates Security (or may do so) pursuant to Clause 25.8 (Security Interests over Lenders’ rights);
  (vii)   to whom information is required to be disclosed in connection with, and for the purposes of, any litigation, arbitration, administrative or other investigations, proceedings or disputes;
  (viii)   who is a Party; or
  (ix)   with the consent of the Parent;
      in each case, such Confidential Information as that Finance Party shall consider appropriate if:
  (1)   in relation to paragraphs (b)(i), (b)(ii) and b(iii) above, the person to whom the Confidential Information is to be given has entered into a Confidentiality Undertaking except that there shall be no
Hogan Lovells

- 100 -


 

      requirement for a Confidentiality Undertaking if the recipient is a professional adviser and is subject to professional obligations to maintain the confidentiality of the Confidential Information;
  (2)   in relation to paragraph (b)(iv) above, the person to whom the Confidential Information is to be given has entered into a Confidentiality Undertaking or is otherwise bound by requirements of confidentiality in relation to the Confidential Information they receive and is informed that some or all of such Confidential Information may be price-sensitive information;
  (3)   in relation to paragraphs (b)(v), (b)(vi) and (b)(vii) above, the person to whom the Confidential Information is to be given is informed of its confidential nature and that some or all of such Confidential Information may be price-sensitive information except that there shall be no requirement to so inform if, in the opinion of that Finance Party, it is not practicable so to do in the circumstances;
  (c)   to any person appointed by that Finance Party or by a person to whom sub paragraph (b)(i) or (b)(ii) above applies to provide administration or settlement services in respect of one or more of the Finance Documents including without limitation, in relation to the trading of participations in respect of the Finance Documents, such Confidential Information as may be required to be disclosed to enable such service provider to provide any of the services referred to in this paragraph (c) if the service provider to whom the Confidential Information is to be given has entered into a confidentiality agreement substantially in the form of the LMA Master Confidentiality Undertaking for Use With Administration/Settlement Service Providers or such other form of confidentiality undertaking agreed between the Parent and the relevant Finance Party;
  (d)   to any rating agency (including its professional advisers) such Confidential Information as may be required to be disclosed to enable such rating agency to carry out its normal rating activities in relation to the Finance Documents and/or the Obligors if the rating agency to whom the Confidential Information is to be given is informed of its confidential nature and that some or all of such Confidential Information may be price-sensitive information.
38.3   Disclosure to numbering service providers
  (a)   The Agent may disclose to any national or international numbering service provider appointed by the Agent to provide identification numbering services in respect of this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors the following information.
  (i)   names of Obligors;
  (ii)   country of domicile of Obligors;
 
  (iii)   place of incorporation of Obligors;
 
  (iv)   date of this Agreement;
 
  (v)   the names of the Agent;
 
  (vi)   date of each amendment and restatement of this Agreement;
 
  (vii)   amount of Total Commitments;
Hogan Lovells

- 101 -


 

  (viii)   currencies of the Facilities;
 
  (ix)   type of Facilities;
 
  (x)   ranking of Facilities;
 
  (xi)   Termination Date for Facilities;
 
  (xii)   changes to any of the information previously supplied pursuant to sub paragraphs (i) to (xi) above; and
 
  (xiii)   such other information agreed between the Agent and the Parent,
      to enable such numbering service provider to provide its usual syndicated loan numbering identification services.
  (b)   The Parties acknowledge and agree that each identification number assigned to this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors by a numbering service provider and the information associated with each such number may be disclosed to users of its services in accordance with the standard terms and conditions of that numbering service provider.
  (c)   The Parent represents that none of the information set out in sub-paragraphs (i) to (xiii) of paragraph (a) above is, nor will at any time be, unpublished price-sensitive information.
  (d)   The Agent shall notify the Parent and the other Finance Parties of:
  (i)   the name of any numbering service provider appointed by the Agent in respect of this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors; and
  (ii)   the number or, as the case may be, numbers assigned to this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors by such numbering service provider.
38.4   Entire agreement
    This Clause 38 (Confidentiality) constitutes the entire agreement between the Parties in relation to the obligations of the Finance Parties under the Finance Documents regarding Confidential Information and supersedes any previous agreement, whether express or implied, regarding Confidential Information.
38.5   Inside information
    Each of the Finance Parties acknowledges that some or all of the Confidential Information is or may be price-sensitive information and that the use of such information may be regulated or prohibited by applicable legislation including securities law relating to insider dealing and market abuse and each of the Finance Parties undertakes not to use any Confidential Information for any unlawful purpose.
38.6   Notification of disclosure
    Each of the Finance Parties agrees (to the extent permitted by law and regulation) to inform the Parent of the circumstances of any disclosure by it of Confidential Information made pursuant to sub-paragraph (b)(v) of Clause 38.2 (Disclosure of Confidential Information) except where such disclosure is made to any of the persons referred to in that paragraph during the ordinary course of its supervisory or regulatory function.
Hogan Lovells

- 102 -


 

38.7   Continuing obligations
    The obligations in this Clause 38 (Confidentiality) are continuing and, in particular, shall survive and remain binding on each Finance Party for a period of twelve months from the earlier of:
  (a)   the date on which all amounts payable by the Obligors under or in connection with the Finance Documents have been paid in full and all Commitments have been cancelled or otherwise cease to be available; and
  (b)   the date on which such Finance Party otherwise ceases to be a Finance Party.
39.   Counterparts
    Each Finance Document may be executed in any number of counterparts, and this has the same effect as if the signatures on the counterparts were on a single copy of the Finance Document.
Hogan Lovells

- 103 -


 

Section 12
Governing law and enforcement
40.   Governing law
 
    This Agreement and all non-contractual obligations arising in any way whatsoever out of or in connection with this Agreement shall be governed by, construed and take effect in accordance with English law.
 
41.   Enforcement
 
41.1   Jurisdiction of English courts
  (a)   The courts of England shall have exclusive jurisdiction to settle any claim, dispute or matter of difference which may arise in any way whatsoever out of or in connection with the Finance Documents (including a dispute regarding the existence, validity or termination of any Finance Document or any claim for set-off) or the legal relationships established by any Finance Document (a “Dispute”), only where such Dispute is the subject of proceedings commenced by an Obligor.
 
  (b)   Where a Dispute is the subject of proceedings commenced by one or more Finance Parties, the Finance Parties are entitled to bring such proceedings in any court or courts of competent jurisdiction (including but not limited to the courts of England). If any Obligor raises a counter-claim in the context of proceedings commenced by one or more Finance Parties, that Obligor shall bring such counter-claim before the court seized of the Finance Party’s claim and no other court.
 
  (c)   The commencement of legal proceedings in one or more jurisdictions shall not, to the extent allowed by law, preclude the Finance Parties from commencing legal actions or proceedings in any other jurisdiction, whether concurrently or not.
 
  (d)   To the extent allowed by law, each Obligor irrevocably waives any objection it may now or hereafter have on any grounds whatsoever to the laying of venue of any legal proceeding, and any claim it may now or hereafter have that any such legal proceeding has been brought in an inappropriate or inconvenient forum.
41.2   Service of process
 
    Without prejudice to any other mode of service allowed under any relevant law, each Obligor (other than an Obligor incorporated in England and Wales):
  (a)   irrevocably appoints Enstar (EU) Limited (registered in England and Wales with registered number 03168082) at its registered office at the date of this Agreement (or such other address in England and Wales as the Parent may notify to the Agent in writing) as its agent for service of process in relation to any proceedings before the English courts in connection with any Finance Document; and
 
  (b)   agrees that failure by an agent for service of process to notify the relevant Obligor of the process will not invalidate the proceedings concerned; and
 
  (c)   if any person appointed as an agent for service of process is unable for any reason to act as agent for service of process, Enstar (EU) Limited (on behalf of all the Obligors) must immediately (and in any event within 5 Business Days of such event taking place) appoint another agent on terms acceptable to the Agent. Failing this, the Agent may appoint another agent for this purpose.
Hogan Lovells

- 104 -


 

41.3   Waiver of immunity
 
    Each Obligor (to the fullest extent permitted by law) irrevocably and unconditionally:
  (a)   agrees not to claim any immunity from proceedings brought against it by any Finance Party in relation to any Finance Document, and to ensure that no such claim is made on its behalf;
 
  (b)   waives all rights of immunity in respect of it or its assets; and
 
  (c)   consents generally in respect of such proceedings to the giving of relief or the issue of any process in connection with such proceedings.
This Agreement has been entered into on the date stated at the beginning of this Agreement.
Hogan Lovells

- 105 -


 

Schedule 1
The Original Obligors
     
    Registration number (or equivalent, if any) and
Name of Original Guarantor   jurisdiction of incorporation
Enstar Group Limited
  Bermuda — 30916
Hillcot Holdings Limited
  Bermuda — 32870
Virginia Holdings Limited
  Bermuda — 37001
Revir Limited
  Bermuda — 28913
Kenmare Holdings Limited
  Bermuda — 30917
Cavell Holdings Limited
  England and Wales — 1095628
Flatts Limited
  England and Wales — 6239044
     
    Registration number (or equivalent, if any) and
Name of Original Chargor   jurisdiction of incorporation
Enstar Group Limited
  Bermuda — 30916
Hillcot Holdings Limited
  Bermuda — 32870
Virginia Holdings Limited
  Bermuda — 37001
Revir Limited
  Bermuda — 28913
Kenmare Holdings Limited
  Bermuda — 30917
Cavell Holdings Limited
  England and Wales — 1095628
Flatts Limited
  England and Wales — 6239044
Hogan Lovells

- 106 -


 

Schedule 2
Conditions precedent
Part 1A
Conditions precedent to first Utilisation
1.   Obligors
  (a)   A copy of the constitutional documents of the Parent and of each other Original Obligor with such amendments as the Security Agent may reasonably request.
 
  (b)   A copy of a resolution of the board of directors or if applicable, a committee of the board (at which the finance director shall be present) of each Original Obligor:
  (i)   approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Finance Documents to which it is a party and resolving that it execute, deliver and perform the Finance Documents to which it is a party;
 
  (ii)   authorising a specified person or persons to execute the Finance Documents to which it is a party on its behalf;
 
  (iii)   authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all documents and notices (including, if relevant, any Utilisation Request) to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with the Finance Documents to which it is a party; and
 
  (iv)   in the case of an Obligor other than the Parent, authorising the Parent to act as its agent in connection with the Finance Documents.
  (c)   If applicable, a copy of a resolution of the board of directors of the relevant company, establishing the committee referred to in paragraph (b) above.
 
  (d)   A specimen of the signature of each person authorised by the resolution referred to in paragraph (b) above in relation to the Finance Documents and related documents.
 
  (e)   A copy of a resolution signed by all the holders of the issued shares in each Original Guarantor, approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Finance Documents to which the Original Guarantor is a party.
 
  (f)   A copy of a resolution of the board of directors of each corporate shareholder of each Original Guarantor approving the terms of the resolution referred to in paragraph (e) above.
 
  (g)   A certificate of the Parent (signed by a director) confirming that borrowing or guaranteeing or securing, as appropriate, the Total Commitments would not cause any borrowing, guarantee, security or similar limit binding on any Original Obligor to be exceeded.
 
  (h)   A certificate of an authorised signatory of the Parent or other relevant Original Obligor certifying that each copy document relating to it specified in this Part 1 of Schedule 2 is correct, complete and in full force and effect and has not been amended or superseded as at a date no earlier than the date of this Agreement.
 
  (i)   A certificate of an authorised signatory of each Obligor incorporated in a jurisdiction other than England and Wales stating that such Obligor is not
Hogan Lovells

- 107 -


 

      registered in the UK as an overseas company with a UK establishment under the Overseas Companies Regulations 2009.
2.   Finance Documents
  (a)   This Agreement executed by members of the Group party to this Agreement.
 
  (b)   The Fee Letters executed by the Parent.
 
  (c)   At least two originals of each of the following Transaction Security Documents executed by the Original Obligors specified below opposite the relevant Transaction Security Document:
         
     
Name of Original Obligor   Transaction Security Document   Governing law of document
Each Original Guarantor
  Share Pledge   English
 
       
Enstar Group Limited
  Share Pledge over the ordinary shares in Cumberland Holdings Limited   Bermudan
  (d)   Any document or information required to be delivered to the Agent or the Security Agent on or prior to the date of first utilisation under this Agreement pursuant to the terms of any Transaction Security Document and not otherwise specifically referred to in this Schedule.
3.   Legal opinions
 
    The following legal opinions, each addressed to the Agent, the Security Agent and the Original Lender and capable of being relied upon by any persons who become Lenders pursuant to the primary syndication of the Facilities.
  (a)   A legal opinion of Hogan Lovells International LLP, legal advisers to the Agent and the Arranger as to English law substantially in the form distributed to the Original Lender prior to signing this Agreement.
 
  (b)   A legal opinion of Appleby, legal advisers to the Agent and Arranger as to Bermudan law substantially in the form distributed to the Original Lender prior to signing this Agreement.
4.   Other documents and evidence
  (a)   Evidence that any process agent referred to in Clause 41.2 (Service of process), if not an Original Obligor, has accepted its appointment.
 
  (b)   The Group Structure Chart.
 
  (c)   The Budget.
 
  (d)   The Reports.
 
  (e)   A copy, certified by an authorised signatory of the Parent to be a true copy, of the Original Financial Statements of each Obligor.
 
  (f)   A copy of any other Authorisation or other document, opinion or assurance which the Agent considers to be necessary or desirable (if it has notified the Parent accordingly) in connection with the entry into and performance of the transactions
Hogan Lovells

- 108 -


 

      contemplated by any Finance Document or for the validity and enforceability of any Finance Document.
 
  (g)   Any information and evidence in respect of any Obligor or shareholders required by any Finance Party to enable it to be satisfied with the results of all “know your customer” or other checks which it is required to carry out in relation to such person.
5.   Miscellaneous
  (a)   A Funds Flow Statement.
 
  (b)   Evidence that the fees, costs and expenses then due from the Parent pursuant to Clause 13 (Fees), Clause 14.7 (Stamp taxes) and Clause 18 (Costs and expenses) have been paid or will be paid by the first Utilisation Date.
 
  (c)   Evidence satisfactory to the Agent that the amount available to Royston under the Royston Facility Agreement has been reduced to no greater than $35,000,000 and that the FSA has approved any related Capital Release Amount.
 
  (d)   Evidence that the Intercompany Loans will be repaid with the proceeds of Facility A.
Hogan Lovells

- 109 -


 

Part 1B
Conditions precedent relating to the CIGNA Reinsurance Arrangements
1.   An extract from the board resolution of the Parent confirming approval for the CIGNA Reinsurance Arrangements and the management report referred to in 2 below.
 
2.   A copy of the report by the management of the Parent detailing the commercial rationale for the CIGNA Reinsurance Arrangements.
 
3.   Evidence that no other debt or contingent liability (other than the Parent CIGNA Guarantee) will be incurred to fund and/or support the CIGNA Reinsurance Arrangements.
 
4.   Evidence that, following completion of the CIGNA Reinsurance Arrangements, the Group Capital Resources will be not less than the Group Capital Requirement.
 
5.   Evidence that, following the CIGNA Reinsurance Arrangements, the capital resources of any insurance company in the Group of which CIGNA will be a Subsidiary will be not less than the amount that it is required to hold in accordance with applicable law and applicable rules and guidance given by any regulator, including, without limitation, its Pillar 1 Capital Requirement, its ICA Capital Requirement and its ICG Capital Requirement.
 
6.   A breakdown of the CIGNA investment portfolio.
Hogan Lovells

- 110 -


 

Part 2
Conditions precedent required to be delivered by an Additional Obligor
1.   An Accession Deed executed by the Additional Obligor and the Parent.
 
2.   A copy of the constitutional documents of the Additional Obligor, with such amendments as the Agent may reasonably require.
 
3.   A copy of a resolution of the board of directors of the Additional Obligor (at which the finance director shall be present):
  (a)   approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Accession Deed and the Finance Documents and resolving that it execute, deliver and perform the Accession Deed and any other Finance Document to which it is party;
 
  (b)   authorising a specified person or persons to execute the Accession Deed and other Finance Documents on its behalf;
 
  (c)   authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all other documents and notices to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with the Finance Documents to which it is a party; and
 
  (d)   authorising the Parent to act as its agent in connection with the Finance Documents.
4.   A specimen of the signature of each person authorised by the resolution referred to in paragraph 3 above.
 
5.   A copy of a special resolution signed by all the holders of the issued shares of the Additional Guarantor, approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Finance Documents to which the Additional Guarantor is a party.
 
6.   A copy of a resolution of the board of directors of each corporate shareholder of each Additional Guarantor approving the terms of the resolution referred to in paragraph 5 above.
 
7.   A certificate of the Additional Obligor (signed by a director) confirming that borrowing or guaranteeing or securing, as appropriate, the Total Commitments would not cause any borrowing, guarantee, security or similar limit binding on it to be exceeded.
 
8.   A certificate of an authorised signatory of the Additional Obligor certifying that each copy document listed in this Part 2 of Schedule 2 is correct, complete and in full force and effect and has not been amended or superseded as at a date no earlier than the date of the Accession Deed.
 
9.   A copy of any other authorisation, consent, approval, resolution, licence, exemption, filing, notarisation or registration or other document, opinion or assurance which the Agent considers to be necessary or desirable in connection with the entry into and performance of the transactions contemplated by the Accession Letter or for the validity and enforceability of any Finance Document.
 
10.   If available, the latest audited financial statements of the Additional Obligor.
 
11.   The following legal opinions, each addressed to the Agent, the Security Agent and the Lenders:
Hogan Lovells

- 111 -


 

  (a)   A legal opinion of Hogan Lovells International LLP as advisers to the Agent in England, as to English law in the form distributed to the Lenders prior to signing the Accession Deed.
 
  (b)   If the Additional Obligor is incorporated in or has its “centre of main interest” or “establishment” (as referred to in Clause 20.25 (Centre of main interests and establishments)) in a jurisdiction other than England and Wales or is executing a Finance Document which is governed by a law other than English law, a legal opinion of the legal advisers to the Agent in the jurisdiction of its incorporation, “centre of main interest” or “establishment” (as applicable) or, as the case may be, the jurisdiction of the governing law of that Finance Document (the “Applicable Jurisdiction”) as to the law of the Applicable Jurisdiction and in the form distributed to the Lenders prior to signing the Accession Deed.
 
  (c)   If an Obligor or Additional Obligor (as the case may be) grants security over the shares it owns in a Subsidiary where that Subsidiary is incorporated in a different jurisdiction from the jurisdiction of that Chargor, legal opinions of the legal advisers to the Agent:
  (i)   in the Applicable Jurisdiction for the relevant Transaction Security Document; and
 
  (ii)   in the jurisdiction where the relevant Obligor or Additional Obligor is incorporated, or has its centre of main interests or “establishment” (as applicable).
12.   If the proposed Additional Obligor is incorporated in a jurisdiction other than England and Wales, evidence that the process agent specified in Clause 41.2 (Service of process), if not an Obligor, has accepted its appointment in relation to the proposed Additional Obligor.
 
13.   The Transaction Security Documents or other security documents which are required by the Agent to be executed by the proposed Additional Obligor.
 
14.   Any notices or documents (including title deeds) required to be given or executed under the terms of those security documents.
 
15.   Share certificates and stock transfer forms executed in blank (as described in paragraph 2(d) of Part 1A of this Schedule) as required by any security document.
 
16. (a)   In relation to Additional Obligors incorporated in England and Wales or Scotland, evidence that members of the Group incorporated in England and Wales or Scotland have done all that is necessary (including, without limitation, by re-registering as a private company) to ensure that the relevant Additional Obligor can enter into the Finance Documents and perform its obligations under the Finance Documents without breach of any applicable financial assistance or capital maintenance laws. Such evidence shall include copies of board and special resolutions for each relevant Additional Obligor and copies of the registers of directors and shareholders of each relevant Additional Obligor.
  (b)   If the Additional Obligor is not incorporated in England and Wales or Scotland, such documentary evidence as legal counsel to the Agent may require, that such Additional Obligor:
  (i)   has complied with any law in its jurisdiction relating to financial assistance or analogous process; and
Hogan Lovells

- 112 -


 

  (ii)   has not registered an establishment in the UK under the Overseas Companies Regulations 2009 (SI 2009/1801) as at the date on which it has executed any Transaction Security Document, or if it has, evidence of the registered UK establishment’s full name and registered number.
17.   Evidence that all necessary or desirable Authorisations from any government authority or other regulatory body in connection with the entry into and performance of the transactions contemplated by the Accession Deed or any Finance Document to which the Additional Obligor is party or for the validity or enforceability of any of those documents have been obtained and are in full force and effect, together with certified copies of those obtained.
 
18.   A certificate of the Parent confirming that no Default is continuing or would occur as a result of the Additional Obligor executing the Accession Deed or the Finance Documents to which it is party.
 
19.   Such other information or documents that the Agent may reasonably require, including any information and evidence in respect of the Additional Obligor required by any Finance Party to enable it to be satisfied with the results of all “know your customer” or other checks which it is required to carry out in relation to such Obligor.
 
20.   A copy of the register listing the directors of the Additional Obligor.
Hogan Lovells

- 113 -


 

Schedule 3
Requests
Utilisation Request — Loans
From: [Borrower] [Obligors’ Agent]*
To: [Agent]
Dated:
Dear Sirs
[Parent] — Senior Facilities Agreement dated [ *** ] (the “Facilities Agreement”)
1.   We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This is an Utilisation Request. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in this Utilisation Request unless given a different meaning in this Utilisation Request.
2.   We wish to borrow a Loan on the following terms:
             
 
  (a)   Borrower:   [ *** ]
 
           
 
  (b)   Proposed Utilisation Date:   [ *** ] (or, if that is not a Business Day, the next Business Day)
 
           
 
  (c)   Facility to be utilised:   [Facility A]/[Facility B]**
 
           
 
  (d)   Currency of Loan:   [ *** ]
 
           
 
  (e)   Amount:   [ *** ] or, if less, the Available Facility
 
           
 
  (f)   Interest Period:   [ *** ]
 
           
 
  (g)   The purpose for which the Loan will be borrowed:   [ *** ]
3.   We confirm that each condition specified in Clause 4.2 (Further conditions precedent) is satisfied on the date of this Utilisation Request [*** and confirm that no debt or contingent liability (other than the Parent CIGNA Guarantee) will be incurred to fund and/or support the CIGNA Reinsurance Arrangements ***]***.
 
4.   [The proceeds of this Loan should be credited to [account].]
 
5.   This Utilisation Request is irrevocable.
Yours faithfully
         
   
/s/    
authorised signatory for   
   
 
[the Parent on behalf of] [insert name of relevant Borrower]/[insert name of Borrower]*
 
NOTES:
     
*   Amend as appropriate. The Utilisation Request can be given by the Borrower or by the obligors’ Agent.
 
**   Select the Facility to be utilised and delete references to the other Facilities.
 
***   To be included for a Loan for the purpose set out in Clause 3.1(b)(i).
Hogan Lovells

- 114 -


 

Schedule 4
Mandatory Cost Formula
1.   The Mandatory Cost is an addition to the interest rate to compensate the Lenders for the cost of compliance with:
  (a)   the requirements of the Bank of England and/or the FSA (or, in either case, any other authority which replaces all or any of its functions); or
 
  (b)   the requirements of the European Central Bank.
2.   On the first day of each Interest Period (or as soon as possible thereafter) the Agent shall calculate, as a percentage rate, a rate (the “Additional Cost Rate”) for each Lender in accordance with the paragraphs set out below. The Mandatory Cost will be calculated by the Agent as a weighted average of the Lenders’ Additional Cost Rates (weighted in proportion to the percentage participation of each Lender in the relevant Loans) and will be expressed as a percentage rate per annum.
 
3.   The Additional Cost Rate for any Lender lending from a Facility Office in a Participating Member State will be the percentage notified by that Lender to the Agent. This percentage will be certified by that Lender in its notice to the Agent to be its reasonable determination of the cost (expressed as a percentage of that Lender’s participation in all Loans made from that Facility Office) of complying with the minimum reserve requirements of the European Central Bank in respect of loans made from that Facility Office.
 
4.   The Additional Cost Rate for any Lender lending from a Facility Office in the United Kingdom will be calculated by the Agent as follows:
                 
 
  (a)   in relation to a Sterling Loan:   (GRAPHICS)   per cent per annum
                 
 
  (b)   in relation to a Loan in any currency other than sterling:   (GRAPHICS)   per cent per annum
    where:
      A            is the percentage of Eligible Liabilities (assuming these to be in excess of any stated minimum) which that Lender is from time to time required to maintain as an interest free cash ratio deposit with the Bank of England to comply with cash ratio requirements.
 
      B            is the percentage rate of interest (excluding the Margin and the Mandatory Cost and, if the Loan is an Unpaid Sum, the additional rate of interest specified in paragraph (a) of Clause 10.3 (Default interest)) payable for the relevant Interest Period on the Loan.
 
      C            is the percentage (if any) of Eligible Liabilities which that Lender is required from time to time to maintain as interest bearing Special Deposits with the Bank of England.
 
      D            is the percentage rate per annum payable by the Bank of England to the Agent on interest bearing Special Deposits.
Hogan Lovells

- 115 -


 

  E     is designed to compensate Lenders for amounts payable under the Fees Rules and is calculated by the Agent as being the average of the most recent rates of charge supplied by the Reference Banks to the Agent pursuant to paragraph 7 below and expressed in pounds per £1,000,000.
5.   For the purposes of this Schedule:
  (a)   “Eligible Liabilities” and “Special Deposits” have the meanings given to them from time to time under or pursuant to the Bank of England Act 1998 or (as may be appropriate) by the Bank of England;
 
  (b)   “Fees Rules” means the rules on periodic fees contained in the FSA Supervision Manual or such other law or regulation as may be in force from time to time in respect of the payment of fees for the acceptance of deposits;
 
  (c)   “Fee Tariffs” means the fee tariffs specified in the Fees Rules under the activity group A.1 Deposit acceptors (ignoring any minimum fee or zero rated fee required pursuant to the Fees Rules but taking into account any applicable discount rate); and
 
  (d)   “Tariff Base” has the meaning given to it in, and will be calculated in accordance with, the Fees Rules.
6.   In application of the above formulae, A, B, C and D will be included in the formulae as percentages (i.e. 5 per cent. will be included in the formula as 5 and not as 0.05). A negative result obtained by subtracting D from B shall be taken as zero. The resulting figures shall be rounded to four decimal places.
 
7.   If requested by the Agent, each Reference Bank shall, as soon as practicable after publication by the FSA, supply to the Agent, the rate of charge payable by that Reference Bank to the FSA pursuant to the Fees Rules in respect of the relevant financial year of the FSA (calculated for this purpose by that Reference Bank as being the average of the Fee Tariffs applicable to that Reference Bank for that financial year) and expressed in pounds per £1,000,000 of the Tariff Base of that Reference Bank.
 
8.   Each Lender shall supply any information required by the Agent for the purpose of calculating its Additional Cost Rate. In particular, but without limitation, each Lender shall supply the following information on or prior to the date on which it becomes a Lender:
  (a)   the jurisdiction of its Facility Office; and
 
  (b)   any other information that the Agent may reasonably require for such purpose.
    Each Lender shall promptly notify the Agent of any change to the information provided by it pursuant to this paragraph.
 
9.   The percentages of each Lender for the purpose of A and C above and the rates of charge of each Reference Bank for the purpose of E above shall be determined by the Agent based upon the information supplied to it pursuant to paragraphs 7 and 8 above and on the assumption that, unless a Lender notifies the Agent to the contrary, each Lender’s obligations in relation to cash ratio deposits and Special Deposits are the same as those of a typical bank from its jurisdiction of incorporation with a Facility Office in the same jurisdiction as its Facility Office.
 
10.   The Agent shall have no liability to any person if such determination results in an Additional Cost Rate which over or under compensates any Lender and shall be entitled to assume that the information provided by any Lender or Reference Bank pursuant to paragraphs 3, 7 and 8 above is true and correct in all respects.
Hogan Lovells

- 116 -


 

11.   The Agent shall distribute the additional amounts received as a result of the Mandatory Cost to the Lenders on the basis of the Additional Cost Rate for each Lender based on the information provided by each Lender and each Reference Bank pursuant to paragraphs 3, 7 and 8 above.
 
12.   Any determination by the Agent pursuant to this Schedule in relation to a formula, the Mandatory Cost, an Additional Cost Rate or any amount payable to a Lender shall, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive and binding on all Parties.
 
13.   The Agent may from time to time, after consultation with the Parent and the Lenders, determine and notify to all Parties any amendments which are required to be made to this Schedule in order to comply with any change in law, regulation or any requirements from time to time imposed by the Bank of England, the FSA or the European Central Bank (or, in any case, any other authority which replaces all or any of its functions) and any such determination shall, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive and binding on all Parties.
Hogan Lovells

- 117 -


 

Schedule 5
Form of Transfer Certificate
     
To:
  [ *** ] as Agent and [          ] as Security Agent
 
   
From:
  [The Existing Lender] (the “Existing Lender”) and [The New Lender] (the “New Lender”)
 
   
Dated:
   
[Parent] — Senior Facilities Agreement dated [ *** ] (the “Facilities Agreement”)
1.   We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This agreement (the “Agreement”) shall take effect as a Transfer Certificate for the purpose of the Facilities Agreement. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in this Agreement unless given a different meaning in this Agreement.
 
2.   We refer to Clause 25.5 (Procedure for transfer) of the Facilities Agreement:
  (a)   The Existing Lender and the New Lender agree to the Existing Lender transferring to the New Lender by novation all or part of the Existing Lender’s Commitment, rights and obligations referred to in the Schedule in accordance with Clause 25.5 (Procedure for transfer) [OR] [ *** Each Existing Lender listed in Part 1 of the Schedule transfers by novation to each New Lender listed in Part 2 of the Schedule that portion of the outstanding Loans and Commitments in accordance with Clause 25.5 (Procedure for transfer), such that:
  (i)   each New Lender will become a Lender under the Agreement with the respective Commitment and portion of outstanding Loans set out opposite its name in Part 3 of the Schedule; and
 
  (ii)   each Existing Lender’s Commitment and portion of outstanding Loans will be reduced to the amounts set out opposite its name in Part 3 of the Schedule. *** ]1
  (b)   The proposed Transfer Date is [ *** ].
 
  (c)   The Facility Office and address, fax number and attention details for notices of the New Lender for the purposes of Clause 33.2 (Addresses) are set out in the Schedule.
3.   [ *** The/Each *** ] New Lender expressly acknowledges the limitations on the Existing Lender[’s][s’] obligations set out in paragraph (c) of Clause 25.4 (Limitation of responsibility of Existing Lenders).
 
4.   The New Lender confirms, for the benefit of the Agent and without liability to any Obligor, that it is:
  (a)   [a Qualifying Lender falling within paragraph (i)(1) or paragraph (ii) of the definition of Qualifying Lender;]
 
  (b)   [a Treaty Lender;]
 
  (c)   [not a Qualifying Lender].
5.   [ *** The/Each New Lender confirms that the person beneficially entitled to interest payable to that Lender in respect of an advance under a Finance Document is either:
 
1   This option is for use when there is to be a global transfer certificate.
Hogan Lovells

- 118 -


 

  (a)   a company resident in the United Kingdom for United Kingdom tax purposes; or
 
  (b)   a partnership each member of which is:
  (i)   a company so resident in the United Kingdom; or
 
  (ii)   a company not so resident in the United Kingdom which carries on a trade in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment and which brings into account in computing its chargeable profits (within the meaning of section 19 of the CTA) the whole of any share of interest payable in respect of that advance that falls to it by reason of Part 17 of the CTA; or
  (c)   a company not so resident in the United Kingdom which carries on a trade in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment and which brings into account interest payable in respect of that advance in computing the chargeable profits (within the meaning of section 19 of the CTA) of that company. *** ]
 
  (d)   [The New Lender confirms (for the benefit of the Agent and without liability to any Obligor) that it is a Treaty Lender that holds a passport under the HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme (reference number [ ]) and is tax resident in [insert jurisdiction of tax residence], so that interest payable to it by borrowers is generally subject to full exemption from UK withholding tax and notifies the Parent that the Borrower must, to the extent that the New Lender becomes a Lender under a Facility which is made available to the Borrower pursuant to Clause 2.1 (The Facilities) of the Facilities Agreement, make an application to HM Revenue & Customs under form DTTP2 within 30 days of the Transfer Date. 2
6.   This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and this has the same effect as if the signatures on the counterparts were on a single copy of this Agreement.
 
7.   The New Lender confirms that it [is/is not] a Non-Acceptable L/C Lender3
 
8.   For the purpose of Clause 33.6 (Use of websites) the New Lender is a [ *** Website Lender *** ] [ *** Paper Form Lender *** ] OR [ *** each New Lender specifies in Part 4 of the Schedule opposite its name whether it is a Website Lender or a Paper Form Lender *** ].
 
9.   This Agreement and all non-contractual obligations arising in any way whatsoever out of or in connection with this Agreement shall be governed by, construed and take effect in accordance with English law.
 
10.   This Agreement has been entered into on the date stated at the beginning of this Agreement.
Note:   The execution of this Transfer Certificate may not transfer a proportionate share of the Existing Lender’s interest in the Transaction Security in all jurisdictions. It is the responsibility of the New Lender to ascertain whether any other documents or other formalities are required to perfect a transfer of such a share in the Existing Lender’s Transaction Security in any jurisdiction and, if so, to arrange for execution of those documents and completion of those formalities.
 
2   This confirmation must be included if the New Lender holds a passport under the HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme and wishes that scheme to apply to the Facilities Agreement.
 
3   Include only if the transfer includes the transfer of a RCF commitment/participation.
Hogan Lovells

- 119 -


 

The Schedule
Commitment/rights and obligations to be transferred
[ *** insert relevant details *** ]
[ *** Facility Office address, fax number and attention details for notices and account details for payments *** ]
     
[Existing Lender]
  [New Lender]
 
   
By:
  By:
This Agreement is accepted as a Transfer Certificate for the purposes of the Facilities Agreement by the Agent and the Transfer Date is confirmed as [     ].
[Agent]
By:
[Security Agent]
By:
[ *** OR FOR GLOBAL TRANSFER CERTIFICATES *** ]
Part 1
The Existing Lenders
[ *** ]
[ *** ]
[ *** ]
Part 2
The New Lenders
[ *** ]
[ *** ]
[ *** ]
Hogan Lovells

- 120 -


 

Part 3
Details of portion of outstanding Utilisations and Commitment for each Facility
                 
    Facility A       Facility B    
Lender   Commitment   Utilisation   Commitment   Utilisation
[ *** list here existing and new lenders *** ]
  [ *** ]   [ *** ]   [ *** ]   [ *** ]
Hogan Lovells

- 121 -


 

Part 4
New Lenders’ administrative details
                 
    Facility office   Address for   Account   Website or
    Address/Fax No.   service of notices   for   Paper Form
New Lender   Attention of:   (if different)   Payment   Lender
[ *** ]
  [ *** ]   [ *** ]   [ *** ]   [ *** ]
     
Executed as a Deed by
  )
 
   
[ *** Each Existing Lender *** ]
  ) Authorised Signatory
 
   
Dated:
   
 
   
Executed as a Deed by
  )
 
   
[ *** Each New Lender *** ]
  ) Authorised Signatory
 
   
Dated:
   
 
   
The Transfer Certificate is accepted by the Agent and the Transfer Date is confirmed by the Agent as [ *** ]
  )
 
  )
 
   
Signed by [ *** Agent *** ]
  )
 
   
 
  )
Dated:
Signed by [ *** Security Agent *** ]
Dated:
Hogan Lovells

- 122 -


 

Schedule 6
Form of Assignment Agreement4
To:    [ *** ] as Agent and [ *** ], [ *** ] as Security Agent, [ *** ] as Parent for and on behalf of each Obligor
 
From:    [the Existing Lender] (the “Existing Lender”) and [the New Lender] (the “New Lender”)
 
Dated:    [ *** ]
[Parent] — [ *** ] Senior Facilities Agreement dated [ *** ] (the “Facilities Agreement”)
1.   We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This is an Assignment Agreement. This agreement (the “Agreement”) shall take effect as an Assignment Agreement for the purposes of the Facilities Agreement. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in this Agreement unless given a different meaning in this Agreement.
 
2.   We refer to Clause 25.6 (Procedure for assignment) of the Facilities Agreement.
  (a)   The Existing Lender assigns absolutely to the New Lender all the rights of the Existing Lender under the Facilities Agreement, the other Finance Documents and in respect of the Transaction Security which correspond to that portion of the Existing Lender’s Commitments and participations in Utilisations under the Facilities Agreement as specified in the Schedule.
 
  (b)   The Existing Lender is released from all the obligations of the Existing Lender which correspond to that portion of the Existing Lender’s Commitments and participations in Utilisations under the Facilities Agreement specified in the Schedule.
 
  (c)   The New Lender becomes a Party as a Lender and is bound by obligations equivalent to those from which the Existing Lender is released under paragraph (b) above.
3.   The proposed Transfer Date is [ *** ].
 
4.   On the Transfer Date the New Lender becomes Party to the relevant Finance Documents as a Lender.
 
5.   The Facility office and address, fax number and attention details for notices of the New Lender for the purposes of Clause 33.2 (Addresses) are set out in the Schedule.
 
6.   The New Lender expressly acknowledges the limitations on the Existing Lender’s obligations set out in paragraph (c) of Clause 25.4 (Limitation of responsibility of Existing Lenders).
 
7.   The New Lender confirms, for the benefit of the Agent and without liability to any Obligor, that it is:
  (a)   [a Qualifying Lender (falling within paragraph (i)(1) or paragraph (ii) of the definition of Qualifying Lender);]
 
  (b)   [a Treaty Lender;]
 
  (c)   [not a Qualifying Lender].
 
4   [ *** If the New Lender considers it necessary to make this transfer effective against third parties, it may arrange for this assignment to be notified to the French Obligors by bailiff in accordance with Article 1690 of the French Civil Code. *** ]

- 123 -


 

8.   [ *** The New Lender confirms that the person beneficially entitled to interest payable to that Lender in respect of an advance under a Finance Document is either:
  (a)   a company resident in the United Kingdom for United Kingdom tax purposes; or
 
  (b)   a partnership each member of which is:
  (i)   a company so resident in the United Kingdom; or
 
  (ii)   a company not so resident in the United Kingdom which carries on a trade in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment and which brings into account in computing its chargeable profits (within the meaning of section 19 of the CTA) the whole of any share of interest payable in respect of that advance that falls to it by reason of Part 17 of the CTA; or
  (c)   a company not so resident in the United Kingdom which carries on a trade in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment and which brings into account interest payable in respect of that advance in computing the chargeable profits (within the meaning of Section 19 of the CTA) of that company. *** ]
9.   [The New Lender confirms (for the benefit of the Agent and without liability to any Obligor) that it is a Treaty Lender that holds a passport under the HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme (reference number [ ]) and is tax resident in [insert jurisdiction of tax residence], so that interest payable to it by borrowers is generally subject to full exemption from UK withholding tax and notifies the Parent that the Borrower must, to the extent that the New Lender becomes a Lender under a Facility which is made available to the Borrower pursuant to Clause 2.1 (The Facilities) of the Facilities Agreement, make an application to HM Revenue & Customs under form DTTP2 within 30 days of the Transfer Date.] 5
 
10.   This Agreement acts as notice to the Agent (on behalf of each Finance Party) and upon delivery in accordance with Clause 25.7 (Copy of Transfer Certificate or Assignment Agreement to Parent) to the Parent (on behalf of each Obligor) of the assignment referred to in this Assignment Agreement.
 
11.   The New Lender confirms that it [is/is not] a non-Acceptable L/C Lender.6
 
12.   This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and this has the same effect as if the signatures on the counterparts were on a single copy of this Assignment Agreement.
 
13.   For the purpose of Clause 33.6 (Use of websites) the New Lender is a [ *** Website Lender *** ] [ *** Paper Form Lender *** ].
 
14.   This Agreement and all non-contractual obligations arising in any way whatsoever out of or in connection with this Assignment Agreement shall be governed by, construed and take effect in accordance with English law.
 
15.   This Agreement has been [ *** entered into *** ] on the date stated at the beginning of this Agreement.
Note:   The execution of this Assignment Agreement may not transfer a proportionate share of the Existing Lender’s interest in the Transaction Security in all jurisdictions. It is the responsibility of the New Lender to ascertain whether any other documents or other formalities are required to perfect a transfer of such a share in the Existing Lender’s Transaction Security in any jurisdiction and, if so, to arrange for execution of those documents and completion of those formalities. Security in any jurisdiction and, if so, to arrange for execution of those documents and completion of those formalities.
 
5   This confirmation must be included if the New Lender holds a passport under the HMRC DT Treaty Passport scheme and wishes that scheme to apply to the Facilities Agreement.
 
6   Include only if the assignment includes any RCF commitment/participation.

- 124 -


 

The Schedule
Commitment/rights and obligations to be transferred by assignment,
release and accession
[ *** insert relevant details *** ]
[ *** Facility office address, fax number and attention details for notices and account details for payments *** ]
     
[ *** Existing Lender *** ]
  [ *** New Lender *** ]
 
   
By:
  By:
This Agreement is accepted as an Assignment Agreement for the purposes of the Facilities Agreement by the Agent and by the Security Agent, and the Transfer Date is confirmed as [ *** ].
[ *** Signature of this Agreement by the Agent constitutes confirmation by the Agent of receipt of notice of the assignment referred to in this Agreement, which notice the Agent receives on behalf of each Finance Party. *** ]
[ *** Agent *** ]
By:
[ *** Security Agent *** ]
By:

- 125 -


 

Schedule 7
Form of Accession Deed
To:    [ *** ] as Agent and [ *** ] as Security Agent for itself and each of the other parties to the Facilities Agreement referred to below
 
From:    [Subsidiary] and [Parent]
Dated:
Dear Sirs
[Parent] — Senior Facilities Agreement dated [ *** ] (the “Facilities Agreement”)
1.   We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This deed (the “Accession Deed”) shall take effect as an Accession Deed for the purposes of the Facilities Agreement. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in paragraphs 1-3 of this Accession Deed unless given a different meaning in this Accession Deed.
 
2.   [Subsidiary] agrees to become an Additional [Guarantor]/[Chargor] and to be bound by the terms of the Facilities Agreement and the other Finance Documents as an Additional [Guarantor]/[Chargor] pursuant Clause 27.2 (Additional Guarantors)] of the Facilities Agreement. [Subsidiary] is a company duly incorporated under the laws of [name of relevant jurisdiction] and is a limited liability company and registered number [ *** ].
 
3.   [Subsidiary’s] administrative details for the purposes of the Facilities Agreement are as follows:
       Address:
       Fax No.:
       Attention:
4.   [Subsidiary] (for the purposes of this paragraph 4, (the “Acceding Debtor”) intends to [incur Liabilities under the following documents]/[give a guarantee, indemnity or other assurance against loss in respect of Liabilities under the following documents]:
 
    [Insert details (date, parties and description) of relevant documents]
 
    the “Relevant Documents”.
 
    It is agreed as follows:
  (a)   Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement shall, unless otherwise defined in this Accession Deed, bear the same meaning when used in this paragraph 4.
 
  (b)   The Acceding Debtor and the Security Agent agree that the Security Agent shall hold:
  (i)   [any Security in respect of Liabilities created or expressed to be created pursuant to the Relevant Documents;
 
  (ii)   all proceeds of that Security; and]7
 
7   Include to the extent that the Security created in the Relevant Documents is expressed to be granted to the Security Agent as trustee for the Secured Parties.

- 126 -


 

  (iii)   all obligations expressed to be undertaken by the Acceding Debtor to pay amounts in respect of the Liabilities to the Security Agent as trustee for the Secured Parties (in the Relevant Documents or otherwise) and secured by the Transaction Security together with all representations and warranties expressed to be given by the Acceding Debtor (in the Relevant Documents or otherwise) in favour of the Security Agent as trustee for the Secured Parties,
    on trust for the Secured Parties on the terms and conditions contained in the Facilities Agreement.
5.   This Accession Deed and all non-contractual obligations arising in any way whatsoever out of or in connection with this Accession Deed shall be governed by, construed and take effect in accordance with English law.
This Accession Deed has been signed on behalf of the Security Agent (for the purposes of paragraph 4 above only), signed on behalf of the Parent and executed as a deed by [Subsidiary] and is delivered on the date stated above.
         
[Subsidiary]
       
 
       
[Executed as a Deed
    )  
 
       
by: [Subsidiary]
    )  
 
       
Director
       
 
       
Director/Secretary
       
 
       
OR
       
 
       
[Executed as a Deed
    )  
 
       
by: [Subsidiary]
    )  
     
Signature of Director:
  ____________________________
 
   
Name of Director:
  ____________________________
 
   
in the presence of:
   
 
   
Signature of witness:
  ____________________________
 
   
Name of witness:
  ____________________________
 
   
Address of witness:
  ____________________________
     
 
  ____________________________
 
   
 
  ____________________________
 
   
 
  ____________________________
 
   
 
  ____________________________
 
   
Occupation of witness:]
  ____________________________

- 127 -


 

The Parent
[Parent]
By:
The Security Agent
[Full name of Current Security Agent]
By:
Date:

- 128 -


 

Schedule 8
Form of Compliance Certificate
     
To:
  Barclays Bank PLC as Agent
 
   
From:
  Enstar Group Limited (the “Parent”)
Dated:
Dear Sirs
Enstar Group Limited — Senior Facilities Agreement dated [ *** ] December 2010 (the “Facilities Agreement”)
1.   We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This is a Compliance Certificate. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning when used in this Compliance Certificate unless given a different meaning in this Compliance Certificate.
 
2.   We confirm that, as at the end of the Relevant Period ending [***]:
  (a)   Gearing Ratio
 
      Total Debt was [***] and Consolidated Tangible Net Worth was [***], therefore, the Gearing Ration was [***];
 
  (b)   Minimum Net Worth
 
      Consolidated Tangible Net Worth was [***];
 
  (c)   Regulatory Cover
  (i)   each member of the Group holds capital resources of [***] which are not less than the amount that it is required to hold in accordance with applicable law and applicable rules and guidance given by any regulator, including, without limitation, its Pillar 1 Capital Requirement, its ICA Capital Requirement and its ICG Capital Requirement; and
 
  (ii)   the Group Capital Resources of the Group are [***] which are not less than the Group Capital Requirement; and
  (d)   UK Security Cover
  (i)   the aggregate of the total assets less total liabilities and (without double counting) Intra-Group Indebtedness of each member of the Secured Group (each as set out in the relevant financial statements of such member of the Secured Group) was [***]; and
 
  (ii)   the amount of outstanding Loans was [***],
      therefore, the ratio of (i) above to (ii) above was [***].
3.   We confirm that no Default is continuing.8
Signed:
 
8   If this statement cannot be made, the certificate should identify any Default that is continuing and the steps, if any, being taken to remedy it.

- 129 -


 

       
       
  Director of Enstar Group Limited   Director of Enstar Group Limited
[insert applicable certification language]9
 
for and on behalf of
[name of Auditors of the Parent]10
 
9   To be agreed with the Parent’s Auditors and the Lenders prior to signing the Agreement.
 
10   Only applicable if the Compliance Certificate accompanies the audited financial statements and is to be signed by the Auditors. To be agreed with the Parent’s auditor’s prior to signing the Agreement.

- 130 -


 

Schedule 9
Timetables
Loans
             
        Loans in   Loans in other
    Loans in euro   sterling   currencies
Delivery of a duly completed Utilisation Request (Clause 5.1 (Delivery of a Utilisation Request))
  U-3
9.30 a.m.
  U-1
9.30 a.m.
  U-3
9.30 a.m.
 
           
Agent determines (in relation to a Utilisation) the Base Currency Amount of the Loan, if required under Clause 5.4 (Lenders’ participation) and notifies the Lenders of the Loan in accordance with Clause 5.4 (Lenders’ participation)
  U-3
Noon
  U-1
Noon
  U-3
Noon
 
           
LIBOR is fixed
  Quotation Day
as of 11.00 a.m.
  Quotation
Day as of
11.00 a.m.
  Quotation Day
as of
11.00 a.m.
         
“U”
  =   date of utilisation or, if applicable, in the case of a Loan that has already been borrowed, the first day of the relevant Interest Period for that Loan.
 
       
“U-X”
  =   X Business Days prior to date of utilisation

- 131 -


 

Schedule 10
Security provisions
1.   Declaration of Trust
 
    The Security Agent and each other Finance Party agree that the Security Agent shall hold the Security Property in trust for the benefit of the Finance Parties on the terms of the Finance Documents.
 
2.   Defects in security
 
    The Security Agent shall not be liable for any failure or omission to perfect, or defect in perfecting, the Security created pursuant to any Security Document, including:
  (a)   failure to obtain any Authorisation for the execution, validity, enforceability or admissibility in evidence of any Security Document; or
 
  (b)   failure to effect or procure registration of or otherwise protect or perfect any of the Security created by the Security Documents under any laws in any territory.
3.   No enquiry
 
    The Security Agent may accept without enquiry, requisition, objection or investigation such title as the Borrower may have to any Charged Assets.
 
4.   Retention of documents
 
    The Security Agent may hold title deeds and other documents relating to any of the Charged Assets in such manner as it sees fit (including allowing the Borrower to retain them).
 
5.   Indemnity out of the Security Property
 
    The Security Agent and every receiver, delegate, attorney, agent or other similar person appointed under any Security Document may indemnify itself out of the Security Property against any cost, loss or liability incurred by it in that capacity (otherwise than by reason of its own gross negligence or wilful misconduct).
 
6.   Basis of distribution
 
    To enable it to make any distribution, the Security Agent may fix a date as at which the amount of the Secured Liabilities is to be calculated and may require, and rely on, a certificate from any Finance Party giving details of:
  (a)   any sums due or owing to any Finance Party as at that date; and
 
  (b)   such other matters as it thinks fit.
7.   Rights of Security Agent
 
    The Security Agent shall have all the rights, privileges and immunities which gratuitous trustees have or may have in England, even though it is entitled to remuneration.
 
8.   No duty to collect payments
 
    The Security Agent shall not have any duty:
  (a)   to ensure that any payment or other financial benefit in respect of any of the Charged Assets is duly and punctually paid, received or collected; or

- 132 -


 

  (b)   to ensure the taking up of any (or any offer of any) stocks, shares, rights, moneys or other property accruing or offered at any time by way of interest, dividend, redemption, bonus, rights, preference, option, warrant or otherwise in respect of any of the Charged Assets.
9.   Perpetuity period
 
    The perpetuity period for the trusts created by the Finance Documents shall be 80 years from the date of this Agreement.
 
10.   Appropriation
  (a)   Each Party irrevocably waives any right to appropriate any payment to, or other sum received, recovered or held by, the Security Agent in or towards payment of any particular part of the Secured Liabilities and agrees that the Security Agent shall have the exclusive right to do so.
 
  (b)   Sub-paragraph (a) above will override any application made or purported to be made by any other person.
11.   Investments
 
    All money received or held by the Security Agent under the Finance Documents may, in the name of, or under the control of, the Security Agent:
  (a)   be invested in any investment it may select; or
 
  (b)   be deposited at such bank or institution (including itself, any other Finance Party or any Affiliate of any Finance Party) as it thinks fit.
12.   Suspense account
 
    Subject to paragraph 13 below the Security Agent may:
  (a)   hold in an interest bearing suspense account any money received by it from the Borrower or any other person; and
 
  (b)   invest an amount equal to the balance from time to time standing to the credit of that suspense account in any of the investments authorised by paragraph 11 above.
13.   Timing of distributions
 
    Distributions by the Security Agent shall be made as and when determined by it.
 
14.   Delegation
  (a)   The Security Agent may:
  (i)   employ and pay an agent selected by it to transact or conduct any business and to do all acts required to be done by it (including the receipt and payment of money);
 
  (ii)   delegate to any person on any terms (including power to sub-delegate) all or any of its functions; and
 
  (iii)   with the prior consent of the Majority Lenders, appoint, on such terms as it may determine, or remove, any person to act either as separate or joint

- 133 -


 

      security trustee or agent with those rights and obligations vested in the Security Agent by this Agreement or any Security Document.
  (b)   The Security Agent will not be:
  (i)   responsible to anyone for any misconduct or omission by any agent, delegate or security trustee or agent appointed by it pursuant to sub-paragraph (a) above; or
 
  (ii)   bound to supervise the proceedings or acts of any such agent, delegate or security trustee or agent,
      provided that it exercises reasonable care in selecting that agent, delegate or security trustee or agent.
15.   Unwinding
 
    Any appropriation or distribution which later transpires to have been or is agreed by the Security Agent to have been invalid or which has to be refunded shall be refunded and shall be deemed never to have been made.
 
16.   Lenders
 
    The Security Agent shall be entitled to assume that each Lender is a Lender unless notified by the Agent to the contrary.

- 134 -


 

Schedule 11
Structure chart showing ownership of Enstar’s subsidiaries.
Hogan Lovells

- 135 -


 

Part 2
Structure chart showing ownership of Enstar’s subsidiaries.
Hogan Lovells

- 136 -


 

Part 311
Structure chart showing ownership of Enstar’s subsidiaries.
 
11   Awaiting part 4
Hogan Lovells

- 137 -


 

Part 4
Structure chart showing ownership of Enstar’s subsidiaries.
Hogan Lovells

- 138 -


 

Schedule 12
The Secured Group
Part 1
Members of the Secured Group whose shares are subject to Transaction Security
             
    Registered   Jurisdiction of
Name of member of Secured Group   Number   Incorporation
Brampton Insurance Company Limited
    01272965     England and Wales
Unione Italiana (UK) Reinsurance Company Limited
    00199059     England and Wales
River Thames Insurance Company Limited
    00462838     England and Wales
Cavell Insurance Company Limited
    00157661     England and Wales
Mercantile Indemnity Company Limited
    01500302     England and Wales
Fieldmill Insurance Company Limited
    01457354     England and Wales
Longmynd Insurance Company Limited
    01454023     England and Wales
Hillcot Re Limited
    01457317     England and Wales
Marlon Insurance Company Limited
    00998720     England and Wales
Cumberland Holdings Limited
    40161     Bermuda
Part 2
Members of the Secured Group whose shares are not subject to Transaction Security
             
    Registered   Jurisdiction of
Name of member of Secured Group   Number   Incorporation
Enstar Australia Holdings Pty Ltd
    128812546     Australia
AG Australia Holdings Limited
    054573401     Australia
Gordian RunOff Limited
    052179647     Australia
The Copenhagen Reinsurance Limited
          Denmark
The Copenhagen Reinsurance Company (UK) Limited
    00088079     England and Wales
Copenhagen Reinsurance Services Limited
    03447398     England and Wales
Hogan Lovells

- 139 -


 

Schedule 13
Intercompany Loans
             
        Amount of
Name of lender under   Name of Borrower under   Intercompany
Intercompany Loan   Intercompany Loan   Loan
Brittany Insurance Company Limited
  BH Acquisitions Limited     10,000,000  
Hudson Reinsurance Company Limited
  Kenmare Holdings Limited     3,500,000  
Rosemont Reinsurance Limited
  Goshawk Holdings (Bermuda) Limited     500,000  
Overseas Reinsurance Corporation Limited
  Revir Limited     18,000,000  
Enstar Limited
  Enstar Group Limited     17,300,000  
Fitzwilliam Insurance Limited
  Kenmare Holdings Limited     2,800,000  
 
  Total     52,100,000  

- 140 -


 

Schedule 14
Existing Security
Part 1
Chargors
                                 
            Security            
            document            
            registered at            
    Registered   Companies   Date   Date    
Company Name   Number   House   created   registered   Person entitled
Cavell Holdings Limited
    1095628     Charge over shares     06.12.06       20.12.06     National Australia Bank Limited
Part 2
Secured Group — Letter of credit / ordinary course security
                                 
            Security            
            document            
            registered at            
    Registered   Companies   Date   Date    
Company Name   Number   House   created   registered   Person entitled
Cavell Insurance Company Limited
    157661     Security agreement     17.12.92       30.12.92     Citibank N.A.
 
          Amendment letter     15.02.94       22.02.94     Citibank N.A
 
          Security agreement     30.03.98       08.04.98     Citibank N.A
 
          Reinsurance deposit agreement     30.03.98       14.04.98     Citibank N.A.
Marlon Insurance Company Limited
    998720     Security agreement     15.11.95       24.11.95     Citibank N.A.
 
          Reinsurance deposit agreement     15.11.95       24.11.95     Citibank N.A.
Longmynd Insurance Company Limited
    1454023     Charge     06.11.87       26.11.87     Citibank N.A.
Fieldmill Insurance Company Limited
    1457354     Charge     06.11.87       14.11.87     Citibank N.A
River Thames Insurance Company Limited
    462838     Reinsurance deposit agreement     11.07.88       20.07.88     Citibank N.A

- 141 -


 

                                 
            Security            
            document            
            registered at            
    Registered   Companies   Date   Date    
Company Name   Number   House   created   registered   Person entitled
 
          Security agreement     11.07.88       20.07.88     Citibank N.A
 
          Security agreement     06.01.89       11.01.89     Citibank N.A
 
          Security agreement     12.06.90       19.06.90     Citibank N.A
 
          Security agreement     02.01.96       09.01.96     Citibank N.A
Brampton Insurance Company Limited
    1272965     Reinsurance deposit agreement     23.02.96       29.02.96     Citibank N.A.
Unione Italiana (UK) Reinsurance Company Limited
    199059     Charge     02.12.87       09.12.87     Citibank N.A.
Hillcot Re Limited
    1457317     Charge     19.11.87       02.12.87     Citibank N.A.
Knapton Insurance Limited
    14644     Reinsurance deposit agreement     25.09.09       12.10.09     Citibank N.A.
The Copenhagen Reinsurance Company (UK) Limited
    88079     Charge     01.10.84       18.10.84     The Chase Manhattan Bank N.A.
 
          Reinsurance deposit agreement     09.11.89       24.11.89     Bank of Montreal, Citibank N.A.
 
          Deposit charge     20.02.90       05.03.90     Barclays Bank PLC
 
          Security Agreement     25.11.91       02.12.91     Citibank N.A.
 
          Fixed (ASIC Charge No: 1344262)     16.08.06       25.08.06     079478612. The Royal Bank of Scotland N.V.
Gordian Runoff Limited
    052179647     Fixed (ASIC Charge No: 373330)     30.12.92       25.01.93     004325080, Citigroup Pty Limited
 
          Fixed (ASIC Charge No: 1344254)     16.08.06       25.08.06     004325080, Citigroup Pty Limited
 
          Fixed (ASIC Charge No: 1344258)     16.08.06       25.08.06     079478612. The Royal Bank of Scotland N.V.

- 142 -


 

                                 
            Security            
            document            
            registered at            
    Registered   Companies   Date   Date    
Company Name   Number   House   created   registered   Person entitled
 
          Fixed (ASIC Charge No: 1344262)     16.08.06       25.08.06     079478612. The Royal Bank of Scotland N.V.
 
          Floating (ASIC Charge No: 373432)     21.12.92       27.01.93     064874531, Bank of America, National Association
 
          Fixed (ASIC Charge No: 510034)     13.09.95       04.10.95     064874531, Bank of America, National Association
Part 3
Secured Group — Security to be released as a Condition Subsequent
                                 
            Security            
            document            
            registered at            
    Registered   Companies   Date   Date    
Company Name   Number   House   created   registered   Person entitled
Enstar Australia Holdings Pty Limited
    128812546     Fixed (ASIC Charge No: 1596644)     28.02.08       29.02.08     004044937, National Australia Bank Limited
AG Australia Holdings Limited
    054573401     Fixed (ASIC Charge No: 1614223)     25.03.08       03.04.08     004044937, National Australia Bank Limited

- 143 -


 

Signatures
The Parent
         
Enstar Group Limited
 
         
By:
  /s/ Paul O’Shea
 
    
Address:   Windsor Place, 3rd Floor, 18 Queen Street,
Hamilton 11, Bermuda
Fax:
  +1 441 296 0895    
 
       
The Borrower    
 
       
Enstar Group Limited    
 
       
By:
  /s/ Paul O’Shea
 
   
Address:   Windsor Place, 3rd Floor, 18 Queen Street,
Hamilton 11, Bermuda
Fax:
  +1 441 296 0895    
 
       
The Original Guarantors    
 
       
Enstar Group Limited    
 
       
By:
  /s/ Paul O’Shea
 
   
Address:   Windsor Place, 3rd Floor, 18 Queen Street,
Hamilton 11, Bermuda
Fax:
  +1 441 296 0895    
 
       
 
       
Hillcot Holdings Limited    
 
       
By:
  /s/ Paul O’Shea
 
   
Address:   Windsor Place, 3rd Floor, 18 Queen Street,
Hamilton 11, Bermuda
Fax:
  +1 441 296 0895    

- 144 -


 

         
Virginia Holdings Limited    
 
       
By:
  /s/ Paul O’Shea
 
   
Address:   Windsor Place, 3rd Floor, 18 Queen Street,
Hamilton 11, Bermuda
Fax:
  +1 441 296 0895    
 
       
Revir Limited    
 
       
By:
  /s/ Elizabeth DaSilva
 
   
Address:   Windsor Place, 3rd Floor, 18 Queen Street,
Hamilton 11, Bermuda
Fax:
  +1 441 296 0895    
 
       
Kenmare Holdings Limited    
 
       
By:
  /s/ Paul O’Shea
 
   
Address:   Windsor Place, 3rd Floor, 18 Queen Street,
Hamilton 11, Bermuda
Fax:
  +1 441 296 0895    
 
       
Cavell Holdings Limited    
 
       
By:
  /s/ Gareth Nokes
 
   
Address:   Avaya House, 2 Cathedral Hill, Guildford,
Surrey, GU2 7YL
Fax:
  +44 1483 452644    
 
       
Flatts Limited    
 
       
By:
  /s/ Gareth Nokes
 
   
Address:   Avaya House, 2 Cathedral Hill, Guildford,
Surrey, GU2 7YL
Fax:
  +44 1483 452644    

- 145 -


 

         
The Arranger    
 
       
Barclays Corporate    
 
       
By:
  /s/ Richard Braham
 
   
Address:   Barclays Corporate, Level 28, 1 Churchill Place,
Canary Wharf, London E14 5HP
Fax:
  +44 20 7116 7636    
 
       
Attention:
  John Atkinson    
 
  Debt Finance    
 
  Transaction Management    
 
  Barclays Corporate    
 
       
The Agent    
 
       
Barclays Bank PLC    
 
       
By:
  /s/ Richard Braham
 
   
Address:   5 The North Colonnade, Canary Wharf,
London E14 4BB
Fax:
  +44 (0)20 7773 4893    
 
       
Attention:
  Duncan Nash    
 
       
The Security Agent    
 
       
Barclays Bank PLC    
 
       
By:
  /s/ Richard Braham
 
   
Address:   5 The North Colonnade, Canary Wharf,
London E14 4BB
Fax:
  +44 (0)20 7773 4893    
 
       
Attention:
  Duncan Nash    

- 146 -


 

         
The Original Lender    
 
       
Barclays Bank PLC    
 
       
By:
  /s/ Richard Braham
 
   
Address:   Barclays Corporate, Level 11, 1 Churchill Place,
London, E14 5HP United Kingdom
Fax:
  +44 20 7116 7643    
 
       
Attention:
  Richard Braham    
 
  Relationship Director    
 
  Non Bank Financial Institutions    
 
  Barclays Corporate    

- 147 -

exv10w25
Exhibit 10.25
ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
2011-2015 ANNUAL INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PROGRAM

 


 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
         
    Page
1. PURPOSES
    1  
2. DEFINITIONS
    1  
3. BONUS POOL
    2  
4. BENEFICIARY DESIGNATION
    3  
5. DELIVERY TO GUARDIAN
    3  
6. SOURCE OF SHARES
    3  
7. ADMINISTRATION
    3  
8. AMENDMENT AND TERMINATION
    3  
9. TAX WITHHOLDING
    3  
10. HEADINGS
    3  
11. PLAN
    4  
APPENDIX A
    A-1  
APPENDIX B
    B-1  

i


 

ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
2011-2015 ANNUAL INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PROGRAM
          WHEREAS, Enstar Group Limited, a Bermuda corporation (the “Company”), has previously established the Castlewood Holdings Limited 2006 Equity Incentive Plan (the “Plan”), primarily in order to award equity-based benefits to certain officers and other key employees of the Company and its “Related Corporations” (as defined in the Plan);
          WHEREAS, one kind of equity-based benefit that can be awarded under the Plan is “Bonus Shares” (as defined in the Plan); and
          WHEREAS, the Company desires to establish an annual incentive compensation program for each of the 2011, 2012, 2013, 2014, and 2015 calendar years (the “Program”) for the benefit of certain officers and other key employees of the Company and its Related Corporations whereby such officers and key employees would be awarded cash, Bonus Shares, or a combination thereof, each as set forth in the Program, upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth below.
          NOW, THEREFORE, effective as of January 1, 2011, the Program is hereby adopted by the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors of the Company (the “Committee”) with the following terms and conditions:
     1. Purposes. The purpose of the Program is to motivate certain officers and employees of the Company to grow the Company’s profitability.
     2. Definitions.
          (a) “Award” means an award of Bonus Shares and cash to a Participant in accordance with Section 3 of the Program.
          (b) “Change in Control” means “Change in Control” as such term is defined in a Participant’s employment agreement or, if a Participant does not have an employment agreement with the Company or any Related Corporation, as such term is defined in the Plan.
          (c) “CEO” means the Chief Executive Officer of Company.
          (d) “Measurement Period” means each of the 2011, 2012, 2013, 2014 and 2015 calendar years. In the event of a Change in Control during any such year, the Measurement Period shall be the period beginning on the first day of such year and ending on the date of the Change in Control.
          (e) “Participant” means each of the individuals whose names are set forth in Appendix A attached hereto and who is employed during the Measurement Period, and such other individuals as the Committee may determine taking into consideration the recommendations of the CEO. Within 60 days after the end of any Measurement Period, the Committee shall, taking into consideration the recommendations of the CEO, identify those individuals in addition to those identified on Appendix A who shall be entitled to participate for such Measurement Period and shall determine the percentage of the Bonus Pool to be received by each Participant for such Measurement Period. In the event a Change in Control occurs

 


 

within the Measurement Period, the Committee shall make such determinations within 60 days prior to the date of the Change in Control.
          (f) “Senior Management” means the Chief Executive Officer, Chief Operating Officers, and Chief Financial Officer of the Company.
          (g) “Shares” means “Common Shares” as defined in the Plan.
     3. Bonus Pool.
          (a) For each Measurement Period in which the Company has any Consolidated Net After-Tax Profits, the Company shall pay to each Participant, in cash, Bonus Shares, or a combination thereof, as determined by the Committee, an amount determined by multiplying the Bonus Pool by the percentage (expressed as a decimal) of the Bonus Pool allocated to each Participant. The portion of such amount to be paid to the Participant in Bonus Shares (rounded down to the nearest whole number of Shares) shall be determined by dividing the portion of the Bonus Pool payable to the Participant in Bonus Shares by the Share Value (based on the average Share Value over the 5 trading days following the release of the Company’s earnings for the Measurement Period). Awards settled in Bonus Shares will be payable under the Program to the extent that Shares remain available for issuance under the Plan. If the total number of Bonus Shares to be awarded with respect to any Measurement Period exceeds the number of Shares available for issuance under the Plan, then the number of Bonus Shares payable to each Participant will be reduced on a pro rata basis based on each individual Participant’s percentage for that Measurement Period, and Participants will receive the unpaid portion of their Award as a cash payment instead.
          (b) The following terms shall be defined as set forth below:
               (1) “Bonus Pool” means, for any Measurement Period, a percentage of the Company’s Consolidated Net After-Tax Profits for such Measurement Period. The guideline for this percentage is 15% but this percentage can be varied by the Committee for any Measurement Period no later than 30 days from the end of the Measurement Period. If, for any Measurement Period, the Company does not have any Consolidated Net After-Tax Profits, the Bonus Pool for such Measurement Period shall be zero.
               (2) “Share Value” means “Fair Market Value” as defined in the Plan.
               (3) “Consolidated Net After-Tax Profits” means for each year ending on December 31, the net earnings for that year as recorded in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Earnings plus any bonus expense recorded in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Earnings for such year.
          (c) Within 60 days after the end of the Measurement Period, the Committee shall notify each Participant of the Award (if any) to such Participant under the Program. If an Award is to be paid under the Program, it shall be paid to Participants no later than March 31 following the applicable Measurement Period (or, if a Change in Control occurs during a Measurement Period, within 30 days after the last day of the Measurement Period ending on the date of the Change in Control).

2


 

     4. Beneficiary Designation.
          (a) Each Participant shall designate the person(s) or entities as the beneficiary(ies) to whom the Participant’s Award shall be paid in the event of the Participant’s death prior to the payment of such Award to him or her. Each beneficiary designation shall be substantially in the form set forth in Appendix B attached hereto and shall be effective only when filed with the Committee during the Participant’s lifetime.
          (b) Any beneficiary designation may be changed by a Participant without the consent of any previously designated beneficiary or any other person or entity, unless otherwise required by law, by the filing of a new beneficiary designation with the Committee. The filing of a new beneficiary designation shall cancel all beneficiary designations previously filed.
          (c) If any Participant fails to designate a beneficiary in the manner provided above, or if the beneficiary designated by a Participant predeceases the Participant, the Committee shall direct such Participant’s Award to be paid to the Participant’s surviving spouse or, if the Participant has no surviving spouse, then to the Participant’s estate.
     5. Delivery to Guardian. If an Award is payable under this Program to a minor, a person declared incompetent or a person incapable of handling the disposition of property, the Committee may direct the payment of the Award to the guardian, legal representative or person having the care and custody of the minor, incompetent or incapable person. The Committee may require proof of incompetency, minority, incapacity or guardianship as the Committee may deem appropriate prior to the delivery. The payment shall completely discharge the Committee, the members of the Board of Directors of the Company or any Related Corporation, the Company and any Related Corporation from all liability with respect to the Award paid.
     6. Source of Shares. This Program shall be unfunded, and the payment of Bonus Shares shall be pursuant to the Plan. Each Participant and beneficiary shall be a general and unsecured creditor of the Company and any Related Corporation to the extent of the Award determined hereunder, and the Participant shall have no right, title or interest in any specific asset that the Company or any Related Corporation may set aside, earmark or identify as for the payment of an Award under the Program. The obligations of the Company and any Related Corporation under the Program shall be merely that of an unfunded and unsecured promise to pay cash and Bonus Shares in the future.
     7. Administration. This Program shall be administered by the Committee.
     8. Amendment and Termination. The Board of Directors of the Company reserves the right to amend the Program with respect to any Measurement Period, by written resolution, at any time within 90 days of the commencement of such Measurement Period.
     9. Tax Withholding. The payment of cash and Bonus Shares to a Participant or beneficiary under this Program shall be subject to any applicable tax withholding.
     10. Headings. The headings of the Sections and subsections of the Program are for reference only. In the event of a conflict between a heading and the content of a Section or subsection, the content of the Section or subsection shall control.
     11. Plan. Because Bonus Shares may be awarded under the Program, the terms and conditions of the Plan are hereby incorporated by reference in connection with issuance of Bonus

3


 

Shares. If any terms of the Program conflict with the terms of the Plan, the terms of the Program shall control. Nothing contained herein shall limit the ability of the Committee to issue Bonus Shares under the Plan.

4


 

APPENDIX A
ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
2011-2015 ANNUAL INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PROGRAM
PARTICIPANTS
 
Name
Dominic Silvester
Paul O’Shea
Nicholas Packer
Richard Harris
David Rocke
Such other individuals as the Committee may determine from time to time taking into account the recommendations of Senior Management.

A-1


 

APPENDIX B
ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
2011-2015 ANNUAL INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PROGRAM
BENEFICIARY DESIGNATION FORM
     This Form is for your use under the Enstar Group Limited 2011-2015 Annual Incentive Compensation Program (the “Program”) to name a beneficiary for an Award that may be paid to you from the Program. You should complete the Form, sign it, have it signed by your employer, and date it.
* * * *
     I understand that in the event of my death before I receive an Award that may be payable to me under the Program, the Award will be paid to the beneficiary designated by me below or, if none or if my designated beneficiary predeceases me, to my surviving spouse or, if none, to my estate. I further understand that the last beneficiary designation filed by me during my lifetime and accepted by the Company cancels all prior beneficiary designations previously filed by me under the Program.
     I hereby state that ____________________________ [insert name], residing or having its principal place of business at _____________________ [insert address], [whose Social Security number is __________________,] [whose employer identification or similar number is ________________] is designated as my beneficiary.
           
 
     
 
Signature of Participant
      Date
 
       
 
      ACCEPTED:
 
       
 
       
 
      [insert name of employer]
 
       
 
      By:  
 
         
 
       
 
      Date

B-1

exv21w1
ENSTAR GROUP LIMITED
LISTING OF SUBSIDIARIES
DECEMBER 31 2010
         
    % of Voting    
Name   Securities   Jurisdiction
 
       
Enstar Group Limited
  N/A   Bermuda
 
       
A. Cumberland Holdings Limited
  100%   Bermuda
1) Enstar Australia Holdings Pty Limited
  100%   Australia
a) Enstar Australia Ltd.
  100%   Australia
i) Cranmore Adjusters (Australia) Pty Ltd.
  100%   Australia
b) AG Australia Holdings Lts
  100%   Australia
i) Gordian Run-off Limited
  100%   Australia
c) Shelly Bay Holdings Ltd.
  100%   Australia
i) Church Bay Limited
  100%   Australia
ii) Harrington Sound Limited
  100%   Australia
I) TGI Australia Limited
  100%   Australia
 
       
B. Enstar Limited
  100%   Bermuda
1) Enstar (EU) Holdings Ltd.
  100%   England
a) Enstar (EU) Ltd.
  100%   England
b) Cranmore Adjusters Limited
  100%   England
2) Cranmore (Bermuda) Limited
  100%   Bermuda
a) Cranmore (Asia) Ltd
  100%   Bermuda
3) Enstar Brokers Limited
  100%   Bermuda
4) Castlewood (Bermuda) Ltd.
  100%   Bermuda
5) Bantry Holdings Ltd.
  50%   Bermuda
a) Blackrock Holdings Ltd.
  30%   Bermuda
i) Kinsale Brokers Limited
  100%   England
 
       
C. Kenmare Holdings Limited
  100%   Bermuda
1) Fitzwilliam Insurance Limited
  100%   Bermuda
2) Revir Limited
  100%   Bermuda
a) River Thames Insurance Company
  100%   England
b) Overseas Reinsurance Corporation Limited
  100%   Bermuda
c) Regis Agencies Limited
  100%   England
3) Hudson Reinsurance Company Limited
  100%   Bermuda
a) Denman Holdings Limited
  100%   Barbados
b) Chatsworth Limited
  100%   Bermuda
i) Global Legacy Acquisition LP
  98%   Bermuda
4) Harper Holding Sarl
  100%   Luxembourg
a) Harper Insurance Limited
  100%   Switzerland
i) Harper Financing Limited
  100%   England
b) Enstar Holdings (US) Inc.
  100%   Delaware
i) Enstar (US) Inc.
  100%   Delaware
A) Enstar New York, Inc
  100%   New York
I) Financial Guaranty Advisers, LLC
  33%   Delaware
ii) Cranmore (US) Inc.
  100%   Delaware
iii) Enstar Investments, Inc.
  100%   Delaware
A) Sun Gulf Holdings, Inc.
  100%   Delaware
I) Capital Assurance Company
  100%   Florida
II) Capital Assurance Services, Inc.
  100%   Florida
III) Constellation Reinsurance
  100%   New York
B) CLIC Holdings, Inc.
  100%   Delaware
I) Claremont Insurance Company
  100%   California
C) PWAC Holdings, Inc.
  100%   Delaware
I) Providence Washington Insurance Solutions, LLC
  100%   Rhode Island
II) PW Acquisition Co.
  100%   Rhode Island
x) Providence Washington Holdings, Inc
  100%   Rhode Island
xi) PW Holdings, Inc
  100%   Rhode Island
xii) Providence Washington Insurance Company
  100%   Rhode Island
xiia) York Insurance Company
  100%   Rhode Island
xiib) American Concept Insurance Company
  100%   Rhode Island
5) Mercantile Indemnity Company Ltd.
  100%   England
6) Longmynd Insurance Company Ltd.
  100%   England
7) Fieldmill Insurance Company Ltd.
  100%   England
8) Virginia Holdings Ltd.
  100%   Bermuda
a) Unione Italiana (UK) Reinsurance Company
  100%   England
b) Seaton Insurance Company
  100%   Rhode Island
c) Cavell Holdings Limited (U.K.)
  100%   England
i) Cavell Insurance Company Limited
  100%   England

 


 

         
    % of Voting    
Name   Securities   Jurisdiction
 
       
9) Tate & Lyle Reinsurance Ltd.
  100%   Bermuda
10) Courtenay Holdings Ltd
  100%   Bermuda
a) Enstar Acquisitions Limited
  100%   England
i) Goshawk Insurance Holdings plc
  99.45%(4)   England
A) Goshawk Holdings (Bermuda) Limited
  100%   Bermuda
I) Rosemont Reinsurance Limited
  100%   Bermuda
B) Goshawk Dedicated Limited
  100%   England
b) Simcoe Holdings Limited
  100%   Bermuda
i) Electricity Producers Insurance Company (Bermuda) Ltd.
  100%   Bermuda
c) Royston Holdings Limited
  100%   Bermuda
i) Royston Run-off Ltd
  100%   England
A) Unionamerica Holdings Limited
  100%   England
I) Unionamerica Acquisition Company Limited
  100%   England
xa) Unionamerica Insurance Company Limited
  100%   England
xb) SPRE Limited
  100%   England
d) Rombalds Limited
  100%   England
i) Guildhall Insurance Company Ltd.
  100%   England
11) Comox Holdings Ltd
  100%   Bermuda
a) Bosworth Run-Off Limited
  100%   England
12) Sundown Holdings Limited
  100%   Bermuda
13) Oceania Holdings Ltd.
  100%   Bermuda
a) Inter-Ocean Holdings Limited
  100%   Bermuda
i) Inter-Ocean Reinsurance Company Ltd.
  100%   Bermuda
A) Inter-Ocean Reinsurance (Ireland) Ltd.
  95.0%(2)   Ireland
14) Flatts Limited
  100%   England
a) Marlon Insurance Company Limited
  100%   England
i) Marlon Management Services Limited
  100%   England
ii) The Copenhagen Reinsurance Limited
  100%   Denmark
A) The Copenhagen Reinsurance Company (UK) Limited
  100%   England
I) Copenhagen Reinsurance Services Limited
  100%   England
15) Shelbourne Group Limited
  56.80%   England
a) SGL No 1 Ltd.
  100%   England
b) Shelbourne Syndicate Services Ltd
  100%   England
16) Hillcot Re Limited
  100%   England
a) Hillcot Underwriting Management
  100%   England
17) Northshore Holdings Limited
  100%   Bermuda
18) Hove Holdings Limited
  100%   Bermuda
a) Mongard Limited
  100%   Bermuda
19) Nordic Run-off Limited
  100%   England
a) Forsakringsaktiebolaget Assuransinvest Limited
  100%   Sweden
20) Knapton Holdings Limited
  100%   England
a) Knapton Insurance Limited
  100%   England
21) New Castle Reinsurance Company Limited
  100%   Bermuda
 
       
D. Hillcot Holdings Limited
  100%   Bermuda
1) Brampton Insurance Company Limited
  100%   England
 
       
E. Enstar USA, Inc.
  100%   Georgia
1) Enstar Financial Services, Inc.
  100%   Florida
2) Enstar Group Operations, Inc.
  100%   Georgia
 
       
B.H. Acquisition Ltd.
  100%(3)   Bermuda
1) Brittany Insurance Company Ltd.
  100%   Bermuda
2) Paget Holdings GmbH Ltd.
  100%   Austria
a) Compagnie Europeenne d’Assurances Industrielles SA
  99.9%(1)   Belgium
 
(1)   The remaining 0.1% of the company’s voting securities is owned directly by Brittany Insurance Company Ltd.
 
(2)   The remaining 5.0% of the company’s voting securities is owned directly by Inter-Ocean Holdings Limited
 
(3)   B.H. Acquisition Ltd. is 33% owned by Enstar USA, Inc. and 67% owned by Enstar Limited
 
(4)   Goshawk Insurance Holdings plc is 89.44% owned by Enstar Acquisition Ltd. and 10.01% owned by Kenmare Holdings Limited

 

exv23w1
Exhibit 23.1
CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
We consent to the incorporation by reference in Registration Statements No. 333-149551, 333-148863, 333-148862 and 333-141793 on Form S-8 of our report dated March 4, 2011, relating to the consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule of Enstar Group Limited and subsidiaries (the “Company”), and the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting, appearing in the Annual Report on Form 10-K of Enstar Group Limited and subsidiaries for the year ended December 31, 2010.
/s/ Deloitte & Touche
Hamilton, Bermuda
March 4, 2011

exv31w1
EXHIBIT 31.1
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO
RULE 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a),
AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 302
OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002
I, Dominic F. Silvester, certify that:
1.   I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Enstar Group Limited;
 
2.   Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
 
3.   Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
 
4.   The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
  a.   Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
 
  b.   Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
 
  c.   Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
 
  d.   Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5.   The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
  a.   All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
 
  b.   Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.
Dated: March 4, 2011
         
     
/s/ Dominic F. Silvester    
Dominic F. Silvester    
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer   

 

exv31w2
         
EXHIBIT 31.2
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO
RULE 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a),
AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 302
OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002
I, Richard J. Harris, certify that:
1.   I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Enstar Group Limited;
 
2.   Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
 
3.   Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
 
4.   The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
  a.   Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
 
  b.   Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
 
  c.   Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
 
  d.   Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5.   The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
  a.   All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
 
  b.   Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.
Dated: March 4, 2011
         
     
/s/ Richard J. Harris    
Richard J. Harris    
Chief Financial Officer   

 

exv32w1
         
EXHIBIT 32.1
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO
18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350,
AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 906
OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002
          In connection with the Annual Report of Enstar Group Limited (the “Company”) on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, Dominic F. Silvester, certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. section 1350, as adopted pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that to the best of my knowledge:
  (1)   The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and
 
  (2)   The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.
Dated: March 4, 2011
         
     
/s/ Dominic F. Silvester    
Dominic F. Silvester    
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer   

 

exv32w2
         
EXHIBIT 32.2
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO
18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350,
AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 906
OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002
          In connection with the Annual Report of Enstar Group Limited (the “Company”) on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, Richard J. Harris, certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. section 1350, as adopted pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that to the best of my knowledge:
  (1)   The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and
 
  (2)   The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.
Dated: March 4, 2011
         
     
/s/ Richard J. Harris    
Richard J. Harris    
Chief Financial Officer